poly_int: GET_MODE_NUNITS
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blob2b6e5888a2aafef6496e0213bbb8b5cf86b2d03d
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
4 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
5 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7 This file is part of GCC.
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
10 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
11 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
12 version.
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
15 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
16 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
17 for more details.
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
23 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
24 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
25 out locations for types and decls.
26 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
27 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
29 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
30 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
31 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
32 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
33 information. */
35 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
37 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
38 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
39 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
40 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
41 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
43 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
44 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
46 CIE = Common Information Entry
47 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
49 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
51 FDE = Frame Description Entry
52 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
53 how to restore registers
55 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
56 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
58 #include "config.h"
59 #include "system.h"
60 #include "coretypes.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "function.h"
63 #include "rtl.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "memmodel.h"
66 #include "tm_p.h"
67 #include "stringpool.h"
68 #include "insn-config.h"
69 #include "ira.h"
70 #include "cgraph.h"
71 #include "diagnostic.h"
72 #include "fold-const.h"
73 #include "stor-layout.h"
74 #include "varasm.h"
75 #include "version.h"
76 #include "flags.h"
77 #include "rtlhash.h"
78 #include "reload.h"
79 #include "output.h"
80 #include "expr.h"
81 #include "dwarf2out.h"
82 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
83 #include "toplev.h"
84 #include "md5.h"
85 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
86 #include "print-rtl.h"
87 #include "debug.h"
88 #include "common/common-target.h"
89 #include "langhooks.h"
90 #include "lra.h"
91 #include "dumpfile.h"
92 #include "opts.h"
93 #include "tree-dfa.h"
94 #include "gdb/gdb-index.h"
95 #include "rtl-iter.h"
96 #include "stringpool.h"
97 #include "attribs.h"
99 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, unsigned int, const char *,
100 int, bool);
101 static rtx_insn *last_var_location_insn;
102 static rtx_insn *cached_next_real_insn;
103 static void dwarf2out_decl (tree);
105 #ifndef XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
106 #define XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO 0
107 #endif
109 #ifndef HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS
110 #define HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS 0
111 #endif
113 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
114 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
116 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
117 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
118 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
119 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
120 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
121 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
122 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
123 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
124 #else
125 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
126 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
127 #endif
129 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
130 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
131 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
132 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
133 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
134 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
135 #endif
137 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
138 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
139 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
140 #endif
142 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
143 must be kept around forever. */
144 static GTY(()) vec<rtx, va_gc> *used_rtx_array;
146 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
147 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
148 vec<tree, va_gc> *because we want to tell the garbage collector about
149 it. */
150 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *incomplete_types;
152 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
153 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
154 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
155 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
156 define type declaration DIE's. */
157 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *decl_scope_table;
159 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_info_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
163 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_abbrev_section;
164 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
165 static GTY(()) section *debug_addr_section;
166 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
167 static const char *debug_macinfo_section_name;
168 static unsigned macinfo_label_base = 1;
169 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
170 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_line_section;
171 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
172 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
173 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
174 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
175 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_str_section;
176 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_dwo_section;
177 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_offsets_section;
178 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
179 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
181 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
182 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 40
184 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
185 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
186 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
187 bytes.
189 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
190 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
192 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
193 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
194 #endif
196 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR
197 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "-4" : "-12")
198 #endif
200 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
201 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
202 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
204 /* CIE identifier. */
205 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
206 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
207 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
208 #else
209 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
210 #endif
213 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
214 information for each routine. */
215 #define NOT_INDEXED (-1U)
216 #define NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED (-2U)
218 static GTY(()) vec<dw_fde_ref, va_gc> *fde_vec;
220 struct GTY((for_user)) indirect_string_node {
221 const char *str;
222 unsigned int refcount;
223 enum dwarf_form form;
224 char *label;
225 unsigned int index;
228 struct indirect_string_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<indirect_string_node>
230 typedef const char *compare_type;
232 static hashval_t hash (indirect_string_node *);
233 static bool equal (indirect_string_node *, const char *);
236 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_str_hash;
238 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_line_str_hash;
240 /* With split_debug_info, both the comp_dir and dwo_name go in the
241 main object file, rather than the dwo, similar to the force_direct
242 parameter elsewhere but with additional complications:
244 1) The string is needed in both the main object file and the dwo.
245 That is, the comp_dir and dwo_name will appear in both places.
247 2) Strings can use four forms: DW_FORM_string, DW_FORM_strp,
248 DW_FORM_line_strp or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index.
250 3) GCC chooses the form to use late, depending on the size and
251 reference count.
253 Rather than forcing the all debug string handling functions and
254 callers to deal with these complications, simply use a separate,
255 special-cased string table for any attribute that should go in the
256 main object file. This limits the complexity to just the places
257 that need it. */
259 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *skeleton_debug_str_hash;
261 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
263 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
264 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
266 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
267 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
268 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
270 /* The default cold text section. */
271 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
273 /* The DIE for C++14 'auto' in a function return type. */
274 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref auto_die;
276 /* The DIE for C++14 'decltype(auto)' in a function return type. */
277 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref decltype_auto_die;
279 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
281 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
282 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
284 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
285 personality CFI. */
286 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
288 /* Whether an eh_frame section is required. */
289 static GTY(()) bool do_eh_frame = false;
291 /* .debug_rnglists next index. */
292 static unsigned int rnglist_idx;
294 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
295 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
296 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
298 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
299 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
300 #endif
302 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
303 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
304 #endif
306 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
307 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
308 #endif
310 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
311 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
312 #endif
314 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
315 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
316 #endif
318 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
319 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
320 #endif
321 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
322 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
323 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
324 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
325 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
326 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
327 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
328 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
329 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
330 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
332 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
334 static int
335 matches_main_base (const char *path)
337 /* Cache the last query. */
338 static const char *last_path = NULL;
339 static int last_match = 0;
340 if (path != last_path)
342 const char *base;
343 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
344 last_path = path;
345 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
346 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
348 return last_match;
351 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
353 static int
354 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
355 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
356 int matches, int result)
358 /* Find the type name. */
359 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
360 tree t = type_decl;
361 const char *name = 0;
362 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
363 t = DECL_NAME (t);
364 if (t)
365 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
367 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
368 criterion,
369 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
370 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
371 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
372 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
373 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
374 result,
375 (void*) type_decl, name);
376 return result;
378 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
379 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
381 #else
383 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
384 (result)
386 #endif
388 /* Get the number of HOST_WIDE_INTs needed to represent the precision
389 of the number. Some constants have a large uniform precision, so
390 we get the precision needed for the actual value of the number. */
392 static unsigned int
393 get_full_len (const wide_int &op)
395 int prec = wi::min_precision (op, UNSIGNED);
396 return ((prec + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)
397 / HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
400 static bool
401 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
403 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
404 tree type_decl;
405 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
407 if (generic)
408 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
409 else
410 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
412 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
413 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
414 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
415 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
417 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
419 if (type_decl != NULL)
421 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
422 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
424 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
425 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
428 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
431 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
432 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
433 for collect2 the first time around. */
435 static void
436 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
438 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
440 int flags;
442 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
444 int fde_encoding;
445 int per_encoding;
446 int lsda_encoding;
448 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
449 /*global=*/0);
450 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
451 /*global=*/1);
452 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
453 /*global=*/0);
454 flags = ((! flag_pic
455 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
456 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
457 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
458 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
459 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
460 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
461 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
463 else
464 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
466 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
467 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
468 #else
469 eh_frame_section = ((flags == SECTION_WRITE)
470 ? data_section : readonly_data_section);
471 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
474 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
476 #ifdef EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
477 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Emit special labels to guide
478 collect2. */
479 if (!back)
481 tree label = get_file_function_name ("F");
482 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
483 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
484 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
485 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
487 #endif
490 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
491 FOR_EH. */
493 static void
494 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
496 if (for_eh)
497 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
498 else
500 if (!debug_frame_section)
501 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
502 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
503 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
507 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
509 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
510 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
512 switch (cfi)
514 case DW_CFA_nop:
515 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
516 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
517 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
518 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
520 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
521 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
522 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
523 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
524 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
525 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
527 case DW_CFA_offset:
528 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
529 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
530 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
531 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
532 case DW_CFA_restore:
533 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
534 case DW_CFA_undefined:
535 case DW_CFA_same_value:
536 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
537 case DW_CFA_register:
538 case DW_CFA_expression:
539 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
540 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
542 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
543 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
544 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
545 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
547 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
548 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
550 default:
551 gcc_unreachable ();
555 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
557 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
558 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
560 switch (cfi)
562 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
563 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
564 case DW_CFA_offset:
565 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
566 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
567 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
569 case DW_CFA_register:
570 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
572 case DW_CFA_expression:
573 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
574 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
576 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
577 return dw_cfi_oprnd_cfa_loc;
579 default:
580 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
584 /* Output one FDE. */
586 static void
587 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
588 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
589 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
591 const char *begin, *end;
592 static unsigned int j;
593 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
595 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
596 /* empty */ 0);
597 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
598 for_eh + j);
599 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
600 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
601 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
603 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
604 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
605 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
606 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
607 "FDE Length");
609 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
611 if (for_eh)
612 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
613 else
614 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
615 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
617 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
618 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
620 if (for_eh)
622 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
623 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
624 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
625 "FDE initial location");
626 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
627 end, begin, "FDE address range");
629 else
631 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
632 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
635 if (augmentation[0])
637 if (any_lsda_needed)
639 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
641 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
643 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
644 + 4 /* CIE offset */
645 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
646 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
647 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
649 size += pad;
650 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
653 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
655 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
657 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
658 fde->funcdef_number);
659 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
660 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
661 false,
662 "Language Specific Data Area");
664 else
666 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
667 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
668 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
669 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
672 else
673 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
676 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE. */
677 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
679 size_t from, until, i;
681 from = 0;
682 until = vec_safe_length (fde->dw_fde_cfi);
684 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
686 else if (!second)
687 until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
688 else
689 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
691 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
692 output_cfi ((*fde->dw_fde_cfi)[i], fde, for_eh);
695 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
696 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
697 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
698 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
699 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
701 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
702 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
703 switch *back* into the table section. */
704 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
705 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
706 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
707 #endif
709 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
710 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
711 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
712 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
714 j += 2;
717 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
719 static bool
720 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
722 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
723 return true;
725 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
726 return true;
728 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
729 return true;
731 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
732 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
733 return false;
735 return true;
738 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
739 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
740 location of saved registers. */
742 static void
743 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
745 unsigned int i;
746 dw_fde_ref fde;
747 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
748 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
749 char section_start_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
750 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
751 char augmentation[6];
752 int augmentation_size;
753 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
754 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
755 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
756 int return_reg;
757 rtx personality = NULL;
758 int dw_cie_version;
760 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
761 if (!fde_vec)
762 return;
764 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
765 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
766 return;
768 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
769 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
770 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
771 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
772 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
773 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
774 if (for_eh)
776 bool any_eh_needed = false;
778 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
780 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
781 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
782 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
783 any_eh_needed = true;
784 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
785 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
788 if (!any_eh_needed)
789 return;
792 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
793 if (flag_debug_asm)
794 app_enable ();
796 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
797 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
799 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
800 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
802 /* Output the CIE. */
803 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
804 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
805 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
807 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
808 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
809 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
810 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
811 "Length of Common Information Entry");
813 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
815 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
816 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
817 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
818 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
819 "CIE Identifier Tag");
821 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
822 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
823 due to overflowing the return register column. */
824 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
825 dw_cie_version = 1;
826 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
827 dw_cie_version = 3;
828 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
830 augmentation[0] = 0;
831 augmentation_size = 0;
833 personality = current_unit_personality;
834 if (for_eh)
836 char *p;
838 /* Augmentation:
839 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
840 augmentation section.
841 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
842 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
843 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
844 FDE code pointers.
845 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
846 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
848 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
849 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
850 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
852 p = augmentation + 1;
853 if (personality)
855 *p++ = 'P';
856 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
857 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
859 if (any_lsda_needed)
861 *p++ = 'L';
862 augmentation_size += 1;
864 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
866 *p++ = 'R';
867 augmentation_size += 1;
869 if (p > augmentation + 1)
871 augmentation[0] = 'z';
872 *p = '\0';
875 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
876 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
878 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
879 + 4 /* CIE Id */
880 + 1 /* CIE version */
881 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
882 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
883 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
884 + 1 /* RA column */
885 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
886 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
887 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
889 augmentation_size += pad;
891 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
892 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
893 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
897 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
898 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
900 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
901 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
903 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
904 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
905 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
907 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
908 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
909 else
910 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
912 if (augmentation[0])
914 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
915 if (personality)
917 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
918 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
919 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
920 personality,
921 true, NULL);
924 if (any_lsda_needed)
925 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
926 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
928 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
929 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
930 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
933 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
934 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
936 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
937 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
938 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
939 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
941 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
942 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
944 unsigned int k;
946 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
947 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
948 continue;
950 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
951 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
952 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
955 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
956 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
958 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
959 if (flag_debug_asm)
960 app_disable ();
963 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
965 static void
966 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
968 int enc;
969 rtx ref;
971 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
973 /* .cfi_personality and .cfi_lsda are only relevant to DWARF2
974 eh unwinders. */
975 if (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2)
976 return;
978 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
980 if (personality)
982 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
983 ref = personality;
985 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
986 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
987 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
988 of the weirder relocation types. */
989 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
990 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
992 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
993 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
994 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
997 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
999 char lab[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1001 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
1002 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
1003 current_function_funcdef_no);
1004 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
1005 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
1007 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
1008 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
1010 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
1011 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
1012 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1016 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE. Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
1017 this allocation may be done before pass_final. */
1019 dw_fde_ref
1020 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
1022 dw_fde_ref fde;
1024 fde = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_fde_node> ();
1025 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
1026 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
1027 fde->fde_index = vec_safe_length (fde_vec);
1028 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
1029 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
1030 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
1031 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1032 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1034 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
1035 cfun->fde = fde;
1036 vec_safe_push (fde_vec, fde);
1038 return fde;
1041 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
1042 the prologue. */
1044 void
1045 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1046 unsigned int column ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1047 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1049 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1050 char * dup_label;
1051 dw_fde_ref fde;
1052 section *fnsec;
1053 bool do_frame;
1055 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
1057 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
1059 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
1060 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
1061 if (!do_frame
1062 && (!flag_exceptions
1063 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
1064 return;
1066 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
1067 switch_to_section (fnsec);
1068 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1069 current_function_funcdef_no);
1070 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1071 current_function_funcdef_no);
1072 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
1073 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
1075 /* We can elide FDE allocation if we're not emitting frame unwind info. */
1076 if (!do_frame)
1077 return;
1079 /* Unlike the debug version, the EH version of frame unwind info is a per-
1080 function setting so we need to record whether we need it for the unit. */
1081 do_eh_frame |= dwarf2out_do_eh_frame ();
1083 /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
1084 emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
1085 would include pass_dwarf2_frame. If we've not created the FDE yet,
1086 do so now. */
1087 fde = cfun->fde;
1088 if (fde == NULL)
1089 fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1091 /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier. */
1092 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1093 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1094 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1095 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1097 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1098 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
1099 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1100 if (file)
1101 dwarf2out_source_line (line, column, file, 0, true);
1102 #endif
1104 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1105 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1106 else
1108 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1109 if (!current_unit_personality)
1110 current_unit_personality = personality;
1112 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1113 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1114 function anymore. */
1115 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1116 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1117 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1121 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1122 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1123 been generated. */
1125 void
1126 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1127 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1129 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1131 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1132 function. */
1133 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1134 current_function_funcdef_no);
1135 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1136 current_function_funcdef_no);
1137 cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1140 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1141 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1142 been generated. */
1144 void
1145 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1146 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1148 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1149 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1151 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1152 return;
1154 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1155 function. */
1156 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1157 current_function_funcdef_no);
1158 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1159 current_function_funcdef_no);
1160 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1163 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1164 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1165 been generated. */
1167 void
1168 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1169 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1171 dw_fde_ref fde;
1172 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1174 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
1175 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
1177 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1178 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1180 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1181 function. */
1182 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1183 current_function_funcdef_no);
1184 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1185 fde = cfun->fde;
1186 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1187 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1188 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1191 void
1192 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1194 /* Output call frame information. */
1195 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1196 output_call_frame_info (0);
1198 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
1199 if (do_eh_frame)
1200 output_call_frame_info (1);
1203 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
1205 static void
1206 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1208 section *sec = current_function_section ();
1209 if (sec == text_section)
1210 text_section_used = true;
1211 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1212 cold_text_section_used = true;
1215 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1216 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1218 void
1219 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1221 section *sect;
1222 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1224 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1226 if (!in_cold_section_p)
1228 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1229 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
1230 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1232 else
1234 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1235 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
1236 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1238 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1240 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
1241 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1242 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1244 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1245 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1247 /* Now do the real section switch. */
1248 sect = current_function_section ();
1249 switch_to_section (sect);
1251 fde->second_in_std_section
1252 = (sect == text_section
1253 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1255 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1256 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1258 var_location_switch_text_section ();
1260 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1261 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1264 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1265 for emitting location expressions. */
1267 /* Data about a single source file. */
1268 struct GTY((for_user)) dwarf_file_data {
1269 const char * filename;
1270 int emitted_number;
1273 /* Describe an entry into the .debug_addr section. */
1275 enum ate_kind {
1276 ate_kind_rtx,
1277 ate_kind_rtx_dtprel,
1278 ate_kind_label
1281 struct GTY((for_user)) addr_table_entry {
1282 enum ate_kind kind;
1283 unsigned int refcount;
1284 unsigned int index;
1285 union addr_table_entry_struct_union
1287 rtx GTY ((tag ("0"))) rtl;
1288 char * GTY ((tag ("1"))) label;
1290 GTY ((desc ("%1.kind"))) addr;
1293 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1294 so you can track variables that are in different places over
1295 their entire life. */
1296 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1297 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1298 const char *begin; /* Label and addr_entry for start of range */
1299 addr_table_entry *begin_entry;
1300 const char *end; /* Label for end of range */
1301 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1302 Only on head of list */
1303 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1304 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1305 hashval_t hash;
1306 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1307 resolved. */
1308 bool resolved_addr;
1309 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
1310 bool replaced;
1311 /* True if it has been emitted into .debug_loc* / .debug_loclists*
1312 section. */
1313 unsigned char emitted : 1;
1314 /* True if hash field is index rather than hash value. */
1315 unsigned char num_assigned : 1;
1316 /* True if .debug_loclists.dwo offset has been emitted for it already. */
1317 unsigned char offset_emitted : 1;
1318 /* True if note_variable_value_in_expr has been called on it. */
1319 unsigned char noted_variable_value : 1;
1320 /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1321 are the same. */
1322 bool force;
1323 } dw_loc_list_node;
1325 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (poly_int64);
1326 static dw_loc_descr_ref uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
1328 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
1330 static const char *
1331 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1333 const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1335 if (name != NULL)
1336 return name;
1338 return "OP_<unknown>";
1341 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
1342 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1343 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
1345 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1346 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1347 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1349 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
1351 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1352 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1353 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
1354 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1355 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1356 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_entry = NULL;
1357 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1359 return descr;
1362 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
1364 static inline void
1365 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1367 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1369 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1370 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1373 *d = descr;
1376 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality. */
1378 static bool
1379 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1381 if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1382 return false;
1383 switch (a->val_class)
1385 case dw_val_class_none:
1386 return true;
1387 case dw_val_class_addr:
1388 return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1390 case dw_val_class_offset:
1391 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1392 case dw_val_class_const:
1393 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
1394 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
1395 case dw_val_class_range_list:
1396 /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned. */
1397 return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1399 case dw_val_class_loc:
1400 return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1401 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1402 return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1403 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1404 return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1405 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1406 return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1407 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1408 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1409 case dw_val_class_macptr:
1410 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
1411 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
1412 return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1413 case dw_val_class_str:
1414 return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1415 case dw_val_class_flag:
1416 return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1417 case dw_val_class_file:
1418 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
1419 return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1420 case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1421 return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1423 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1424 return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1425 && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1427 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1428 return *a->v.val_wide == *b->v.val_wide;
1430 case dw_val_class_vec:
1432 size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1433 size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1435 return (a_len == b_len
1436 && !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1439 case dw_val_class_data8:
1440 return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1442 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1443 return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1444 && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1446 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
1447 return (a->v.val_discr_value.pos == b->v.val_discr_value.pos
1448 && a->v.val_discr_value.v.uval == b->v.val_discr_value.v.uval);
1449 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
1450 /* It makes no sense comparing two discriminant value lists. */
1451 return false;
1453 gcc_unreachable ();
1456 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality. */
1458 static bool
1459 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1461 if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1462 return false;
1464 /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1465 address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1466 should be zero for other types of locations. */
1467 if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1468 return false;
1470 return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1471 && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1474 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality. */
1476 bool
1477 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1479 while (1)
1481 if (a == b)
1482 return true;
1483 if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1484 return false;
1485 if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1486 return false;
1488 a = a->dw_loc_next;
1489 b = b->dw_loc_next;
1494 /* Add a constant POLY_OFFSET to a location expression. */
1496 static void
1497 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, poly_int64 poly_offset)
1499 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1500 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1502 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1504 if (known_eq (poly_offset, 0))
1505 return;
1507 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1508 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1511 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1512 if (!poly_offset.is_constant (&offset))
1514 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (poly_offset);
1515 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
1516 return;
1519 p = NULL;
1520 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1521 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1522 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1523 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1524 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1526 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1527 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
1528 if (p != NULL
1529 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1530 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1531 *p += offset;
1533 else if (offset > 0)
1534 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1536 else
1538 loc->dw_loc_next
1539 = uint_loc_descriptor (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) offset);
1540 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1544 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1545 REG and OFFSET. */
1547 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1548 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, poly_int64 offset)
1550 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
1551 if (offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
1553 if (reg <= 31)
1554 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1555 const_offset, 0);
1556 else
1557 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, const_offset);
1559 else
1561 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = new_reg_loc_descr (reg, 0);
1562 loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, offset);
1563 return ret;
1567 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
1569 static void
1570 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, poly_int64 offset)
1572 dw_loc_list_ref d;
1573 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1574 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1577 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
1578 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1580 /* The number of bits that can be encoded by largest DW_FORM_dataN.
1581 In DWARF4 and earlier it is DW_FORM_data8 with 64 bits, in DWARF5
1582 DW_FORM_data16 with 128 bits. */
1583 #define DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS \
1584 (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 128 : 64)
1586 /* Utility inline function for construction of ops that were GNU extension
1587 before DWARF 5. */
1588 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
1589 dwarf_OP (enum dwarf_location_atom op)
1591 switch (op)
1593 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1594 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1595 return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer;
1596 break;
1598 case DW_OP_entry_value:
1599 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1600 return DW_OP_GNU_entry_value;
1601 break;
1603 case DW_OP_const_type:
1604 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1605 return DW_OP_GNU_const_type;
1606 break;
1608 case DW_OP_regval_type:
1609 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1610 return DW_OP_GNU_regval_type;
1611 break;
1613 case DW_OP_deref_type:
1614 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1615 return DW_OP_GNU_deref_type;
1616 break;
1618 case DW_OP_convert:
1619 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1620 return DW_OP_GNU_convert;
1621 break;
1623 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1624 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1625 return DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret;
1626 break;
1628 default:
1629 break;
1631 return op;
1634 /* Similarly for attributes. */
1635 static inline enum dwarf_attribute
1636 dwarf_AT (enum dwarf_attribute at)
1638 switch (at)
1640 case DW_AT_call_return_pc:
1641 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1642 return DW_AT_low_pc;
1643 break;
1645 case DW_AT_call_tail_call:
1646 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1647 return DW_AT_GNU_tail_call;
1648 break;
1650 case DW_AT_call_origin:
1651 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1652 return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1653 break;
1655 case DW_AT_call_target:
1656 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1657 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target;
1658 break;
1660 case DW_AT_call_target_clobbered:
1661 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1662 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered;
1663 break;
1665 case DW_AT_call_parameter:
1666 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1667 return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1668 break;
1670 case DW_AT_call_value:
1671 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1672 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value;
1673 break;
1675 case DW_AT_call_data_value:
1676 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1677 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value;
1678 break;
1680 case DW_AT_call_all_calls:
1681 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1682 return DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites;
1683 break;
1685 case DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls:
1686 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1687 return DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites;
1688 break;
1690 case DW_AT_dwo_name:
1691 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1692 return DW_AT_GNU_dwo_name;
1693 break;
1695 default:
1696 break;
1698 return at;
1701 /* And similarly for tags. */
1702 static inline enum dwarf_tag
1703 dwarf_TAG (enum dwarf_tag tag)
1705 switch (tag)
1707 case DW_TAG_call_site:
1708 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1709 return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site;
1710 break;
1712 case DW_TAG_call_site_parameter:
1713 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1714 return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter;
1715 break;
1717 default:
1718 break;
1720 return tag;
1723 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1725 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
1727 static unsigned long
1728 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1730 unsigned long size = 1;
1732 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1734 case DW_OP_addr:
1735 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1736 break;
1737 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
1738 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
1739 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
1740 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index);
1741 break;
1742 case DW_OP_const1u:
1743 case DW_OP_const1s:
1744 size += 1;
1745 break;
1746 case DW_OP_const2u:
1747 case DW_OP_const2s:
1748 size += 2;
1749 break;
1750 case DW_OP_const4u:
1751 case DW_OP_const4s:
1752 size += 4;
1753 break;
1754 case DW_OP_const8u:
1755 case DW_OP_const8s:
1756 size += 8;
1757 break;
1758 case DW_OP_constu:
1759 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1760 break;
1761 case DW_OP_consts:
1762 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1763 break;
1764 case DW_OP_pick:
1765 size += 1;
1766 break;
1767 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1768 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1769 break;
1770 case DW_OP_skip:
1771 case DW_OP_bra:
1772 size += 2;
1773 break;
1774 case DW_OP_breg0:
1775 case DW_OP_breg1:
1776 case DW_OP_breg2:
1777 case DW_OP_breg3:
1778 case DW_OP_breg4:
1779 case DW_OP_breg5:
1780 case DW_OP_breg6:
1781 case DW_OP_breg7:
1782 case DW_OP_breg8:
1783 case DW_OP_breg9:
1784 case DW_OP_breg10:
1785 case DW_OP_breg11:
1786 case DW_OP_breg12:
1787 case DW_OP_breg13:
1788 case DW_OP_breg14:
1789 case DW_OP_breg15:
1790 case DW_OP_breg16:
1791 case DW_OP_breg17:
1792 case DW_OP_breg18:
1793 case DW_OP_breg19:
1794 case DW_OP_breg20:
1795 case DW_OP_breg21:
1796 case DW_OP_breg22:
1797 case DW_OP_breg23:
1798 case DW_OP_breg24:
1799 case DW_OP_breg25:
1800 case DW_OP_breg26:
1801 case DW_OP_breg27:
1802 case DW_OP_breg28:
1803 case DW_OP_breg29:
1804 case DW_OP_breg30:
1805 case DW_OP_breg31:
1806 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1807 break;
1808 case DW_OP_regx:
1809 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1810 break;
1811 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1812 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1813 break;
1814 case DW_OP_bregx:
1815 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1816 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1817 break;
1818 case DW_OP_piece:
1819 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1820 break;
1821 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1822 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1823 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1824 break;
1825 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1826 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1827 size += 1;
1828 break;
1829 case DW_OP_call2:
1830 size += 2;
1831 break;
1832 case DW_OP_call4:
1833 size += 4;
1834 break;
1835 case DW_OP_call_ref:
1836 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
1837 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1838 break;
1839 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1840 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1841 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1842 break;
1843 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1844 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1845 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1846 break;
1847 case DW_OP_entry_value:
1848 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1850 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1851 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1852 break;
1854 case DW_OP_const_type:
1855 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1857 unsigned long o
1858 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1859 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1860 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1862 case dw_val_class_vec:
1863 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1864 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1865 break;
1866 case dw_val_class_const:
1867 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1868 break;
1869 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1870 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1871 break;
1872 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1873 size += (get_full_len (*loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide)
1874 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1875 break;
1876 default:
1877 gcc_unreachable ();
1879 break;
1881 case DW_OP_regval_type:
1882 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1884 unsigned long o
1885 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1886 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1887 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1889 break;
1890 case DW_OP_deref_type:
1891 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1893 unsigned long o
1894 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1895 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1897 break;
1898 case DW_OP_convert:
1899 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1900 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1901 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1902 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1903 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1904 else
1906 unsigned long o
1907 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1908 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1910 break;
1911 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1912 size += 4;
1913 break;
1914 default:
1915 break;
1918 return size;
1921 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
1923 unsigned long
1924 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1926 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1927 unsigned long size;
1929 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
1930 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
1931 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1933 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
1934 break;
1935 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1937 if (! l)
1938 return size;
1940 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1942 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
1943 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1946 return size;
1949 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_value attribute. */
1951 static int
1952 size_of_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value)
1954 if (discr_value->pos)
1955 return size_of_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval);
1956 else
1957 return size_of_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval);
1960 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_list attribute. */
1962 static int
1963 size_of_discr_list (dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
1965 int size = 0;
1967 for (dw_discr_list_ref list = discr_list;
1968 list != NULL;
1969 list = list->dw_discr_next)
1971 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then one or two
1972 LEB128 numbers, depending on whether it's a single case label or a
1973 range label. */
1974 size += 1;
1975 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound);
1976 if (list->dw_discr_range != 0)
1977 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound);
1979 return size;
1982 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
1983 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
1984 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
1986 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
1987 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
1988 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
1989 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
1990 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
1991 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
1993 static void
1994 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
1996 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
1997 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
1999 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2001 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2002 case DW_OP_const2u:
2003 case DW_OP_const2s:
2004 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2005 break;
2006 case DW_OP_const4u:
2007 if (loc->dtprel)
2009 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
2010 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
2011 val1->v.val_addr);
2012 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2013 break;
2015 /* FALLTHRU */
2016 case DW_OP_const4s:
2017 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2018 break;
2019 case DW_OP_const8u:
2020 if (loc->dtprel)
2022 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
2023 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
2024 val1->v.val_addr);
2025 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2026 break;
2028 /* FALLTHRU */
2029 case DW_OP_const8s:
2030 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2031 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2032 break;
2033 case DW_OP_skip:
2034 case DW_OP_bra:
2036 int offset;
2038 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2039 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2041 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
2043 break;
2044 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2045 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2046 switch (val2->val_class)
2048 case dw_val_class_const:
2049 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2050 break;
2051 case dw_val_class_vec:
2053 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2054 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2055 unsigned int i;
2056 unsigned char *p;
2058 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2060 elt_size /= 2;
2061 len *= 2;
2063 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2064 i < len;
2065 i++, p += elt_size)
2066 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2067 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2069 break;
2070 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2072 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2074 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2076 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2077 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2079 else
2081 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2082 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2084 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2085 first, NULL);
2086 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2087 second, NULL);
2089 break;
2090 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2092 int i;
2093 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2094 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2095 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2096 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2097 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2098 else
2099 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2100 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2101 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2103 break;
2104 case dw_val_class_addr:
2105 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
2106 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
2107 break;
2108 default:
2109 gcc_unreachable ();
2111 break;
2112 #else
2113 case DW_OP_const2u:
2114 case DW_OP_const2s:
2115 case DW_OP_const4u:
2116 case DW_OP_const4s:
2117 case DW_OP_const8u:
2118 case DW_OP_const8s:
2119 case DW_OP_skip:
2120 case DW_OP_bra:
2121 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2122 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
2123 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
2124 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
2125 only doing unwinding. */
2126 gcc_unreachable ();
2127 #endif
2128 case DW_OP_const1u:
2129 case DW_OP_const1s:
2130 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2131 break;
2132 case DW_OP_constu:
2133 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2134 break;
2135 case DW_OP_consts:
2136 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2137 break;
2138 case DW_OP_pick:
2139 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2140 break;
2141 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2142 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2143 break;
2144 case DW_OP_breg0:
2145 case DW_OP_breg1:
2146 case DW_OP_breg2:
2147 case DW_OP_breg3:
2148 case DW_OP_breg4:
2149 case DW_OP_breg5:
2150 case DW_OP_breg6:
2151 case DW_OP_breg7:
2152 case DW_OP_breg8:
2153 case DW_OP_breg9:
2154 case DW_OP_breg10:
2155 case DW_OP_breg11:
2156 case DW_OP_breg12:
2157 case DW_OP_breg13:
2158 case DW_OP_breg14:
2159 case DW_OP_breg15:
2160 case DW_OP_breg16:
2161 case DW_OP_breg17:
2162 case DW_OP_breg18:
2163 case DW_OP_breg19:
2164 case DW_OP_breg20:
2165 case DW_OP_breg21:
2166 case DW_OP_breg22:
2167 case DW_OP_breg23:
2168 case DW_OP_breg24:
2169 case DW_OP_breg25:
2170 case DW_OP_breg26:
2171 case DW_OP_breg27:
2172 case DW_OP_breg28:
2173 case DW_OP_breg29:
2174 case DW_OP_breg30:
2175 case DW_OP_breg31:
2176 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2177 break;
2178 case DW_OP_regx:
2180 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2181 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2182 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2183 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2184 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2185 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2187 break;
2188 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2189 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2190 break;
2191 case DW_OP_bregx:
2193 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2194 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2195 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2196 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2197 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2198 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2199 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2201 break;
2202 case DW_OP_piece:
2203 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2204 break;
2205 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2206 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2207 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2208 break;
2209 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2210 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2211 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2212 break;
2214 case DW_OP_addr:
2215 if (loc->dtprel)
2217 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
2219 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
2220 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2221 val1->v.val_addr);
2222 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2224 else
2225 gcc_unreachable ();
2227 else
2229 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2230 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2231 #else
2232 gcc_unreachable ();
2233 #endif
2235 break;
2237 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2238 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2239 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
2240 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index,
2241 "(index into .debug_addr)");
2242 break;
2244 case DW_OP_call2:
2245 case DW_OP_call4:
2247 unsigned long die_offset
2248 = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2249 /* Make sure the offset has been computed and that we can encode it as
2250 an operand. */
2251 gcc_assert (die_offset > 0
2252 && die_offset <= (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2
2253 ? 0xffff
2254 : 0xffffffff));
2255 dw2_asm_output_data ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2) ? 2 : 4,
2256 die_offset, NULL);
2258 break;
2260 case DW_OP_call_ref:
2261 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
2263 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2264 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2265 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2266 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2267 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2269 break;
2271 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2272 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2274 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2275 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2276 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2277 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2278 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2279 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2281 break;
2283 case DW_OP_entry_value:
2284 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2285 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
2286 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2287 break;
2289 case DW_OP_const_type:
2290 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2292 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
2293 gcc_assert (o);
2294 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2295 switch (val2->val_class)
2297 case dw_val_class_const:
2298 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2299 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2300 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2301 break;
2302 case dw_val_class_vec:
2304 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2305 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2306 unsigned int i;
2307 unsigned char *p;
2309 l = len * elt_size;
2310 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2311 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2313 elt_size /= 2;
2314 len *= 2;
2316 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2317 i < len;
2318 i++, p += elt_size)
2319 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2320 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2322 break;
2323 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2325 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2326 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2328 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
2329 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2331 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2332 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2334 else
2336 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2337 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2339 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
2340 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
2342 break;
2343 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2345 int i;
2346 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2347 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2349 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * l, NULL);
2350 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2351 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2352 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2353 else
2354 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2355 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2357 break;
2358 default:
2359 gcc_unreachable ();
2362 break;
2363 case DW_OP_regval_type:
2364 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2366 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2367 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2368 gcc_assert (o);
2369 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2371 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2372 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2373 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2375 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2376 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2378 break;
2379 case DW_OP_deref_type:
2380 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2382 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2383 gcc_assert (o);
2384 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2385 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2387 break;
2388 case DW_OP_convert:
2389 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2390 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2391 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2392 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
2393 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2394 else
2396 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2397 gcc_assert (o);
2398 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2400 break;
2402 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2404 unsigned long o;
2405 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2406 o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2407 dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2409 break;
2411 default:
2412 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2413 break;
2417 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2418 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2419 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2420 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2421 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2422 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2424 void
2425 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2427 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2429 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2430 /* Output the opcode. */
2431 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2432 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2434 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2435 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2436 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2437 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2439 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2440 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2442 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2443 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2444 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2445 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2448 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2449 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2451 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2452 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2456 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2457 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
2459 static void
2460 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2462 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2463 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2465 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2467 case DW_OP_addr:
2468 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2469 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2470 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2471 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
2472 gcc_unreachable ();
2474 case DW_OP_const1u:
2475 case DW_OP_const1s:
2476 case DW_OP_pick:
2477 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2478 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2479 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2480 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2481 break;
2483 case DW_OP_const2u:
2484 case DW_OP_const2s:
2485 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2486 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2487 break;
2489 case DW_OP_const4u:
2490 case DW_OP_const4s:
2491 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2492 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2493 break;
2495 case DW_OP_const8u:
2496 case DW_OP_const8s:
2497 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2498 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2499 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2500 break;
2502 case DW_OP_skip:
2503 case DW_OP_bra:
2505 int offset;
2507 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2508 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2510 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2511 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2513 break;
2515 case DW_OP_regx:
2517 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2518 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2519 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2520 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2521 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2523 break;
2525 case DW_OP_constu:
2526 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2527 case DW_OP_piece:
2528 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2529 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2530 break;
2532 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2533 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2534 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2535 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2536 break;
2538 case DW_OP_consts:
2539 case DW_OP_breg0:
2540 case DW_OP_breg1:
2541 case DW_OP_breg2:
2542 case DW_OP_breg3:
2543 case DW_OP_breg4:
2544 case DW_OP_breg5:
2545 case DW_OP_breg6:
2546 case DW_OP_breg7:
2547 case DW_OP_breg8:
2548 case DW_OP_breg9:
2549 case DW_OP_breg10:
2550 case DW_OP_breg11:
2551 case DW_OP_breg12:
2552 case DW_OP_breg13:
2553 case DW_OP_breg14:
2554 case DW_OP_breg15:
2555 case DW_OP_breg16:
2556 case DW_OP_breg17:
2557 case DW_OP_breg18:
2558 case DW_OP_breg19:
2559 case DW_OP_breg20:
2560 case DW_OP_breg21:
2561 case DW_OP_breg22:
2562 case DW_OP_breg23:
2563 case DW_OP_breg24:
2564 case DW_OP_breg25:
2565 case DW_OP_breg26:
2566 case DW_OP_breg27:
2567 case DW_OP_breg28:
2568 case DW_OP_breg29:
2569 case DW_OP_breg30:
2570 case DW_OP_breg31:
2571 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2572 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2573 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2574 break;
2576 case DW_OP_bregx:
2578 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2579 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2580 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2581 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2582 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2583 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2584 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2586 break;
2588 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2589 case DW_OP_entry_value:
2590 case DW_OP_const_type:
2591 case DW_OP_regval_type:
2592 case DW_OP_deref_type:
2593 case DW_OP_convert:
2594 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2595 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2596 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2597 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2598 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2599 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2600 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2601 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2602 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2603 gcc_unreachable ();
2604 break;
2606 default:
2607 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2608 break;
2612 void
2613 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2615 while (1)
2617 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2618 /* Output the opcode. */
2619 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2621 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2622 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2623 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2624 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2626 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2628 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2629 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2630 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2631 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2633 /* Output the opcode. */
2634 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2635 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2637 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2638 break;
2639 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2641 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2645 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2646 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2647 expression. */
2649 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2650 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, poly_int64 offset)
2652 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head, *tmp;
2654 offset += cfa->offset;
2656 if (cfa->indirect)
2658 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2659 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2660 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
2661 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2662 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2663 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2665 else
2666 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2668 return head;
2671 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2672 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2673 ALIGNMENT byte. */
2675 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2676 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2677 poly_int64 offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2679 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head;
2680 unsigned int dwarf_fp
2681 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2683 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
2684 if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2686 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2687 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2688 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2689 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2691 else
2692 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2693 return head;
2696 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
2698 /* .debug_str support. */
2700 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2701 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2702 static void dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *);
2703 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2704 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2705 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2706 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2707 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2708 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2709 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2710 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2711 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2712 static void dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree);
2713 static void dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree);
2714 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2715 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool, bool);
2716 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2717 dw_die_ref);
2718 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2719 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *);
2720 static void dwarf2out_size_function (tree);
2721 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2722 static void dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int);
2723 static void dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit);
2724 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2725 static void dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
2726 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off);
2727 static bool dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
2728 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off);
2730 /* The debug hooks structure. */
2732 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2734 dwarf2out_init,
2735 dwarf2out_finish,
2736 dwarf2out_early_finish,
2737 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2738 dwarf2out_define,
2739 dwarf2out_undef,
2740 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2741 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2742 dwarf2out_begin_block,
2743 dwarf2out_end_block,
2744 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2745 dwarf2out_source_line,
2746 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2747 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2748 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2749 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2750 #else
2751 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2752 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2753 #endif
2754 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2755 dwarf2out_begin_function,
2756 dwarf2out_end_function, /* end_function */
2757 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit,
2758 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
2759 dwarf2out_early_global_decl,
2760 dwarf2out_late_global_decl,
2761 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
2762 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2763 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl,
2764 dwarf2out_register_external_die,
2765 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2766 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2767 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2768 something tries to reference them. */
2769 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
2770 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2771 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2772 dwarf2out_var_location,
2773 debug_nothing_tree, /* inline_entry */
2774 dwarf2out_size_function, /* size_function */
2775 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2776 dwarf2out_set_name,
2777 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2778 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2781 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_lineno_debug_hooks =
2783 dwarf2out_init,
2784 debug_nothing_charstar,
2785 debug_nothing_charstar,
2786 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2787 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2788 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2789 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2790 debug_nothing_int,
2791 debug_nothing_int_int, /* begin_block */
2792 debug_nothing_int_int, /* end_block */
2793 debug_true_const_tree, /* ignore_block */
2794 dwarf2out_source_line, /* source_line */
2795 debug_nothing_int_int_charstar, /* begin_prologue */
2796 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
2797 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* begin_epilogue */
2798 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_epilogue */
2799 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
2800 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
2801 debug_nothing_tree, /* register_main_translation_unit */
2802 debug_nothing_tree, /* function_decl */
2803 debug_nothing_tree, /* early_global_decl */
2804 debug_nothing_tree, /* late_global_decl */
2805 debug_nothing_tree_int, /* type_decl */
2806 debug_nothing_tree_tree_tree_bool_bool,/* imported_module_or_decl */
2807 debug_false_tree_charstarstar_uhwistar,/* die_ref_for_decl */
2808 debug_nothing_tree_charstar_uhwi, /* register_external_die */
2809 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2810 debug_nothing_tree, /* outlining_inline_function */
2811 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2812 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2813 debug_nothing_rtx_insn, /* var_location */
2814 debug_nothing_tree, /* inline_entry */
2815 debug_nothing_tree, /* size_function */
2816 debug_nothing_void, /* switch_text_section */
2817 debug_nothing_tree_tree, /* set_name */
2818 0, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2819 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_ADDRESS /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2822 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2823 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2824 throughout the remainder of this file. */
2826 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2827 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
2828 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2829 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
2831 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2832 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
2833 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2834 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
2835 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2836 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2837 yet. For Dwarf V5 or higher .debug_types doesn't exist any more,
2838 it is DW_UT_type unit type in .debug_info section. */
2840 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
2842 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2843 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
2845 typedef long int dw_offset;
2847 struct comdat_type_node;
2849 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2850 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
2851 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2852 supported. */
2854 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2855 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
2856 LI_set_address,
2858 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
2859 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2860 special opcodes. */
2861 LI_set_line,
2863 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
2864 LI_set_file,
2866 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
2867 LI_set_column,
2869 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
2870 LI_negate_stmt,
2872 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
2873 LI_set_prologue_end,
2874 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2876 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
2877 LI_set_discriminator
2880 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2881 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2882 unsigned int val;
2883 } dw_line_info_entry;
2886 struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table {
2887 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
2888 const char *end_label;
2890 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2891 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
2892 unsigned int file_num;
2893 unsigned int line_num;
2894 unsigned int column_num;
2895 int discrim_num;
2896 bool is_stmt;
2897 bool in_use;
2899 vec<dw_line_info_entry, va_gc> *entries;
2903 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
2904 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
2905 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
2907 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
2908 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
2909 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
2911 dw_attr_node;
2914 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
2915 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
2916 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
2918 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"), for_user)) die_struct {
2919 union die_symbol_or_type_node
2921 const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
2922 comdat_type_node *GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
2924 GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
2925 vec<dw_attr_node, va_gc> *die_attr;
2926 dw_die_ref die_parent;
2927 dw_die_ref die_child;
2928 dw_die_ref die_sib;
2929 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
2930 dw_offset die_offset;
2931 unsigned long die_abbrev;
2932 int die_mark;
2933 unsigned int decl_id;
2934 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
2935 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
2936 BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
2937 BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
2938 /* For an external ref to die_symbol if die_offset contains an extra
2939 offset to that symbol. */
2940 BOOL_BITFIELD with_offset : 1;
2941 /* Whether this DIE was removed from the DIE tree, for example via
2942 prune_unused_types. We don't consider those present from the
2943 DIE lookup routines. */
2944 BOOL_BITFIELD removed : 1;
2945 /* Lots of spare bits. */
2947 die_node;
2949 /* Set to TRUE while dwarf2out_early_global_decl is running. */
2950 static bool early_dwarf;
2951 static bool early_dwarf_finished;
2952 struct set_early_dwarf {
2953 bool saved;
2954 set_early_dwarf () : saved(early_dwarf)
2956 gcc_assert (! early_dwarf_finished);
2957 early_dwarf = true;
2959 ~set_early_dwarf () { early_dwarf = saved; }
2962 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
2963 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
2964 c = die->die_child; \
2965 if (c) do { \
2966 c = c->die_sib; \
2967 expr; \
2968 } while (c != die->die_child); \
2969 } while (0)
2971 /* The pubname structure */
2973 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
2974 dw_die_ref die;
2975 const char *name;
2977 pubname_entry;
2980 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges {
2981 const char *label;
2982 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
2983 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
2984 int num;
2985 /* Index for the range list for DW_FORM_rnglistx. */
2986 unsigned int idx : 31;
2987 /* True if this range might be possibly in a different section
2988 from previous entry. */
2989 unsigned int maybe_new_sec : 1;
2992 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
2994 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
2995 unsigned char code;
2996 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
2997 const char *info;
2999 macinfo_entry;
3002 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label {
3003 const char *begin;
3004 const char *end;
3007 /* The comdat type node structure. */
3008 struct GTY(()) comdat_type_node
3010 dw_die_ref root_die;
3011 dw_die_ref type_die;
3012 dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
3013 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
3014 comdat_type_node *next;
3017 /* A list of DIEs for which we can't determine ancestry (parent_die
3018 field) just yet. Later in dwarf2out_finish we will fill in the
3019 missing bits. */
3020 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
3021 dw_die_ref die;
3022 /* The tree for which this DIE was created. We use this to
3023 determine ancestry later. */
3024 tree created_for;
3025 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3027 limbo_die_node;
3029 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
3031 dw_die_ref old_die;
3032 dw_die_ref new_die;
3033 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
3035 skeleton_chain_node;
3037 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3038 implicitly generated for a type.
3040 Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
3041 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
3042 and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
3043 a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3044 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3045 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. Likewise with the Ada
3046 front-end, but for each type, tagged or not. */
3048 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3049 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3050 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3051 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3052 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3053 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3054 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3055 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3056 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3058 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3059 language, and compiler version. */
3061 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3062 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3063 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE \
3064 + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 4 : 3))
3066 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
3067 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3068 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3069 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
3071 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF skeleton compilation unit header. */
3072 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE \
3073 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 8 : 0))
3075 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3076 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3078 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3079 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3080 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3081 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3082 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3084 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3085 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3086 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3087 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3088 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3089 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3091 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3092 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3093 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3094 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3095 #else
3096 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3097 #endif
3098 #endif
3100 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3101 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3102 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3104 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3105 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
3107 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3108 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3110 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3111 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3112 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3113 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3114 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3116 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
3117 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
3118 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
3119 #endif
3121 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3122 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3123 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3125 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3126 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
3128 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
3129 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
3131 /* A list of CU DIEs that have been separated. */
3132 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *cu_die_list;
3134 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3135 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3137 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
3138 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
3139 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
3141 struct dwarf_file_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<dwarf_file_data>
3143 typedef const char *compare_type;
3145 static hashval_t hash (dwarf_file_data *);
3146 static bool equal (dwarf_file_data *, const char *);
3149 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3150 static GTY(()) hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher> *file_table;
3152 struct decl_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_node>
3154 typedef tree compare_type;
3156 static hashval_t hash (die_node *);
3157 static bool equal (die_node *, tree);
3159 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3160 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3161 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_die_hasher> *decl_die_table;
3163 struct GTY ((for_user)) variable_value_struct {
3164 unsigned int decl_id;
3165 vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *dies;
3168 struct variable_value_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<variable_value_struct>
3170 typedef tree compare_type;
3172 static hashval_t hash (variable_value_struct *);
3173 static bool equal (variable_value_struct *, tree);
3175 /* A hash table of DIEs that contain DW_OP_GNU_variable_value with
3176 dw_val_class_decl_ref class, indexed by FUNCTION_DECLs which is
3177 DECL_CONTEXT of the referenced VAR_DECLs. */
3178 static GTY (()) hash_table<variable_value_hasher> *variable_value_hash;
3180 struct block_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_struct>
3182 static hashval_t hash (die_struct *);
3183 static bool equal (die_struct *, die_struct *);
3186 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
3187 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
3188 static GTY (()) hash_table<block_die_hasher> *common_block_die_table;
3190 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
3191 dw_die_ref die;
3192 tree arg;
3193 } die_arg_entry;
3196 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3197 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
3198 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
3199 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
3200 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
3201 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
3202 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
3203 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
3204 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
3205 NULL as second operand. */
3206 rtx GTY (()) loc;
3207 const char * GTY (()) label;
3208 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3211 /* Variable location list. */
3212 struct GTY ((for_user)) var_loc_list_def {
3213 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3215 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
3216 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
3217 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
3218 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
3219 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
3220 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
3221 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3223 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
3224 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
3225 is after section switch. */
3226 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
3228 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3229 unsigned int decl_id;
3231 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3233 /* Call argument location list. */
3234 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
3235 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
3236 const char * GTY (()) label;
3237 tree GTY (()) block;
3238 bool tail_call_p;
3239 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
3240 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3244 struct decl_loc_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<var_loc_list>
3246 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3248 static hashval_t hash (var_loc_list *);
3249 static bool equal (var_loc_list *, const_tree);
3252 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3253 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *decl_loc_table;
3255 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
3256 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
3257 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
3259 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
3260 static int call_site_count = -1;
3261 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
3262 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
3264 /* A cached location list. */
3265 struct GTY ((for_user)) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
3266 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
3267 unsigned int decl_id;
3269 /* The cached location list. */
3270 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
3272 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
3274 struct dw_loc_list_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<cached_dw_loc_list>
3277 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3279 static hashval_t hash (cached_dw_loc_list *);
3280 static bool equal (cached_dw_loc_list *, const_tree);
3283 /* Table of cached location lists. */
3284 static GTY (()) hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *cached_dw_loc_list_table;
3286 /* A vector of references to DIE's that are uniquely identified by their tag,
3287 presence/absence of children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3288 static GTY(()) vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *abbrev_die_table;
3290 /* A hash map to remember the stack usage for DWARF procedures. The value
3291 stored is the stack size difference between before the DWARF procedure
3292 invokation and after it returned. In other words, for a DWARF procedure
3293 that consumes N stack slots and that pushes M ones, this stores M - N. */
3294 static hash_map<dw_die_ref, int> *dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
3296 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
3297 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
3299 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
3300 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
3301 assembly for the function. */
3302 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
3304 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
3305 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
3306 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
3308 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
3309 static GTY(()) vec<dw_line_info_table *, va_gc> *separate_line_info;
3311 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
3312 refer to. */
3313 static bool info_section_emitted;
3315 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3316 accessible names. */
3317 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubname_table;
3319 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3320 accessible types. */
3321 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubtype_table;
3323 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
3324 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
3325 static GTY (()) vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *macinfo_table;
3327 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
3328 emitted. */
3329 #define have_macinfo \
3330 ((!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS) \
3331 && debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
3332 && !macinfo_table->is_empty ())
3334 /* Vector of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3335 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges, va_gc> *ranges_table;
3337 /* Vector of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
3338 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges_by_label, va_gc> *ranges_by_label;
3340 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3341 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3343 /* Unique label counter. */
3344 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3346 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
3347 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
3349 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
3350 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3352 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3353 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3355 static GTY(()) vec<die_arg_entry, va_gc> *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
3357 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
3358 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
3359 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
3360 we do it at the end of compilation. */
3361 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *generic_type_instances;
3363 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3364 within the current function. */
3365 static poly_int64 frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3366 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
3368 static vec<dw_die_ref> base_types;
3370 /* Flags to represent a set of attribute classes for attributes that represent
3371 a scalar value (bounds, pointers, ...). */
3372 enum dw_scalar_form
3374 dw_scalar_form_constant = 0x01,
3375 dw_scalar_form_exprloc = 0x02,
3376 dw_scalar_form_reference = 0x04
3379 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3381 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
3382 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3383 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
3384 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3385 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3386 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3387 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
3388 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3389 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_node *);
3390 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_node *);
3391 static inline unsigned int AT_index (dw_attr_node *);
3392 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3393 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_node *);
3394 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3395 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_node *);
3396 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3397 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *);
3398 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3399 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3400 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3401 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3402 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
3403 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3404 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_node *);
3405 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *);
3406 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3407 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3408 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_node *);
3409 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *);
3410 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *, int);
3411 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3412 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3413 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_node *);
3414 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3415 dw_loc_list_ref);
3416 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3417 static addr_table_entry *add_addr_table_entry (void *, enum ate_kind);
3418 static void remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *);
3419 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx, bool);
3420 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_node *);
3421 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3422 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3423 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3424 static void add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3425 const char *);
3426 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3427 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3428 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3429 unsigned long, bool);
3430 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *);
3431 static dw_attr_node *get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3432 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3433 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3434 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3435 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3436 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3437 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3438 static bool is_cxx (void);
3439 static bool is_cxx (const_tree);
3440 static bool is_fortran (void);
3441 static bool is_ada (void);
3442 static bool remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3443 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3444 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3445 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3446 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3447 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
3448 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
3449 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3450 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3451 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
3452 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3453 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
3454 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3455 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3456 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3457 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3458 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3459 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3460 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3461 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3462 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_node *,
3463 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3464 struct checksum_attributes;
3465 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
3466 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3467 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3468 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
3469 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3470 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
3471 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *, dw_attr_node *, int *);
3472 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3473 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3474 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3475 static inline bool is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref);
3476 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
3477 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
3478 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
3479 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
3480 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
3481 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3482 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
3483 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
3484 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
3485 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
3486 dw_die_ref,
3487 dw_die_ref);
3488 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
3489 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
3491 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3492 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3493 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3494 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3495 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3496 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
3497 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3498 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3499 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3500 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3501 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3502 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3503 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3504 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3505 static void output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long, dw_die_ref);
3506 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3507 static void output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type);
3508 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int, const unsigned char *);
3509 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
3510 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3511 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3512 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3513 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3514 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3515 static void output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3516 static void output_aranges (void);
3517 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree, bool = false);
3518 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3519 bool *, bool);
3520 static void output_ranges (void);
3521 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3522 static void output_line_info (bool);
3523 static void output_file_names (void);
3524 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree, bool);
3525 static int is_base_type (tree);
3526 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3527 static int decl_quals (const_tree);
3528 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3529 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3530 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3531 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3532 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3533 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3534 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3535 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3536 enum var_init_status);
3537 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3538 enum var_init_status);
3539 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, poly_int64,
3540 enum var_init_status);
3541 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3542 static bool resolve_one_addr (rtx *);
3543 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3544 enum var_init_status);
3545 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, machine_mode mode,
3546 enum var_init_status);
3547 struct loc_descr_context;
3548 static void add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref);
3549 static void add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list);
3550 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int,
3551 struct loc_descr_context *);
3552 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int,
3553 struct loc_descr_context *);
3554 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3555 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3556 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3557 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3558 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3559 struct vlr_context;
3560 static dw_loc_descr_ref field_byte_offset (const_tree, struct vlr_context *,
3561 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
3562 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3563 dw_loc_list_ref);
3564 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3565 struct vlr_context *);
3566 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3567 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3568 static void insert_wide_int (const wide_int &, unsigned char *, int);
3569 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3570 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3571 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3572 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3573 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3574 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3575 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3576 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3577 static void add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree, int,
3578 struct loc_descr_context *);
3579 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree,
3580 struct loc_descr_context *);
3581 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3582 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3583 static void add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3584 static inline void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3585 struct vlr_context *);
3586 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3587 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3588 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3589 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3590 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3591 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree, bool = false);
3592 static void add_discr_value (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_value *);
3593 static void add_discr_list (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_list_ref);
3594 static inline dw_discr_list_ref AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *);
3595 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3596 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3597 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3598 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3599 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3600 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3601 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3602 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3603 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3604 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3605 #if 0
3606 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3607 #endif
3608 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3609 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3610 #if 0
3611 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3612 #endif
3613 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3614 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3615 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3616 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3617 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3618 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3619 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3620 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3621 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3622 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3623 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3624 static void gen_field_die (tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3625 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3626 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3627 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3628 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3629 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3630 enum debug_info_usage);
3631 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3632 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3633 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3634 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3635 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref);
3636 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3637 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3638 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3639 static dw_die_ref gen_namelist_decl (tree, dw_die_ref, tree);
3640 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3641 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3642 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3643 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3644 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3645 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3646 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3647 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3648 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3649 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3650 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3651 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3652 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3653 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
3654 const char *, const char *);
3655 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3656 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3657 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3659 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3660 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3661 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3662 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3663 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3664 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3665 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3666 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3667 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *);
3668 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *);
3669 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3670 const char *, const char *);
3671 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3672 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3673 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3674 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3675 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3676 static void resolve_variable_values (void);
3678 static const char *comp_dir_string (void);
3680 static void hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref, inchash::hash &);
3682 /* enum for tracking thread-local variables whose address is really an offset
3683 relative to the TLS pointer, which will need link-time relocation, but will
3684 not need relocation by the DWARF consumer. */
3686 enum dtprel_bool
3688 dtprel_false = 0,
3689 dtprel_true = 1
3692 /* Return the operator to use for an address of a variable. For dtprel_true, we
3693 use DW_OP_const*. For regular variables, which need both link-time
3694 relocation and consumer-level relocation (e.g., to account for shared objects
3695 loaded at a random address), we use DW_OP_addr*. */
3697 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
3698 dw_addr_op (enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3700 if (dtprel == dtprel_true)
3701 return (dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_const_index
3702 : (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u));
3703 else
3704 return dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_addr_index : DW_OP_addr;
3707 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated address location description. If
3708 dwarf_split_debug_info is true, then record the address with the appropriate
3709 relocation. */
3710 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3711 new_addr_loc_descr (rtx addr, enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3713 dw_loc_descr_ref ref = new_loc_descr (dw_addr_op (dtprel), 0, 0);
3715 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3716 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = addr;
3717 ref->dtprel = dtprel;
3718 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
3719 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
3720 = add_addr_table_entry (addr,
3721 dtprel ? ate_kind_rtx_dtprel : ate_kind_rtx);
3722 else
3723 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
3725 return ref;
3728 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3730 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3731 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3732 #endif
3733 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3734 #define DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info.dwo"
3735 #endif
3736 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION
3737 #define DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info"
3738 #endif
3739 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3740 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info.dwo"
3741 #endif
3742 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3743 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3744 #endif
3745 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION
3746 #define DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev"
3747 #endif
3748 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3749 #define DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev.dwo"
3750 #endif
3751 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3752 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev.dwo"
3753 #endif
3754 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3755 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3756 #endif
3757 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION
3758 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION ".debug_addr"
3759 #endif
3760 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3761 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3762 #endif
3763 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION
3764 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo"
3765 #endif
3766 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3767 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo.dwo"
3768 #endif
3769 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3770 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo.dwo"
3771 #endif
3772 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
3773 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro"
3774 #endif
3775 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION
3776 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro"
3777 #endif
3778 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3779 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro.dwo"
3780 #endif
3781 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3782 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro.dwo"
3783 #endif
3784 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3785 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3786 #endif
3787 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION
3788 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line"
3789 #endif
3790 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3791 #define DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line.dwo"
3792 #endif
3793 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3794 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line.dwo"
3795 #endif
3796 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3797 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3798 #endif
3799 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION
3800 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc.dwo"
3801 #endif
3802 #ifndef DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
3803 #define DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION ".debug_loclists"
3804 #endif
3805 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
3806 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION ".debug_loclists.dwo"
3807 #endif
3808 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3809 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION \
3810 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3811 ? ".debug_gnu_pubnames" : ".debug_pubnames")
3812 #endif
3813 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
3814 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION \
3815 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3816 ? ".debug_gnu_pubtypes" : ".debug_pubtypes")
3817 #endif
3818 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3819 #define DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets"
3820 #endif
3821 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3822 #define DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3823 #endif
3824 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3825 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3826 #endif
3827 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3828 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3829 #endif
3830 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION
3831 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str"
3832 #endif
3833 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION
3834 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION ".debug_str.dwo"
3835 #endif
3836 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION
3837 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str.dwo"
3838 #endif
3839 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3840 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3841 #endif
3842 #ifndef DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
3843 #define DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION ".debug_rnglists"
3844 #endif
3845 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION
3846 #define DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION ".debug_line_str"
3847 #endif
3848 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION
3849 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line_str"
3850 #endif
3852 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3853 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3854 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3855 #endif
3857 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3858 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3859 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
3860 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
3861 : SECTION_DEBUG)
3863 /* Section flags for .debug_str.dwo section. */
3864 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE)
3866 /* Attribute used to refer to the macro section. */
3867 #define DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_AT_macros \
3868 : dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros)
3870 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3871 the section names themselves. */
3873 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3874 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3875 #endif
3876 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3877 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
3878 #endif
3879 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3880 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3881 #endif
3882 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3883 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_line"
3884 #endif
3885 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3886 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3887 #endif
3888 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3889 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_info"
3890 #endif
3891 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3892 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3893 #endif
3894 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3895 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_abbrev"
3896 #endif
3897 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL
3898 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_addr"
3899 #endif
3900 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3901 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3902 #endif
3903 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3904 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3905 #endif
3906 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3907 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3908 #endif
3909 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
3910 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macro"
3911 #endif
3912 #define SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV 1
3913 #define SKELETON_TYPE_DIE_ABBREV 2
3915 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3916 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3917 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3918 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3919 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3921 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3922 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3923 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3924 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3925 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3926 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3927 static char debug_skeleton_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3928 static char debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3929 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3930 static char debug_addr_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3931 static char debug_skeleton_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3932 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3933 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3934 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3935 static char ranges_base_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3937 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3938 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3939 #endif
3940 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
3941 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
3942 #endif
3943 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3944 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3945 #endif
3946 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3947 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3948 #endif
3949 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3950 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3951 #endif
3954 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3955 static dw_die_ref
3956 comp_unit_die (void)
3958 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
3959 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
3960 return single_comp_unit_die;
3963 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3964 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
3966 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
3968 void
3969 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
3971 demangle_name_func = func;
3974 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3976 static inline int
3977 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
3979 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3980 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3981 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3984 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3985 removed. */
3987 static inline tree
3988 type_main_variant (tree type)
3990 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3992 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3993 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3994 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3995 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3996 here. */
3997 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3998 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3999 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4001 return type;
4004 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4006 static inline int
4007 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
4009 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4011 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4012 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4015 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
4017 static void
4018 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
4020 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
4023 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
4025 static unsigned long int
4026 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
4028 if (ref->die_offset)
4029 return ref->die_offset;
4030 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
4032 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
4033 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4035 return ref->die_offset;
4038 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type. */
4040 static unsigned long int
4041 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
4043 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4044 return ref->die_offset;
4047 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4049 static const char *
4050 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4052 const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
4054 if (name != NULL)
4055 return name;
4057 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4060 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4062 static const char *
4063 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4065 const char *name;
4067 switch (attr)
4069 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4070 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
4071 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
4072 #else
4073 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4074 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4075 #endif
4077 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4078 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
4079 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
4080 #else
4081 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4082 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4083 #endif
4086 name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
4088 if (name != NULL)
4089 return name;
4091 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4094 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4096 static const char *
4097 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4099 const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
4101 if (name != NULL)
4102 return name;
4104 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4107 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4108 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4109 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4110 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4111 given block. */
4113 static tree
4114 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
4116 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4117 return NULL_TREE;
4119 /* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN can point to itself; ignore that if
4120 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4121 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4122 return NULL_TREE;
4124 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4125 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4126 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4128 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4131 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4132 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4133 parameter. */
4135 static tree
4136 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4138 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4140 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4141 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4142 else
4143 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4144 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4146 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4147 context = NULL_TREE;
4149 return context;
4152 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
4154 static inline void
4155 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_node *attr)
4157 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
4158 if (die == NULL)
4159 return;
4161 if (flag_checking)
4163 /* Check we do not add duplicate attrs. Can't use get_AT here
4164 because that recurses to the specification/abstract origin DIE. */
4165 dw_attr_node *a;
4166 unsigned ix;
4167 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4168 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != attr->dw_attr);
4171 vec_safe_reserve (die->die_attr, 1);
4172 vec_safe_push (die->die_attr, *attr);
4175 static inline enum dw_val_class
4176 AT_class (dw_attr_node *a)
4178 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4181 /* Return the index for any attribute that will be referenced with a
4182 DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index. String indices
4183 are stored in dw_attr_val.v.val_str for reference counting
4184 pruning. */
4186 static inline unsigned int
4187 AT_index (dw_attr_node *a)
4189 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4190 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->index;
4191 else if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != NULL)
4192 return a->dw_attr_val.val_entry->index;
4193 return NOT_INDEXED;
4196 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4198 static inline void
4199 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4201 dw_attr_node attr;
4203 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4204 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4205 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4206 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4207 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4210 static inline unsigned
4211 AT_flag (dw_attr_node *a)
4213 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4214 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4217 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4219 static inline void
4220 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4222 dw_attr_node attr;
4224 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4225 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4226 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4227 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4228 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4231 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4232 AT_int (dw_attr_node *a)
4234 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const
4235 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const_implicit));
4236 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4239 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4241 static inline void
4242 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4243 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4245 dw_attr_node attr;
4247 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4248 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4249 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4250 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4251 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4254 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4255 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *a)
4257 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const
4258 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit));
4259 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4262 /* Add an unsigned wide integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4264 static inline void
4265 add_AT_wide (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4266 const wide_int& w)
4268 dw_attr_node attr;
4270 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4271 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
4272 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4273 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
4274 *attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = w;
4275 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4278 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4280 static inline void
4281 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4282 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
4284 dw_attr_node attr;
4286 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4287 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
4288 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4289 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
4290 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
4291 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4294 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4296 static inline void
4297 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4298 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4300 dw_attr_node attr;
4302 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4303 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4304 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4305 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4306 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4307 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4308 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4311 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
4313 static inline void
4314 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4315 unsigned char data8[8])
4317 dw_attr_node attr;
4319 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4320 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
4321 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4322 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
4323 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4326 /* Add DW_AT_low_pc and DW_AT_high_pc to a DIE. When using
4327 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4328 final executable have force_direct set to avoid using indexed
4329 references. */
4331 static inline void
4332 add_AT_low_high_pc (dw_die_ref die, const char *lbl_low, const char *lbl_high,
4333 bool force_direct)
4335 dw_attr_node attr;
4336 char * lbl_id;
4338 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_low);
4339 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_low_pc;
4340 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4341 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4342 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4343 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4344 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4345 else
4346 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4347 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4349 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_high_pc;
4350 if (dwarf_version < 4)
4351 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4352 else
4353 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_high_pc;
4354 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_high);
4355 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4356 if (attr.dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4357 && dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4358 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4359 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4360 else
4361 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4362 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4365 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4367 hashval_t
4368 indirect_string_hasher::hash (indirect_string_node *x)
4370 return htab_hash_string (x->str);
4373 bool
4374 indirect_string_hasher::equal (indirect_string_node *x1, const char *x2)
4376 return strcmp (x1->str, x2) == 0;
4379 /* Add STR to the given string hash table. */
4381 static struct indirect_string_node *
4382 find_AT_string_in_table (const char *str,
4383 hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *table)
4385 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4387 indirect_string_node **slot
4388 = table->find_slot_with_hash (str, htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4389 if (*slot == NULL)
4391 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<indirect_string_node> ();
4392 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4393 *slot = node;
4395 else
4396 node = *slot;
4398 node->refcount++;
4399 return node;
4402 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
4404 static struct indirect_string_node *
4405 find_AT_string (const char *str)
4407 if (! debug_str_hash)
4408 debug_str_hash = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4410 return find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_str_hash);
4413 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4415 static inline void
4416 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4418 dw_attr_node attr;
4419 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4421 node = find_AT_string (str);
4423 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4424 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4425 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4426 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4427 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4430 static inline const char *
4431 AT_string (dw_attr_node *a)
4433 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4434 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4437 /* Call this function directly to bypass AT_string_form's logic to put
4438 the string inline in the die. */
4440 static void
4441 set_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4443 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4444 /* Already indirect is a no op. */
4445 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
4446 || node->form == DW_FORM_line_strp
4447 || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4449 gcc_assert (node->label);
4450 return;
4452 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4453 ++dw2_string_counter;
4454 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4456 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
4458 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4459 node->index = NOT_INDEXED;
4461 else
4463 node->form = DW_FORM_GNU_str_index;
4464 node->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4468 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish, called to reset indirect
4469 string decisions done for early LTO dwarf output before fat object
4470 dwarf output. */
4473 reset_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, void *)
4475 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
4476 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4478 free (node->label);
4479 node->label = NULL;
4480 node->form = (dwarf_form) 0;
4481 node->index = 0;
4483 return 1;
4486 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4487 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4489 static enum dwarf_form
4490 find_string_form (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4492 unsigned int len;
4494 if (node->form)
4495 return node->form;
4497 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4499 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4500 always better to put it inline. */
4501 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4502 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4504 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4505 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4506 single module. */
4507 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
4508 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4509 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
4510 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4512 set_indirect_string (node);
4514 return node->form;
4517 /* Find out whether the string referenced from the attribute should be
4518 output inline in DIE or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4520 static enum dwarf_form
4521 AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *a)
4523 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4524 return find_string_form (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str);
4527 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4529 static inline void
4530 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4532 dw_attr_node attr;
4533 gcc_checking_assert (targ_die != NULL);
4535 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
4536 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
4537 if (targ_die == NULL)
4538 return;
4540 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4541 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4542 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4543 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4544 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4545 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4548 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead. */
4550 static inline void
4551 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_node *ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
4553 gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4554 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
4555 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4558 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4559 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
4561 static inline void
4562 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4564 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4565 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4566 targ_die->die_definition = die;
4569 static inline dw_die_ref
4570 AT_ref (dw_attr_node *a)
4572 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4573 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4576 static inline int
4577 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a)
4579 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4580 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4582 return 0;
4585 static inline void
4586 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a, int i)
4588 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4589 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4592 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4594 static inline void
4595 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4597 dw_attr_node attr;
4599 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4600 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4601 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4602 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4603 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4606 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4608 static inline void
4609 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4611 dw_attr_node attr;
4613 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4614 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4615 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4616 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4617 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4620 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4621 AT_loc (dw_attr_node *a)
4623 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4624 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4627 static inline void
4628 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4630 dw_attr_node attr;
4632 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4633 return;
4635 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4636 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4637 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4638 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4639 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4640 have_location_lists = true;
4643 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4644 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *a)
4646 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4647 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4650 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
4651 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_node *a)
4653 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4654 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4657 struct addr_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<addr_table_entry>
4659 static hashval_t hash (addr_table_entry *);
4660 static bool equal (addr_table_entry *, addr_table_entry *);
4663 /* Table of entries into the .debug_addr section. */
4665 static GTY (()) hash_table<addr_hasher> *addr_index_table;
4667 /* Hash an address_table_entry. */
4669 hashval_t
4670 addr_hasher::hash (addr_table_entry *a)
4672 inchash::hash hstate;
4673 switch (a->kind)
4675 case ate_kind_rtx:
4676 hstate.add_int (0);
4677 break;
4678 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4679 hstate.add_int (1);
4680 break;
4681 case ate_kind_label:
4682 return htab_hash_string (a->addr.label);
4683 default:
4684 gcc_unreachable ();
4686 inchash::add_rtx (a->addr.rtl, hstate);
4687 return hstate.end ();
4690 /* Determine equality for two address_table_entries. */
4692 bool
4693 addr_hasher::equal (addr_table_entry *a1, addr_table_entry *a2)
4695 if (a1->kind != a2->kind)
4696 return 0;
4697 switch (a1->kind)
4699 case ate_kind_rtx:
4700 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4701 return rtx_equal_p (a1->addr.rtl, a2->addr.rtl);
4702 case ate_kind_label:
4703 return strcmp (a1->addr.label, a2->addr.label) == 0;
4704 default:
4705 gcc_unreachable ();
4709 /* Initialize an addr_table_entry. */
4711 void
4712 init_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *e, enum ate_kind kind, void *addr)
4714 e->kind = kind;
4715 switch (kind)
4717 case ate_kind_rtx:
4718 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4719 e->addr.rtl = (rtx) addr;
4720 break;
4721 case ate_kind_label:
4722 e->addr.label = (char *) addr;
4723 break;
4725 e->refcount = 0;
4726 e->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4729 /* Add attr to the address table entry to the table. Defer setting an
4730 index until output time. */
4732 static addr_table_entry *
4733 add_addr_table_entry (void *addr, enum ate_kind kind)
4735 addr_table_entry *node;
4736 addr_table_entry finder;
4738 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info);
4739 if (! addr_index_table)
4740 addr_index_table = hash_table<addr_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4741 init_addr_table_entry (&finder, kind, addr);
4742 addr_table_entry **slot = addr_index_table->find_slot (&finder, INSERT);
4744 if (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
4746 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<addr_table_entry> ();
4747 init_addr_table_entry (node, kind, addr);
4748 *slot = node;
4750 else
4751 node = *slot;
4753 node->refcount++;
4754 return node;
4757 /* Remove an entry from the addr table by decrementing its refcount.
4758 Strictly, decrementing the refcount would be enough, but the
4759 assertion that the entry is actually in the table has found
4760 bugs. */
4762 static void
4763 remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *entry)
4765 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info && addr_index_table);
4766 /* After an index is assigned, the table is frozen. */
4767 gcc_assert (entry->refcount > 0 && entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4768 entry->refcount--;
4771 /* Given a location list, remove all addresses it refers to from the
4772 address_table. */
4774 static void
4775 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4777 for (; descr; descr = descr->dw_loc_next)
4778 if (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry != NULL)
4780 gcc_assert (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4781 remove_addr_table_entry (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
4785 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
4786 htab_traverse. Assign an addr_table_entry its index. All entries
4787 must be collected into the table when this function is called,
4788 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
4789 in the same order for each run. */
4792 index_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **h, unsigned int *index)
4794 addr_table_entry *node = *h;
4796 /* Don't index unreferenced nodes. */
4797 if (node->refcount == 0)
4798 return 1;
4800 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4801 node->index = *index;
4802 *index += 1;
4804 return 1;
4807 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. When using
4808 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4809 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4810 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4812 static inline void
4813 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr,
4814 bool force_direct)
4816 dw_attr_node attr;
4818 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4819 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4820 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4821 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4822 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = add_addr_table_entry (addr, ate_kind_rtx);
4823 else
4824 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4825 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4828 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
4830 static inline rtx
4831 AT_addr (dw_attr_node *a)
4833 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
4834 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4837 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
4839 static inline void
4840 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4841 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
4843 dw_attr_node attr;
4845 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4846 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
4847 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4848 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
4849 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4852 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
4854 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4855 AT_file (dw_attr_node *a)
4857 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file
4858 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file_implicit));
4859 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
4862 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
4864 static inline void
4865 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4866 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
4868 dw_attr_node attr;
4870 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4871 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
4872 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4873 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
4874 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
4875 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4878 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4880 static inline void
4881 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4882 const char *lbl_id)
4884 dw_attr_node attr;
4886 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4887 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4888 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4889 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4890 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
4891 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4892 = add_addr_table_entry (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id,
4893 ate_kind_label);
4894 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4897 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4898 debug_line section. */
4900 static inline void
4901 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4902 const char *label)
4904 dw_attr_node attr;
4906 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4907 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
4908 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4909 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4910 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4913 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4914 debug_loclists section. */
4916 static inline void
4917 add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4918 const char *label)
4920 dw_attr_node attr;
4922 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4923 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loclistsptr;
4924 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4925 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4926 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4929 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4930 debug_macinfo section. */
4932 static inline void
4933 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4934 const char *label)
4936 dw_attr_node attr;
4938 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4939 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
4940 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4941 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4942 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4945 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4947 static inline void
4948 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4949 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4951 dw_attr_node attr;
4953 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4954 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4955 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4956 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4957 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4960 /* Add a range_list attribute value to a DIE. When using
4961 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4962 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4963 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4965 #define UNRELOCATED_OFFSET ((addr_table_entry *) 1)
4966 #define RELOCATED_OFFSET (NULL)
4968 static void
4969 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4970 long unsigned int offset, bool force_direct)
4972 dw_attr_node attr;
4974 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4975 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4976 /* For the range_list attribute, use val_entry to store whether the
4977 offset should follow split-debug-info or normal semantics. This
4978 value is read in output_range_list_offset. */
4979 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4980 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = UNRELOCATED_OFFSET;
4981 else
4982 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = RELOCATED_OFFSET;
4983 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4984 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4987 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
4989 static inline const char *
4990 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *a)
4992 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4993 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
4996 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
4998 static inline const char *
4999 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *a)
5001 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
5002 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
5005 static inline const char *
5006 AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *a)
5008 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5009 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5010 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr
5011 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loclistsptr
5012 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_high_pc));
5013 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5016 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5018 static dw_attr_node *
5019 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5021 dw_attr_node *a;
5022 unsigned ix;
5023 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5025 if (! die)
5026 return NULL;
5028 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5029 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5030 return a;
5031 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5032 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5033 spec = AT_ref (a);
5035 if (spec)
5036 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5038 return NULL;
5041 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE. */
5043 static dw_die_ref
5044 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
5046 dw_die_ref t;
5048 if (!die)
5049 return NULL;
5051 if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
5052 || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
5053 die = t;
5055 return die->die_parent;
5058 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5059 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5060 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5062 static inline const char *
5063 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5065 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5067 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5070 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5071 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5072 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5074 static inline const char *
5075 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5077 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5079 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5082 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5083 NULL if it is not present. */
5085 static inline const char *
5086 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5088 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5090 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5093 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5094 if it is not present. */
5096 static inline int
5097 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5099 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5101 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5104 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5105 if it is not present. */
5107 static inline unsigned
5108 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5110 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5112 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5115 static inline dw_die_ref
5116 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5118 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5120 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5123 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5124 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5126 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5128 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5131 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5133 static inline bool
5134 is_cxx (void)
5136 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5138 return (lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
5139 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14);
5142 /* Return TRUE if DECL was created by the C++ frontend. */
5144 static bool
5145 is_cxx (const_tree decl)
5147 if (in_lto_p)
5149 const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5150 if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5151 return strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context), "GNU C++", 7) == 0;
5153 return is_cxx ();
5156 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5158 static inline bool
5159 is_fortran (void)
5161 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5163 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5164 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5165 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95
5166 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran03
5167 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran08);
5170 static inline bool
5171 is_fortran (const_tree decl)
5173 if (in_lto_p)
5175 const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5176 if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5177 return (strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5178 "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0
5179 || strcmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5180 "GNU F77") == 0);
5182 return is_fortran ();
5185 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5187 static inline bool
5188 is_ada (void)
5190 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5192 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5195 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. Return TRUE if removal
5196 was successful. */
5198 static bool
5199 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5201 dw_attr_node *a;
5202 unsigned ix;
5204 if (! die)
5205 return false;
5207 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5208 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5210 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5211 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5212 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5214 /* vec::ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5215 that are needed. */
5216 die->die_attr->ordered_remove (ix);
5217 return true;
5219 return false;
5222 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5223 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5225 static void
5226 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5228 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5229 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5230 if (prev == child)
5232 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5233 prev = NULL;
5235 else
5236 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5237 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5238 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5239 child->die_sib = NULL;
5242 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
5243 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
5245 static void
5246 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
5248 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
5250 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
5251 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
5253 new_child->die_parent = parent;
5254 if (prev == old_child)
5256 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
5257 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
5259 else
5261 prev->die_sib = new_child;
5262 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
5264 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
5265 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
5266 old_child->die_sib = NULL;
5269 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
5271 static void
5272 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5274 dw_die_ref c;
5275 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
5276 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
5277 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
5280 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5281 matches TAG. */
5283 static void
5284 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5286 dw_die_ref c;
5288 c = die->die_child;
5289 if (c) do {
5290 dw_die_ref prev = c;
5291 c = c->die_sib;
5292 while (c->die_tag == tag)
5294 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5295 c->die_parent = NULL;
5296 /* Might have removed every child. */
5297 if (die->die_child == NULL)
5298 return;
5299 c = prev->die_sib;
5301 } while (c != die->die_child);
5304 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5306 static void
5307 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5309 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5310 if (! die || ! child_die)
5311 return;
5312 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5314 child_die->die_parent = die;
5315 if (die->die_child)
5317 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5318 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5320 else
5321 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5322 die->die_child = child_die;
5325 /* Like add_child_die, but put CHILD_DIE after AFTER_DIE. */
5327 static void
5328 add_child_die_after (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die,
5329 dw_die_ref after_die)
5331 gcc_assert (die
5332 && child_die
5333 && after_die
5334 && die->die_child
5335 && die != child_die);
5337 child_die->die_parent = die;
5338 child_die->die_sib = after_die->die_sib;
5339 after_die->die_sib = child_die;
5340 if (die->die_child == after_die)
5341 die->die_child = child_die;
5344 /* Unassociate CHILD from its parent, and make its parent be
5345 NEW_PARENT. */
5347 static void
5348 reparent_child (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5350 for (dw_die_ref p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5351 if (p->die_sib == child)
5353 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5354 break;
5356 add_child_die (new_parent, child);
5359 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5360 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5361 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5363 static void
5364 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5366 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5367 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5368 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5370 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5372 if (tmp)
5373 child = tmp;
5376 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5377 || (child->die_parent
5378 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5380 reparent_child (child, parent);
5383 /* Create and return a new die with TAG_VALUE as tag. */
5385 static inline dw_die_ref
5386 new_die_raw (enum dwarf_tag tag_value)
5388 dw_die_ref die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
5389 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5390 return die;
5393 /* Create and return a new die with a parent of PARENT_DIE. If
5394 PARENT_DIE is NULL, the new DIE is placed in limbo and an
5395 associated tree T must be supplied to determine parenthood
5396 later. */
5398 static inline dw_die_ref
5399 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5401 dw_die_ref die = new_die_raw (tag_value);
5403 if (parent_die != NULL)
5404 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5405 else
5407 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5409 /* No DIEs created after early dwarf should end up in limbo,
5410 because the limbo list should not persist past LTO
5411 streaming. */
5412 if (tag_value != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5413 /* These are allowed because they're generated while
5414 breaking out COMDAT units late. */
5415 && tag_value != DW_TAG_type_unit
5416 && tag_value != DW_TAG_skeleton_unit
5417 && !early_dwarf
5418 /* Allow nested functions to live in limbo because they will
5419 only temporarily live there, as decls_for_scope will fix
5420 them up. */
5421 && (TREE_CODE (t) != FUNCTION_DECL
5422 || !decl_function_context (t))
5423 /* Same as nested functions above but for types. Types that
5424 are local to a function will be fixed in
5425 decls_for_scope. */
5426 && (!RECORD_OR_UNION_TYPE_P (t)
5427 || !TYPE_CONTEXT (t)
5428 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (t)) != FUNCTION_DECL)
5429 /* FIXME debug-early: Allow late limbo DIE creation for LTO,
5430 especially in the ltrans stage, but once we implement LTO
5431 dwarf streaming, we should remove this exception. */
5432 && !in_lto_p)
5434 fprintf (stderr, "symbol ended up in limbo too late:");
5435 debug_generic_stmt (t);
5436 gcc_unreachable ();
5439 limbo_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
5440 limbo_node->die = die;
5441 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5442 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5443 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5446 return die;
5449 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5451 static inline dw_die_ref
5452 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5454 dw_die_ref die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5455 if (die && die->removed)
5457 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = NULL;
5458 return NULL;
5460 return die;
5463 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
5464 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
5465 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
5467 static inline dw_die_ref
5468 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5470 if (type
5471 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
5472 && type_die
5473 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
5474 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
5475 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
5476 return type_die;
5479 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
5480 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
5481 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
5482 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
5483 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
5484 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
5486 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
5487 a naming typedef is. */
5489 static inline dw_die_ref
5490 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
5492 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
5493 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
5496 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5498 static inline void
5499 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5501 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5504 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5506 inline hashval_t
5507 decl_die_hasher::hash (die_node *x)
5509 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5512 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5514 inline bool
5515 decl_die_hasher::equal (die_node *x, tree y)
5517 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5520 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5522 static inline dw_die_ref
5523 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5525 dw_die_ref *die = decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl),
5526 NO_INSERT);
5527 if (!die)
5528 return NULL;
5529 if ((*die)->removed)
5531 decl_die_table->clear_slot (die);
5532 return NULL;
5534 return *die;
5538 /* For DECL which might have early dwarf output query a SYMBOL + OFFSET
5539 style reference. Return true if we found one refering to a DIE for
5540 DECL, otherwise return false. */
5542 static bool
5543 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
5544 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off)
5546 dw_die_ref die;
5548 if (flag_wpa && !decl_die_table)
5549 return false;
5551 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5552 die = BLOCK_DIE (decl);
5553 else
5554 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
5555 if (!die)
5556 return false;
5558 /* During WPA stage we currently use DIEs to store the
5559 decl <-> label + offset map. That's quite inefficient but it
5560 works for now. */
5561 if (flag_wpa)
5563 dw_die_ref ref = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
5564 if (!ref)
5566 gcc_assert (die == comp_unit_die ());
5567 return false;
5569 *off = ref->die_offset;
5570 *sym = ref->die_id.die_symbol;
5571 return true;
5574 /* Similar to get_ref_die_offset_label, but using the "correct"
5575 label. */
5576 *off = die->die_offset;
5577 while (die->die_parent)
5578 die = die->die_parent;
5579 /* For the containing CU DIE we compute a die_symbol in
5580 compute_comp_unit_symbol. */
5581 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
5582 && die->die_id.die_symbol != NULL);
5583 *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
5584 return true;
5587 /* Add a reference of kind ATTR_KIND to a DIE at SYMBOL + OFFSET to DIE. */
5589 static void
5590 add_AT_external_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5591 const char *symbol, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5593 /* Create a fake DIE that contains the reference. Don't use
5594 new_die because we don't want to end up in the limbo list. */
5595 dw_die_ref ref = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
5596 ref->die_id.die_symbol = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (get_identifier (symbol));
5597 ref->die_offset = offset;
5598 ref->with_offset = 1;
5599 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr_kind, ref);
5602 /* Create a DIE for DECL if required and add a reference to a DIE
5603 at SYMBOL + OFFSET which contains attributes dumped early. */
5605 static void
5606 dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
5607 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off)
5609 if (debug_info_level == DINFO_LEVEL_NONE)
5610 return;
5612 if (flag_wpa && !decl_die_table)
5613 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (1000);
5615 dw_die_ref die
5616 = TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK ? BLOCK_DIE (decl) : lookup_decl_die (decl);
5617 gcc_assert (!die);
5619 tree ctx;
5620 dw_die_ref parent = NULL;
5621 /* Need to lookup a DIE for the decls context - the containing
5622 function or translation unit. */
5623 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5625 ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (decl);
5626 /* ??? We do not output DIEs for all scopes thus skip as
5627 many DIEs as needed. */
5628 while (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK
5629 && !BLOCK_DIE (ctx))
5630 ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (ctx);
5632 else
5633 ctx = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
5634 while (ctx && TYPE_P (ctx))
5635 ctx = TYPE_CONTEXT (ctx);
5636 if (ctx)
5638 if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK)
5639 parent = BLOCK_DIE (ctx);
5640 else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
5641 /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA. */
5642 && !flag_wpa)
5643 /* Otherwise all late annotations go to the main CU which
5644 imports the original CUs. */
5645 parent = comp_unit_die ();
5646 else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == FUNCTION_DECL
5647 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL
5648 && TREE_CODE (decl) != BLOCK)
5649 /* Leave function local entities parent determination to when
5650 we process scope vars. */
5652 else
5653 parent = lookup_decl_die (ctx);
5655 else
5656 /* In some cases the FEs fail to set DECL_CONTEXT properly.
5657 Handle this case gracefully by globalizing stuff. */
5658 parent = comp_unit_die ();
5659 /* Create a DIE "stub". */
5660 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
5662 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
5663 if (! flag_wpa)
5665 die = comp_unit_die ();
5666 dw_die_ref import = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_unit, die, NULL_TREE);
5667 add_AT_external_die_ref (import, DW_AT_import, sym, off);
5668 /* We re-target all CU decls to the LTRANS CU DIE, so no need
5669 to create a DIE for the original CUs. */
5670 return;
5672 /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA. */
5673 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, decl);
5674 break;
5675 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
5676 if (is_fortran (decl))
5677 die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, parent, decl);
5678 else
5679 die = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, parent, decl);
5680 break;
5681 case FUNCTION_DECL:
5682 die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, parent, decl);
5683 break;
5684 case VAR_DECL:
5685 die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
5686 break;
5687 case RESULT_DECL:
5688 die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
5689 break;
5690 case PARM_DECL:
5691 die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, parent, decl);
5692 break;
5693 case CONST_DECL:
5694 die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, parent, decl);
5695 break;
5696 case LABEL_DECL:
5697 die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, parent, decl);
5698 break;
5699 case BLOCK:
5700 die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, parent, decl);
5701 break;
5702 default:
5703 gcc_unreachable ();
5705 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5706 BLOCK_DIE (decl) = die;
5707 else
5708 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
5710 /* Add a reference to the DIE providing early debug at $sym + off. */
5711 add_AT_external_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, sym, off);
5714 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5716 inline hashval_t
5717 decl_loc_hasher::hash (var_loc_list *x)
5719 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5722 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5723 UID of decl *Y. */
5725 inline bool
5726 decl_loc_hasher::equal (var_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5728 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5731 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5733 static inline var_loc_list *
5734 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
5736 if (!decl_loc_table)
5737 return NULL;
5738 return decl_loc_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5741 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
5743 inline hashval_t
5744 dw_loc_list_hasher::hash (cached_dw_loc_list *x)
5746 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5749 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
5750 UID of decl *Y. */
5752 inline bool
5753 dw_loc_list_hasher::equal (cached_dw_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5755 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5758 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5760 static void
5761 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5763 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5765 *decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT) = decl_die;
5766 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5769 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5771 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5772 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
5774 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
5775 if (ret)
5776 return ret;
5777 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
5778 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
5779 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
5782 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5784 static rtx *
5785 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
5787 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
5788 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
5789 else
5790 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
5793 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
5794 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
5796 static rtx_expr_list *
5797 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
5799 if (bitsize > 0 && bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
5800 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
5801 else
5802 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
5803 GEN_INT (bitsize),
5804 loc_note), next);
5807 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
5808 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
5810 static rtx
5811 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5812 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
5814 if (bitsize != -1)
5816 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
5817 if (bitpos != 0)
5818 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
5820 return loc_note;
5823 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
5824 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
5825 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
5826 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
5827 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
5828 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
5829 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
5830 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
5831 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
5833 static void
5834 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
5835 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
5836 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
5838 HOST_WIDE_INT diff;
5839 bool copy = inner != NULL;
5841 if (copy)
5843 /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos. */
5844 while (src != inner)
5846 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5847 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5848 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5849 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5852 /* Add padding if needed. */
5853 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
5855 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
5856 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5857 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5859 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
5861 gcc_assert (!copy);
5862 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
5863 just update the location for it and return. */
5864 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
5865 return;
5867 /* Add the piece that changed. */
5868 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5869 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5870 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
5871 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
5872 if (!copy)
5873 src = dest;
5874 while (diff > 0 && *src)
5876 rtx piece = *src;
5877 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
5878 if (copy)
5879 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
5880 else
5882 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
5883 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
5886 /* Add padding if needed. */
5887 if (diff < 0 && *src)
5889 if (!copy)
5890 dest = src;
5891 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5892 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5894 if (!copy)
5895 return;
5896 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
5897 while (*src)
5899 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5900 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5901 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5902 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5906 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5908 static struct var_loc_node *
5909 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
5911 unsigned int decl_id;
5912 var_loc_list *temp;
5913 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
5914 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
5916 if (VAR_P (decl) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
5918 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
5919 if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
5920 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
5921 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
5923 bool reverse;
5924 tree innerdecl = get_ref_base_and_extent_hwi (realdecl, &bitpos,
5925 &bitsize, &reverse);
5926 if (!innerdecl
5927 || !DECL_P (innerdecl)
5928 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
5929 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
5930 || bitsize == 0
5931 || bitpos + bitsize > 256)
5932 return NULL;
5933 decl = innerdecl;
5937 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5938 var_loc_list **slot
5939 = decl_loc_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5940 if (*slot == NULL)
5942 temp = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_list> ();
5943 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5944 *slot = temp;
5946 else
5947 temp = *slot;
5949 /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
5950 even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry. */
5951 if (temp->last
5952 && temp->first == temp->last
5953 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
5954 && NOTE_P (temp->first->loc)
5955 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
5956 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
5957 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
5958 && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
5959 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
5960 && prev_real_insn (as_a<rtx_insn *> (temp->first->loc)) == NULL_RTX
5961 && (bitsize != -1
5962 || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
5963 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
5964 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
5965 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
5967 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5968 temp->first->next = loc;
5969 temp->last = loc;
5970 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5972 else if (temp->last)
5974 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
5975 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
5976 HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos = 0;
5977 if (last->next)
5979 last = last->next;
5980 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
5982 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
5984 piece_loc = &last->loc;
5987 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
5988 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
5989 break;
5990 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
5991 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
5993 while (*piece_loc);
5995 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
5996 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
5997 last element. */
5998 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
6000 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
6001 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
6002 if (piece_loc != NULL)
6004 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
6005 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
6006 return NULL;
6008 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
6009 if (temp->last != last)
6011 temp->last->next = NULL;
6012 unused = last;
6013 last = temp->last;
6014 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
6016 else
6018 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
6019 || (temp->first->next == temp->last
6020 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
6021 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
6022 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6023 return temp->last;
6026 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
6027 last_loc_note = last->loc;
6028 else if (piece_loc != NULL
6029 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
6030 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
6031 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
6032 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
6033 else
6034 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
6035 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
6036 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
6037 we have nothing to do. */
6038 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
6039 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
6040 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
6041 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6042 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
6043 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6044 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
6045 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
6046 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
6048 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
6049 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
6050 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
6051 if (unused)
6053 loc = unused;
6054 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
6056 else
6057 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6058 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
6059 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6060 else
6061 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
6062 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
6063 last->next = loc;
6064 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
6065 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
6066 if (last != temp->last)
6067 temp->last = last;
6069 else if (unused)
6070 ggc_free (unused);
6072 else
6074 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6075 temp->first = loc;
6076 temp->last = loc;
6077 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6079 return loc;
6082 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
6083 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
6084 the DIE internal representation. */
6085 static int print_indent;
6087 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
6089 static inline void
6090 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
6092 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
6095 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
6097 static inline void
6098 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
6100 int i;
6102 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
6103 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
6106 static inline void
6107 print_discr_value (FILE *outfile, dw_discr_value *discr_value)
6109 if (discr_value->pos)
6110 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, discr_value->v.sval);
6111 else
6112 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, discr_value->v.uval);
6115 static void print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref, FILE *);
6117 /* Print the value associated to the VAL DWARF value node to OUTFILE. If
6118 RECURSE, output location descriptor operations. */
6120 static void
6121 print_dw_val (dw_val_node *val, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6123 switch (val->val_class)
6125 case dw_val_class_addr:
6126 fprintf (outfile, "address");
6127 break;
6128 case dw_val_class_offset:
6129 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
6130 break;
6131 case dw_val_class_loc:
6132 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
6133 if (val->v.val_loc == NULL)
6134 fprintf (outfile, " -> <null>\n");
6135 else if (recurse)
6137 fprintf (outfile, ":\n");
6138 print_indent += 4;
6139 print_loc_descr (val->v.val_loc, outfile);
6140 print_indent -= 4;
6142 else
6143 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)\n", (void *) val->v.val_loc);
6144 break;
6145 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6146 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
6147 val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol);
6148 break;
6149 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6150 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
6151 break;
6152 case dw_val_class_const:
6153 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6154 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val->v.val_int);
6155 break;
6156 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6157 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6158 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, val->v.val_unsigned);
6159 break;
6160 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6161 fprintf (outfile, "constant (" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
6162 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
6163 val->v.val_double.high,
6164 val->v.val_double.low);
6165 break;
6166 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6168 int i = val->v.val_wide->get_len ();
6169 fprintf (outfile, "constant (");
6170 gcc_assert (i > 0);
6171 if (val->v.val_wide->elt (i - 1) == 0)
6172 fprintf (outfile, "0x");
6173 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
6174 val->v.val_wide->elt (--i));
6175 while (--i >= 0)
6176 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_PADDED_HEX,
6177 val->v.val_wide->elt (i));
6178 fprintf (outfile, ")");
6179 break;
6181 case dw_val_class_vec:
6182 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
6183 break;
6184 case dw_val_class_flag:
6185 fprintf (outfile, "%u", val->v.val_flag);
6186 break;
6187 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6188 if (val->v.val_die_ref.die != NULL)
6190 dw_die_ref die = val->v.val_die_ref.die;
6192 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6194 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
6195 print_signature (outfile,
6196 die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6198 else if (die->die_id.die_symbol)
6200 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", die->die_id.die_symbol);
6201 if (die->with_offset)
6202 fprintf (outfile, " + %ld", die->die_offset);
6204 else
6205 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", die->die_offset);
6206 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) die);
6208 else
6209 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
6210 break;
6211 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6212 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
6213 val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl2, val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1);
6214 break;
6215 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6216 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6217 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6218 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6219 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6220 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", val->v.val_lbl_id);
6221 break;
6222 case dw_val_class_str:
6223 if (val->v.val_str->str != NULL)
6224 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", val->v.val_str->str);
6225 else
6226 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
6227 break;
6228 case dw_val_class_file:
6229 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6230 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", val->v.val_file->filename,
6231 val->v.val_file->emitted_number);
6232 break;
6233 case dw_val_class_data8:
6235 int i;
6237 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
6238 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", val->v.val_data8[i]);
6239 break;
6241 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
6242 print_discr_value (outfile, &val->v.val_discr_value);
6243 break;
6244 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
6245 for (dw_discr_list_ref node = val->v.val_discr_list;
6246 node != NULL;
6247 node = node->dw_discr_next)
6249 if (node->dw_discr_range)
6251 fprintf (outfile, " .. ");
6252 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6253 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_upper_bound);
6255 else
6256 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6258 if (node->dw_discr_next != NULL)
6259 fprintf (outfile, " | ");
6261 default:
6262 break;
6266 /* Likewise, for a DIE attribute. */
6268 static void
6269 print_attribute (dw_attr_node *a, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6271 print_dw_val (&a->dw_attr_val, recurse, outfile);
6275 /* Print the list of operands in the LOC location description to OUTFILE. This
6276 routine is a debugging aid only. */
6278 static void
6279 print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, FILE *outfile)
6281 dw_loc_descr_ref l = loc;
6283 if (loc == NULL)
6285 print_spaces (outfile);
6286 fprintf (outfile, "<null>\n");
6287 return;
6290 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
6292 print_spaces (outfile);
6293 fprintf (outfile, "(%p) %s",
6294 (void *) l,
6295 dwarf_stack_op_name (l->dw_loc_opc));
6296 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6298 fprintf (outfile, " ");
6299 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd1, false, outfile);
6301 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6303 fprintf (outfile, ", ");
6304 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd2, false, outfile);
6306 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6310 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
6311 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6313 static void
6314 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
6316 dw_attr_node *a;
6317 dw_die_ref c;
6318 unsigned ix;
6320 print_spaces (outfile);
6321 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
6322 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
6323 (void*) die);
6324 print_spaces (outfile);
6325 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
6326 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
6327 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
6329 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6331 print_spaces (outfile);
6332 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
6333 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6334 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6337 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6339 print_spaces (outfile);
6340 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
6342 print_attribute (a, true, outfile);
6343 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6346 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6348 print_indent += 4;
6349 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
6350 print_indent -= 4;
6352 if (print_indent == 0)
6353 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6356 /* Print the list of operations in the LOC location description. */
6358 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6359 debug_dwarf_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
6361 print_loc_descr (loc, stderr);
6364 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
6366 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6367 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
6369 print_die (die, stderr);
6372 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6373 debug (die_struct &ref)
6375 print_die (&ref, stderr);
6378 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6379 debug (die_struct *ptr)
6381 if (ptr)
6382 debug (*ptr);
6383 else
6384 fprintf (stderr, "<nil>\n");
6388 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
6389 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6391 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6392 debug_dwarf (void)
6394 print_indent = 0;
6395 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
6398 /* Verify the DIE tree structure. */
6400 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6401 verify_die (dw_die_ref die)
6403 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6404 if (die->die_parent == NULL
6405 && die->die_sib == NULL)
6406 return;
6407 /* Verify the die_sib list is cyclic. */
6408 dw_die_ref x = die;
6411 x->die_mark = 1;
6412 x = x->die_sib;
6414 while (x && !x->die_mark);
6415 gcc_assert (x == die);
6416 x = die;
6419 /* Verify all dies have the same parent. */
6420 gcc_assert (x->die_parent == die->die_parent);
6421 if (x->die_child)
6423 /* Verify the child has the proper parent and recurse. */
6424 gcc_assert (x->die_child->die_parent == x);
6425 verify_die (x->die_child);
6427 x->die_mark = 0;
6428 x = x->die_sib;
6430 while (x && x->die_mark);
6433 /* Sanity checks on DIEs. */
6435 static void
6436 check_die (dw_die_ref die)
6438 unsigned ix;
6439 dw_attr_node *a;
6440 bool inline_found = false;
6441 int n_location = 0, n_low_pc = 0, n_high_pc = 0, n_artificial = 0;
6442 int n_decl_line = 0, n_decl_column = 0, n_decl_file = 0;
6443 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6445 switch (a->dw_attr)
6447 case DW_AT_inline:
6448 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned)
6449 inline_found = true;
6450 break;
6451 case DW_AT_location:
6452 ++n_location;
6453 break;
6454 case DW_AT_low_pc:
6455 ++n_low_pc;
6456 break;
6457 case DW_AT_high_pc:
6458 ++n_high_pc;
6459 break;
6460 case DW_AT_artificial:
6461 ++n_artificial;
6462 break;
6463 case DW_AT_decl_column:
6464 ++n_decl_column;
6465 break;
6466 case DW_AT_decl_line:
6467 ++n_decl_line;
6468 break;
6469 case DW_AT_decl_file:
6470 ++n_decl_file;
6471 break;
6472 default:
6473 break;
6476 if (n_location > 1 || n_low_pc > 1 || n_high_pc > 1 || n_artificial > 1
6477 || n_decl_column > 1 || n_decl_line > 1 || n_decl_file > 1)
6479 fprintf (stderr, "Duplicate attributes in DIE:\n");
6480 debug_dwarf_die (die);
6481 gcc_unreachable ();
6483 if (inline_found)
6485 /* A debugging information entry that is a member of an abstract
6486 instance tree [that has DW_AT_inline] should not contain any
6487 attributes which describe aspects of the subroutine which vary
6488 between distinct inlined expansions or distinct out-of-line
6489 expansions. */
6490 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6491 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_low_pc
6492 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_high_pc
6493 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_location
6494 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_frame_base
6495 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_call_all_calls
6496 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites);
6500 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6501 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6502 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
6504 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6506 static inline void
6507 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6509 int tem;
6510 inchash::hash hstate;
6511 hashval_t hash;
6513 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
6514 CHECKSUM (tem);
6515 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6516 hash = hstate.end();
6517 CHECKSUM (hash);
6520 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6522 static void
6523 attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6525 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6526 rtx r;
6528 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
6530 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6531 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6532 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6533 return;
6535 switch (AT_class (at))
6537 case dw_val_class_const:
6538 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6539 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6540 break;
6541 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6542 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6543 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6544 break;
6545 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6546 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6547 break;
6548 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6549 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6550 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6551 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6552 break;
6553 case dw_val_class_vec:
6554 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6555 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6556 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6557 break;
6558 case dw_val_class_flag:
6559 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
6560 break;
6561 case dw_val_class_str:
6562 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6563 break;
6565 case dw_val_class_addr:
6566 r = AT_addr (at);
6567 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6568 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6569 break;
6571 case dw_val_class_offset:
6572 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6573 break;
6575 case dw_val_class_loc:
6576 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6577 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
6578 break;
6580 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6581 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
6582 break;
6584 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6585 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6586 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6587 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6588 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6589 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6590 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6591 break;
6593 case dw_val_class_file:
6594 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6595 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6596 break;
6598 case dw_val_class_data8:
6599 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6600 break;
6602 default:
6603 break;
6607 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6609 static void
6610 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6612 dw_die_ref c;
6613 dw_attr_node *a;
6614 unsigned ix;
6616 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6617 if (die->die_mark)
6619 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6620 return;
6622 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6624 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6626 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6627 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6629 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6632 #undef CHECKSUM
6633 #undef CHECKSUM_BLOCK
6634 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6636 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
6637 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6638 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6639 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
6640 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6641 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6642 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
6643 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
6645 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
6647 static void
6648 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6650 unsigned char byte;
6651 bool more;
6653 while (1)
6655 byte = (value & 0x7f);
6656 value >>= 7;
6657 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
6658 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
6659 if (more)
6660 byte |= 0x80;
6661 CHECKSUM (byte);
6662 if (!more)
6663 break;
6667 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
6669 static void
6670 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6672 while (1)
6674 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
6675 value >>= 7;
6676 if (value != 0)
6677 /* More bytes to follow. */
6678 byte |= 0x80;
6679 CHECKSUM (byte);
6680 if (value == 0)
6681 break;
6685 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
6686 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
6688 static void
6689 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6691 const char *name;
6692 dw_die_ref spec;
6693 int tag = die->die_tag;
6695 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
6696 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
6697 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
6698 return;
6700 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6702 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6703 if (spec != NULL)
6704 die = spec;
6706 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
6707 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
6709 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
6710 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
6711 if (name != NULL)
6712 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
6715 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6717 static inline void
6718 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6720 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
6721 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
6722 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
6724 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6725 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
6726 return;
6729 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
6730 while (loc != NULL)
6732 inchash::hash hstate;
6733 hashval_t hash;
6735 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dtprel);
6736 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
6737 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6738 hash = hstate.end ();
6739 CHECKSUM (hash);
6740 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
6744 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6746 static void
6747 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_node *at,
6748 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6750 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6751 rtx r;
6753 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6755 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
6757 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
6758 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
6759 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
6760 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
6761 is complete or not. */
6762 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
6763 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6764 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6765 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
6766 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
6767 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
6768 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
6770 dw_attr_node *name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
6772 if (name_attr != NULL)
6774 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6776 if (decl == NULL)
6777 decl = target_die;
6778 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
6779 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6780 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6781 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6782 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
6783 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
6784 return;
6788 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
6789 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
6790 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
6791 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
6793 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
6794 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6795 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
6797 else
6799 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6801 if (decl == NULL)
6802 decl = target_die;
6803 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6804 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
6805 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6806 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6807 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6808 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
6810 return;
6813 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
6814 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6816 switch (AT_class (at))
6818 case dw_val_class_const:
6819 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6820 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6821 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6822 break;
6824 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6825 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6826 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6827 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6828 break;
6830 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6831 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6832 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
6833 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6834 break;
6836 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6837 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6838 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6839 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6840 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6841 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6842 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6843 break;
6845 case dw_val_class_vec:
6846 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6847 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6848 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size);
6849 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6850 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6851 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6852 break;
6854 case dw_val_class_flag:
6855 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
6856 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
6857 break;
6859 case dw_val_class_str:
6860 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6861 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6862 break;
6864 case dw_val_class_addr:
6865 r = AT_addr (at);
6866 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6867 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6868 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6869 break;
6871 case dw_val_class_offset:
6872 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6873 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6874 break;
6876 case dw_val_class_loc:
6877 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6878 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
6879 break;
6881 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6882 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6883 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6884 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6885 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6886 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6887 break;
6889 case dw_val_class_file:
6890 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6891 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6892 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6893 break;
6895 case dw_val_class_data8:
6896 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6897 break;
6899 default:
6900 break;
6904 struct checksum_attributes
6906 dw_attr_node *at_name;
6907 dw_attr_node *at_type;
6908 dw_attr_node *at_friend;
6909 dw_attr_node *at_accessibility;
6910 dw_attr_node *at_address_class;
6911 dw_attr_node *at_alignment;
6912 dw_attr_node *at_allocated;
6913 dw_attr_node *at_artificial;
6914 dw_attr_node *at_associated;
6915 dw_attr_node *at_binary_scale;
6916 dw_attr_node *at_bit_offset;
6917 dw_attr_node *at_bit_size;
6918 dw_attr_node *at_bit_stride;
6919 dw_attr_node *at_byte_size;
6920 dw_attr_node *at_byte_stride;
6921 dw_attr_node *at_const_value;
6922 dw_attr_node *at_containing_type;
6923 dw_attr_node *at_count;
6924 dw_attr_node *at_data_location;
6925 dw_attr_node *at_data_member_location;
6926 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_scale;
6927 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_sign;
6928 dw_attr_node *at_default_value;
6929 dw_attr_node *at_digit_count;
6930 dw_attr_node *at_discr;
6931 dw_attr_node *at_discr_list;
6932 dw_attr_node *at_discr_value;
6933 dw_attr_node *at_encoding;
6934 dw_attr_node *at_endianity;
6935 dw_attr_node *at_explicit;
6936 dw_attr_node *at_is_optional;
6937 dw_attr_node *at_location;
6938 dw_attr_node *at_lower_bound;
6939 dw_attr_node *at_mutable;
6940 dw_attr_node *at_ordering;
6941 dw_attr_node *at_picture_string;
6942 dw_attr_node *at_prototyped;
6943 dw_attr_node *at_small;
6944 dw_attr_node *at_segment;
6945 dw_attr_node *at_string_length;
6946 dw_attr_node *at_string_length_bit_size;
6947 dw_attr_node *at_string_length_byte_size;
6948 dw_attr_node *at_threads_scaled;
6949 dw_attr_node *at_upper_bound;
6950 dw_attr_node *at_use_location;
6951 dw_attr_node *at_use_UTF8;
6952 dw_attr_node *at_variable_parameter;
6953 dw_attr_node *at_virtuality;
6954 dw_attr_node *at_visibility;
6955 dw_attr_node *at_vtable_elem_location;
6958 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
6960 static void
6961 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
6963 dw_attr_node *a;
6964 unsigned ix;
6966 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6968 switch (a->dw_attr)
6970 case DW_AT_name:
6971 attrs->at_name = a;
6972 break;
6973 case DW_AT_type:
6974 attrs->at_type = a;
6975 break;
6976 case DW_AT_friend:
6977 attrs->at_friend = a;
6978 break;
6979 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6980 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
6981 break;
6982 case DW_AT_address_class:
6983 attrs->at_address_class = a;
6984 break;
6985 case DW_AT_alignment:
6986 attrs->at_alignment = a;
6987 break;
6988 case DW_AT_allocated:
6989 attrs->at_allocated = a;
6990 break;
6991 case DW_AT_artificial:
6992 attrs->at_artificial = a;
6993 break;
6994 case DW_AT_associated:
6995 attrs->at_associated = a;
6996 break;
6997 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
6998 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
6999 break;
7000 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
7001 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
7002 break;
7003 case DW_AT_bit_size:
7004 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
7005 break;
7006 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
7007 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
7008 break;
7009 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7010 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
7011 break;
7012 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
7013 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
7014 break;
7015 case DW_AT_const_value:
7016 attrs->at_const_value = a;
7017 break;
7018 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7019 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
7020 break;
7021 case DW_AT_count:
7022 attrs->at_count = a;
7023 break;
7024 case DW_AT_data_location:
7025 attrs->at_data_location = a;
7026 break;
7027 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
7028 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
7029 break;
7030 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
7031 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
7032 break;
7033 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
7034 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
7035 break;
7036 case DW_AT_default_value:
7037 attrs->at_default_value = a;
7038 break;
7039 case DW_AT_digit_count:
7040 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
7041 break;
7042 case DW_AT_discr:
7043 attrs->at_discr = a;
7044 break;
7045 case DW_AT_discr_list:
7046 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
7047 break;
7048 case DW_AT_discr_value:
7049 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
7050 break;
7051 case DW_AT_encoding:
7052 attrs->at_encoding = a;
7053 break;
7054 case DW_AT_endianity:
7055 attrs->at_endianity = a;
7056 break;
7057 case DW_AT_explicit:
7058 attrs->at_explicit = a;
7059 break;
7060 case DW_AT_is_optional:
7061 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
7062 break;
7063 case DW_AT_location:
7064 attrs->at_location = a;
7065 break;
7066 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
7067 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
7068 break;
7069 case DW_AT_mutable:
7070 attrs->at_mutable = a;
7071 break;
7072 case DW_AT_ordering:
7073 attrs->at_ordering = a;
7074 break;
7075 case DW_AT_picture_string:
7076 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
7077 break;
7078 case DW_AT_prototyped:
7079 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
7080 break;
7081 case DW_AT_small:
7082 attrs->at_small = a;
7083 break;
7084 case DW_AT_segment:
7085 attrs->at_segment = a;
7086 break;
7087 case DW_AT_string_length:
7088 attrs->at_string_length = a;
7089 break;
7090 case DW_AT_string_length_bit_size:
7091 attrs->at_string_length_bit_size = a;
7092 break;
7093 case DW_AT_string_length_byte_size:
7094 attrs->at_string_length_byte_size = a;
7095 break;
7096 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
7097 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
7098 break;
7099 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
7100 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
7101 break;
7102 case DW_AT_use_location:
7103 attrs->at_use_location = a;
7104 break;
7105 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
7106 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
7107 break;
7108 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
7109 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
7110 break;
7111 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7112 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
7113 break;
7114 case DW_AT_visibility:
7115 attrs->at_visibility = a;
7116 break;
7117 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
7118 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
7119 break;
7120 default:
7121 break;
7126 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
7128 static void
7129 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
7131 dw_die_ref c;
7132 dw_die_ref decl;
7133 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
7135 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
7136 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
7138 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
7140 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7141 if (decl != NULL)
7142 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
7143 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
7145 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
7146 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
7147 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
7148 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
7149 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
7150 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
7151 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
7152 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
7153 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
7154 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
7155 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
7156 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
7157 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
7158 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
7159 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
7160 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
7161 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
7162 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
7163 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
7164 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
7165 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
7166 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
7167 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
7168 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
7169 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
7170 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
7171 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
7172 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
7173 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
7174 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
7175 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
7176 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
7177 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
7178 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
7179 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
7180 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
7181 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
7182 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_bit_size);
7183 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_byte_size);
7184 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
7185 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
7186 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
7187 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
7188 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
7189 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
7190 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
7191 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
7192 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
7193 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
7194 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_alignment);
7196 /* Checksum the child DIEs. */
7197 c = die->die_child;
7198 if (c) do {
7199 dw_attr_node *name_attr;
7201 c = c->die_sib;
7202 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
7203 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7205 /* Ignore instantiations of member type and function templates. */
7207 else if (name_attr != NULL
7208 && (is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram))
7210 /* Use a shallow checksum for named nested types and member
7211 functions. */
7212 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
7213 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
7214 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
7216 else
7218 /* Use a deep checksum for other children. */
7219 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
7220 if (c->die_mark == 0)
7221 c->die_mark = -1;
7222 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
7224 } while (c != die->die_child);
7226 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
7229 /* Add a type name and tag to a hash. */
7230 static void
7231 die_odr_checksum (int tag, const char *name, md5_ctx *ctx)
7233 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
7234 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
7237 #undef CHECKSUM
7238 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
7239 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
7240 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
7241 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
7243 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
7244 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
7245 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
7246 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
7247 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
7248 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
7249 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
7251 static void
7252 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
7254 int mark;
7255 const char *name;
7256 unsigned char checksum[16];
7257 struct md5_ctx ctx;
7258 dw_die_ref decl;
7259 dw_die_ref parent;
7261 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
7262 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7263 parent = get_die_parent (die);
7265 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
7266 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
7267 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
7269 if (is_cxx () && name != NULL)
7271 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7273 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
7274 if (parent != NULL)
7275 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7277 /* Checksum the current DIE. */
7278 die_odr_checksum (die->die_tag, name, &ctx);
7279 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7281 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
7284 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
7286 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7287 mark = 1;
7288 die->die_mark = mark;
7290 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
7291 if (parent != NULL)
7292 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7294 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
7295 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
7296 unmark_all_dies (die);
7297 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7299 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
7300 type node together. */
7301 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
7302 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
7303 die->comdat_type_p = true;
7304 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7305 type_node->type_die = die;
7307 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
7308 as well. */
7309 if (decl != NULL)
7311 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7312 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7316 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
7317 static inline int
7318 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
7320 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
7321 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
7322 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
7325 /* Do the values look the same? */
7326 static int
7327 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
7329 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
7330 rtx r1, r2;
7332 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
7333 return 0;
7335 switch (v1->val_class)
7337 case dw_val_class_const:
7338 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
7339 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
7340 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7341 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
7342 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
7343 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7344 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
7345 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
7346 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
7347 return *v1->v.val_wide == *v2->v.val_wide;
7348 case dw_val_class_vec:
7349 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
7350 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
7351 return 0;
7352 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
7353 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
7354 return 0;
7355 return 1;
7356 case dw_val_class_flag:
7357 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
7358 case dw_val_class_str:
7359 return !strcmp (v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
7361 case dw_val_class_addr:
7362 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
7363 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
7364 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
7365 return 0;
7366 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
7368 case dw_val_class_offset:
7369 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
7371 case dw_val_class_loc:
7372 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
7373 loc1 && loc2;
7374 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
7375 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
7376 return 0;
7377 return !loc1 && !loc2;
7379 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7380 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
7382 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7383 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
7384 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7385 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7386 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7387 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
7388 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
7389 return 1;
7391 case dw_val_class_file:
7392 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
7393 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
7395 case dw_val_class_data8:
7396 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
7398 default:
7399 return 1;
7403 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
7405 static int
7406 same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *at1, dw_attr_node *at2, int *mark)
7408 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
7409 return 0;
7411 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
7412 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
7413 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
7414 return 1;
7416 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
7419 /* Do the dies look the same? */
7421 static int
7422 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
7424 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
7425 dw_attr_node *a1;
7426 unsigned ix;
7428 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
7429 if (die1->die_mark)
7430 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
7431 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
7433 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
7434 return 0;
7436 if (vec_safe_length (die1->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die2->die_attr))
7437 return 0;
7439 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
7440 if (!same_attr_p (a1, &(*die2->die_attr)[ix], mark))
7441 return 0;
7443 c1 = die1->die_child;
7444 c2 = die2->die_child;
7445 if (! c1)
7447 if (c2)
7448 return 0;
7450 else
7451 for (;;)
7453 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
7454 return 0;
7455 c1 = c1->die_sib;
7456 c2 = c2->die_sib;
7457 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
7459 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
7460 break;
7461 else
7462 return 0;
7466 return 1;
7469 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
7470 children, and set die_symbol. */
7472 static void
7473 compute_comp_unit_symbol (dw_die_ref unit_die)
7475 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
7476 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
7477 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
7478 char *p;
7479 int i, mark;
7480 unsigned char checksum[16];
7481 struct md5_ctx ctx;
7483 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
7484 the name filename of the unit. */
7486 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7487 mark = 0;
7488 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
7489 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
7490 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7492 /* When we this for comp_unit_die () we have a DW_AT_name that might
7493 not start with a letter but with anything valid for filenames and
7494 clean_symbol_name doesn't fix that up. Prepend 'g' if the first
7495 character is not a letter. */
7496 sprintf (name, "%s%s.", ISALPHA (*base) ? "" : "g", base);
7497 clean_symbol_name (name);
7499 p = name + strlen (name);
7500 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
7502 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
7503 p += 2;
7506 unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
7509 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
7511 static int
7512 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
7514 switch (die->die_tag)
7516 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7517 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7518 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7519 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7520 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7521 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7522 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7523 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7524 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7525 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7526 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7527 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7528 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7529 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7530 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7531 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7532 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7533 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7534 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7535 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7536 return 1;
7537 default:
7538 return 0;
7542 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
7543 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
7544 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
7545 compilations (functions). */
7547 static int
7548 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
7550 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
7551 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
7552 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
7553 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
7555 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
7556 return 0;
7558 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
7559 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
7560 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
7561 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
7562 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
7564 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
7566 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
7569 return is_type_die (c);
7572 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
7574 static inline bool
7575 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
7577 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7578 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7581 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort. */
7583 static inline bool
7584 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
7586 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7587 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
7588 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit
7589 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7592 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE. */
7594 static inline bool
7595 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
7597 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
7600 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE. */
7602 static inline bool
7603 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
7605 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7606 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
7609 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a template parameter. */
7611 static inline bool
7612 is_template_parameter (dw_die_ref die)
7614 switch (die->die_tag)
7616 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
7617 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
7618 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
7619 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
7620 return true;
7621 default:
7622 return false;
7626 /* Return non-zero if this DIE represents a template instantiation. */
7628 static inline bool
7629 is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref die)
7631 dw_die_ref c;
7633 if (!is_type_die (die) && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7634 return false;
7635 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (is_template_parameter (c)) return true);
7636 return false;
7639 static char *
7640 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
7642 char buf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7644 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
7645 return xstrdup (buf);
7648 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
7650 static int
7651 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
7653 dw_attr_node *a;
7654 unsigned ix;
7656 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7657 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
7658 return 1;
7660 return 0;
7663 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
7665 static int
7666 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
7668 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7670 if (decl == NULL)
7671 decl = die;
7672 return local_scope_p (decl);
7675 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
7676 subprogram. */
7678 static int
7679 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
7681 dw_die_ref c;
7683 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
7684 return 1;
7685 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition (c)) return 1);
7686 return 0;
7689 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
7690 COMDAT .debug_types section or .debug_info section with DW_UT_*type
7691 unit type. */
7693 static int
7694 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
7696 switch (die->die_tag)
7698 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7699 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7700 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7701 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7702 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, types nested in a
7703 subprogram, or types that contain subprogram definitions. */
7704 if (is_declaration_die (die)
7705 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7706 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die)
7707 || contains_subprogram_definition (die))
7708 return 0;
7709 return 1;
7710 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7711 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7712 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7713 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7714 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7715 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7716 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7717 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7718 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7719 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7720 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7721 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7722 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7723 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7724 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7725 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7726 default:
7727 return 0;
7731 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
7733 static dw_die_ref
7734 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
7736 dw_die_ref clone = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
7737 dw_attr_node *a;
7738 unsigned ix;
7740 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7741 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7743 return clone;
7746 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
7748 static dw_die_ref
7749 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
7751 dw_die_ref c;
7752 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
7754 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree (c)));
7756 return clone;
7759 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
7761 static dw_die_ref
7762 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
7764 dw_die_ref clone;
7765 dw_die_ref decl;
7766 dw_attr_node *a;
7767 unsigned ix;
7769 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
7770 if (is_declaration_die (die))
7771 return clone_die (die);
7773 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
7774 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7775 if (decl != NULL)
7777 clone = clone_die (decl);
7778 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7779 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7780 return clone;
7783 clone = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
7785 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7787 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
7788 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
7789 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
7791 switch (a->dw_attr)
7793 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
7794 case DW_AT_artificial:
7795 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7796 case DW_AT_external:
7797 case DW_AT_name:
7798 case DW_AT_type:
7799 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7800 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
7801 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
7802 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7803 break;
7804 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7805 case DW_AT_alignment:
7806 default:
7807 break;
7811 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7812 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7814 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
7815 return clone;
7819 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
7821 struct decl_table_entry
7823 dw_die_ref orig;
7824 dw_die_ref copy;
7827 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
7829 /* Hashtable helpers. */
7831 struct decl_table_entry_hasher : free_ptr_hash <decl_table_entry>
7833 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
7834 static inline hashval_t hash (const decl_table_entry *);
7835 static inline bool equal (const decl_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
7838 inline hashval_t
7839 decl_table_entry_hasher::hash (const decl_table_entry *entry)
7841 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
7844 inline bool
7845 decl_table_entry_hasher::equal (const decl_table_entry *entry1,
7846 const die_struct *entry2)
7848 return entry1->orig == entry2;
7851 typedef hash_table<decl_table_entry_hasher> decl_hash_type;
7853 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
7854 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
7855 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
7856 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
7858 static dw_die_ref
7859 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die,
7860 decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7862 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
7863 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
7864 dw_die_ref copy;
7865 decl_table_entry **slot = NULL;
7866 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
7868 if (decl_table)
7870 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
7871 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die, htab_hash_pointer (die),
7872 INSERT);
7873 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7875 entry = *slot;
7876 return entry->copy;
7879 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
7880 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7881 entry->orig = die;
7882 entry->copy = NULL;
7883 *slot = entry;
7886 if (parent != NULL)
7888 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
7889 if (spec != NULL)
7890 parent = spec;
7891 if (!is_unit_die (parent))
7892 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
7895 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
7896 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
7898 if (decl_table)
7900 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
7901 entry->copy = copy;
7904 return copy;
7906 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE. This includes
7907 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
7908 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
7909 attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
7910 parent of the declaration DIE. Returns NULL otherwise. */
7912 static dw_die_ref
7913 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
7915 dw_die_ref decl;
7916 dw_die_ref new_decl;
7917 dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
7919 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7920 if (decl == NULL)
7921 decl = die;
7922 else
7924 unsigned ix;
7925 dw_die_ref c;
7926 dw_attr_node *a;
7928 /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
7929 be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE. */
7930 orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
7932 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
7933 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
7934 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7935 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
7937 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
7939 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (decl->die_attr, ix, a)
7941 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
7942 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
7943 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
7944 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
7947 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree (c)));
7950 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
7951 && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
7953 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
7954 if (new_decl != NULL)
7956 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
7957 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
7961 return orig_parent;
7964 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
7965 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
7967 static void
7968 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
7970 if (node->new_die != NULL)
7971 return;
7973 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
7975 if (node->parent != NULL)
7977 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
7978 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
7982 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
7983 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
7984 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
7986 static void
7987 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
7989 skeleton_chain_node node;
7990 dw_die_ref c;
7991 dw_die_ref first;
7992 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7993 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7995 node.parent = parent;
7997 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
7998 if (c)
7999 next = c->die_sib;
8000 if (c) do {
8001 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
8002 prev = c;
8003 c = next;
8004 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
8005 node.old_die = c;
8006 node.new_die = NULL;
8007 if (is_declaration_die (c))
8009 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
8011 /* Instantiated templates do not need to be cloned into the
8012 type unit. Just move the DIE and its children back to
8013 the skeleton tree (in the main CU). */
8014 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
8015 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8016 c = prev;
8018 else if (c->comdat_type_p)
8020 /* This is the skeleton of earlier break_out_comdat_types
8021 type. Clone the existing DIE, but keep the children
8022 under the original (which is in the main CU). */
8023 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8025 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8026 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8027 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8028 c = clone;
8029 continue;
8031 else
8033 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
8034 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
8035 all the original's children, where the original came from
8036 (which is about to be moved to the type unit). */
8037 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8038 move_all_children (c, clone);
8040 /* If the original has a DW_AT_object_pointer attribute,
8041 it would now point to a child DIE just moved to the
8042 cloned tree, so we need to remove that attribute from
8043 the original. */
8044 remove_AT (c, DW_AT_object_pointer);
8046 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8047 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8048 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8049 node.old_die = clone;
8050 node.new_die = c;
8051 c = clone;
8054 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8055 } while (next != NULL);
8058 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
8060 static dw_die_ref
8061 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
8063 skeleton_chain_node node;
8065 node.old_die = die;
8066 node.new_die = NULL;
8067 node.parent = NULL;
8069 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
8070 and is not an instantiation of a template, always leave
8071 at least a declaration in its place. */
8072 if (die->die_parent != NULL
8073 && is_type_die (die->die_parent)
8074 && !is_template_instantiation (die))
8075 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
8077 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8078 return node.new_die;
8081 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
8082 declaration. The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
8083 existing references to it follow it to the new location. If any of the
8084 original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
8085 original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
8086 skeleton tree. */
8088 static dw_die_ref
8089 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
8090 dw_die_ref prev)
8092 dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
8094 /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE. If the returned
8095 ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
8096 that DIE. */
8097 orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
8099 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
8100 if (skeleton == NULL)
8101 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8102 else
8104 skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
8105 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
8107 /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
8108 the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
8109 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
8110 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
8111 references to it. */
8112 if (orig_parent != NULL)
8114 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8115 add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
8117 else
8118 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
8121 return skeleton;
8124 static void
8125 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8126 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8127 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs);
8129 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Make a copy of the DIE DWARF
8130 procedure, put it under TYPE_NODE and return the copy. Continue looking for
8131 DWARF procedure references in the DW_AT_location attribute. */
8133 static dw_die_ref
8134 copy_dwarf_procedure (dw_die_ref die,
8135 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8136 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8138 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure);
8140 /* DWARF procedures are not supposed to have children... */
8141 gcc_assert (die->die_child == NULL);
8143 /* ... and they are supposed to have only one attribute: DW_AT_location. */
8144 gcc_assert (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) == 1
8145 && ((*die->die_attr)[0].dw_attr == DW_AT_location));
8147 /* Do not copy more than once DWARF procedures. */
8148 bool existed;
8149 dw_die_ref &die_copy = copied_dwarf_procs.get_or_insert (die, &existed);
8150 if (existed)
8151 return die_copy;
8153 die_copy = clone_die (die);
8154 add_child_die (type_node->root_die, die_copy);
8155 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die_copy, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8156 return die_copy;
8159 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Look for references to DWARF
8160 procedures in DIE's attributes. */
8162 static void
8163 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8164 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8165 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8167 dw_attr_node *a;
8168 unsigned i;
8170 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, i, a)
8172 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8174 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_loc)
8175 continue;
8177 for (loc = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8179 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
8181 case DW_OP_call2:
8182 case DW_OP_call4:
8183 case DW_OP_call_ref:
8184 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
8185 == dw_val_class_die_ref);
8186 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die
8187 = copy_dwarf_procedure (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die,
8188 type_node,
8189 copied_dwarf_procs);
8191 default:
8192 break;
8198 /* Copy DWARF procedures that are referenced by the DIE tree to TREE_NODE and
8199 rewrite references to point to the copies.
8201 References are looked for in DIE's attributes and recursively in all its
8202 children attributes that are location descriptions. COPIED_DWARF_PROCS is a
8203 mapping from old DWARF procedures to their copy. It is used not to copy
8204 twice the same DWARF procedure under TYPE_NODE. */
8206 static void
8207 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (dw_die_ref die,
8208 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8209 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8211 dw_die_ref c;
8213 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8214 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c,
8215 type_node,
8216 copied_dwarf_procs));
8219 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types or .debug_info
8220 DW_UT_*type sections for each type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT
8221 section. */
8223 static void
8224 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
8226 dw_die_ref c;
8227 dw_die_ref first;
8228 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
8229 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
8230 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
8232 first = c = die->die_child;
8233 if (c)
8234 next = c->die_sib;
8235 if (c) do {
8236 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
8237 prev = c;
8238 c = next;
8239 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
8240 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
8242 dw_die_ref replacement;
8243 comdat_type_node *type_node;
8245 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
8246 break_out_comdat_types (c);
8248 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
8249 add it to the list of comdat types. */
8250 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
8251 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
8252 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
8253 type_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<comdat_type_node> ();
8254 type_node->root_die = unit;
8255 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
8256 comdat_type_list = type_node;
8258 /* Generate the type signature. */
8259 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
8261 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
8262 declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
8263 from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary). */
8264 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
8265 type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
8267 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
8268 add_child_die (unit, c);
8270 /* Types can reference DWARF procedures for type size or data location
8271 expressions. Calls in DWARF expressions cannot target procedures
8272 that are not in the same section. So we must copy DWARF procedures
8273 along with this type and then rewrite references to them. */
8274 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> copied_dwarf_procs;
8275 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8277 if (replacement != NULL)
8278 c = replacement;
8280 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
8281 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
8282 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
8283 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
8285 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
8286 break_out_comdat_types (c);
8288 } while (next != NULL);
8291 /* Like clone_tree, but copy DW_TAG_subprogram DIEs as declarations.
8292 Enter all the cloned children into the hash table decl_table. */
8294 static dw_die_ref
8295 clone_tree_partial (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8297 dw_die_ref c;
8298 dw_die_ref clone;
8299 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8300 decl_table_entry **slot;
8302 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
8303 clone = clone_as_declaration (die);
8304 else
8305 clone = clone_die (die);
8307 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die,
8308 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
8310 /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet. If it would be there
8311 before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
8312 clone_tree_partial wouldn't be called. */
8313 gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
8315 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8316 entry->orig = die;
8317 entry->copy = clone;
8318 *slot = entry;
8320 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
8321 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
8322 add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8324 return clone;
8327 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
8328 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
8329 type_unit). */
8331 static void
8332 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8334 dw_die_ref c;
8335 dw_attr_node *a;
8336 unsigned ix;
8338 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8340 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8342 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
8343 decl_table_entry **slot;
8344 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8346 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
8347 continue;
8349 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
8350 htab_hash_pointer (targ),
8351 INSERT);
8353 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8355 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
8356 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
8357 entry = *slot;
8358 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
8360 else
8362 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
8363 dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
8365 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
8366 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
8367 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
8368 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
8369 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8370 entry->orig = targ;
8371 entry->copy = copy;
8372 *slot = entry;
8374 /* If TARG is not a declaration DIE, we need to copy its
8375 children. */
8376 if (!is_declaration_die (targ))
8378 FOR_EACH_CHILD (
8379 targ, c,
8380 add_child_die (copy,
8381 clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8384 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
8385 type unit. */
8386 mark_dies (copy);
8388 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
8389 into the new type unit. */
8390 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
8391 && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
8392 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
8393 decl_table);
8395 add_child_die (parent, copy);
8396 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
8398 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
8399 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
8400 get visited otherwise. */
8401 if (parent != unit)
8403 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
8404 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
8405 parent->die_mark = 1;
8406 while (parent->die_parent
8407 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
8409 parent = parent->die_parent;
8410 parent->die_mark = 1;
8412 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
8418 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
8421 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
8422 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
8423 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
8424 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
8425 don't have an external reference. */
8427 static void
8428 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
8430 mark_dies (unit);
8431 decl_hash_type decl_table (10);
8432 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, &decl_table);
8433 unmark_dies (unit);
8436 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
8437 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
8438 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
8440 static void
8441 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
8443 dw_die_ref c;
8445 if (! die->die_child)
8446 return;
8448 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
8449 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
8451 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
8454 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
8456 static void
8457 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
8459 dw_die_ref c;
8460 dw_attr_node *a;
8461 unsigned ix;
8463 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8464 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8465 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
8467 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
8470 /* During assign_location_list_indexes and output_loclists_offset the
8471 current index, after it the number of assigned indexes (i.e. how
8472 large the .debug_loclists* offset table should be). */
8473 static unsigned int loc_list_idx;
8475 /* Output all location list offsets for the DIE and its children. */
8477 static void
8478 output_loclists_offsets (dw_die_ref die)
8480 dw_die_ref c;
8481 dw_attr_node *a;
8482 unsigned ix;
8484 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8485 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8487 dw_loc_list_ref l = AT_loc_list (a);
8488 if (l->offset_emitted)
8489 continue;
8490 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l->ll_symbol,
8491 loc_section_label, NULL);
8492 gcc_assert (l->hash == loc_list_idx);
8493 loc_list_idx++;
8494 l->offset_emitted = true;
8497 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_loclists_offsets (c));
8500 /* Recursively set indexes of location lists. */
8502 static void
8503 assign_location_list_indexes (dw_die_ref die)
8505 dw_die_ref c;
8506 dw_attr_node *a;
8507 unsigned ix;
8509 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8510 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8512 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
8513 if (!list->num_assigned)
8515 list->num_assigned = true;
8516 list->hash = loc_list_idx++;
8520 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_location_list_indexes (c));
8523 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
8524 larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
8525 even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
8526 can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
8527 So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
8528 make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
8530 This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
8531 references. */
8533 struct external_ref
8535 dw_die_ref type;
8536 dw_die_ref stub;
8537 unsigned n_refs;
8540 /* Hashtable helpers. */
8542 struct external_ref_hasher : free_ptr_hash <external_ref>
8544 static inline hashval_t hash (const external_ref *);
8545 static inline bool equal (const external_ref *, const external_ref *);
8548 inline hashval_t
8549 external_ref_hasher::hash (const external_ref *r)
8551 dw_die_ref die = r->type;
8552 hashval_t h = 0;
8554 /* We can't use the address of the DIE for hashing, because
8555 that will make the order of the stub DIEs non-deterministic. */
8556 if (! die->comdat_type_p)
8557 /* We have a symbol; use it to compute a hash. */
8558 h = htab_hash_string (die->die_id.die_symbol);
8559 else
8561 /* We have a type signature; use a subset of the bits as the hash.
8562 The 8-byte signature is at least as large as hashval_t. */
8563 comdat_type_node *type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8564 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
8566 return h;
8569 inline bool
8570 external_ref_hasher::equal (const external_ref *r1, const external_ref *r2)
8572 return r1->type == r2->type;
8575 typedef hash_table<external_ref_hasher> external_ref_hash_type;
8577 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE. */
8579 static struct external_ref *
8580 lookup_external_ref (external_ref_hash_type *map, dw_die_ref die)
8582 struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
8583 external_ref **slot;
8585 ref.type = die;
8586 slot = map->find_slot (&ref, INSERT);
8587 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8588 return *slot;
8590 ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
8591 ref_p->type = die;
8592 *slot = ref_p;
8593 return ref_p;
8596 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
8598 If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub. If we see external
8599 references, remember how many we've seen. */
8601 static void
8602 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *map)
8604 dw_die_ref c;
8605 dw_attr_node *a;
8606 unsigned ix;
8607 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8609 if (is_type_die (die)
8610 && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
8612 /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references. */
8613 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8614 ref_p->stub = die;
8617 /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
8618 other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
8619 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8620 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8621 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
8622 && is_type_die (c))
8624 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8625 ref_p->n_refs++;
8628 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
8631 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below. SLOT
8632 points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing. If we don't
8633 already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub. */
8636 dwarf2_build_local_stub (external_ref **slot, dw_die_ref data)
8638 struct external_ref *ref_p = *slot;
8640 if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
8642 /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
8643 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
8644 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names. */
8645 dw_die_ref cu = data;
8646 dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
8647 dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
8649 if (type->comdat_type_p)
8651 /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature. */
8652 stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
8653 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
8655 else
8657 /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name. */
8658 stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
8659 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
8662 stub->die_mark++;
8663 ref_p->stub = stub;
8665 return 1;
8668 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
8669 any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
8670 them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table. This is useful because
8671 references to local DIEs are smaller. */
8673 static external_ref_hash_type *
8674 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
8676 external_ref_hash_type *map = new external_ref_hash_type (10);
8677 optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
8678 map->traverse <dw_die_ref, dwarf2_build_local_stub> (die);
8679 return map;
8682 /* The following 3 variables are temporaries that are computed only during the
8683 build_abbrev_table call and used and released during the following
8684 optimize_abbrev_table call. */
8686 /* First abbrev_id that can be optimized based on usage. */
8687 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_start;
8689 /* Maximum abbrev_id of a base type plus one (we can't optimize DIEs with
8690 abbrev_id smaller than this, because they must be already sized
8691 during build_abbrev_table). */
8692 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_base_type_end;
8694 /* Vector of usage counts during build_abbrev_table. Indexed by
8695 abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start. */
8696 static vec<unsigned int> abbrev_usage_count;
8698 /* Vector of all DIEs added with die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start. */
8699 static vec<dw_die_ref> sorted_abbrev_dies;
8701 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
8702 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
8703 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
8704 die are visited recursively. */
8706 static void
8707 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *extern_map)
8709 unsigned int abbrev_id = 0;
8710 dw_die_ref c;
8711 dw_attr_node *a;
8712 unsigned ix;
8713 dw_die_ref abbrev;
8715 /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
8716 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
8717 the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs. */
8718 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8719 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8720 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
8722 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8723 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
8725 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c);
8726 if (ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die)
8727 change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
8728 else
8729 /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external. */
8730 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
8733 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
8735 dw_attr_node *die_a, *abbrev_a;
8736 unsigned ix;
8737 bool ok = true;
8739 if (abbrev_id == 0)
8740 continue;
8741 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
8742 continue;
8743 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
8744 continue;
8746 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr))
8747 continue;
8749 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
8751 abbrev_a = &(*abbrev->die_attr)[ix];
8752 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
8753 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
8755 ok = false;
8756 break;
8759 if (ok)
8760 break;
8763 if (abbrev_id >= vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table))
8765 vec_safe_push (abbrev_die_table, die);
8766 if (abbrev_opt_start)
8767 abbrev_usage_count.safe_push (0);
8769 if (abbrev_opt_start && abbrev_id >= abbrev_opt_start)
8771 abbrev_usage_count[abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start]++;
8772 sorted_abbrev_dies.safe_push (die);
8775 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
8776 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
8779 /* Callback function for sorted_abbrev_dies vector sorting. We sort
8780 by die_abbrev's usage count, from the most commonly used
8781 abbreviation to the least. */
8783 static int
8784 die_abbrev_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
8786 dw_die_ref die1 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p1;
8787 dw_die_ref die2 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p2;
8789 gcc_checking_assert (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
8790 gcc_checking_assert (die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
8792 if (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end
8793 && die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
8795 if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
8796 > abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
8797 return -1;
8798 if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
8799 < abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
8800 return 1;
8803 /* Stabilize the sort. */
8804 if (die1->die_abbrev < die2->die_abbrev)
8805 return -1;
8806 if (die1->die_abbrev > die2->die_abbrev)
8807 return 1;
8809 return 0;
8812 /* Convert dw_val_class_const and dw_val_class_unsigned_const class attributes
8813 of DIEs in between sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id] and abbrev_dies[end_id - 1]
8814 into dw_val_class_const_implicit or
8815 dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit. */
8817 static void
8818 optimize_implicit_const (unsigned int first_id, unsigned int end,
8819 vec<bool> &implicit_consts)
8821 /* It never makes sense if there is just one DIE using the abbreviation. */
8822 if (end < first_id + 2)
8823 return;
8825 dw_attr_node *a;
8826 unsigned ix, i;
8827 dw_die_ref die = sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id];
8828 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8829 if (implicit_consts[ix])
8831 enum dw_val_class new_class = dw_val_class_none;
8832 switch (AT_class (a))
8834 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8835 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) AT_unsigned (a) < 0)
8836 continue;
8838 /* The .debug_abbrev section will grow by
8839 size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)) and we avoid the constants
8840 in all the DIEs using that abbreviation. */
8841 if (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)) * (end - first_id)
8842 <= (unsigned) size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)))
8843 continue;
8845 new_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit;
8846 break;
8848 case dw_val_class_const:
8849 new_class = dw_val_class_const_implicit;
8850 break;
8852 case dw_val_class_file:
8853 new_class = dw_val_class_file_implicit;
8854 break;
8856 default:
8857 continue;
8859 for (i = first_id; i < end; i++)
8860 (*sorted_abbrev_dies[i]->die_attr)[ix].dw_attr_val.val_class
8861 = new_class;
8865 /* Attempt to optimize abbreviation table from abbrev_opt_start
8866 abbreviation above. */
8868 static void
8869 optimize_abbrev_table (void)
8871 if (abbrev_opt_start
8872 && vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > abbrev_opt_start
8873 && (dwarf_version >= 5 || vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > 127))
8875 auto_vec<bool, 32> implicit_consts;
8876 sorted_abbrev_dies.qsort (die_abbrev_cmp);
8878 unsigned int abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_start - 1;
8879 unsigned int first_id = ~0U;
8880 unsigned int last_abbrev_id = 0;
8881 unsigned int i;
8882 dw_die_ref die;
8883 if (abbrev_opt_base_type_end > abbrev_opt_start)
8884 abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_base_type_end - 1;
8885 /* Reassign abbreviation ids from abbrev_opt_start above, so that
8886 most commonly used abbreviations come first. */
8887 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (sorted_abbrev_dies, i, die)
8889 dw_attr_node *a;
8890 unsigned ix;
8892 /* If calc_base_type_die_sizes has been called, the CU and
8893 base types after it can't be optimized, because we've already
8894 calculated their DIE offsets. We've sorted them first. */
8895 if (die->die_abbrev < abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
8896 continue;
8897 if (die->die_abbrev != last_abbrev_id)
8899 last_abbrev_id = die->die_abbrev;
8900 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
8901 optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
8902 abbrev_id++;
8903 (*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id] = die;
8904 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
8906 first_id = i;
8907 implicit_consts.truncate (0);
8909 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8910 switch (AT_class (a))
8912 case dw_val_class_const:
8913 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8914 case dw_val_class_file:
8915 implicit_consts.safe_push (true);
8916 break;
8917 default:
8918 implicit_consts.safe_push (false);
8919 break;
8923 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
8925 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8926 if (!implicit_consts[ix])
8927 continue;
8928 else
8930 dw_attr_node *other_a
8931 = &(*(*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id]->die_attr)[ix];
8932 if (!dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_attr_val,
8933 &other_a->dw_attr_val))
8934 implicit_consts[ix] = false;
8937 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
8939 gcc_assert (abbrev_id == vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) - 1);
8940 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
8941 optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
8944 abbrev_opt_start = 0;
8945 abbrev_opt_base_type_end = 0;
8946 abbrev_usage_count.release ();
8947 sorted_abbrev_dies.release ();
8950 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
8952 static int
8953 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
8955 int log;
8957 if (value == 0)
8958 log = 0;
8959 else
8960 log = floor_log2 (value);
8962 log = log / 8;
8963 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
8965 return log;
8968 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
8969 .debug_info section. */
8971 static unsigned long
8972 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
8974 unsigned long size = 0;
8975 dw_attr_node *a;
8976 unsigned ix;
8977 enum dwarf_form form;
8979 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
8980 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8982 switch (AT_class (a))
8984 case dw_val_class_addr:
8985 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8987 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8988 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8990 else
8991 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8992 break;
8993 case dw_val_class_offset:
8994 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8995 break;
8996 case dw_val_class_loc:
8998 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
9000 /* Block length. */
9001 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9002 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
9003 else
9004 size += constant_size (lsize);
9005 size += lsize;
9007 break;
9008 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9009 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && dwarf_version >= 5)
9011 gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
9012 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash);
9014 else
9015 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9016 break;
9017 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9018 if (value_format (a) == DW_FORM_rnglistx)
9020 gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
9021 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9022 size += size_of_uleb128 (r->idx);
9024 else
9025 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9026 break;
9027 case dw_val_class_const:
9028 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
9029 break;
9030 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9032 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9033 if (dwarf_version == 3
9034 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
9035 && csize >= 4)
9036 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
9037 else
9038 size += csize;
9040 break;
9041 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9042 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9043 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9044 /* These occupy no size in the DIE, just an extra sleb128 in
9045 .debug_abbrev. */
9046 break;
9047 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9048 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9049 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9050 size++; /* block */
9051 break;
9052 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9053 size += (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9054 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
9055 if (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9056 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9057 size++; /* block */
9058 break;
9059 case dw_val_class_vec:
9060 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9061 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
9062 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9063 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
9064 break;
9065 case dw_val_class_flag:
9066 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9067 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9068 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9069 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9070 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9071 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9072 the same abbrev entry. */
9073 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9074 else
9075 size += 1;
9076 break;
9077 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9078 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9080 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
9081 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
9082 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
9083 it's always sized as an offset. */
9084 if (use_debug_types)
9085 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
9086 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
9087 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9088 else
9089 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9091 else
9092 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9093 break;
9094 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9095 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9096 break;
9097 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9098 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9100 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
9101 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9103 else
9104 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9105 break;
9106 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9107 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9108 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9109 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9110 break;
9111 case dw_val_class_str:
9112 form = AT_string_form (a);
9113 if (form == DW_FORM_strp || form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
9114 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9115 else if (form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9116 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9117 else
9118 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
9119 break;
9120 case dw_val_class_file:
9121 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
9122 break;
9123 case dw_val_class_data8:
9124 size += 8;
9125 break;
9126 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9127 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9128 break;
9129 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9130 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9131 break;
9132 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9133 size += size_of_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value);
9134 break;
9135 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9137 unsigned block_size = size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a));
9139 /* This is a block, so we have the block length and then its
9140 data. */
9141 size += constant_size (block_size) + block_size;
9143 break;
9144 default:
9145 gcc_unreachable ();
9149 return size;
9152 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
9153 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
9154 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
9155 die_offset field in each DIE. */
9157 static void
9158 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
9160 dw_die_ref c;
9162 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
9163 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
9164 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
9165 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
9167 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
9169 if (die->die_child != NULL)
9170 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
9171 next_die_offset += 1;
9174 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
9175 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
9176 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
9177 values for the base types. */
9179 static void
9180 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
9182 unsigned long die_offset = (dwarf_split_debug_info
9183 ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
9184 : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
9185 unsigned int i;
9186 dw_die_ref base_type;
9187 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9188 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
9189 #endif
9191 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
9192 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
9194 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9195 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
9196 && prev->die_sib == base_type
9197 && base_type->die_child == NULL
9198 && base_type->die_abbrev);
9199 prev = base_type;
9200 #endif
9201 if (abbrev_opt_start
9202 && base_type->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9203 abbrev_opt_base_type_end = base_type->die_abbrev + 1;
9204 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
9205 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
9209 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
9210 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
9211 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
9212 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
9214 static void
9215 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9217 dw_die_ref c;
9219 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
9221 die->die_mark = 1;
9222 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
9225 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
9227 static void
9228 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9230 dw_die_ref c;
9232 if (! use_debug_types)
9233 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
9235 die->die_mark = 0;
9236 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
9239 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
9241 static void
9242 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9244 dw_die_ref c;
9245 dw_attr_node *a;
9246 unsigned ix;
9248 if (!die->die_mark)
9249 return;
9250 die->die_mark = 0;
9252 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
9254 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9255 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
9256 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
9259 /* Calculate if the entry should appear in the final output file. It may be
9260 from a pruned a type. */
9262 static bool
9263 include_pubname_in_output (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *table, pubname_entry *p)
9265 /* By limiting gnu pubnames to definitions only, gold can generate a
9266 gdb index without entries for declarations, which don't include
9267 enough information to be useful. */
9268 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2 && is_declaration_die (p->die))
9269 return false;
9271 if (table == pubname_table)
9273 /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the
9274 parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned.
9275 Don't output them if that is the case. */
9276 if (p->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator &&
9277 (p->die->die_parent == NULL
9278 || !p->die->die_parent->die_perennial_p))
9279 return false;
9281 /* Everything else in the pubname table is included. */
9282 return true;
9285 /* The pubtypes table shouldn't include types that have been
9286 pruned. */
9287 return (p->die->die_offset != 0
9288 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types);
9291 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
9292 generated for the compilation unit. */
9294 static unsigned long
9295 size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
9297 unsigned long size;
9298 unsigned i;
9299 pubname_entry *p;
9300 int space_for_flags = (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) ? 1 : 0;
9302 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
9303 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, p)
9304 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, p))
9305 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1 + space_for_flags;
9307 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9308 return size;
9311 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
9313 static unsigned long
9314 size_of_aranges (void)
9316 unsigned long size;
9318 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
9320 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
9321 if (text_section_used)
9322 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9323 if (cold_text_section_used)
9324 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9325 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
9327 unsigned fde_idx;
9328 dw_fde_ref fde;
9330 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
9332 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
9333 continue;
9334 if (!fde->in_std_section)
9335 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9336 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
9337 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9341 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
9342 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9343 return size;
9346 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
9348 static enum dwarf_form
9349 value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9351 switch (AT_class (a))
9353 case dw_val_class_addr:
9354 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
9355 switch (a->dw_attr)
9357 case DW_AT_low_pc:
9358 case DW_AT_high_pc:
9359 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
9360 case DW_AT_trampoline:
9361 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9362 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
9363 default:
9364 break;
9366 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9368 case 1:
9369 return DW_FORM_data1;
9370 case 2:
9371 return DW_FORM_data2;
9372 case 4:
9373 return DW_FORM_data4;
9374 case 8:
9375 return DW_FORM_data8;
9376 default:
9377 gcc_unreachable ();
9379 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9380 if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9381 && dwarf_version >= 5
9382 && AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned)
9383 return DW_FORM_loclistx;
9384 /* FALLTHRU */
9385 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9386 /* For range lists in DWARF 5, use DW_FORM_rnglistx from .debug_info.dwo
9387 but in .debug_info use DW_FORM_sec_offset, which is shorter if we
9388 care about sizes of .debug* sections in shared libraries and
9389 executables and don't take into account relocations that affect just
9390 relocatable objects - for DW_FORM_rnglistx we'd have to emit offset
9391 table in the .debug_rnglists section. */
9392 if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9393 && dwarf_version >= 5
9394 && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_range_list
9395 && rnglist_idx
9396 && a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9397 return DW_FORM_rnglistx;
9398 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9399 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
9400 /* FALLTHRU */
9401 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9402 case dw_val_class_offset:
9403 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
9405 case 4:
9406 return DW_FORM_data4;
9407 case 8:
9408 return DW_FORM_data8;
9409 default:
9410 gcc_unreachable ();
9412 case dw_val_class_loc:
9413 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9414 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
9415 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
9417 case 1:
9418 return DW_FORM_block1;
9419 case 2:
9420 return DW_FORM_block2;
9421 case 4:
9422 return DW_FORM_block4;
9423 default:
9424 gcc_unreachable ();
9426 case dw_val_class_const:
9427 return DW_FORM_sdata;
9428 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9429 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
9431 case 1:
9432 return DW_FORM_data1;
9433 case 2:
9434 return DW_FORM_data2;
9435 case 4:
9436 /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
9437 DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
9438 constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
9439 a large constant. */
9440 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9441 return DW_FORM_udata;
9442 return DW_FORM_data4;
9443 case 8:
9444 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9445 return DW_FORM_udata;
9446 return DW_FORM_data8;
9447 default:
9448 gcc_unreachable ();
9450 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9451 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9452 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9453 return DW_FORM_implicit_const;
9454 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9455 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9457 case 8:
9458 return DW_FORM_data2;
9459 case 16:
9460 return DW_FORM_data4;
9461 case 32:
9462 return DW_FORM_data8;
9463 case 64:
9464 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9465 return DW_FORM_data16;
9466 /* FALLTHRU */
9467 default:
9468 return DW_FORM_block1;
9470 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9471 switch (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9473 case 8:
9474 return DW_FORM_data1;
9475 case 16:
9476 return DW_FORM_data2;
9477 case 32:
9478 return DW_FORM_data4;
9479 case 64:
9480 return DW_FORM_data8;
9481 case 128:
9482 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9483 return DW_FORM_data16;
9484 /* FALLTHRU */
9485 default:
9486 return DW_FORM_block1;
9488 case dw_val_class_vec:
9489 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9490 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
9492 case 1:
9493 return DW_FORM_block1;
9494 case 2:
9495 return DW_FORM_block2;
9496 case 4:
9497 return DW_FORM_block4;
9498 default:
9499 gcc_unreachable ();
9501 case dw_val_class_flag:
9502 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9504 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9505 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9506 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9507 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9508 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9509 the same abbrev entry. */
9510 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9511 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
9513 return DW_FORM_flag;
9514 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9515 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9516 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
9517 else
9518 return DW_FORM_ref;
9519 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9520 return DW_FORM_data;
9521 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9522 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9523 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
9524 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9525 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9526 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9527 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
9528 case dw_val_class_str:
9529 return AT_string_form (a);
9530 case dw_val_class_file:
9531 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
9533 case 1:
9534 return DW_FORM_data1;
9535 case 2:
9536 return DW_FORM_data2;
9537 case 4:
9538 return DW_FORM_data4;
9539 default:
9540 gcc_unreachable ();
9543 case dw_val_class_data8:
9544 return DW_FORM_data8;
9546 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9547 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9549 case 1:
9550 return DW_FORM_data1;
9551 case 2:
9552 return DW_FORM_data2;
9553 case 4:
9554 return DW_FORM_data4;
9555 case 8:
9556 return DW_FORM_data8;
9557 default:
9558 gcc_unreachable ();
9561 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9562 return (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos
9563 ? DW_FORM_udata
9564 : DW_FORM_sdata);
9565 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9566 switch (constant_size (size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a))))
9568 case 1:
9569 return DW_FORM_block1;
9570 case 2:
9571 return DW_FORM_block2;
9572 case 4:
9573 return DW_FORM_block4;
9574 default:
9575 gcc_unreachable ();
9578 default:
9579 gcc_unreachable ();
9583 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
9585 static void
9586 output_value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9588 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
9590 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
9593 /* Given a die and id, produce the appropriate abbreviations. */
9595 static void
9596 output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long abbrev_id, dw_die_ref abbrev)
9598 unsigned ix;
9599 dw_attr_node *a_attr;
9601 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
9602 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
9603 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
9605 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
9606 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
9607 else
9608 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
9610 for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (abbrev->die_attr, ix, &a_attr); ix++)
9612 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
9613 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
9614 output_value_format (a_attr);
9615 if (value_format (a_attr) == DW_FORM_implicit_const)
9617 if (AT_class (a_attr) == dw_val_class_file_implicit)
9619 int f = maybe_emit_file (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
9620 const char *filename = a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename;
9621 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (f, "(%s)", filename);
9623 else
9624 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int, NULL);
9628 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9629 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9633 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
9634 table. */
9636 static void
9637 output_abbrev_section (void)
9639 unsigned int abbrev_id;
9640 dw_die_ref abbrev;
9642 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
9643 if (abbrev_id != 0)
9644 output_die_abbrevs (abbrev_id, abbrev);
9646 /* Terminate the table. */
9647 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9650 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
9651 expression. */
9653 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
9654 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
9655 const char *section)
9657 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_list_node> ();
9659 retlist->begin = begin;
9660 retlist->begin_entry = NULL;
9661 retlist->end = end;
9662 retlist->expr = expr;
9663 retlist->section = section;
9665 return retlist;
9668 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
9669 hasn't got one yet. */
9671 static inline void
9672 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
9674 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
9675 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
9678 /* Output the location list given to us. */
9680 static void
9681 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
9683 if (list_head->emitted)
9684 return;
9685 list_head->emitted = true;
9687 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
9689 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
9690 const char *last_section = NULL;
9691 const char *base_label = NULL;
9693 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
9694 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
9696 unsigned long size;
9697 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
9698 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force)
9699 continue;
9700 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
9701 /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor. We could
9702 perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
9703 in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
9704 in a single range are unlikely very useful. */
9705 if (dwarf_version < 5 && size > 0xffff)
9706 continue;
9707 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9709 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9711 /* For -gsplit-dwarf, emit DW_LLE_starx_length, which has
9712 uleb128 index into .debug_addr and uleb128 length. */
9713 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_startx_length,
9714 "DW_LLE_startx_length (%s)",
9715 list_head->ll_symbol);
9716 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
9717 "Location list range start index "
9718 "(%s)", curr->begin);
9719 /* FIXME: This will ICE ifndef HAVE_AS_LEB128.
9720 For that case we probably need to emit DW_LLE_startx_endx,
9721 but we'd need 2 .debug_addr entries rather than just one. */
9722 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
9723 "Location list length (%s)",
9724 list_head->ll_symbol);
9726 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections && HAVE_AS_LEB128)
9728 /* If all code is in .text section, the base address is
9729 already provided by the CU attributes. Use
9730 DW_LLE_offset_pair where both addresses are uleb128 encoded
9731 offsets against that base. */
9732 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
9733 "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
9734 list_head->ll_symbol);
9735 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, curr->section,
9736 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9737 list_head->ll_symbol);
9738 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->section,
9739 "Location list end address (%s)",
9740 list_head->ll_symbol);
9742 else if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
9744 /* Otherwise, find out how many consecutive entries could share
9745 the same base entry. If just one, emit DW_LLE_start_length,
9746 otherwise emit DW_LLE_base_address for the base address
9747 followed by a series of DW_LLE_offset_pair. */
9748 if (last_section == NULL || curr->section != last_section)
9750 dw_loc_list_ref curr2;
9751 for (curr2 = curr->dw_loc_next; curr2 != NULL;
9752 curr2 = curr2->dw_loc_next)
9754 if (strcmp (curr2->begin, curr2->end) == 0
9755 && !curr2->force)
9756 continue;
9757 break;
9759 if (curr2 == NULL || curr->section != curr2->section)
9760 last_section = NULL;
9761 else
9763 last_section = curr->section;
9764 base_label = curr->begin;
9765 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_base_address,
9766 "DW_LLE_base_address (%s)",
9767 list_head->ll_symbol);
9768 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, base_label,
9769 "Base address (%s)",
9770 list_head->ll_symbol);
9773 /* Only one entry with the same base address. Use
9774 DW_LLE_start_length with absolute address and uleb128
9775 length. */
9776 if (last_section == NULL)
9778 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_length,
9779 "DW_LLE_start_length (%s)",
9780 list_head->ll_symbol);
9781 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9782 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9783 list_head->ll_symbol);
9784 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
9785 "Location list length "
9786 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9788 /* Otherwise emit DW_LLE_offset_pair, relative to above emitted
9789 DW_LLE_base_address. */
9790 else
9792 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
9793 "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
9794 list_head->ll_symbol);
9795 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, base_label,
9796 "Location list begin address "
9797 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9798 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, base_label,
9799 "Location list end address "
9800 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9803 /* The assembler does not support .uleb128 directive. Emit
9804 DW_LLE_start_end with a pair of absolute addresses. */
9805 else
9807 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_end,
9808 "DW_LLE_start_end (%s)",
9809 list_head->ll_symbol);
9810 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9811 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9812 list_head->ll_symbol);
9813 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
9814 "Location list end address (%s)",
9815 list_head->ll_symbol);
9818 else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9820 /* For -gsplit-dwarf -gdwarf-{2,3,4} emit index into .debug_addr
9821 and 4 byte length. */
9822 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_start_length_entry,
9823 "Location list start/length entry (%s)",
9824 list_head->ll_symbol);
9825 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
9826 "Location list range start index (%s)",
9827 curr->begin);
9828 /* The length field is 4 bytes. If we ever need to support
9829 an 8-byte length, we can add a new DW_LLE code or fall back
9830 to DW_LLE_GNU_start_end_entry. */
9831 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, curr->end, curr->begin,
9832 "Location list range length (%s)",
9833 list_head->ll_symbol);
9835 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
9837 /* Pair of relative addresses against start of text section. */
9838 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
9839 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9840 list_head->ll_symbol);
9841 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
9842 "Location list end address (%s)",
9843 list_head->ll_symbol);
9845 else
9847 /* Pair of absolute addresses. */
9848 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9849 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9850 list_head->ll_symbol);
9851 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
9852 "Location list end address (%s)",
9853 list_head->ll_symbol);
9856 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
9857 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9858 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Location expression size");
9859 else
9861 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
9862 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "Location expression size");
9865 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
9868 /* And finally list termination. */
9869 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9870 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_end_of_list,
9871 "DW_LLE_end_of_list (%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9872 else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9873 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_end_of_list_entry,
9874 "Location list terminator (%s)",
9875 list_head->ll_symbol);
9876 else
9878 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9879 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
9880 list_head->ll_symbol);
9881 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9882 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
9883 list_head->ll_symbol);
9887 /* Output a range_list offset into the .debug_ranges or .debug_rnglists
9888 section. Emit a relocated reference if val_entry is NULL, otherwise,
9889 emit an indirect reference. */
9891 static void
9892 output_range_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9894 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9896 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry == RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9898 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9900 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9901 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
9902 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
9904 else
9906 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
9907 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
9908 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
9909 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
9910 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
9911 *p = '\0';
9914 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9916 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9917 gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
9918 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r->idx, "%s", name);
9920 else
9921 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9922 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
9923 "%s (offset from %s)", name, ranges_section_label);
9926 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section. */
9928 static void
9929 output_loc_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9931 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
9933 gcc_assert (sym);
9934 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
9935 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
9936 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9937 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9939 gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
9940 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash, "%s (%s)",
9941 dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr),
9942 sym);
9944 else
9945 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
9946 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9949 /* Output an attribute's index or value appropriately. */
9951 static void
9952 output_attr_index_or_value (dw_attr_node *a)
9954 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9956 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9958 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a), "%s", name);
9959 return;
9961 switch (AT_class (a))
9963 case dw_val_class_addr:
9964 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
9965 break;
9966 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9967 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9968 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
9969 break;
9970 default:
9971 gcc_unreachable ();
9975 /* Output a type signature. */
9977 static inline void
9978 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
9980 int i;
9982 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9983 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
9986 /* Output a discriminant value. */
9988 static inline void
9989 output_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value, const char *name)
9991 if (discr_value->pos)
9992 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval, "%s", name);
9993 else
9994 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval, "%s", name);
9997 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
9998 the definitions of each child DIE. */
10000 static void
10001 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
10003 dw_attr_node *a;
10004 dw_die_ref c;
10005 unsigned long size;
10006 unsigned ix;
10008 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
10009 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
10010 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
10012 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
10014 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10016 switch (AT_class (a))
10018 case dw_val_class_addr:
10019 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10020 break;
10022 case dw_val_class_offset:
10023 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10024 "%s", name);
10025 break;
10027 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10028 output_range_list_offset (a);
10029 break;
10031 case dw_val_class_loc:
10032 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10034 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10035 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10036 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
10037 else
10038 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10040 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
10041 break;
10043 case dw_val_class_const:
10044 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
10045 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
10046 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
10047 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
10048 break;
10050 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10052 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
10053 if (dwarf_version == 3
10054 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
10055 && csize >= 4)
10056 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10057 else
10058 dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10060 break;
10062 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
10063 if (flag_debug_asm)
10064 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10065 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ")\n",
10066 ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_int (a));
10067 break;
10069 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
10070 if (flag_debug_asm)
10071 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10072 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX ")\n",
10073 ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_unsigned (a));
10074 break;
10076 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10078 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
10080 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10081 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
10082 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
10083 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10084 NULL);
10086 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10088 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10089 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10091 else
10093 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10094 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10097 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10098 first, "%s", name);
10099 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10100 second, NULL);
10102 break;
10104 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
10106 int i;
10107 int len = get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide);
10108 int l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
10109 if (len * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10110 dw2_asm_output_data (1, get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
10111 * l, NULL);
10113 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10114 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10116 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10117 "%s", name);
10118 name = "";
10120 else
10121 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
10123 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10124 "%s", name);
10125 name = "";
10128 break;
10130 case dw_val_class_vec:
10132 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
10133 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
10134 unsigned int i;
10135 unsigned char *p;
10137 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
10138 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
10139 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10141 elt_size /= 2;
10142 len *= 2;
10144 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
10145 i < len;
10146 i++, p += elt_size)
10147 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
10148 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
10149 break;
10152 case dw_val_class_flag:
10153 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10155 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10156 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10157 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10158 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10159 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10160 the same abbrev entry. */
10161 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
10162 if (flag_debug_asm)
10163 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
10164 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
10165 break;
10167 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
10168 break;
10170 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10171 output_loc_list_offset (a);
10172 break;
10174 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10175 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10177 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
10179 comdat_type_node *type_node
10180 = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
10182 gcc_assert (type_node);
10183 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
10185 else
10187 const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
10188 int size;
10190 gcc_assert (sym);
10191 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
10192 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
10193 offset. */
10194 if (dwarf_version == 2)
10195 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10196 else
10197 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10198 /* ??? We cannot unconditionally output die_offset if
10199 non-zero - others might create references to those
10200 DIEs via symbols.
10201 And we do not clear its DIE offset after outputting it
10202 (and the label refers to the actual DIEs, not the
10203 DWARF CU unit header which is when using label + offset
10204 would be the correct thing to do).
10205 ??? This is the reason for the with_offset flag. */
10206 if (AT_ref (a)->with_offset)
10207 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10208 debug_info_section, "%s", name);
10209 else
10210 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
10211 name);
10214 else
10216 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
10217 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10218 "%s", name);
10220 break;
10222 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10224 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10226 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
10227 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
10228 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
10229 "%s", name);
10231 break;
10233 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10234 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA
10235 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10236 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10237 "%s", name);
10238 #else
10239 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10240 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10241 "%s", name);
10242 #endif
10243 break;
10245 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10246 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10247 break;
10249 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10250 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10251 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
10252 break;
10254 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10255 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10256 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
10257 break;
10259 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
10260 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10261 debug_loc_section, "%s", name);
10262 break;
10264 case dw_val_class_str:
10265 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_strp)
10266 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10267 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10268 debug_str_section,
10269 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10270 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
10271 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10272 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10273 debug_line_str_section,
10274 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10275 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
10276 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a),
10277 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10278 else
10279 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
10280 break;
10282 case dw_val_class_file:
10284 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
10286 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
10287 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10288 break;
10291 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
10292 if (flag_debug_asm)
10293 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s (%d, %s)\n",
10294 ASM_COMMENT_START, name,
10295 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file),
10296 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10297 break;
10299 case dw_val_class_data8:
10301 int i;
10303 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10304 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
10305 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10306 break;
10309 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
10310 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10311 get_AT_low_pc (die), "DW_AT_high_pc");
10312 break;
10314 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
10315 output_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value, name);
10316 break;
10318 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
10320 dw_discr_list_ref list = AT_discr_list (a);
10321 const int size = size_of_discr_list (list);
10323 /* This is a block, so output its length first. */
10324 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size,
10325 "%s: block size", name);
10327 for (; list != NULL; list = list->dw_discr_next)
10329 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then as
10330 many LEB128 numbers as required. */
10331 if (list->dw_discr_range)
10332 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_range,
10333 "%s: DW_DSC_range", name);
10334 else
10335 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_label,
10336 "%s: DW_DSC_label", name);
10338 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound, name);
10339 if (list->dw_discr_range)
10340 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound, name);
10342 break;
10345 default:
10346 gcc_unreachable ();
10350 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
10352 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
10353 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10354 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
10355 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
10358 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
10359 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
10361 static void
10362 output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type ut)
10364 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10366 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10367 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10368 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10369 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10370 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
10371 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10374 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF version number");
10375 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10377 const char *name;
10378 switch (ut)
10380 case DW_UT_compile: name = "DW_UT_compile"; break;
10381 case DW_UT_type: name = "DW_UT_type"; break;
10382 case DW_UT_split_compile: name = "DW_UT_split_compile"; break;
10383 case DW_UT_split_type: name = "DW_UT_split_type"; break;
10384 default: gcc_unreachable ();
10386 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ut, "%s", name);
10387 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10389 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
10390 debug_abbrev_section,
10391 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10392 if (dwarf_version < 5)
10393 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10396 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
10398 static void
10399 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty,
10400 const unsigned char *dwo_id)
10402 const char *secname, *oldsym;
10403 char *tmp;
10405 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
10406 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
10407 return;
10409 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
10410 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
10411 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
10412 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
10413 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10414 mark_dies (die);
10416 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
10418 /* For now, optimize only the main CU, in order to optimize the rest
10419 we'd need to see all of them earlier. Leave the rest for post-linking
10420 tools like DWZ. */
10421 if (die == comp_unit_die ())
10422 abbrev_opt_start = vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table);
10424 build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
10426 optimize_abbrev_table ();
10428 delete extern_map;
10430 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10431 next_die_offset = (dwo_id
10432 ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
10433 : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
10434 calc_die_sizes (die);
10436 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10437 if (oldsym && die->comdat_type_p)
10439 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
10441 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
10442 secname = tmp;
10443 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
10444 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10446 else
10448 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
10449 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
10450 info_section_emitted = true;
10453 /* For LTO cross unit DIE refs we want a symbol on the start of the
10454 debuginfo section, not on the CU DIE. */
10455 if ((flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload) && oldsym)
10457 /* ??? No way to get visibility assembled without a decl. */
10458 tree decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, VAR_DECL,
10459 get_identifier (oldsym), char_type_node);
10460 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = true;
10461 TREE_STATIC (decl) = true;
10462 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = true;
10463 DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) = VISIBILITY_HIDDEN;
10464 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (decl) = true;
10465 targetm.asm_out.assemble_visibility (decl, VISIBILITY_HIDDEN);
10466 #ifdef ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
10467 /* We prefer a .weak because that handles duplicates from duplicate
10468 archive members in a graceful way. */
10469 ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10470 #else
10471 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10472 #endif
10473 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10476 /* Output debugging information. */
10477 output_compilation_unit_header (dwo_id
10478 ? DW_UT_split_compile : DW_UT_compile);
10479 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10481 if (dwo_id != NULL)
10482 for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10483 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
10485 output_die (die);
10487 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
10488 output_pubnames. */
10489 if (oldsym)
10491 unmark_dies (die);
10492 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
10496 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
10497 and .debug_pubtypes. This is configured per-target, but can be
10498 overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options. */
10500 static inline bool
10501 want_pubnames (void)
10503 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10504 return false;
10505 if (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1)
10506 return debug_generate_pub_sections;
10507 return targetm.want_debug_pub_sections;
10510 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes. */
10512 static void
10513 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
10515 if (want_pubnames ())
10516 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
10519 /* Add a string attribute value to a skeleton DIE. */
10521 static inline void
10522 add_skeleton_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
10523 const char *str)
10525 dw_attr_node attr;
10526 struct indirect_string_node *node;
10528 if (! skeleton_debug_str_hash)
10529 skeleton_debug_str_hash
10530 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
10532 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, skeleton_debug_str_hash);
10533 find_string_form (node);
10534 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
10535 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
10537 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
10538 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
10539 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
10540 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
10541 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
10544 /* Helper function to generate top-level dies for skeleton debug_info and
10545 debug_types. */
10547 static void
10548 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (dw_die_ref die)
10550 const char *dwo_file_name = concat (aux_base_name, ".dwo", NULL);
10551 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
10553 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_dwo_name), dwo_file_name);
10554 if (comp_dir != NULL)
10555 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, comp_dir);
10556 add_AT_pubnames (die);
10557 add_AT_lineptr (die, DW_AT_GNU_addr_base, debug_addr_section_label);
10560 /* Output skeleton debug sections that point to the dwo file. */
10562 static void
10563 output_skeleton_debug_sections (dw_die_ref comp_unit,
10564 const unsigned char *dwo_id)
10566 /* These attributes will be found in the full debug_info section. */
10567 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_producer);
10568 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_language);
10570 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_info_section);
10571 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_info_section_label);
10573 /* Produce the skeleton compilation-unit header. This one differs enough from
10574 a normal CU header that it's better not to call output_compilation_unit
10575 header. */
10576 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10577 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10578 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit "
10579 "DWARF extension");
10581 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10582 DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
10583 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
10584 + size_of_die (comp_unit),
10585 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10586 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF version number");
10587 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10589 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_UT_skeleton, "DW_UT_skeleton");
10590 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10592 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
10593 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section,
10594 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10595 if (dwarf_version < 5)
10596 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10597 else
10598 for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10599 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
10601 comp_unit->die_abbrev = SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV;
10602 output_die (comp_unit);
10604 /* Build the skeleton debug_abbrev section. */
10605 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section);
10606 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label);
10608 output_die_abbrevs (SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV, comp_unit);
10610 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of skeleton .debug_abbrev");
10613 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
10615 static void
10616 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
10618 const char *secname;
10619 char *tmp;
10620 int i;
10621 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10622 tree comdat_key;
10623 #endif
10625 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10626 mark_dies (node->root_die);
10628 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
10630 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
10632 delete extern_map;
10633 extern_map = NULL;
10635 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10636 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
10637 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
10639 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10640 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10642 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
10643 secname = ".debug_info";
10644 else
10645 secname = ".debug_info.dwo";
10647 else if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
10648 secname = ".debug_types";
10649 else
10650 secname = ".debug_types.dwo";
10652 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10653 sprintf (tmp, dwarf_version >= 5 ? "wi." : "wt.");
10654 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10655 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10656 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
10657 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
10658 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
10659 comdat_key);
10660 #else
10661 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10662 sprintf (tmp, (dwarf_version >= 5
10663 ? ".gnu.linkonce.wi." : ".gnu.linkonce.wt."));
10664 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10665 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10666 secname = tmp;
10667 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10668 #endif
10670 /* Output debugging information. */
10671 output_compilation_unit_header (dwarf_split_debug_info
10672 ? DW_UT_split_type : DW_UT_type);
10673 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
10674 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
10675 "Offset to Type DIE");
10676 output_die (node->root_die);
10678 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
10681 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
10683 static const char *
10684 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
10686 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
10687 return NULL;
10688 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
10691 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
10693 static void
10694 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
10696 pubname_entry e;
10698 e.die = die;
10699 e.name = xstrdup (str);
10700 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
10703 static void
10704 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10706 if (!want_pubnames ())
10707 return;
10709 /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
10710 just read the enclosing die. For example, if the consumer is looking at a
10711 class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
10712 looked up the class to find the member. Either way, searching the class is
10713 faster than searching the index. */
10714 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !class_scope_p (die->die_parent))
10715 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
10717 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
10719 if (name)
10720 add_pubname_string (name, die);
10724 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section. */
10726 static void
10727 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
10729 pubname_entry e;
10731 gcc_assert (scope_name);
10732 e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
10733 e.die = die;
10734 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
10737 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
10739 static void
10740 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10742 pubname_entry e;
10744 if (!want_pubnames ())
10745 return;
10747 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10748 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
10749 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
10751 tree scope = NULL;
10752 const char *scope_name = "";
10753 const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
10754 const char *name;
10756 scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
10757 if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
10759 scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
10760 if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
10761 scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
10762 else
10763 scope_name = "";
10766 if (TYPE_P (decl))
10767 name = type_tag (decl);
10768 else
10769 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
10771 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
10772 it to the table. */
10773 if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
10775 e.die = die;
10776 e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
10777 vec_safe_push (pubtype_table, e);
10780 /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
10781 enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
10782 enum type meets the criteria above. So rather than re-check the parent
10783 enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
10784 here. This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
10785 enums don't have names. */
10786 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
10788 dw_die_ref c;
10790 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
10795 /* Output a single entry in the pubnames table. */
10797 static void
10798 output_pubname (dw_offset die_offset, pubname_entry *entry)
10800 dw_die_ref die = entry->die;
10801 int is_static = get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_external) ? 0 : 1;
10803 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
10805 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2)
10807 /* This logic follows gdb's method for determining the value of the flag
10808 byte. */
10809 uint32_t flags = GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_NONE;
10810 switch (die->die_tag)
10812 case DW_TAG_typedef:
10813 case DW_TAG_base_type:
10814 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
10815 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10816 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10817 break;
10818 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
10819 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10820 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10821 if (!is_cxx ())
10822 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10823 break;
10824 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
10825 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10826 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_FUNCTION);
10827 if (!is_ada ())
10828 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10829 break;
10830 case DW_TAG_constant:
10831 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10832 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10833 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10834 break;
10835 case DW_TAG_variable:
10836 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10837 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10838 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10839 break;
10840 case DW_TAG_namespace:
10841 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
10842 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10843 break;
10844 case DW_TAG_class_type:
10845 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
10846 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
10847 case DW_TAG_union_type:
10848 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
10849 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10850 if (!is_cxx ())
10851 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10852 break;
10853 default:
10854 /* An unusual tag. Leave the flag-byte empty. */
10855 break;
10857 dw2_asm_output_data (1, flags >> GDB_INDEX_CU_BITSIZE,
10858 "GDB-index flags");
10861 dw2_asm_output_nstring (entry->name, -1, "external name");
10865 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
10866 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
10868 static void
10869 output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
10871 unsigned i;
10872 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
10873 pubname_entry *pub;
10875 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10877 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10878 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10879 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10880 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
10881 "Pub Info Length");
10884 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is independent of dwarf version. */
10885 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10887 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10888 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
10889 debug_skeleton_info_section,
10890 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10891 else
10892 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10893 debug_info_section,
10894 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10895 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
10896 "Compilation Unit Length");
10898 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, pub)
10900 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, pub))
10902 dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
10904 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
10905 if (names == pubname_table && pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
10906 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
10908 /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
10909 the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
10910 unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
10911 the skeleton DIE (if there is one). */
10912 if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
10914 comdat_type_node *type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
10916 if (type_node != NULL)
10917 die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
10918 ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
10919 : comp_unit_die ()->die_offset);
10922 output_pubname (die_offset, pub);
10926 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10929 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary. */
10931 static void
10932 output_pubtables (void)
10934 if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
10935 return;
10937 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
10938 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
10939 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
10940 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
10941 simply won't look for the section. */
10942 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
10943 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
10947 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
10948 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
10949 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
10951 static void
10952 output_aranges (void)
10954 unsigned i;
10955 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
10957 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10959 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10960 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10961 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10962 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
10963 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
10966 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even up to DWARF5. */
10967 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10968 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10969 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
10970 debug_skeleton_info_section,
10971 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10972 else
10973 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10974 debug_info_section,
10975 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10976 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
10977 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
10979 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
10980 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
10982 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
10983 pointer size. */
10984 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
10985 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10986 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
10987 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
10990 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
10991 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
10992 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
10993 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
10994 confused with the terminator. */
10995 if (text_section_used)
10997 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
10998 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
10999 text_section_label, "Length");
11001 if (cold_text_section_used)
11003 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
11004 "Address");
11005 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
11006 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
11009 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
11011 unsigned fde_idx;
11012 dw_fde_ref fde;
11014 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
11016 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
11017 continue;
11018 if (!fde->in_std_section)
11020 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
11021 "Address");
11022 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
11023 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
11025 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
11027 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
11028 "Address");
11029 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
11030 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
11035 /* Output the terminator words. */
11036 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11037 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11040 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return its index into
11041 ranges_table vector. */
11043 static unsigned int
11044 add_ranges_num (int num, bool maybe_new_sec)
11046 dw_ranges r = { NULL, num, 0, maybe_new_sec };
11047 vec_safe_push (ranges_table, r);
11048 return vec_safe_length (ranges_table) - 1;
11051 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11052 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. MAYBE_NEW_SEC is true if
11053 this entry might be in a different section from previous range. */
11055 static unsigned int
11056 add_ranges (const_tree block, bool maybe_new_sec)
11058 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0, maybe_new_sec);
11061 /* Note that (*rnglist_table)[offset] is either a head of a rnglist
11062 chain, or middle entry of a chain that will be directly referred to. */
11064 static void
11065 note_rnglist_head (unsigned int offset)
11067 if (dwarf_version < 5 || (*ranges_table)[offset].label)
11068 return;
11069 (*ranges_table)[offset].label = gen_internal_sym ("LLRL");
11072 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of labels.
11073 When using dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined
11074 for the final executable should be direct references--setting the
11075 parameter force_direct ensures this behavior. */
11077 static void
11078 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
11079 bool *added, bool force_direct)
11081 unsigned int in_use = vec_safe_length (ranges_by_label);
11082 unsigned int offset;
11083 dw_ranges_by_label rbl = { begin, end };
11084 vec_safe_push (ranges_by_label, rbl);
11085 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1, true);
11086 if (!*added)
11088 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, force_direct);
11089 *added = true;
11090 note_rnglist_head (offset);
11094 /* Emit .debug_ranges section. */
11096 static void
11097 output_ranges (void)
11099 unsigned i;
11100 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
11101 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11102 dw_ranges *r;
11104 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11105 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11106 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11108 int block_num = r->num;
11110 if (block_num > 0)
11112 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11113 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11115 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11116 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11118 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11119 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11120 base of the text section. */
11121 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11123 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11124 text_section_label,
11125 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11126 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11127 text_section_label, NULL);
11130 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11131 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11132 about whether the target supports cross-section
11133 arithmetic. */
11134 else
11136 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11137 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11138 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11141 fmt = NULL;
11144 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11145 else if (block_num < 0)
11147 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11149 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11151 gcc_unreachable ();
11152 #if 0
11153 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11154 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11155 the #if 0 above. */
11156 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11157 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11158 text_section_label,
11159 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11160 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11161 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11162 text_section_label, NULL);
11163 #endif
11165 else
11167 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11168 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11169 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11170 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11171 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11172 NULL);
11175 else
11177 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11178 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11179 fmt = start_fmt;
11184 /* Non-zero if .debug_line_str should be used for .debug_line section
11185 strings or strings that are likely shareable with those. */
11186 #define DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR \
11187 (!DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET \
11188 && (DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) != 0 \
11189 /* FIXME: there is no .debug_line_str.dwo section, \
11190 for -gsplit-dwarf we should use DW_FORM_strx instead. */ \
11191 && !dwarf_split_debug_info)
11193 /* Assign .debug_rnglists indexes. */
11195 static void
11196 index_rnglists (void)
11198 unsigned i;
11199 dw_ranges *r;
11201 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11202 if (r->label)
11203 r->idx = rnglist_idx++;
11206 /* Emit .debug_rnglists section. */
11208 static void
11209 output_rnglists (unsigned generation)
11211 unsigned i;
11212 dw_ranges *r;
11213 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11214 char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11215 char basebuf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11217 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11218 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11219 /* There are up to 4 unique ranges labels per generation.
11220 See also init_sections_and_labels. */
11221 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
11222 2 + generation * 4);
11223 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
11224 3 + generation * 4);
11225 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11226 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11227 "Initial length escape value indicating "
11228 "64-bit DWARF extension");
11229 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11230 "Length of Range Lists");
11231 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11232 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
11233 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
11234 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
11235 /* Emit the offset table only for -gsplit-dwarf. If we don't care
11236 about relocation sizes and primarily care about the size of .debug*
11237 sections in linked shared libraries and executables, then
11238 the offset table plus corresponding DW_FORM_rnglistx uleb128 indexes
11239 into it are usually larger than just DW_FORM_sec_offset offsets
11240 into the .debug_rnglists section. */
11241 dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? rnglist_idx : 0,
11242 "Offset Entry Count");
11243 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11245 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_base_label);
11246 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11247 if (r->label)
11248 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
11249 ranges_base_label, NULL);
11252 const char *lab = "";
11253 unsigned int len = vec_safe_length (ranges_table);
11254 const char *base = NULL;
11255 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11257 int block_num = r->num;
11259 if (r->label)
11261 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, r->label);
11262 lab = r->label;
11264 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128 && (r->label || r->maybe_new_sec))
11265 base = NULL;
11266 if (block_num > 0)
11268 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11269 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11271 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11272 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11274 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11276 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11277 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11278 base of the text section. */
11279 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11281 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11282 "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11283 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, text_section_label,
11284 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11285 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, text_section_label,
11286 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11287 continue;
11289 if (base == NULL)
11291 dw_ranges *r2 = NULL;
11292 if (i < len - 1)
11293 r2 = &(*ranges_table)[i + 1];
11294 if (r2
11295 && r2->num != 0
11296 && r2->label == NULL
11297 && !r2->maybe_new_sec)
11299 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_base_address,
11300 "DW_RLE_base_address (%s)", lab);
11301 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11302 "Base address (%s)", lab);
11303 strcpy (basebuf, blabel);
11304 base = basebuf;
11307 if (base)
11309 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11310 "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11311 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, base,
11312 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11313 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, base,
11314 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11315 continue;
11317 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11318 "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11319 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11320 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11321 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11322 "Range length (%s)", lab);
11324 else
11326 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11327 "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11328 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11329 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11330 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11331 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11335 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11336 else if (block_num < 0)
11338 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11339 const char *blabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin;
11340 const char *elabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end;
11342 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11343 gcc_unreachable ();
11344 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11346 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11347 "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11348 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11349 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11350 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11351 "Range length (%s)", lab);
11353 else
11355 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11356 "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11357 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11358 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11359 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11360 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11363 else
11364 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_end_of_list,
11365 "DW_RLE_end_of_list (%s)", lab);
11367 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
11370 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
11371 struct file_info
11373 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
11374 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
11375 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
11376 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
11377 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
11380 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11381 files. */
11382 struct dir_info
11384 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
11385 int length; /* Path length. */
11386 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
11387 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
11388 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
11391 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
11392 the directories in the path. */
11394 static int
11395 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
11397 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
11398 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
11399 const unsigned char *cp1;
11400 const unsigned char *cp2;
11402 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
11403 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
11404 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
11405 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
11406 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
11407 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
11408 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
11410 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
11411 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
11413 while (1)
11415 ++cp1;
11416 ++cp2;
11417 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
11418 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
11419 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
11420 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
11421 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
11423 /* Character of current path component the same? */
11424 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
11425 return *cp1 - *cp2;
11429 struct file_name_acquire_data
11431 struct file_info *files;
11432 int used_files;
11433 int max_files;
11436 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
11439 file_name_acquire (dwarf_file_data **slot, file_name_acquire_data *fnad)
11441 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
11442 struct file_info *fi;
11443 const char *f;
11445 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
11447 if (! d->emitted_number)
11448 return 1;
11450 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
11452 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
11454 /* Skip all leading "./". */
11455 f = d->filename;
11456 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
11457 f += 2;
11459 /* Create a new array entry. */
11460 fi->path = f;
11461 fi->length = strlen (f);
11462 fi->file_idx = d;
11464 /* Search for the file name part. */
11465 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
11466 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
11468 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
11470 if (g != NULL)
11472 if (f == NULL || f < g)
11473 f = g;
11476 #endif
11478 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
11479 return 1;
11482 /* Helper function for output_file_names. Emit a FORM encoded
11483 string STR, with assembly comment start ENTRY_KIND and
11484 index IDX */
11486 static void
11487 output_line_string (enum dwarf_form form, const char *str,
11488 const char *entry_kind, unsigned int idx)
11490 switch (form)
11492 case DW_FORM_string:
11493 dw2_asm_output_nstring (str, -1, "%s: %#x", entry_kind, idx);
11494 break;
11495 case DW_FORM_line_strp:
11496 if (!debug_line_str_hash)
11497 debug_line_str_hash
11498 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
11500 struct indirect_string_node *node;
11501 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_line_str_hash);
11502 set_indirect_string (node);
11503 node->form = form;
11504 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
11505 debug_line_str_section, "%s: %#x: \"%s\"",
11506 entry_kind, 0, node->str);
11507 break;
11508 default:
11509 gcc_unreachable ();
11513 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
11514 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
11515 slowdowns with many input files. */
11517 static void
11518 output_file_names (void)
11520 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
11521 int numfiles;
11522 struct file_info *files;
11523 struct dir_info *dirs;
11524 int *saved;
11525 int *savehere;
11526 int *backmap;
11527 int ndirs;
11528 int idx_offset;
11529 int i;
11531 if (!last_emitted_file)
11533 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11535 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Directory entry format count");
11536 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Directories count");
11537 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "File name entry format count");
11538 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "File names count");
11540 else
11542 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11543 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11545 return;
11548 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
11550 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
11551 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
11552 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
11554 fnad.files = files;
11555 fnad.used_files = 0;
11556 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
11557 file_table->traverse<file_name_acquire_data *, file_name_acquire> (&fnad);
11558 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
11560 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
11562 /* Find all the different directories used. */
11563 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
11564 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
11565 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
11566 dirs[0].count = 1;
11567 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
11568 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
11569 ndirs = 1;
11571 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
11572 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
11573 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
11574 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
11576 /* Same directory as last entry. */
11577 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
11578 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
11580 else
11582 int j;
11584 /* This is a new directory. */
11585 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
11586 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
11587 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
11588 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
11589 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
11591 /* Search for a prefix. */
11592 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
11593 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
11594 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
11595 && dirs[j].length > 1
11596 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
11597 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
11598 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
11599 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
11601 ++ndirs;
11604 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
11605 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
11606 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
11607 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
11608 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
11609 results in most cases and never is much off. */
11610 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11611 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11613 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
11614 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
11616 int j;
11617 int total;
11619 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
11620 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
11621 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
11622 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
11624 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
11626 savehere[j] = 0;
11627 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
11629 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
11630 dirs[j] path. */
11631 int k;
11633 k = dirs[j].prefix;
11634 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
11635 k = dirs[k].prefix;
11637 if (k == (int) i)
11639 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
11640 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
11641 dirs[i]. */
11642 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
11643 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
11648 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
11649 directory. */
11650 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
11652 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
11653 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
11654 if (savehere[j] > 0)
11656 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
11657 saved[j] = savehere[j];
11659 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
11660 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
11665 /* Emit the directory name table. */
11666 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
11667 enum dwarf_form str_form = DW_FORM_string;
11668 enum dwarf_form idx_form = DW_FORM_udata;
11669 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11671 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
11672 if (comp_dir == NULL)
11673 comp_dir = "";
11674 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Directory entry format count");
11675 if (DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
11676 str_form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
11677 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
11678 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
11679 get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
11680 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ndirs + idx_offset, "Directories count");
11681 if (str_form == DW_FORM_string)
11683 dw2_asm_output_nstring (comp_dir, -1, "Directory Entry: %#x", 0);
11684 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11685 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11686 dirs[i].length
11687 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11688 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
11690 else
11692 output_line_string (str_form, comp_dir, "Directory Entry", 0);
11693 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11695 const char *str
11696 = ggc_alloc_string (dirs[i].path,
11697 dirs[i].length
11698 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR);
11699 output_line_string (str_form, str, "Directory Entry",
11700 (unsigned) i + idx_offset);
11704 else
11706 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11707 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11708 dirs[i].length
11709 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11710 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
11712 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11715 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
11716 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
11717 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
11718 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
11719 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11720 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
11722 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11724 const char *filename0 = get_AT_string (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_name);
11725 if (filename0 == NULL)
11726 filename0 = "";
11727 /* DW_LNCT_directory_index can use DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data1 and
11728 DW_FORM_data2. Choose one based on the number of directories
11729 and how much space would they occupy in each encoding.
11730 If we have at most 256 directories, all indexes fit into
11731 a single byte, so DW_FORM_data1 is most compact (if there
11732 are at most 128 directories, DW_FORM_udata would be as
11733 compact as that, but not shorter and slower to decode). */
11734 if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 256)
11735 idx_form = DW_FORM_data1;
11736 /* If there are more than 65536 directories, we have to use
11737 DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data2 can't refer to them.
11738 Otherwise, compute what space would occupy if all the indexes
11739 used DW_FORM_udata - sum - and compare that to how large would
11740 be DW_FORM_data2 encoding, and pick the more efficient one. */
11741 else if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 65536)
11743 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT sum = 1;
11744 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11746 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11747 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11748 sum += size_of_uleb128 (dir_idx);
11750 if (sum >= HOST_WIDE_INT_UC (2) * (numfiles + 1))
11751 idx_form = DW_FORM_data2;
11753 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11754 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 4, "File name entry format count");
11755 #else
11756 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "File name entry format count");
11757 #endif
11758 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
11759 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
11760 get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
11761 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_directory_index,
11762 "DW_LNCT_directory_index");
11763 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (idx_form, "%s",
11764 get_DW_FORM_name (idx_form));
11765 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11766 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_timestamp, "DW_LNCT_timestamp");
11767 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
11768 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_size, "DW_LNCT_size");
11769 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
11770 #endif
11771 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (numfiles + 1, "File names count");
11773 output_line_string (str_form, filename0, "File Entry", 0);
11775 /* Include directory index. */
11776 if (idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11777 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11778 0, NULL);
11779 else
11780 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11782 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11783 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11784 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11785 #endif
11788 /* Now write all the file names. */
11789 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11791 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11792 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11794 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11795 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
11797 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
11798 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
11800 int ver;
11801 long long cdt;
11802 long siz;
11803 int maxfilelen = (strlen (files[file_idx].path)
11804 + dirs[dir_idx].length
11805 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1);
11806 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
11808 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
11809 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
11810 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
11812 output_line_string (str_form, filebuf, "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
11814 /* Include directory index. */
11815 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11816 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11817 dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11818 else
11819 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11821 /* Modification time. */
11822 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
11823 &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
11824 ? cdt : 0, NULL);
11826 /* File length in bytes. */
11827 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
11828 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
11829 ? siz : 0, NULL);
11830 #else
11831 output_line_string (str_form,
11832 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length,
11833 "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
11835 /* Include directory index. */
11836 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11837 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11838 dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11839 else
11840 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11842 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11843 continue;
11845 /* Modification time. */
11846 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11848 /* File length in bytes. */
11849 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11850 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
11853 if (dwarf_version < 5)
11854 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11858 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
11860 static void
11861 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
11863 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11864 unsigned int current_line = 1;
11865 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
11866 dw_line_info_entry *ent;
11867 size_t i;
11869 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (table->entries, i, ent)
11871 switch (ent->opcode)
11873 case LI_set_address:
11874 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
11875 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
11876 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
11877 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
11878 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
11879 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
11880 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
11882 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
11883 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
11884 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", line_label);
11885 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11886 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11887 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11888 break;
11890 case LI_set_line:
11891 if (ent->val == current_line)
11893 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
11894 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
11895 "copy line %u", current_line);
11897 else
11899 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
11900 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
11902 current_line = ent->val;
11903 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
11905 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
11906 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
11907 This takes 1 byte. */
11908 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
11909 "line %u", current_line);
11911 else
11913 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
11914 depending on the value being encoded. */
11915 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
11916 "advance to line %u", current_line);
11917 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
11918 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
11921 break;
11923 case LI_set_file:
11924 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
11925 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
11926 break;
11928 case LI_set_column:
11929 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
11930 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
11931 break;
11933 case LI_negate_stmt:
11934 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
11935 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
11936 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
11937 break;
11939 case LI_set_prologue_end:
11940 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
11941 "set prologue end");
11942 break;
11944 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
11945 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
11946 "set epilogue begin");
11947 break;
11949 case LI_set_discriminator:
11950 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
11951 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
11952 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
11953 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
11954 break;
11958 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
11959 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
11960 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11961 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11962 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
11964 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
11965 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
11966 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
11969 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
11970 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
11972 static void
11973 output_line_info (bool prologue_only)
11975 static unsigned int generation;
11976 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11977 char p1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], p2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11978 bool saw_one = false;
11979 int opc;
11981 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, generation);
11982 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, generation);
11983 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, generation);
11984 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, generation++);
11986 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11988 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11989 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11990 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11991 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11992 "Length of Source Line Info");
11995 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11997 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
11998 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12000 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
12001 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
12003 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
12004 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
12006 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
12007 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
12008 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
12009 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
12010 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
12011 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
12012 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
12013 and don't let the target override. */
12014 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
12016 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
12017 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
12018 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
12019 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
12020 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
12021 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
12022 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
12023 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
12024 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
12025 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
12026 "Special Opcode Base");
12028 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
12030 int n_op_args;
12031 switch (opc)
12033 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
12034 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
12035 case DW_LNS_set_file:
12036 case DW_LNS_set_column:
12037 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
12038 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
12039 n_op_args = 1;
12040 break;
12041 default:
12042 n_op_args = 0;
12043 break;
12046 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
12047 opc, n_op_args);
12050 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
12051 output_file_names ();
12052 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
12053 if (prologue_only)
12055 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12056 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12057 return;
12060 if (separate_line_info)
12062 dw_line_info_table *table;
12063 size_t i;
12065 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*separate_line_info, i, table)
12066 if (table->in_use)
12068 output_one_line_info_table (table);
12069 saw_one = true;
12072 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
12074 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
12075 saw_one = true;
12078 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
12079 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
12080 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
12081 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
12082 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
12083 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
12084 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
12086 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12087 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12090 /* Return true if DW_AT_endianity should be emitted according to REVERSE. */
12092 static inline bool
12093 need_endianity_attribute_p (bool reverse)
12095 return reverse && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict);
12098 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
12099 a DIE that describes the given type. REVERSE is true if the type is
12100 to be interpreted in the reverse storage order wrt the target order.
12102 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
12103 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
12105 static dw_die_ref
12106 base_type_die (tree type, bool reverse)
12108 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
12109 enum dwarf_type encoding;
12110 bool fpt_used = false;
12111 struct fixed_point_type_info fpt_info;
12112 tree type_bias = NULL_TREE;
12114 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
12115 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
12116 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
12117 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12119 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12121 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12122 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
12123 && TYPE_NAME (type)
12124 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12125 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
12126 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12128 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
12129 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
12130 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
12132 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
12133 break;
12136 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12137 && lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info)
12139 memset (&fpt_info, 0, sizeof (fpt_info));
12140 if (lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info (type, &fpt_info))
12142 fpt_used = true;
12143 encoding = ((TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12144 ? DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed
12145 : DW_ATE_signed_fixed);
12146 break;
12149 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
12151 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12152 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
12153 else
12154 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
12156 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12157 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
12158 else
12159 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
12161 if (!dwarf_strict
12162 && lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
12163 type_bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
12164 break;
12166 case REAL_TYPE:
12167 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
12169 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12170 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
12171 else
12172 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12174 else
12175 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
12176 break;
12178 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12179 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
12180 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12181 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12182 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
12183 else
12184 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
12185 break;
12187 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
12188 a user defined type for it. */
12189 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12190 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
12191 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
12192 else
12193 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12194 break;
12196 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12197 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
12198 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
12199 break;
12201 default:
12202 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
12203 gcc_unreachable ();
12206 base_type_result = new_die_raw (DW_TAG_base_type);
12208 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
12209 int_size_in_bytes (type));
12210 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12212 if (need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse))
12213 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_endianity,
12214 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? DW_END_little : DW_END_big);
12216 add_alignment_attribute (base_type_result, type);
12218 if (fpt_used)
12220 switch (fpt_info.scale_factor_kind)
12222 case fixed_point_scale_factor_binary:
12223 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_binary_scale,
12224 fpt_info.scale_factor.binary);
12225 break;
12227 case fixed_point_scale_factor_decimal:
12228 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_decimal_scale,
12229 fpt_info.scale_factor.decimal);
12230 break;
12232 case fixed_point_scale_factor_arbitrary:
12233 /* Arbitrary scale factors cannot be described in standard DWARF,
12234 yet. */
12235 if (!dwarf_strict)
12237 /* Describe the scale factor as a rational constant. */
12238 const dw_die_ref scale_factor
12239 = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, comp_unit_die (), type);
12241 add_AT_unsigned (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_numerator,
12242 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.numerator);
12243 add_AT_int (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_denominator,
12244 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.denominator);
12246 add_AT_die_ref (base_type_result, DW_AT_small, scale_factor);
12248 break;
12250 default:
12251 gcc_unreachable ();
12255 if (type_bias)
12256 add_scalar_info (base_type_result, DW_AT_GNU_bias, type_bias,
12257 dw_scalar_form_constant
12258 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
12259 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
12260 NULL);
12262 return base_type_result;
12265 /* A C++ function with deduced return type can have a TEMPLATE_TYPE_PARM
12266 named 'auto' in its type: return true for it, false otherwise. */
12268 static inline bool
12269 is_cxx_auto (tree type)
12271 if (is_cxx ())
12273 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
12274 if (name == get_identifier ("auto")
12275 || name == get_identifier ("decltype(auto)"))
12276 return true;
12278 return false;
12281 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12282 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12284 static inline int
12285 is_base_type (tree type)
12287 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12289 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12290 case REAL_TYPE:
12291 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12292 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12293 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12294 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
12295 return 1;
12297 case VOID_TYPE:
12298 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12299 case RECORD_TYPE:
12300 case UNION_TYPE:
12301 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12302 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12303 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12304 case METHOD_TYPE:
12305 case POINTER_TYPE:
12306 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12307 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
12308 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12309 case LANG_TYPE:
12310 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12311 return 0;
12313 default:
12314 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
12315 return 0;
12316 gcc_unreachable ();
12319 return 0;
12322 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12323 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12324 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12325 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12326 ERROR_MARK node. */
12328 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12329 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12331 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12332 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12333 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12334 return 0;
12335 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type)))
12336 return tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12337 else
12338 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12341 /* Similarly, but return an offset_int instead of UHWI. */
12343 static inline offset_int
12344 offset_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12346 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12347 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12348 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12349 return 0;
12350 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
12351 return wi::to_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12352 else
12353 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12356 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12357 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12359 static dw_die_ref
12360 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, tree bias,
12361 dw_die_ref context_die)
12363 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12364 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12366 if (context_die == NULL)
12367 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
12369 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12371 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12373 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
12374 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
12375 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
12378 add_alignment_attribute (subrange_die, type);
12380 if (low)
12381 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low, NULL);
12382 if (high)
12383 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high, NULL);
12384 if (bias && !dwarf_strict)
12385 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_GNU_bias, bias,
12386 dw_scalar_form_constant
12387 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
12388 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
12389 NULL);
12391 return subrange_die;
12394 /* Returns the (const and/or volatile) cv_qualifiers associated with
12395 the decl node. This will normally be augmented with the
12396 cv_qualifiers of the underlying type in add_type_attribute. */
12398 static int
12399 decl_quals (const_tree decl)
12401 return ((TREE_READONLY (decl)
12402 /* The C++ front-end correctly marks reference-typed
12403 variables as readonly, but from a language (and debug
12404 info) standpoint they are not const-qualified. */
12405 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != REFERENCE_TYPE
12406 ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)
12407 | (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
12408 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED));
12411 /* Determine the TYPE whose qualifiers match the largest strict subset
12412 of the given TYPE_QUALS, and return its qualifiers. Ignore all
12413 qualifiers outside QUAL_MASK. */
12415 static int
12416 get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (tree type, int type_quals, int qual_mask)
12418 tree t;
12419 int best_rank = 0, best_qual = 0, max_rank;
12421 type_quals &= qual_mask;
12422 max_rank = popcount_hwi (type_quals) - 1;
12424 for (t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type); t && best_rank < max_rank;
12425 t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
12427 int q = TYPE_QUALS (t) & qual_mask;
12429 if ((q & type_quals) == q && q != type_quals
12430 && check_base_type (t, type))
12432 int rank = popcount_hwi (q);
12434 if (rank > best_rank)
12436 best_rank = rank;
12437 best_qual = q;
12442 return best_qual;
12445 struct dwarf_qual_info_t { int q; enum dwarf_tag t; };
12446 static const dwarf_qual_info_t dwarf_qual_info[] =
12448 { TYPE_QUAL_CONST, DW_TAG_const_type },
12449 { TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE, DW_TAG_volatile_type },
12450 { TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT, DW_TAG_restrict_type },
12451 { TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC, DW_TAG_atomic_type }
12453 static const unsigned int dwarf_qual_info_size
12454 = sizeof (dwarf_qual_info) / sizeof (dwarf_qual_info[0]);
12456 /* If DIE is a qualified DIE of some base DIE with the same parent,
12457 return the base DIE, otherwise return NULL. Set MASK to the
12458 qualifiers added compared to the returned DIE. */
12460 static dw_die_ref
12461 qualified_die_p (dw_die_ref die, int *mask, unsigned int depth)
12463 unsigned int i;
12464 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12465 if (die->die_tag == dwarf_qual_info[i].t)
12466 break;
12467 if (i == dwarf_qual_info_size)
12468 return NULL;
12469 if (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) != 1)
12470 return NULL;
12471 dw_die_ref type = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_type);
12472 if (type == NULL || type->die_parent != die->die_parent)
12473 return NULL;
12474 *mask |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
12475 if (depth)
12477 dw_die_ref ret = qualified_die_p (type, mask, depth - 1);
12478 if (ret)
12479 return ret;
12481 return type;
12484 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
12485 entry that chains the modifiers specified by CV_QUALS in front of the
12486 given type. REVERSE is true if the type is to be interpreted in the
12487 reverse storage order wrt the target order. */
12489 static dw_die_ref
12490 modified_type_die (tree type, int cv_quals, bool reverse,
12491 dw_die_ref context_die)
12493 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
12494 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
12495 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
12496 tree item_type = NULL;
12497 tree qualified_type;
12498 tree name, low, high;
12499 dw_die_ref mod_scope;
12500 /* Only these cv-qualifiers are currently handled. */
12501 const int cv_qual_mask = (TYPE_QUAL_CONST | TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
12502 | TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT | TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC |
12503 ENCODE_QUAL_ADDR_SPACE(~0U));
12504 const bool reverse_base_type
12505 = need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse) && is_base_type (type);
12507 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
12508 return NULL;
12510 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
12512 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
12514 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
12515 return modified_type_die (debug_type, cv_quals, reverse, context_die);
12518 cv_quals &= cv_qual_mask;
12520 /* Don't emit DW_TAG_restrict_type for DWARFv2, since it is a type
12521 tag modifier (and not an attribute) old consumers won't be able
12522 to handle it. */
12523 if (dwarf_version < 3)
12524 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT;
12526 /* Likewise for DW_TAG_atomic_type for DWARFv5. */
12527 if (dwarf_version < 5)
12528 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC;
12530 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
12531 this type. */
12532 qualified_type = get_qualified_type (type, cv_quals);
12534 if (qualified_type == sizetype)
12536 /* Try not to expose the internal sizetype type's name. */
12537 if (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
12538 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
12540 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
12542 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
12543 && (TYPE_PRECISION (t)
12544 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type))
12545 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
12546 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type)));
12547 qualified_type = t;
12549 else if (qualified_type == sizetype
12550 && TREE_CODE (sizetype) == TREE_CODE (size_type_node)
12551 && TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) == TYPE_PRECISION (size_type_node)
12552 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype) == TYPE_UNSIGNED (size_type_node))
12553 qualified_type = size_type_node;
12556 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
12557 if (qualified_type)
12559 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12561 /* DW_AT_endianity doesn't come from a qualifier on the type, so it is
12562 dealt with specially: the DIE with the attribute, if it exists, is
12563 placed immediately after the regular DIE for the same base type. */
12564 if (mod_type_die
12565 && (!reverse_base_type
12566 || ((mod_type_die = mod_type_die->die_sib) != NULL
12567 && get_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_endianity))))
12568 return mod_type_die;
12571 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
12573 /* Handle C typedef types. */
12574 if (name
12575 && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12576 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
12577 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
12579 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
12581 /* Skip the typedef for base types with DW_AT_endianity, no big deal. */
12582 if (qualified_type == dtype && !reverse_base_type)
12584 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
12586 /* Typedef variants that have an abstract origin don't get their own
12587 type DIE (see gen_typedef_die), so fall back on the ultimate
12588 abstract origin instead. */
12589 if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
12590 return modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (origin), cv_quals, reverse,
12591 context_die);
12593 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
12594 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
12595 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12597 else
12599 int dquals = TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (dtype);
12600 dquals &= cv_qual_mask;
12601 if ((dquals & ~cv_quals) != TYPE_UNQUALIFIED
12602 || (cv_quals == dquals && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
12603 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use
12604 the unnamed type to which it refers. */
12605 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name), cv_quals,
12606 reverse, context_die);
12607 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
12611 mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12613 if (cv_quals)
12615 int sub_quals = 0, first_quals = 0;
12616 unsigned i;
12617 dw_die_ref first = NULL, last = NULL;
12619 /* Determine a lesser qualified type that most closely matches
12620 this one. Then generate DW_TAG_* entries for the remaining
12621 qualifiers. */
12622 sub_quals = get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (type, cv_quals,
12623 cv_qual_mask);
12624 if (sub_quals && use_debug_types)
12626 bool needed = false;
12627 /* If emitting type units, make sure the order of qualifiers
12628 is canonical. Thus, start from unqualified type if
12629 an earlier qualifier is missing in sub_quals, but some later
12630 one is present there. */
12631 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12632 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
12633 needed = true;
12634 else if (needed && (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals))
12636 sub_quals = 0;
12637 break;
12640 mod_type_die = modified_type_die (type, sub_quals, reverse, context_die);
12641 if (mod_scope && mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_parent == mod_scope)
12643 /* As not all intermediate qualified DIEs have corresponding
12644 tree types, ensure that qualified DIEs in the same scope
12645 as their DW_AT_type are emitted after their DW_AT_type,
12646 only with other qualified DIEs for the same type possibly
12647 in between them. Determine the range of such qualified
12648 DIEs now (first being the base type, last being corresponding
12649 last qualified DIE for it). */
12650 unsigned int count = 0;
12651 first = qualified_die_p (mod_type_die, &first_quals,
12652 dwarf_qual_info_size);
12653 if (first == NULL)
12654 first = mod_type_die;
12655 gcc_assert ((first_quals & ~sub_quals) == 0);
12656 for (count = 0, last = first;
12657 count < (1U << dwarf_qual_info_size);
12658 count++, last = last->die_sib)
12660 int quals = 0;
12661 if (last == mod_scope->die_child)
12662 break;
12663 if (qualified_die_p (last->die_sib, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size)
12664 != first)
12665 break;
12669 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12670 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
12672 dw_die_ref d;
12673 if (first && first != last)
12675 for (d = first->die_sib; ; d = d->die_sib)
12677 int quals = 0;
12678 qualified_die_p (d, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size);
12679 if (quals == (first_quals | dwarf_qual_info[i].q))
12680 break;
12681 if (d == last)
12683 d = NULL;
12684 break;
12687 if (d)
12689 mod_type_die = d;
12690 continue;
12693 if (first)
12695 d = new_die_raw (dwarf_qual_info[i].t);
12696 add_child_die_after (mod_scope, d, last);
12697 last = d;
12699 else
12700 d = new_die (dwarf_qual_info[i].t, mod_scope, type);
12701 if (mod_type_die)
12702 add_AT_die_ref (d, DW_AT_type, mod_type_die);
12703 mod_type_die = d;
12704 first_quals |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
12707 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE || code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12709 dwarf_tag tag = DW_TAG_pointer_type;
12710 if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12712 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
12713 tag = DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type;
12714 else
12715 tag = DW_TAG_reference_type;
12717 mod_type_die = new_die (tag, mod_scope, type);
12719 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12720 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12721 add_alignment_attribute (mod_type_die, type);
12722 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12724 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type);
12725 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (as))
12727 int action = targetm.addr_space.debug (as);
12728 if (action >= 0)
12730 /* Positive values indicate an address_class. */
12731 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, action);
12733 else
12735 /* Negative values indicate an (inverted) segment base reg. */
12736 dw_loc_descr_ref d
12737 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (~action, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12738 add_AT_loc (mod_type_die, DW_AT_segment, d);
12742 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
12743 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
12744 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
12746 tree bias = NULL_TREE;
12747 if (lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
12748 bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
12749 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, bias, context_die);
12750 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12752 else if (is_base_type (type))
12754 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type, reverse);
12756 /* The DIE with DW_AT_endianity is placed right after the naked DIE. */
12757 if (reverse_base_type)
12759 dw_die_ref after_die
12760 = modified_type_die (type, cv_quals, false, context_die);
12761 add_child_die_after (comp_unit_die (), mod_type_die, after_die);
12763 else
12764 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), mod_type_die);
12766 add_pubtype (type, mod_type_die);
12768 else
12770 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12772 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
12773 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
12774 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
12775 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
12776 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
12777 ..._TYPE node. */
12778 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
12779 || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
12781 /* For function/method types, can't just use type_main_variant here,
12782 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
12783 but try to canonicalize. */
12784 tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
12785 for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
12786 if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
12787 && check_base_type (t, main)
12788 && check_lang_type (t, type))
12789 return lookup_type_die (t);
12790 return lookup_type_die (type);
12792 else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
12793 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
12794 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
12795 else
12796 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
12797 not the main variant. */
12798 return lookup_type_die (type);
12801 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
12802 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
12803 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
12804 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
12805 if the base type already has the same name. */
12806 if (name
12807 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
12808 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
12809 || (cv_quals == TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)))
12810 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12811 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
12812 && DECL_NAME (name))))
12814 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
12815 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
12816 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
12817 useful source coordinates anyway. */
12818 name = DECL_NAME (name);
12819 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
12821 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
12822 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
12824 name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
12825 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
12826 name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
12829 if (qualified_type && !reverse_base_type)
12830 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
12832 if (item_type)
12833 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
12834 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
12835 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
12836 types are possible in Ada. */
12837 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
12838 TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (item_type),
12839 reverse,
12840 context_die);
12842 if (sub_die != NULL)
12843 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
12845 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
12846 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
12847 add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12849 return mod_type_die;
12852 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
12853 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
12854 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
12856 static void
12857 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
12859 tree parms, args;
12860 int parms_num, i;
12861 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
12862 int non_default;
12864 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
12865 return;
12867 if (TYPE_P (t))
12868 die = lookup_type_die (t);
12869 else if (DECL_P (t))
12870 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
12872 gcc_assert (die);
12874 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
12875 if (!parms)
12876 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
12877 or function. End of story. */
12878 return;
12880 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
12881 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
12882 if (TREE_CHAIN (args) && TREE_CODE (TREE_CHAIN (args)) == INTEGER_CST)
12883 non_default = int_cst_value (TREE_CHAIN (args));
12884 else
12885 non_default = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (args);
12886 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
12888 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
12889 dw_die_ref parm_die;
12891 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
12892 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
12893 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
12894 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
12896 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
12898 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
12899 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
12900 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
12901 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
12902 an argument pack. */
12903 if (arg_pack_elems)
12904 parm_die = template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
12905 arg_pack_elems,
12906 die);
12907 else
12908 parm_die = generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
12909 true /* emit name */, die);
12910 if (i >= non_default)
12911 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_default_value, 1);
12916 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
12917 the representation of a generic type parameter.
12918 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
12919 ARG is the argument to PARM.
12920 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
12921 name of the PARM.
12922 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
12923 as a child node. */
12925 static dw_die_ref
12926 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
12927 bool emit_name_p,
12928 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12930 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
12931 const char *name = NULL;
12933 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
12934 return NULL;
12936 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
12937 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
12938 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
12939 and arguments. */
12940 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12941 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
12942 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
12943 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
12944 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
12945 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
12946 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12947 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
12948 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
12949 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
12950 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
12951 name of the template template argument. */
12952 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
12953 parent_die, parm);
12954 else
12955 gcc_unreachable ();
12957 if (tmpl_die)
12959 tree tmpl_type;
12961 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
12962 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
12963 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
12964 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
12965 the die. */
12966 if (emit_name_p)
12968 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
12969 gcc_assert (name);
12970 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
12973 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12975 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
12976 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
12977 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
12978 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
12979 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
12980 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
12981 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type,
12982 (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type)
12983 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED),
12984 false, parent_die);
12986 else
12988 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
12989 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
12990 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
12992 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
12993 to the name of the argument. */
12994 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
12995 if (name)
12996 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
12999 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
13000 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
13001 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
13002 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
13003 of ARG.
13004 We must be careful here:
13005 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
13006 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
13007 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
13008 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
13009 emitted after cgraph computations.
13010 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
13011 after cgraph is ready. */
13012 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
13015 return tmpl_die;
13018 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
13019 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
13020 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
13022 static dw_die_ref
13023 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
13024 tree parm_pack_args,
13025 dw_die_ref parent_die)
13027 dw_die_ref die;
13028 int j;
13030 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
13032 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
13033 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
13034 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
13035 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
13036 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
13037 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
13038 die);
13039 return die;
13042 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
13043 an enumerated type. */
13045 static inline int
13046 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
13048 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
13051 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
13053 static unsigned int
13054 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
13056 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
13058 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
13060 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13061 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13063 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13064 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13065 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13067 #endif
13069 regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
13070 gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
13071 return regno;
13074 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
13075 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
13076 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
13078 static void
13079 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
13081 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
13083 if (*list_head != NULL)
13085 /* Find the end of the chain. */
13086 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
13089 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
13090 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
13094 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
13095 zero if there is none. */
13097 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13098 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
13100 rtx regs;
13102 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13103 return 0;
13105 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13106 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13107 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13108 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
13109 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
13110 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
13111 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
13113 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
13115 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
13117 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
13118 initialized);
13119 if (result)
13120 add_loc_descr (&result,
13121 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13123 return result;
13126 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
13128 if (REG_NREGS (rtl) > 1 || regs)
13129 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
13130 else
13132 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
13133 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13134 return 0;
13135 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum, initialized);
13139 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
13140 a given hard register number. */
13142 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13143 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
13145 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
13147 if (regno <= 31)
13148 reg_loc_descr
13149 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
13150 else
13151 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
13153 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13154 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13156 return reg_loc_descr;
13159 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
13160 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
13162 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13163 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
13164 enum var_init_status initialized)
13166 int size, i;
13167 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13169 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
13170 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
13172 unsigned reg = REGNO (rtl);
13173 int nregs;
13175 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13176 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13178 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
13179 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13180 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13182 #endif
13184 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
13185 nregs = REG_NREGS (rtl);
13187 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
13189 loc_result = NULL;
13190 while (nregs--)
13192 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13194 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
13195 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13196 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13197 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13198 ++reg;
13200 return loc_result;
13203 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
13205 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
13207 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13208 loc_result = NULL;
13210 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
13212 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13214 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
13215 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13216 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13217 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13220 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13221 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13222 return loc_result;
13225 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13227 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
13228 as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
13229 and DW_OP_shl. */
13231 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13232 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
13234 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
13235 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13236 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13237 return ret;
13240 /* Return a location descriptor that designates constant POLY_I. */
13242 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13243 int_loc_descriptor (poly_int64 poly_i)
13245 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13247 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
13248 if (!poly_i.is_constant (&i))
13250 /* Create location descriptions for the non-constant part and
13251 add any constant offset at the end. */
13252 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL;
13253 HOST_WIDE_INT constant = poly_i.coeffs[0];
13254 for (unsigned int j = 1; j < NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS; ++j)
13256 HOST_WIDE_INT coeff = poly_i.coeffs[j];
13257 if (coeff != 0)
13259 dw_loc_descr_ref start = ret;
13260 unsigned int factor;
13261 int bias;
13262 unsigned int regno = targetm.dwarf_poly_indeterminate_value
13263 (j, &factor, &bias);
13265 /* Add COEFF * ((REGNO / FACTOR) - BIAS) to the value:
13266 add COEFF * (REGNO / FACTOR) now and subtract
13267 COEFF * BIAS from the final constant part. */
13268 constant -= coeff * bias;
13269 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_reg_loc_descr (regno, 0));
13270 if (coeff % factor == 0)
13271 coeff /= factor;
13272 else
13274 int amount = exact_log2 (factor);
13275 gcc_assert (amount >= 0);
13276 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (amount));
13277 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
13279 if (coeff != 1)
13281 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (coeff));
13282 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13284 if (start)
13285 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13288 loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, constant);
13289 return ret;
13292 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
13293 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
13294 if (i >= 0)
13296 int clz = clz_hwi (i);
13297 int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
13298 if (i <= 31)
13299 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
13300 else if (i <= 0xff)
13301 op = DW_OP_const1u;
13302 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13303 op = DW_OP_const2u;
13304 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
13305 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13306 /* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
13307 DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13308 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
13309 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
13310 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13311 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13312 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13313 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
13314 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13316 else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
13317 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
13318 <= 4)
13320 /* As i >= 2**31, the double cast above will yield a negative number.
13321 Since wrapping is defined in DWARF expressions we can output big
13322 positive integers as small negative ones, regardless of the size
13323 of host wide ints.
13325 Here, since the evaluator will handle 32-bit values and since i >=
13326 2**31, we know it's going to be interpreted as a negative literal:
13327 store it this way if we can do better than 5 bytes this way. */
13328 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
13330 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13331 op = DW_OP_const4u;
13333 /* Past this point, i >= 0x100000000 and thus DW_OP_constu will take at
13334 least 6 bytes: see if we can do better before falling back to it. */
13335 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13336 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13337 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes. */
13338 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13339 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
13340 && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
13341 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13342 /* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
13343 DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes. */
13344 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
13345 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
13346 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13347 && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
13348 /* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes. */
13349 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
13350 else
13351 op = DW_OP_constu;
13353 else
13355 if (i >= -0x80)
13356 op = DW_OP_const1s;
13357 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13358 op = DW_OP_const2s;
13359 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
13361 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
13363 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
13364 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13365 return ret;
13367 op = DW_OP_const4s;
13369 else
13371 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
13372 < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
13374 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
13375 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13376 return ret;
13378 op = DW_OP_consts;
13382 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
13385 /* Likewise, for unsigned constants. */
13387 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13388 uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13390 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_int = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13391 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_uint
13392 = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
13394 /* If possible, use the clever signed constants handling. */
13395 if (i <= max_int)
13396 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13398 /* Here, we are left with positive numbers that cannot be represented as
13399 HOST_WIDE_INT, i.e.:
13400 max (HOST_WIDE_INT) < i <= max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
13402 Using DW_OP_const4/8/./u operation to encode them consumes a lot of bytes
13403 whereas may be better to output a negative integer: thanks to integer
13404 wrapping, we know that:
13405 x = x - 2 ** DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13406 = x - 2 * (max (HOST_WIDE_INT) + 1)
13407 So numbers close to max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) could be represented as
13408 small negative integers. Let's try that in cases it will clearly improve
13409 the encoding: there is no gain turning DW_OP_const4u into
13410 DW_OP_const4s. */
13411 if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13412 && ((DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > max_uint - 0x8000)
13413 || (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 8 && i > max_uint - 0x80000000)))
13415 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first_shift = i - max_int - 1;
13417 /* Now, -1 < first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT)
13418 i.e. 0 <= first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT). */
13419 const HOST_WIDE_INT second_shift
13420 = (HOST_WIDE_INT) first_shift - (HOST_WIDE_INT) max_int - 1;
13422 /* So we finally have:
13423 -max (HOST_WIDE_INT) - 1 <= second_shift <= -1.
13424 i.e. min (HOST_WIDE_INT) <= second_shift < 0. */
13425 return int_loc_descriptor (second_shift);
13428 /* Last chance: fallback to a simple constant operation. */
13429 return new_loc_descr
13430 ((HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13431 ? DW_OP_const4u
13432 : DW_OP_const8u,
13433 i, 0);
13436 /* Generate and return a location description that computes the unsigned
13437 comparison of the two stack top entries (a OP b where b is the top-most
13438 entry and a is the second one). The KIND of comparison can be LT_EXPR,
13439 LE_EXPR, GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR. */
13441 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13442 uint_comparison_loc_list (enum tree_code kind)
13444 enum dwarf_location_atom op, flip_op;
13445 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, bra_node, jmp_node, tmp;
13447 switch (kind)
13449 case LT_EXPR:
13450 op = DW_OP_lt;
13451 break;
13452 case LE_EXPR:
13453 op = DW_OP_le;
13454 break;
13455 case GT_EXPR:
13456 op = DW_OP_gt;
13457 break;
13458 case GE_EXPR:
13459 op = DW_OP_ge;
13460 break;
13461 default:
13462 gcc_unreachable ();
13465 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13466 jmp_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
13468 /* Until DWARFv4, operations all work on signed integers. It is nevertheless
13469 possible to perform unsigned comparisons: we just have to distinguish
13470 three cases:
13472 1. when a and b have the same sign (as signed integers); then we should
13473 return: a OP(signed) b;
13475 2. when a is a negative signed integer while b is a positive one, then a
13476 is a greater unsigned integer than b; likewise when a and b's roles
13477 are flipped.
13479 So first, compare the sign of the two operands. */
13480 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0);
13481 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13482 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
13483 /* If they have different signs (i.e. they have different sign bits), then
13484 the stack top value has now the sign bit set and thus it's smaller than
13485 zero. */
13486 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lit0, 0, 0));
13487 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lt, 0, 0));
13488 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
13490 /* We are in case 1. At this point, we know both operands have the same
13491 sign, to it's safe to use the built-in signed comparison. */
13492 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13493 add_loc_descr (&ret, jmp_node);
13495 /* We are in case 2. Here, we know both operands do not have the same sign,
13496 so we have to flip the signed comparison. */
13497 flip_op = (kind == LT_EXPR || kind == LE_EXPR) ? DW_OP_gt : DW_OP_lt;
13498 tmp = new_loc_descr (flip_op, 0, 0);
13499 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13500 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
13501 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13503 /* This dummy operation is necessary to make the two branches join. */
13504 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
13505 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13506 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
13507 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13509 return ret;
13512 /* Likewise, but takes the location description lists (might be destructive on
13513 them). Return NULL if either is NULL or if concatenation fails. */
13515 static dw_loc_list_ref
13516 loc_list_from_uint_comparison (dw_loc_list_ref left, dw_loc_list_ref right,
13517 enum tree_code kind)
13519 if (left == NULL || right == NULL)
13520 return NULL;
13522 add_loc_list (&left, right);
13523 if (left == NULL)
13524 return NULL;
13526 add_loc_descr_to_each (left, uint_comparison_loc_list (kind));
13527 return left;
13530 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
13531 without actually allocating it. */
13533 static unsigned long
13534 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
13536 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
13537 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
13538 + 1;
13541 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
13542 actually allocating it. */
13544 static unsigned long
13545 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13547 unsigned long s;
13549 if (i >= 0)
13551 int clz, ctz;
13552 if (i <= 31)
13553 return 1;
13554 else if (i <= 0xff)
13555 return 2;
13556 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13557 return 3;
13558 clz = clz_hwi (i);
13559 ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
13560 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
13561 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13562 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13563 - clz - 5);
13564 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13565 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13566 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13567 - clz - 8);
13568 else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
13569 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
13570 <= 4)
13571 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
13572 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13573 return 5;
13574 s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13575 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13576 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13577 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13578 - clz - 8);
13579 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
13580 && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13581 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13582 - clz - 16);
13583 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
13584 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13585 && s > 6)
13586 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13587 - clz - 32);
13588 else
13589 return 1 + s;
13591 else
13593 if (i >= -0x80)
13594 return 2;
13595 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13596 return 3;
13597 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
13599 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
13601 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
13602 if (s < 5)
13603 return s;
13605 return 5;
13607 else
13609 unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
13610 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
13612 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
13613 if (s < r)
13614 return s;
13616 return r;
13621 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
13622 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
13624 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13625 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13627 int litsize;
13628 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13630 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13631 return NULL;
13633 litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
13634 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
13635 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
13636 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
13637 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
13638 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
13639 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
13641 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
13642 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13643 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13644 return loc_result;
13647 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13648 size, 0);
13649 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13650 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
13651 return loc_result;
13654 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
13656 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13657 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, poly_int64 offset,
13658 enum var_init_status initialized)
13660 unsigned int regno;
13661 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
13662 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
13664 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13665 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13666 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13667 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
13668 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13670 rtx elim = (ira_use_lra_p
13671 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
13672 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
13674 if (elim != reg)
13676 elim = strip_offset_and_add (elim, &offset);
13677 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
13678 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13679 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
13680 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
13681 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13682 : stack_pointer_rtx));
13684 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
13685 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
13686 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
13687 access stack variables. */
13688 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
13689 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13691 int base_reg
13692 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
13693 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
13694 : REGNO (elim));
13695 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
13698 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
13699 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
13700 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
13701 if (offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
13702 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, const_offset, 0);
13703 else
13705 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, 0, 0);
13706 loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, offset);
13707 return ret;
13712 regno = REGNO (reg);
13713 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13714 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13716 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13717 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13718 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13720 #endif
13721 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (regno);
13723 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
13724 if (!optimize && fde
13725 && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno)
13726 && offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
13728 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
13729 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
13730 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
13731 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
13732 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
13733 else in other part of the routine. */
13734 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, const_offset, 0);
13737 result = new_reg_loc_descr (regno, offset);
13739 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13740 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13742 return result;
13745 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
13747 static inline int
13748 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
13750 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
13751 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13752 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
13753 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
13756 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
13757 failed. */
13759 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13760 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
13762 tree base;
13763 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
13765 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
13766 return NULL;
13768 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
13769 if (base == NULL
13770 || !VAR_P (base)
13771 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
13772 return NULL;
13774 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1, NULL);
13775 if (loc_result == NULL)
13776 return NULL;
13778 if (maybe_ne (MEM_OFFSET (mem), 0))
13779 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
13781 return loc_result;
13784 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
13785 expression. */
13787 static void
13788 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
13790 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
13792 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
13793 if (expr)
13794 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
13795 if (rtl)
13797 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
13798 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
13800 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
13804 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output. */
13806 static bool
13807 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx rtl)
13809 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
13811 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != UNSPEC)
13813 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13814 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
13815 return false;
13818 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, and
13819 the target hook doesn't explicitly allow it in debug info, assume
13820 we can't express it in the debug info. */
13821 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
13822 delegitimize. Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
13823 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
13824 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization. */
13825 if (flag_checking
13826 && (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
13827 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
13828 || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE))
13829 inform (current_function_decl
13830 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
13831 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
13832 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
13833 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
13834 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
13835 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
13836 XINT (rtl, 1));
13837 #else
13838 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
13839 XINT (rtl, 1));
13840 #endif
13841 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13842 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
13843 return false;
13846 if (CONST_POLY_INT_P (rtl))
13847 return false;
13849 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
13851 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13852 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
13853 return false;
13856 /* FIXME: Refer to PR60655. It is possible for simplification
13857 of rtl expressions in var tracking to produce such expressions.
13858 We should really identify / validate expressions
13859 enclosed in CONST that can be handled by assemblers on various
13860 targets and only handle legitimate cases here. */
13861 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13863 case SYMBOL_REF:
13864 break;
13865 case NOT:
13866 case NEG:
13867 return false;
13868 default:
13869 return true;
13872 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
13874 bool marked;
13875 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
13876 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
13877 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
13878 if (!marked)
13880 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13881 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
13882 return false;
13886 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13887 return false;
13889 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
13890 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
13891 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
13892 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
13893 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
13894 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
13896 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
13898 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
13900 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13901 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
13902 return false;
13906 return true;
13909 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
13910 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
13911 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
13913 static bool
13914 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
13916 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
13917 return const_ok_for_output_1 (rtl);
13919 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
13921 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
13922 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
13923 if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
13924 return false;
13925 return true;
13928 return true;
13931 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
13932 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
13934 static dw_die_ref
13935 base_type_for_mode (machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
13937 dw_die_ref type_die;
13938 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
13940 if (type == NULL)
13941 return NULL;
13942 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
13944 case INTEGER_TYPE:
13945 case REAL_TYPE:
13946 break;
13947 default:
13948 return NULL;
13950 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13951 if (!type_die)
13952 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
13953 comp_unit_die ());
13954 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
13955 return NULL;
13956 return type_die;
13959 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
13960 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
13961 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped. Return NULL if the conversion is not
13962 possible. */
13964 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13965 convert_descriptor_to_mode (scalar_int_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
13967 machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
13968 dw_die_ref type_die;
13969 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13971 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13973 add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0));
13974 return op;
13976 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
13977 if (type_die == NULL)
13978 return NULL;
13979 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
13980 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13981 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13982 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13983 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
13984 return op;
13987 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
13989 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13990 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
13991 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
13993 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
13994 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
13995 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13996 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
13998 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
13999 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
14001 return ret;
14004 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
14005 comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
14006 and in which OP_MODE is bigger than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. */
14008 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14009 scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (enum dwarf_location_atom op,
14010 scalar_int_mode op_mode,
14011 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
14013 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
14014 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14016 if (type_die == NULL)
14017 return NULL;
14018 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14019 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14020 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14021 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14022 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14023 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14024 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14025 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14026 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14027 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14028 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14031 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
14032 comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
14033 and in which OP_MODE is smaller than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. */
14035 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14036 scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14037 scalar_int_mode op_mode,
14038 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
14040 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14041 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
14042 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
14043 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
14045 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14046 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14048 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14050 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
14051 whether they are zero extended or not. */
14052 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
14053 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14054 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14055 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14056 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
14057 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
14058 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14059 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14060 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14061 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
14062 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14064 /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
14065 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
14066 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
14067 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
14069 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
14070 DW_OP_{eq,ne}. Pick whatever is shorter. */
14071 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14072 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14073 && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
14074 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
14075 >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
14076 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14077 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
14079 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
14080 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14081 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14082 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
14083 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14086 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14087 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14088 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14089 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
14090 else
14092 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14093 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14095 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14098 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
14100 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14101 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14102 machine_mode mem_mode)
14104 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14105 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14107 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14108 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14109 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14110 return NULL;
14112 scalar_int_mode int_op_mode;
14113 if (dwarf_strict
14114 && dwarf_version < 5
14115 && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode)
14116 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14117 return NULL;
14119 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14120 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14121 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14122 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14124 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14125 return NULL;
14127 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode))
14129 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14130 return scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (op, rtl, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14132 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14133 return scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (op, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14135 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14138 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
14140 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14141 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14142 machine_mode mem_mode)
14144 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14146 machine_mode test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14147 if (test_op_mode == VOIDmode)
14148 test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14150 scalar_int_mode op_mode;
14151 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (test_op_mode, &op_mode))
14152 return NULL;
14154 if (dwarf_strict
14155 && dwarf_version < 5
14156 && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14157 return NULL;
14159 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14160 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14161 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14162 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14164 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14165 return NULL;
14167 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14169 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
14170 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14171 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14173 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14175 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14176 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
14177 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14178 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14179 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14181 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14182 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14184 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14185 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
14186 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14187 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14188 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14190 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14191 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14194 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14196 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14197 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14198 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14199 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14200 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
14201 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14202 else
14203 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14204 bias, 0));
14206 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14209 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
14211 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14212 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14213 machine_mode mem_mode)
14215 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14216 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
14217 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
14219 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
14220 if (dwarf_strict
14221 && dwarf_version < 5
14222 && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14223 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14224 return NULL;
14226 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14227 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14228 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14229 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14231 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14232 return NULL;
14234 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14235 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14236 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14237 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
14239 /* Checked by the caller. */
14240 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
14241 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14243 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (int_mode);
14244 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14245 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14246 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14247 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14249 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14251 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14252 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14253 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14254 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14257 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14258 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14260 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14261 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14262 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14263 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14264 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14266 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14267 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14269 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 0);
14270 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14271 if (type_die == NULL)
14272 return NULL;
14273 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14274 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14275 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14276 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14277 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14278 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14279 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14280 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14281 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14282 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14285 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
14286 op = DW_OP_lt;
14287 else
14288 op = DW_OP_gt;
14289 ret = op0;
14290 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14291 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14292 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14293 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
14294 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14295 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14296 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
14297 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14298 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14299 if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
14300 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14301 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14302 ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, ret);
14303 return ret;
14306 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Perform OP binary op,
14307 but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
14308 convert back to unsigned. */
14310 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14311 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
14312 scalar_int_mode mode, machine_mode mem_mode)
14314 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
14316 if (type_die == NULL)
14317 return NULL;
14318 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14319 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14320 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14321 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14322 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14323 return NULL;
14324 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14325 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14326 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14327 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14328 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14329 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14330 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14331 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14332 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14333 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14334 add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
14335 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14336 return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
14339 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
14340 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14341 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
14342 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
14343 for the mode):
14344 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14345 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14346 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
14347 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14348 L3: DW_OP_drop
14349 L4: DW_OP_nop
14351 CTZ is similar:
14352 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14353 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14354 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14355 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14356 L3: DW_OP_drop
14357 L4: DW_OP_nop
14359 FFS is similar:
14360 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
14361 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
14362 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14363 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14364 L3: DW_OP_drop
14365 L4: DW_OP_nop */
14367 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14368 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14369 machine_mode mem_mode)
14371 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14372 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
14373 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14374 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14375 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
14376 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
14377 rtx msb;
14379 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
14380 return NULL;
14382 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14383 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14384 if (op0 == NULL)
14385 return NULL;
14386 ret = op0;
14387 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
14389 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
14390 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
14392 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
14393 valv = 0;
14394 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
14395 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
14396 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14397 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14398 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14399 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
14400 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
14401 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14402 if (tmp == NULL)
14403 return NULL;
14404 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14405 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14406 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
14407 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
14408 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
14409 mode, mem_mode,
14410 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14411 if (l1label == NULL)
14412 return NULL;
14413 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14414 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14415 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
14416 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14417 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
14418 msb = const1_rtx;
14419 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14420 msb = GEN_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U
14421 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
14422 else
14423 msb = immed_wide_int_const
14424 (wi::set_bit_in_zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - 1,
14425 GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
14426 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
14427 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
14428 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
14429 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
14430 else
14431 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
14432 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14433 if (tmp == NULL)
14434 return NULL;
14435 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14436 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14437 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14438 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
14439 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14440 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14441 if (tmp == NULL)
14442 return NULL;
14443 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14444 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
14445 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14446 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14447 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
14448 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14449 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14450 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14451 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14452 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
14453 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14454 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
14455 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14456 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14457 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14458 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14459 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14460 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
14461 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14462 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
14463 return ret;
14466 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14467 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
14468 const0 DW_OP_swap
14469 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
14470 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
14471 L2: DW_OP_drop
14473 PARITY is similar:
14474 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
14475 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
14476 L2: DW_OP_drop */
14478 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14479 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14480 machine_mode mem_mode)
14482 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14483 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14484 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14486 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
14487 return NULL;
14489 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14490 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14491 if (op0 == NULL)
14492 return NULL;
14493 ret = op0;
14494 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14495 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14496 if (tmp == NULL)
14497 return NULL;
14498 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14499 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14500 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
14501 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14502 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14503 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14504 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14505 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
14506 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14507 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14508 if (tmp == NULL)
14509 return NULL;
14510 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14511 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14512 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
14513 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
14514 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14515 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14516 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14517 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14518 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14519 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14520 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14521 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14522 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14523 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14524 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14525 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14526 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14527 return ret;
14530 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
14531 constS const0
14532 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
14533 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
14534 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
14535 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
14536 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
14538 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14539 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14540 machine_mode mem_mode)
14542 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14543 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14544 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14546 if (BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
14547 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
14548 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
14549 return NULL;
14551 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14552 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14553 if (op0 == NULL)
14554 return NULL;
14556 ret = op0;
14557 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
14558 mode, mem_mode,
14559 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14560 if (tmp == NULL)
14561 return NULL;
14562 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14563 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14564 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14565 if (tmp == NULL)
14566 return NULL;
14567 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14568 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
14569 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14570 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
14571 mode, mem_mode,
14572 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14573 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14574 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
14575 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14576 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14577 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
14578 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14579 if (tmp == NULL)
14580 return NULL;
14581 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14582 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14583 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
14584 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14585 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
14586 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14587 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14588 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14589 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14590 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14591 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
14592 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14593 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14594 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
14595 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14596 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14597 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14598 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14599 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14600 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14601 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14602 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14603 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14604 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
14605 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14606 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14607 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14608 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14609 return ret;
14612 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
14613 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
14614 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
14615 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
14617 ROTATERT is similar:
14618 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
14619 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
14620 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
14622 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14623 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14624 machine_mode mem_mode)
14626 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14627 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
14628 int i;
14630 if (is_narrower_int_mode (GET_MODE (rtlop1), mode))
14631 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
14632 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14633 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14634 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
14635 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14636 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14637 return NULL;
14638 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14639 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
14641 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14642 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
14643 mode, mem_mode,
14644 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14645 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14646 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
14647 ? DW_OP_const4u
14648 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
14649 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
14650 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
14651 else
14652 mask[i] = NULL;
14653 if (mask[i] == NULL)
14654 return NULL;
14655 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14657 ret = op0;
14658 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14659 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14660 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14661 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
14663 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14664 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14665 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
14667 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14668 if (mask[0] != NULL)
14669 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
14670 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
14671 if (mask[1] != NULL)
14673 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14674 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
14675 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14677 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
14679 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14680 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14681 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
14683 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14684 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
14685 return ret;
14688 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
14689 for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL. */
14691 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14692 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
14694 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
14695 dw_die_ref ref;
14697 if (dwarf_strict)
14698 return NULL;
14699 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
14700 /* With LTO during LTRANS we get the late DIE that refers to the early
14701 DIE, thus we add another indirection here. This seems to confuse
14702 gdb enough to make gcc.dg/guality/pr68860-1.c FAIL with LTO. */
14703 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
14704 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
14705 if (ref)
14707 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14708 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
14709 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14711 else
14713 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
14714 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
14716 return ret;
14719 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
14720 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
14721 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
14722 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
14724 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
14725 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
14726 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
14727 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
14729 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
14731 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
14732 autoincrement addressing modes.
14734 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
14736 dw_loc_descr_ref
14737 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14738 machine_mode mem_mode,
14739 enum var_init_status initialized)
14741 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
14742 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14743 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14744 rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
14745 poly_int64 offset;
14747 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14748 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14750 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
14751 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
14752 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
14753 zeroth element of the array. */
14755 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
14757 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
14758 return NULL;
14760 scalar_int_mode int_mode, inner_mode, op1_mode;
14761 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14763 case POST_INC:
14764 case POST_DEC:
14765 case POST_MODIFY:
14766 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
14768 case SUBREG:
14769 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
14770 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
14771 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
14772 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
14773 contains the given subreg. */
14774 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
14775 break;
14776 inner = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
14777 /* FALLTHRU */
14778 case TRUNCATE:
14779 if (inner == NULL_RTX)
14780 inner = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14781 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14782 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
14783 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14784 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14785 || (int_mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
14786 #endif
14788 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14790 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
14791 inner_mode,
14792 mem_mode, initialized);
14793 break;
14795 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14796 break;
14797 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14798 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
14799 ? GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode)
14800 : GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
14802 dw_die_ref type_die;
14803 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14805 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
14806 GET_MODE (inner),
14807 mem_mode, initialized);
14808 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
14809 break;
14810 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14811 if (type_die == NULL)
14813 mem_loc_result = NULL;
14814 break;
14816 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
14817 != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
14818 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14819 else
14820 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_reinterpret), 0, 0);
14821 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14822 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14823 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14824 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14825 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14826 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14828 /* Convert it to untyped afterwards. */
14829 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14830 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14833 break;
14835 case REG:
14836 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14837 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14838 && rtl != arg_pointer_rtx
14839 && rtl != frame_pointer_rtx
14840 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14841 && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
14842 #endif
14845 dw_die_ref type_die;
14846 unsigned int dbx_regnum;
14848 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14849 break;
14850 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14851 break;
14852 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14853 if (type_die == NULL)
14854 break;
14856 dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
14857 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
14858 break;
14859 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_regval_type),
14860 dbx_regnum, 0);
14861 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14862 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14863 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14864 break;
14866 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
14867 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
14868 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
14869 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
14870 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
14871 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
14872 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
14873 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
14874 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
14875 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
14876 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
14877 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
14878 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
14879 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14880 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14881 else if (stack_realign_drap
14882 && crtl->drap_reg
14883 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
14884 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14886 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
14887 out, use DRAP instead. */
14888 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
14889 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14891 break;
14893 case SIGN_EXTEND:
14894 case ZERO_EXTEND:
14895 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14896 || !is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode))
14897 break;
14898 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
14899 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14900 if (op0 == 0)
14901 break;
14902 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
14903 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14904 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14905 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
14906 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
14907 masking. */
14908 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= 4)
14910 mem_loc_result = op0;
14911 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14912 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (inner_mode)));
14913 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14915 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14917 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode);
14918 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
14919 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
14920 op = DW_OP_shra;
14921 else
14922 op = DW_OP_shr;
14923 mem_loc_result = op0;
14924 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14925 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14926 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14927 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14929 else if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
14931 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
14932 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14934 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (inner_mode,
14935 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
14936 if (type_die1 == NULL)
14937 break;
14938 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
14939 if (type_die2 == NULL)
14940 break;
14941 mem_loc_result = op0;
14942 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14943 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14944 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
14945 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14946 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14947 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14948 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14949 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
14950 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14951 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14953 break;
14955 case MEM:
14957 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14958 if (new_rtl != rtl)
14960 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
14961 initialized);
14962 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
14963 return mem_loc_result;
14966 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
14967 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
14968 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14969 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
14970 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
14971 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
14973 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14974 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14976 dw_die_ref type_die;
14977 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
14979 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14980 return NULL;
14981 type_die
14982 = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14983 if (type_die == NULL)
14984 return NULL;
14985 deref = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_deref_type),
14986 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14987 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14988 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14989 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14990 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
14992 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14993 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
14994 else
14995 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14996 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
14997 GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0));
14999 break;
15001 case LO_SUM:
15002 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
15004 case LABEL_REF:
15005 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
15006 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
15007 pool. */
15008 case CONST:
15009 case SYMBOL_REF:
15010 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15011 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15012 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15013 && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
15014 #endif
15016 break;
15017 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
15018 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
15020 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
15022 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
15023 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
15024 break;
15026 temp = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_true);
15028 /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
15029 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12. */
15030 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr ((dwarf_version >= 5
15031 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
15032 : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address),
15033 0, 0);
15034 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
15036 break;
15039 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15041 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
15042 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15044 case NOT:
15045 op = DW_OP_not;
15046 goto try_const_unop;
15047 case NEG:
15048 op = DW_OP_neg;
15049 goto try_const_unop;
15050 try_const_unop:
15051 rtx arg;
15052 arg = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
15053 if (!CONSTANT_P (arg))
15054 arg = gen_rtx_CONST (int_mode, arg);
15055 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (arg, int_mode, mem_mode,
15056 initialized);
15057 if (op0)
15059 mem_loc_result = op0;
15060 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15062 break;
15063 default:
15064 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode,
15065 mem_mode, initialized);
15066 break;
15068 break;
15071 symref:
15072 mem_loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
15073 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
15074 break;
15076 case CONCAT:
15077 case CONCATN:
15078 case VAR_LOCATION:
15079 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
15080 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
15081 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
15082 return 0;
15084 case ENTRY_VALUE:
15085 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15086 return NULL;
15087 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
15089 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15090 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15091 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
15092 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15093 else
15095 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl));
15096 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
15097 return NULL;
15098 op0 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum,
15099 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15102 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
15103 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
15105 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
15106 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15107 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
15108 return NULL;
15110 else
15111 gcc_unreachable ();
15112 if (op0 == NULL)
15113 return NULL;
15114 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_entry_value), 0, 0);
15115 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15116 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
15117 break;
15119 case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
15120 mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
15121 break;
15123 case PRE_MODIFY:
15124 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
15125 PLUS code below. */
15126 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15127 goto plus;
15129 case PRE_INC:
15130 case PRE_DEC:
15131 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
15132 below. */
15133 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
15134 gen_int_mode (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
15135 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
15136 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode),
15137 mode));
15139 /* fall through */
15141 case PLUS:
15142 plus:
15143 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
15144 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15145 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15146 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
15147 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx))
15148 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15149 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
15150 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15151 else
15153 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15154 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15155 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
15156 break;
15158 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15159 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode))
15160 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15161 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
15162 else
15164 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15165 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15166 if (op1 == 0)
15167 return NULL;
15168 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15169 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15170 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15173 break;
15175 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
15176 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
15177 case MINUS:
15178 op = DW_OP_minus;
15179 goto do_binop;
15181 case MULT:
15182 op = DW_OP_mul;
15183 goto do_binop;
15185 case DIV:
15186 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15187 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15188 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15190 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15191 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15192 int_mode, mem_mode);
15193 break;
15195 op = DW_OP_div;
15196 goto do_binop;
15198 case UMOD:
15199 op = DW_OP_mod;
15200 goto do_binop;
15202 case ASHIFT:
15203 op = DW_OP_shl;
15204 goto do_shift;
15206 case ASHIFTRT:
15207 op = DW_OP_shra;
15208 goto do_shift;
15210 case LSHIFTRT:
15211 op = DW_OP_shr;
15212 goto do_shift;
15214 do_shift:
15215 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15216 break;
15217 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode, mem_mode,
15218 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15220 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15221 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (rtlop1), &op1_mode)
15222 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op1_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode))
15223 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (int_mode, rtlop1);
15224 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, int_mode, mem_mode,
15225 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15228 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15229 break;
15231 mem_loc_result = op0;
15232 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15233 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15234 break;
15236 case AND:
15237 op = DW_OP_and;
15238 goto do_binop;
15240 case IOR:
15241 op = DW_OP_or;
15242 goto do_binop;
15244 case XOR:
15245 op = DW_OP_xor;
15246 goto do_binop;
15248 do_binop:
15249 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15250 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15251 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15252 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15254 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15255 break;
15257 mem_loc_result = op0;
15258 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15259 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15260 break;
15262 case MOD:
15263 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15264 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15265 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15267 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
15268 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15269 int_mode, mem_mode);
15270 break;
15273 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15274 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15275 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15276 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15278 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15279 break;
15281 mem_loc_result = op0;
15282 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15283 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15284 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15285 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
15286 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
15287 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15288 break;
15290 case UDIV:
15291 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15292 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15294 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15296 op = DW_OP_div;
15297 goto do_binop;
15299 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15300 base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1),
15301 int_mode, mem_mode);
15303 break;
15305 case NOT:
15306 op = DW_OP_not;
15307 goto do_unop;
15309 case ABS:
15310 op = DW_OP_abs;
15311 goto do_unop;
15313 case NEG:
15314 op = DW_OP_neg;
15315 goto do_unop;
15317 do_unop:
15318 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15319 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15321 if (op0 == 0)
15322 break;
15324 mem_loc_result = op0;
15325 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15326 break;
15328 case CONST_INT:
15329 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15330 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15331 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15332 || (int_mode == Pmode
15333 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
15334 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
15335 #endif
15338 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15339 break;
15341 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15342 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
15343 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
15345 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
15346 scalar_int_mode amode;
15347 if (type_die == NULL)
15348 return NULL;
15349 if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
15350 && (int_mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0)
15351 .exists (&amode))
15352 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
15353 /* const DW_OP_convert <XXX> vs.
15354 DW_OP_const_type <XXX, 1, const>. */
15355 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
15356 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode))
15358 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15359 op0 = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15360 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15361 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15362 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15363 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
15364 return mem_loc_result;
15366 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0,
15367 INTVAL (rtl));
15368 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15369 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15370 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15371 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15372 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
15373 else
15375 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15376 = dw_val_class_const_double;
15377 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15378 = double_int::from_shwi (INTVAL (rtl));
15381 break;
15383 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15384 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15386 dw_die_ref type_die;
15388 /* Note that if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0, a
15389 CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either a large integer
15390 or a floating-point constant. If TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT != 0,
15391 the value is always a floating point constant.
15393 When it is an integer, a CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
15394 the constant requires 2 HWIs to be adequately represented.
15395 We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
15396 if (mode == VOIDmode
15397 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
15398 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
15399 break;
15400 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15401 if (type_die == NULL)
15402 return NULL;
15403 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
15404 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15405 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15406 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15407 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
15408 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
15410 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15411 = dw_val_class_const_double;
15412 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15413 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
15415 else
15416 #endif
15418 scalar_float_mode float_mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (mode);
15419 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (float_mode);
15420 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
15422 insert_float (rtl, array);
15423 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15424 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
15425 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
15426 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15429 break;
15431 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
15432 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15434 dw_die_ref type_die;
15436 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15437 if (type_die == NULL)
15438 return NULL;
15439 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
15440 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15441 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15442 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15443 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15444 = dw_val_class_wide_int;
15445 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
15446 *mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, mode);
15448 break;
15450 case CONST_POLY_INT:
15451 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (rtx_to_poly_int64 (rtl));
15452 break;
15454 case EQ:
15455 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
15456 break;
15458 case GE:
15459 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
15460 break;
15462 case GT:
15463 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
15464 break;
15466 case LE:
15467 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
15468 break;
15470 case LT:
15471 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
15472 break;
15474 case NE:
15475 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
15476 break;
15478 case GEU:
15479 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
15480 break;
15482 case GTU:
15483 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
15484 break;
15486 case LEU:
15487 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
15488 break;
15490 case LTU:
15491 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
15492 break;
15494 case UMIN:
15495 case UMAX:
15496 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
15497 break;
15498 /* FALLTHRU */
15499 case SMIN:
15500 case SMAX:
15501 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
15502 break;
15504 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
15505 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
15506 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15507 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
15508 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15509 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode)
15510 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15511 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15512 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15513 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
15514 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode)))
15516 int shift, size;
15517 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
15518 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15519 if (op0 == 0)
15520 break;
15521 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
15522 op = DW_OP_shra;
15523 else
15524 op = DW_OP_shr;
15525 mem_loc_result = op0;
15526 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
15527 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
15528 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15529 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) - shift - size;
15530 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15532 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15533 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15534 - shift - size));
15535 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15537 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15539 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15540 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
15541 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15544 break;
15546 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
15548 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
15549 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15550 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
15551 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15552 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15553 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15554 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15555 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
15556 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15557 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
15558 break;
15560 mem_loc_result = op1;
15561 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
15562 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
15563 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15564 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
15565 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15566 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15567 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
15568 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15569 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
15571 break;
15573 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
15574 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
15575 case FLOAT:
15576 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
15577 case FIX:
15578 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
15579 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15581 dw_die_ref type_die;
15582 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
15584 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15585 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15586 if (op0 == NULL)
15587 break;
15588 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &int_mode)
15589 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
15590 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15592 type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode,
15593 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
15594 if (type_die == NULL)
15595 break;
15596 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15597 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15598 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15599 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15600 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15602 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
15603 if (type_die == NULL)
15604 break;
15605 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15606 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15607 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15608 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15609 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15610 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15611 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
15612 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15614 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, op0);
15615 if (op0 == NULL)
15616 break;
15618 mem_loc_result = op0;
15620 break;
15622 case CLZ:
15623 case CTZ:
15624 case FFS:
15625 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15626 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15627 break;
15629 case POPCOUNT:
15630 case PARITY:
15631 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15632 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15633 break;
15635 case BSWAP:
15636 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15637 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15638 break;
15640 case ROTATE:
15641 case ROTATERT:
15642 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15643 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15644 break;
15646 case COMPARE:
15647 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
15648 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
15649 natively. */
15650 case SS_MULT:
15651 case US_MULT:
15652 case SS_DIV:
15653 case US_DIV:
15654 case SS_PLUS:
15655 case US_PLUS:
15656 case SS_MINUS:
15657 case US_MINUS:
15658 case SS_NEG:
15659 case US_NEG:
15660 case SS_ABS:
15661 case SS_ASHIFT:
15662 case US_ASHIFT:
15663 case SS_TRUNCATE:
15664 case US_TRUNCATE:
15665 case UNORDERED:
15666 case ORDERED:
15667 case UNEQ:
15668 case UNGE:
15669 case UNGT:
15670 case UNLE:
15671 case UNLT:
15672 case LTGT:
15673 case FRACT_CONVERT:
15674 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
15675 case SAT_FRACT:
15676 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
15677 case SQRT:
15678 case ASM_OPERANDS:
15679 case VEC_MERGE:
15680 case VEC_SELECT:
15681 case VEC_CONCAT:
15682 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
15683 case VEC_SERIES:
15684 case UNSPEC:
15685 case HIGH:
15686 case FMA:
15687 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
15688 case CONST_VECTOR:
15689 case CONST_FIXED:
15690 case CLRSB:
15691 case CLOBBER:
15692 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
15693 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
15694 TLS UNSPECs. */
15695 break;
15697 case CONST_STRING:
15698 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
15699 goto symref;
15701 /* RTL sequences inside PARALLEL record a series of DWARF operations for
15702 the expression. An UNSPEC rtx represents a raw DWARF operation,
15703 new_loc_descr is called for it to build the operation directly.
15704 Otherwise mem_loc_descriptor is called recursively. */
15705 case PARALLEL:
15707 int index = 0;
15708 dw_loc_descr_ref exp_result = NULL;
15710 for (; index < XVECLEN (rtl, 0); index++)
15712 rtx elem = XVECEXP (rtl, 0, index);
15713 if (GET_CODE (elem) == UNSPEC)
15715 /* Each DWARF operation UNSPEC contain two operands, if
15716 one operand is not used for the operation, const0_rtx is
15717 passed. */
15718 gcc_assert (XVECLEN (elem, 0) == 2);
15720 HOST_WIDE_INT dw_op = XINT (elem, 1);
15721 HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 0));
15722 HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 1));
15723 exp_result
15724 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) dw_op, oprnd1,
15725 oprnd2);
15727 else
15728 exp_result
15729 = mem_loc_descriptor (elem, mode, mem_mode,
15730 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15732 if (!mem_loc_result)
15733 mem_loc_result = exp_result;
15734 else
15735 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, exp_result);
15738 break;
15741 default:
15742 if (flag_checking)
15744 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
15745 gcc_unreachable ();
15747 break;
15750 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15751 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15753 return mem_loc_result;
15756 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
15757 This is typically a complex variable. */
15759 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15760 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
15762 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
15763 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
15764 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15765 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
15766 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15768 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
15769 return 0;
15771 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
15772 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
15774 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
15775 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
15777 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15778 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15780 return cc_loc_result;
15783 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
15784 locations. */
15786 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15787 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
15789 unsigned int i;
15790 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
15791 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
15793 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
15795 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
15796 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
15798 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15799 if (ref == NULL)
15800 return NULL;
15802 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
15803 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
15806 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15807 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15809 return cc_loc_result;
15812 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_implicit_pointer
15813 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
15815 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15816 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
15818 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
15819 dw_die_ref ref;
15821 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15822 return NULL;
15823 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
15824 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
15825 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
15826 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
15827 ret = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
15828 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
15829 if (ref)
15831 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15832 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
15833 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15835 else
15837 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
15838 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
15840 return ret;
15843 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
15844 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
15845 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
15846 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
15847 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
15849 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
15850 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
15851 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
15853 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
15855 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15856 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
15857 enum var_init_status initialized)
15859 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
15860 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
15862 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15864 case SUBREG:
15865 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
15866 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
15867 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
15868 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
15869 contains the given subreg. */
15870 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
15871 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
15872 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
15873 else
15874 goto do_default;
15875 break;
15877 case REG:
15878 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
15879 break;
15881 case MEM:
15882 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
15883 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
15884 if (loc_result == NULL)
15885 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
15886 if (loc_result == NULL)
15888 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15889 if (new_rtl != rtl)
15890 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
15892 break;
15894 case CONCAT:
15895 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
15896 initialized);
15897 break;
15899 case CONCATN:
15900 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
15901 break;
15903 case VAR_LOCATION:
15904 /* Single part. */
15905 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
15907 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
15908 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
15909 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
15910 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
15911 break;
15914 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15915 /* FALLTHRU */
15917 case PARALLEL:
15919 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
15920 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
15921 machine_mode mode;
15922 int i;
15924 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
15925 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
15926 VOIDmode, initialized);
15927 if (loc_result == NULL)
15928 return NULL;
15929 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
15930 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
15931 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
15933 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
15935 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
15936 VOIDmode, initialized);
15937 if (temp == NULL)
15938 return NULL;
15939 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
15940 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
15941 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
15944 break;
15946 case CONST_INT:
15947 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
15949 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
15950 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode),
15951 INTVAL (rtl));
15953 break;
15955 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15956 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15957 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15959 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15961 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
15963 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
15964 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
15965 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
15966 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
15967 scalar_mode smode = as_a <scalar_mode> (mode);
15968 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15969 GET_MODE_SIZE (smode), 0);
15970 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
15971 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (smode))
15973 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
15974 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15975 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
15977 else
15978 #endif
15980 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (smode);
15981 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
15983 insert_float (rtl, array);
15984 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15985 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
15986 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
15987 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15990 break;
15992 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
15993 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15994 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15996 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15998 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
15999 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
16000 GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0);
16001 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
16002 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
16003 *loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, int_mode);
16005 break;
16007 case CONST_VECTOR:
16008 if (mode == VOIDmode)
16009 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16011 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16013 unsigned int length;
16014 if (!CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl).is_constant (&length))
16015 return NULL;
16017 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
16018 unsigned char *array
16019 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
16020 unsigned int i;
16021 unsigned char *p;
16022 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
16024 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
16025 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
16027 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
16028 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16030 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16031 insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
16033 break;
16035 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
16036 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16038 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16039 insert_float (elt, p);
16041 break;
16043 default:
16044 gcc_unreachable ();
16047 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
16048 length * elt_size, 0);
16049 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
16050 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
16051 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
16052 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
16054 break;
16056 case CONST:
16057 if (mode == VOIDmode
16058 || CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16059 || CONST_DOUBLE_AS_FLOAT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16060 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
16062 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
16063 break;
16065 /* FALLTHROUGH */
16066 case SYMBOL_REF:
16067 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
16068 break;
16069 /* FALLTHROUGH */
16070 case LABEL_REF:
16071 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16072 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16073 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16075 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
16076 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16077 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
16079 break;
16081 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
16082 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
16083 break;
16085 case PLUS:
16086 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
16087 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
16089 loc_result
16090 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
16091 break;
16093 /* FALLTHRU */
16094 do_default:
16095 default:
16096 if ((is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16097 && GET_MODE (rtl) == int_mode
16098 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16099 && dwarf_version >= 4)
16100 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
16102 /* Value expression. */
16103 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
16104 if (loc_result)
16105 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
16106 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16108 break;
16111 return loc_result;
16114 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
16115 address ranges where a given location is valid.
16116 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
16117 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
16118 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
16119 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
16121 static const char *
16122 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
16124 const char *secname;
16126 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
16127 && (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) || TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_STATIC (decl))
16128 && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
16129 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
16130 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
16131 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
16132 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
16133 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
16134 else
16135 secname = text_section_label;
16137 return secname;
16140 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
16142 static bool
16143 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
16145 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
16146 || VAR_P (decl))
16147 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
16150 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16151 for VARLOC. */
16153 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16154 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
16155 enum var_init_status initialized)
16157 int have_address = 0;
16158 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16159 machine_mode mode;
16161 if (want_address != 2)
16163 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
16164 /* Single part. */
16165 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
16167 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
16168 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
16169 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16170 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
16171 if (MEM_P (varloc))
16173 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16174 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
16175 mode, initialized);
16176 if (descr)
16177 have_address = 1;
16178 else
16180 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
16181 if (x != varloc)
16182 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
16183 initialized);
16186 else
16187 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
16189 else
16190 return 0;
16192 else
16194 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
16195 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
16196 else
16197 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
16198 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
16199 have_address = 1;
16202 if (!descr)
16203 return 0;
16205 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
16206 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16208 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16210 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16211 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16212 return 0;
16214 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16215 have_address = 1;
16217 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
16218 if (want_address && !have_address)
16220 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16221 "Want address and only have value");
16222 return 0;
16225 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
16226 if (!want_address && have_address)
16228 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16229 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16231 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
16233 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16234 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16235 return 0;
16237 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16238 op = DW_OP_deref;
16239 else
16240 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
16242 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16245 return descr;
16248 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
16249 if it is not possible. */
16251 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16252 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16254 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
16255 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
16256 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
16257 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
16258 else
16259 return NULL;
16262 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16263 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
16265 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16266 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
16268 rtx p;
16269 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT padsize = 0;
16270 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
16271 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
16272 rtx varloc;
16273 enum var_init_status initialized;
16275 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
16276 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
16277 return NULL;
16279 decl_size = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
16280 descr = NULL;
16281 descr_tail = &descr;
16283 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
16285 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
16286 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
16287 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
16288 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
16289 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opsize = 0;
16291 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
16292 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
16294 padsize += bitsize;
16295 continue;
16297 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
16298 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
16299 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
16300 if (cur_descr == NULL)
16302 padsize += bitsize;
16303 continue;
16306 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
16307 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
16308 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
16309 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
16310 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
16311 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
16313 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
16314 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16315 last = *tail;
16317 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
16319 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
16320 last = *tail;
16323 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
16325 padsize += bitsize;
16326 /* Discard the current piece of the descriptor and release any
16327 addr_table entries it uses. */
16328 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16329 continue;
16332 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
16333 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
16334 if (padsize)
16336 if (padsize > decl_size)
16338 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16339 goto discard_descr;
16341 decl_size -= padsize;
16342 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
16343 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16345 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16346 goto discard_descr;
16348 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16349 padsize = 0;
16351 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
16352 descr_tail = tail;
16353 if (bitsize > decl_size)
16354 goto discard_descr;
16355 decl_size -= bitsize;
16356 if (last == NULL)
16358 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
16359 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
16360 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
16362 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
16363 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
16364 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16368 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
16369 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
16370 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
16371 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16372 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
16373 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
16374 else
16375 break;
16377 while (1);
16378 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
16379 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
16380 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
16381 adjustment. */
16382 if (MEM_P (varloc))
16384 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize;
16385 if (!poly_uint64 (MEM_SIZE (varloc)).is_constant (&memsize))
16386 goto discard_descr;
16387 memsize *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
16388 if (memsize != bitsize)
16390 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
16391 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
16392 goto discard_descr;
16393 if (memsize < bitsize)
16394 goto discard_descr;
16395 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
16396 offset = memsize - bitsize;
16400 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
16401 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16402 goto discard_descr;
16403 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16407 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
16408 the decl. */
16409 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
16411 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
16412 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16413 goto discard_descr;
16415 return descr;
16417 discard_descr:
16418 /* Discard the descriptor and release any addr_table entries it uses. */
16419 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (descr);
16420 return NULL;
16423 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
16424 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
16425 function. */
16427 static dw_loc_list_ref
16428 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
16430 const char *endname, *secname;
16431 rtx varloc;
16432 enum var_init_status initialized;
16433 struct var_loc_node *node;
16434 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16435 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
16436 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
16437 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
16439 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
16440 actually construct the list of locations.
16441 The first location information is what is passed to the
16442 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
16443 locations just get added on to that list.
16444 Note that we only know the start address for a location
16445 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
16446 the range [current location start, next location start].
16447 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
16448 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
16450 if (cfun && crtl->has_bb_partition)
16452 bool save_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
16453 in_cold_section_p = first_function_block_is_cold;
16454 if (loc_list->last_before_switch == NULL)
16455 in_cold_section_p = !in_cold_section_p;
16456 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
16457 in_cold_section_p = save_in_cold_section_p;
16459 else
16460 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
16462 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
16464 bool range_across_switch = false;
16465 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
16466 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
16468 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16470 descr = NULL;
16471 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
16472 inside DWARF expressions. */
16473 if (want_address == 2)
16474 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
16476 else
16478 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
16479 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
16480 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
16482 if (descr)
16484 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
16485 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
16486 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
16487 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
16488 of first partition and second one starting at the
16489 beginning of second partition. */
16490 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
16491 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
16492 && current_function_decl)
16494 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
16495 range_across_switch = true;
16497 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
16498 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
16499 else if (node->next)
16500 endname = node->next->label;
16501 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
16502 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
16503 else if (!current_function_decl)
16504 endname = text_end_label;
16505 else
16507 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
16508 current_function_funcdef_no);
16509 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
16512 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
16513 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
16514 && node == loc_list->first
16515 && NOTE_P (node->loc)
16516 && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
16517 (*listp)->force = true;
16518 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
16522 if (cfun
16523 && crtl->has_bb_partition
16524 && node == loc_list->last_before_switch)
16526 bool save_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
16527 in_cold_section_p = !first_function_block_is_cold;
16528 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
16529 in_cold_section_p = save_in_cold_section_p;
16532 if (range_across_switch)
16534 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16535 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
16536 else
16538 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
16539 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
16540 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
16541 initialized);
16543 gcc_assert (descr);
16544 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
16545 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
16546 if (node->next)
16547 endname = node->next->label;
16548 else
16549 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end;
16550 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
16551 endname, secname);
16552 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
16556 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
16557 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
16558 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
16559 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
16560 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
16561 available. */
16562 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
16563 gen_llsym (list);
16565 return list;
16568 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
16569 as location description. */
16571 static bool
16572 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
16574 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
16575 return !list->ll_symbol;
16578 /* Duplicate a single element of location list. */
16580 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
16581 copy_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16583 dw_loc_descr_ref copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
16584 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
16585 return copy;
16588 /* To each location in list LIST append loc descr REF. */
16590 static void
16591 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16593 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
16594 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
16595 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16596 while (list)
16598 copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
16599 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
16600 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
16601 copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
16602 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16606 /* To each location in list LIST prepend loc descr REF. */
16608 static void
16609 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16611 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
16612 dw_loc_descr_ref ref_end = list->expr;
16613 add_loc_descr (&ref, list->expr);
16614 list->expr = ref;
16615 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16616 while (list)
16618 dw_loc_descr_ref end = list->expr;
16619 list->expr = copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
16620 while (copy->dw_loc_next != ref_end)
16621 copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
16622 copy->dw_loc_next = end;
16623 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16627 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
16628 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
16629 to expression in RET on each position in program.
16630 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
16632 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
16633 element. General case would involve sorting the lists in program order
16634 and merging them that will need some additional work.
16635 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
16636 structures. */
16638 static void
16639 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
16641 if (!list)
16642 return;
16643 if (!*ret)
16645 *ret = list;
16646 return;
16648 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
16650 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
16651 return;
16653 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
16655 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
16656 *ret = list;
16657 return;
16659 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
16660 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
16661 " location lists.\n");
16662 *ret = NULL;
16663 return;
16666 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
16667 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
16669 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16670 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
16672 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
16673 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
16675 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
16677 gcc_assert (!rtl);
16678 return 0;
16680 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
16682 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
16683 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
16684 populated. */
16685 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
16687 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16688 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
16689 return 0;
16691 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
16692 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16695 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
16696 by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
16697 it into simple arithmetics.
16699 See loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
16701 static dw_loc_list_ref
16702 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev,
16703 loc_descr_context *context)
16705 tree obj, offset;
16706 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
16707 machine_mode mode;
16708 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
16709 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
16711 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
16712 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
16713 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
16714 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
16715 if (!multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos))
16717 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
16718 return 0;
16720 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
16722 expansion_failed (obj,
16723 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
16724 return 0;
16726 if (!offset && known_eq (bitpos, 0))
16727 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1,
16728 context);
16729 else if (toplev
16730 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16731 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16733 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0, context);
16734 if (!list_ret)
16735 return 0;
16736 if (offset)
16738 /* Variable offset. */
16739 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
16740 if (list_ret1 == 0)
16741 return 0;
16742 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16743 if (!list_ret)
16744 return 0;
16745 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16746 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
16748 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
16749 if (bytepos.is_constant (&value) && value > 0)
16750 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16751 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, value, 0));
16752 else if (maybe_ne (bytepos, 0))
16753 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
16754 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16755 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16757 return list_ret;
16760 /* Set LOC to the next operation that is not a DW_OP_nop operation. In the case
16761 all operations from LOC are nops, move to the last one. Insert in NOPS all
16762 operations that are skipped. */
16764 static void
16765 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc,
16766 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> &nops)
16768 while (loc->dw_loc_next != NULL && loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop)
16770 nops.add (loc);
16771 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
16775 /* Helper for loc_descr_without_nops: free the location description operation
16776 P. */
16778 bool
16779 free_loc_descr (const dw_loc_descr_ref &loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16781 ggc_free (loc);
16782 return true;
16785 /* Remove all DW_OP_nop operations from LOC except, if it exists, the one that
16786 finishes LOC. */
16788 static void
16789 loc_descr_without_nops (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc)
16791 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
16792 return;
16794 /* Set of all DW_OP_nop operations we remove. */
16795 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> nops;
16797 /* First, strip all prefix NOP operations in order to keep the head of the
16798 operations list. */
16799 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (loc, nops);
16801 for (dw_loc_descr_ref cur = loc; cur != NULL;)
16803 /* For control flow operations: strip "prefix" nops in destination
16804 labels. */
16805 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
16806 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc, nops);
16807 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
16808 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_loc, nops);
16810 /* Do the same for the operations that follow, then move to the next
16811 iteration. */
16812 if (cur->dw_loc_next != NULL)
16813 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_next, nops);
16814 cur = cur->dw_loc_next;
16817 nops.traverse<void *, free_loc_descr> (NULL);
16821 struct dwarf_procedure_info;
16823 /* Helper structure for location descriptions generation. */
16824 struct loc_descr_context
16826 /* The type that is implicitly referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address, or
16827 NULL_TREE if DW_OP_push_object_address in invalid for this location
16828 description. This is used when processing PLACEHOLDER_EXPR nodes. */
16829 tree context_type;
16830 /* The ..._DECL node that should be translated as a
16831 DW_OP_push_object_address operation. */
16832 tree base_decl;
16833 /* Information about the DWARF procedure we are currently generating. NULL if
16834 we are not generating a DWARF procedure. */
16835 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi;
16836 /* True if integral PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for the first argument passed
16837 by consumer. Used for DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes. */
16838 bool placeholder_arg;
16839 /* True if PLACEHOLDER_EXPR has been seen. */
16840 bool placeholder_seen;
16843 /* DWARF procedures generation
16845 DWARF expressions (aka. location descriptions) are used to encode variable
16846 things such as sizes or offsets. Such computations can have redundant parts
16847 that can be factorized in order to reduce the size of the output debug
16848 information. This is the whole point of DWARF procedures.
16850 Thanks to stor-layout.c, size and offset expressions in GENERIC trees are
16851 already factorized into functions ("size functions") in order to handle very
16852 big and complex types. Such functions are quite simple: they have integral
16853 arguments, they return an integral result and their body contains only a
16854 return statement with arithmetic expressions. This is the only kind of
16855 function we are interested in translating into DWARF procedures, here.
16857 DWARF expressions and DWARF procedure are executed using a stack, so we have
16858 to define some calling convention for them to interact. Let's say that:
16860 - Before calling a DWARF procedure, DWARF expressions must push on the stack
16861 all arguments in reverse order (right-to-left) so that when the DWARF
16862 procedure execution starts, the first argument is the top of the stack.
16864 - Then, when returning, the DWARF procedure must have consumed all arguments
16865 on the stack, must have pushed the result and touched nothing else.
16867 - Each integral argument and the result are integral types can be hold in a
16868 single stack slot.
16870 - We call "frame offset" the number of stack slots that are "under DWARF
16871 procedure control": it includes the arguments slots, the temporaries and
16872 the result slot. Thus, it is equal to the number of arguments when the
16873 procedure execution starts and must be equal to one (the result) when it
16874 returns. */
16876 /* Helper structure used when generating operations for a DWARF procedure. */
16877 struct dwarf_procedure_info
16879 /* The FUNCTION_DECL node corresponding to the DWARF procedure that is
16880 currently translated. */
16881 tree fndecl;
16882 /* The number of arguments FNDECL takes. */
16883 unsigned args_count;
16886 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node for a DWARF procedure. Add
16887 LOCATION as its DW_AT_location attribute. If FNDECL is not NULL_TREE,
16888 equate it to this DIE. */
16890 static dw_die_ref
16891 new_dwarf_proc_die (dw_loc_descr_ref location, tree fndecl,
16892 dw_die_ref parent_die)
16894 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
16896 if ((dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
16897 || location == NULL)
16898 return NULL;
16900 dwarf_proc_die = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, parent_die, fndecl);
16901 if (fndecl)
16902 equate_decl_number_to_die (fndecl, dwarf_proc_die);
16903 add_AT_loc (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_location, location);
16904 return dwarf_proc_die;
16907 /* Return whether TYPE is a supported type as a DWARF procedure argument
16908 type or return type (we handle only scalar types and pointer types that
16909 aren't wider than the DWARF expression evaluation stack. */
16911 static bool
16912 is_handled_procedure_type (tree type)
16914 return ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
16915 || TREE_CODE (type) == OFFSET_TYPE
16916 || TREE_CODE (type) == POINTER_TYPE)
16917 && int_size_in_bytes (type) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
16920 /* Helper for resolve_args_picking: do the same but stop when coming across
16921 visited nodes. For each node we visit, register in FRAME_OFFSETS the frame
16922 offset *before* evaluating the corresponding operation. */
16924 static bool
16925 resolve_args_picking_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
16926 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi,
16927 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> &frame_offsets)
16929 /* The "frame_offset" identifier is already used to name a macro... */
16930 unsigned frame_offset_ = initial_frame_offset;
16931 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
16933 for (l = loc; l != NULL;)
16935 bool existed;
16936 unsigned &l_frame_offset = frame_offsets.get_or_insert (l, &existed);
16938 /* If we already met this node, there is nothing to compute anymore. */
16939 if (existed)
16941 /* Make sure that the stack size is consistent wherever the execution
16942 flow comes from. */
16943 gcc_assert ((unsigned) l_frame_offset == frame_offset_);
16944 break;
16946 l_frame_offset = frame_offset_;
16948 /* If needed, relocate the picking offset with respect to the frame
16949 offset. */
16950 if (l->frame_offset_rel)
16952 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off;
16953 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
16955 case DW_OP_pick:
16956 off = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
16957 break;
16958 case DW_OP_dup:
16959 off = 0;
16960 break;
16961 case DW_OP_over:
16962 off = 1;
16963 break;
16964 default:
16965 gcc_unreachable ();
16967 /* frame_offset_ is the size of the current stack frame, including
16968 incoming arguments. Besides, the arguments are pushed
16969 right-to-left. Thus, in order to access the Nth argument from
16970 this operation node, the picking has to skip temporaries *plus*
16971 one stack slot per argument (0 for the first one, 1 for the second
16972 one, etc.).
16974 The targetted argument number (N) is already set as the operand,
16975 and the number of temporaries can be computed with:
16976 frame_offsets_ - dpi->args_count */
16977 off += frame_offset_ - dpi->args_count;
16979 /* DW_OP_pick handles only offsets from 0 to 255 (inclusive)... */
16980 if (off > 255)
16981 return false;
16983 if (off == 0)
16985 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_dup;
16986 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
16988 else if (off == 1)
16990 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_over;
16991 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
16993 else
16995 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_pick;
16996 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = off;
17000 /* Update frame_offset according to the effect the current operation has
17001 on the stack. */
17002 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17004 case DW_OP_deref:
17005 case DW_OP_swap:
17006 case DW_OP_rot:
17007 case DW_OP_abs:
17008 case DW_OP_neg:
17009 case DW_OP_not:
17010 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
17011 case DW_OP_skip:
17012 case DW_OP_reg0:
17013 case DW_OP_reg1:
17014 case DW_OP_reg2:
17015 case DW_OP_reg3:
17016 case DW_OP_reg4:
17017 case DW_OP_reg5:
17018 case DW_OP_reg6:
17019 case DW_OP_reg7:
17020 case DW_OP_reg8:
17021 case DW_OP_reg9:
17022 case DW_OP_reg10:
17023 case DW_OP_reg11:
17024 case DW_OP_reg12:
17025 case DW_OP_reg13:
17026 case DW_OP_reg14:
17027 case DW_OP_reg15:
17028 case DW_OP_reg16:
17029 case DW_OP_reg17:
17030 case DW_OP_reg18:
17031 case DW_OP_reg19:
17032 case DW_OP_reg20:
17033 case DW_OP_reg21:
17034 case DW_OP_reg22:
17035 case DW_OP_reg23:
17036 case DW_OP_reg24:
17037 case DW_OP_reg25:
17038 case DW_OP_reg26:
17039 case DW_OP_reg27:
17040 case DW_OP_reg28:
17041 case DW_OP_reg29:
17042 case DW_OP_reg30:
17043 case DW_OP_reg31:
17044 case DW_OP_bregx:
17045 case DW_OP_piece:
17046 case DW_OP_deref_size:
17047 case DW_OP_nop:
17048 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
17049 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
17050 case DW_OP_stack_value:
17051 break;
17053 case DW_OP_addr:
17054 case DW_OP_const1u:
17055 case DW_OP_const1s:
17056 case DW_OP_const2u:
17057 case DW_OP_const2s:
17058 case DW_OP_const4u:
17059 case DW_OP_const4s:
17060 case DW_OP_const8u:
17061 case DW_OP_const8s:
17062 case DW_OP_constu:
17063 case DW_OP_consts:
17064 case DW_OP_dup:
17065 case DW_OP_over:
17066 case DW_OP_pick:
17067 case DW_OP_lit0:
17068 case DW_OP_lit1:
17069 case DW_OP_lit2:
17070 case DW_OP_lit3:
17071 case DW_OP_lit4:
17072 case DW_OP_lit5:
17073 case DW_OP_lit6:
17074 case DW_OP_lit7:
17075 case DW_OP_lit8:
17076 case DW_OP_lit9:
17077 case DW_OP_lit10:
17078 case DW_OP_lit11:
17079 case DW_OP_lit12:
17080 case DW_OP_lit13:
17081 case DW_OP_lit14:
17082 case DW_OP_lit15:
17083 case DW_OP_lit16:
17084 case DW_OP_lit17:
17085 case DW_OP_lit18:
17086 case DW_OP_lit19:
17087 case DW_OP_lit20:
17088 case DW_OP_lit21:
17089 case DW_OP_lit22:
17090 case DW_OP_lit23:
17091 case DW_OP_lit24:
17092 case DW_OP_lit25:
17093 case DW_OP_lit26:
17094 case DW_OP_lit27:
17095 case DW_OP_lit28:
17096 case DW_OP_lit29:
17097 case DW_OP_lit30:
17098 case DW_OP_lit31:
17099 case DW_OP_breg0:
17100 case DW_OP_breg1:
17101 case DW_OP_breg2:
17102 case DW_OP_breg3:
17103 case DW_OP_breg4:
17104 case DW_OP_breg5:
17105 case DW_OP_breg6:
17106 case DW_OP_breg7:
17107 case DW_OP_breg8:
17108 case DW_OP_breg9:
17109 case DW_OP_breg10:
17110 case DW_OP_breg11:
17111 case DW_OP_breg12:
17112 case DW_OP_breg13:
17113 case DW_OP_breg14:
17114 case DW_OP_breg15:
17115 case DW_OP_breg16:
17116 case DW_OP_breg17:
17117 case DW_OP_breg18:
17118 case DW_OP_breg19:
17119 case DW_OP_breg20:
17120 case DW_OP_breg21:
17121 case DW_OP_breg22:
17122 case DW_OP_breg23:
17123 case DW_OP_breg24:
17124 case DW_OP_breg25:
17125 case DW_OP_breg26:
17126 case DW_OP_breg27:
17127 case DW_OP_breg28:
17128 case DW_OP_breg29:
17129 case DW_OP_breg30:
17130 case DW_OP_breg31:
17131 case DW_OP_fbreg:
17132 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
17133 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
17134 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
17135 ++frame_offset_;
17136 break;
17138 case DW_OP_drop:
17139 case DW_OP_xderef:
17140 case DW_OP_and:
17141 case DW_OP_div:
17142 case DW_OP_minus:
17143 case DW_OP_mod:
17144 case DW_OP_mul:
17145 case DW_OP_or:
17146 case DW_OP_plus:
17147 case DW_OP_shl:
17148 case DW_OP_shr:
17149 case DW_OP_shra:
17150 case DW_OP_xor:
17151 case DW_OP_bra:
17152 case DW_OP_eq:
17153 case DW_OP_ge:
17154 case DW_OP_gt:
17155 case DW_OP_le:
17156 case DW_OP_lt:
17157 case DW_OP_ne:
17158 case DW_OP_regx:
17159 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
17160 --frame_offset_;
17161 break;
17163 case DW_OP_call2:
17164 case DW_OP_call4:
17165 case DW_OP_call_ref:
17167 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
17168 int *stack_usage = dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->get (dwarf_proc);
17170 if (stack_usage == NULL)
17171 return false;
17172 frame_offset_ += *stack_usage;
17173 break;
17176 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
17177 case DW_OP_entry_value:
17178 case DW_OP_const_type:
17179 case DW_OP_regval_type:
17180 case DW_OP_deref_type:
17181 case DW_OP_convert:
17182 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
17183 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
17184 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
17185 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
17186 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
17187 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
17188 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
17189 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
17190 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
17191 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
17192 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
17193 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
17194 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
17195 /* loc_list_from_tree will probably not output these operations for
17196 size functions, so assume they will not appear here. */
17197 /* Fall through... */
17199 default:
17200 gcc_unreachable ();
17203 /* Now, follow the control flow (except subroutine calls). */
17204 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17206 case DW_OP_bra:
17207 if (!resolve_args_picking_1 (l->dw_loc_next, frame_offset_, dpi,
17208 frame_offsets))
17209 return false;
17210 /* Fall through. */
17212 case DW_OP_skip:
17213 l = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc;
17214 break;
17216 case DW_OP_stack_value:
17217 return true;
17219 default:
17220 l = l->dw_loc_next;
17221 break;
17225 return true;
17228 /* Make a DFS over operations reachable through LOC (i.e. follow branch
17229 operations) in order to resolve the operand of DW_OP_pick operations that
17230 target DWARF procedure arguments (DPI). INITIAL_FRAME_OFFSET is the frame
17231 offset *before* LOC is executed. Return if all relocations were
17232 successful. */
17234 static bool
17235 resolve_args_picking (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
17236 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi)
17238 /* Associate to all visited operations the frame offset *before* evaluating
17239 this operation. */
17240 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> frame_offsets;
17242 return resolve_args_picking_1 (loc, initial_frame_offset, dpi,
17243 frame_offsets);
17246 /* Try to generate a DWARF procedure that computes the same result as FNDECL.
17247 Return NULL if it is not possible. */
17249 static dw_die_ref
17250 function_to_dwarf_procedure (tree fndecl)
17252 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
17253 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
17254 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
17255 tree tree_body = DECL_SAVED_TREE (fndecl);
17256 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_body, epilogue;
17258 tree cursor;
17259 unsigned i;
17261 /* Do not generate multiple DWARF procedures for the same function
17262 declaration. */
17263 dwarf_proc_die = lookup_decl_die (fndecl);
17264 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
17265 return dwarf_proc_die;
17267 /* DWARF procedures are available starting with the DWARFv3 standard. */
17268 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
17269 return NULL;
17271 /* We handle only functions for which we still have a body, that return a
17272 supported type and that takes arguments with supported types. Note that
17273 there is no point translating functions that return nothing. */
17274 if (tree_body == NULL_TREE
17275 || DECL_RESULT (fndecl) == NULL_TREE
17276 || !is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))))
17277 return NULL;
17279 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
17280 cursor != NULL_TREE;
17281 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor))
17282 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (cursor)))
17283 return NULL;
17285 /* Match only "expr" in: RETURN_EXPR (MODIFY_EXPR (RESULT_DECL, expr)). */
17286 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != RETURN_EXPR)
17287 return NULL;
17288 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0);
17289 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != MODIFY_EXPR
17290 || TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0) != DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
17291 return NULL;
17292 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 1);
17294 /* Try to translate the body expression itself. Note that this will probably
17295 cause an infinite recursion if its call graph has a cycle. This is very
17296 unlikely for size functions, however, so don't bother with such things at
17297 the moment. */
17298 ctx.context_type = NULL_TREE;
17299 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
17300 ctx.dpi = &dpi;
17301 ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
17302 ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
17303 dpi.fndecl = fndecl;
17304 dpi.args_count = list_length (DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl));
17305 loc_body = loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_body, 0, &ctx);
17306 if (!loc_body)
17307 return NULL;
17309 /* After evaluating all operands in "loc_body", we should still have on the
17310 stack all arguments plus the desired function result (top of the stack).
17311 Generate code in order to keep only the result in our stack frame. */
17312 epilogue = NULL;
17313 for (i = 0; i < dpi.args_count; ++i)
17315 dw_loc_descr_ref op_couple = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0);
17316 op_couple->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
17317 op_couple->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next = epilogue;
17318 epilogue = op_couple;
17320 add_loc_descr (&loc_body, epilogue);
17321 if (!resolve_args_picking (loc_body, dpi.args_count, &dpi))
17322 return NULL;
17324 /* Trailing nops from loc_descriptor_from_tree (if any) cannot be removed
17325 because they are considered useful. Now there is an epilogue, they are
17326 not anymore, so give it another try. */
17327 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_body);
17329 /* fndecl may be used both as a regular DW_TAG_subprogram DIE and as
17330 a DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, so we may have a conflict, here. It's unlikely,
17331 though, given that size functions do not come from source, so they should
17332 not have a dedicated DW_TAG_subprogram DIE. */
17333 dwarf_proc_die
17334 = new_dwarf_proc_die (loc_body, fndecl,
17335 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (fndecl)));
17337 /* The called DWARF procedure consumes one stack slot per argument and
17338 returns one stack slot. */
17339 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->put (dwarf_proc_die, 1 - dpi.args_count);
17341 return dwarf_proc_die;
17345 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
17346 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
17347 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
17348 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
17349 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
17350 to refer to register values).
17352 CONTEXT provides information to customize the location descriptions
17353 generation. Its context_type field specifies what type is implicitly
17354 referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address. If it is NULL_TREE, this operation
17355 will not be generated.
17357 Its DPI field determines whether we are generating a DWARF expression for a
17358 DWARF procedure, so PARM_DECL references are processed specifically.
17360 If CONTEXT is NULL, the behavior is the same as if context_type, base_decl
17361 and dpi fields were null. */
17363 static dw_loc_list_ref
17364 loc_list_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address,
17365 struct loc_descr_context *context)
17367 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
17368 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
17369 int have_address = 0;
17370 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
17372 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
17373 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
17374 problem... */
17376 if (context != NULL
17377 && context->base_decl == loc
17378 && want_address == 0)
17380 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17381 return new_loc_list (new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0),
17382 NULL, NULL, NULL);
17383 else
17384 return NULL;
17387 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
17389 case ERROR_MARK:
17390 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
17391 return 0;
17393 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
17394 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
17395 position of other fields. It is supposed to appear only as the first
17396 operand of COMPONENT_REF nodes and to reference precisely the type
17397 that the context allows. */
17398 if (context != NULL
17399 && TREE_TYPE (loc) == context->context_type
17400 && want_address >= 1)
17402 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17404 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
17405 have_address = 1;
17406 break;
17408 else
17409 return NULL;
17411 /* For DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes, PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for
17412 the single argument passed by consumer. */
17413 else if (context != NULL
17414 && context->placeholder_arg
17415 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
17416 && want_address == 0)
17418 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 0, 0);
17419 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
17420 context->placeholder_seen = true;
17421 break;
17423 else
17424 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17425 "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR for an unexpected type");
17426 break;
17428 case CALL_EXPR:
17430 const int nargs = call_expr_nargs (loc);
17431 tree callee = get_callee_fndecl (loc);
17432 int i;
17433 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc;
17435 if (callee == NULL_TREE)
17436 goto call_expansion_failed;
17438 /* We handle only functions that return an integer. */
17439 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (callee))))
17440 goto call_expansion_failed;
17442 dwarf_proc = function_to_dwarf_procedure (callee);
17443 if (dwarf_proc == NULL)
17444 goto call_expansion_failed;
17446 /* Evaluate arguments right-to-left so that the first argument will
17447 be the top-most one on the stack. */
17448 for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; --i)
17450 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr
17451 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (CALL_EXPR_ARG (loc, i), 0,
17452 context);
17454 if (loc_descr == NULL)
17455 goto call_expansion_failed;
17457 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descr);
17460 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call4, 0, 0);
17461 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
17462 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = dwarf_proc;
17463 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
17464 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17465 break;
17467 call_expansion_failed:
17468 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
17469 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
17470 return 0;
17473 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
17474 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
17475 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
17476 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
17477 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
17478 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
17479 return 0;
17481 case ADDR_EXPR:
17482 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
17483 e.g. for &this->field. */
17484 if (want_address)
17486 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
17487 (loc, want_address == 2, context);
17488 if (list_ret)
17489 have_address = 1;
17490 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
17491 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17492 have_address = 1;
17494 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
17495 if (!list_ret && !ret)
17496 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1, context);
17497 else
17499 if (want_address)
17500 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
17501 return NULL;
17503 break;
17505 case VAR_DECL:
17506 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
17508 rtx rtl;
17509 enum dwarf_location_atom tls_op;
17510 enum dtprel_bool dtprel = dtprel_false;
17512 if (targetm.have_tls)
17514 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
17515 data. */
17516 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
17517 return 0;
17519 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
17520 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
17521 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
17522 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
17523 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
17524 operand shouldn't be. */
17525 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
17526 return 0;
17527 dtprel = dtprel_true;
17528 /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
17529 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12. */
17530 tls_op = (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
17531 : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address);
17533 else
17535 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
17536 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
17537 return 0;
17538 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
17539 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
17540 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
17541 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
17542 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
17543 tls_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
17546 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
17547 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
17548 return 0;
17550 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
17551 return 0;
17552 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17553 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
17554 return 0;
17556 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel);
17557 ret1 = new_loc_descr (tls_op, 0, 0);
17558 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17560 have_address = 1;
17561 break;
17563 /* FALLTHRU */
17565 case PARM_DECL:
17566 if (context != NULL && context->dpi != NULL
17567 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == context->dpi->fndecl)
17569 /* We are generating code for a DWARF procedure and we want to access
17570 one of its arguments: find the appropriate argument offset and let
17571 the resolve_args_picking pass compute the offset that complies
17572 with the stack frame size. */
17573 unsigned i = 0;
17574 tree cursor;
17576 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (context->dpi->fndecl);
17577 cursor != NULL_TREE && cursor != loc;
17578 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor), ++i)
17580 /* If we are translating a DWARF procedure, all referenced parameters
17581 must belong to the current function. */
17582 gcc_assert (cursor != NULL_TREE);
17584 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, i, 0);
17585 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
17586 break;
17588 /* FALLTHRU */
17590 case RESULT_DECL:
17591 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
17592 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
17593 want_address, context);
17594 /* FALLTHRU */
17596 case FUNCTION_DECL:
17598 rtx rtl;
17599 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
17601 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
17603 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
17604 have_address = want_address != 0;
17605 break;
17607 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
17608 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
17610 if (TREE_CODE (loc) != FUNCTION_DECL
17611 && early_dwarf
17612 && current_function_decl
17613 && want_address != 1
17614 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (loc)
17615 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
17616 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17617 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == current_function_decl
17618 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17619 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
17621 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (loc);
17622 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_variable_value, 0, 0);
17623 if (ref)
17625 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
17626 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
17627 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
17629 else
17631 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
17632 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = loc;
17634 break;
17636 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
17637 return 0;
17639 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
17641 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
17642 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17643 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
17644 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
17646 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17648 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
17649 return 0;
17651 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
17652 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
17653 else
17655 machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
17657 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
17658 if (want_address == 2)
17660 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
17661 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17662 have_address = 1;
17664 else
17666 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
17667 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
17668 if (MEM_P (rtl))
17670 mem_mode = mode;
17671 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
17672 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17673 have_address = 1;
17675 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
17676 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17678 if (!ret)
17679 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
17680 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
17683 break;
17685 case MEM_REF:
17686 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
17688 have_address = 1;
17689 goto do_plus;
17691 /* Fallthru. */
17692 case INDIRECT_REF:
17693 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17694 have_address = 1;
17695 break;
17697 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
17698 case SSA_NAME:
17699 case DEBUG_EXPR_DECL:
17700 return NULL;
17702 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
17703 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address,
17704 context);
17706 CASE_CONVERT:
17707 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
17708 case SAVE_EXPR:
17709 case MODIFY_EXPR:
17710 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
17711 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address,
17712 context);
17714 case COMPONENT_REF:
17715 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
17716 case ARRAY_REF:
17717 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
17718 case REALPART_EXPR:
17719 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
17721 tree obj, offset;
17722 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
17723 machine_mode mode;
17724 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
17726 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
17727 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
17729 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
17731 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (obj,
17732 want_address == 2
17733 && known_eq (bitpos, 0)
17734 && !offset ? 2 : 1,
17735 context);
17736 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
17737 for nonzero bitpos. */
17738 if (list_ret == 0)
17739 return 0;
17740 if (!multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
17741 || !multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))
17743 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17744 "bitfield access");
17745 return 0;
17748 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
17750 /* Variable offset. */
17751 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (offset, 0, context);
17752 if (list_ret1 == 0)
17753 return 0;
17754 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17755 if (!list_ret)
17756 return 0;
17757 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
17760 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
17761 if (bytepos.is_constant (&value) && value > 0)
17762 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
17763 value, 0));
17764 else if (maybe_ne (bytepos, 0))
17765 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
17767 have_address = 1;
17768 break;
17771 case INTEGER_CST:
17772 if ((want_address || !tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
17773 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17774 have_address = 1;
17775 else if (want_address == 2
17776 && tree_fits_shwi_p (loc)
17777 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
17778 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
17779 tree_to_shwi (loc))))
17780 have_address = 1;
17781 else if (tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
17782 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_to_shwi (loc));
17783 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (loc))
17784 ret = uint_loc_descriptor (tree_to_uhwi (loc));
17785 else
17787 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17788 "Integer operand is not host integer");
17789 return 0;
17791 break;
17793 case CONSTRUCTOR:
17794 case REAL_CST:
17795 case STRING_CST:
17796 case COMPLEX_CST:
17797 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17798 have_address = 1;
17799 else if (TREE_CODE (loc) == CONSTRUCTOR)
17801 tree type = TREE_TYPE (loc);
17802 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
17803 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
17804 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
17805 constructor_elt *ce;
17807 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
17809 /* This is very limited, but it's enough to output
17810 pointers to member functions, as long as the
17811 referenced function is defined in the current
17812 translation unit. */
17813 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (loc), cnt, ce)
17815 tree val = ce->value;
17817 tree field = ce->index;
17819 if (val)
17820 STRIP_NOPS (val);
17822 if (!field || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
17824 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17825 "bitfield in record type constructor");
17826 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17827 ret = NULL;
17828 break;
17831 HOST_WIDE_INT fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
17832 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT pos = int_byte_position (field);
17833 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
17834 if (pos < offset)
17836 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17837 "out-of-order fields in record constructor");
17838 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17839 ret = NULL;
17840 break;
17842 if (pos > offset)
17844 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, pos - offset, 0);
17845 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17846 offset = pos;
17848 if (val && fieldsize != 0)
17850 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, want_address, context);
17851 if (!ret1)
17853 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17854 "unsupported expression in field");
17855 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17856 ret = NULL;
17857 break;
17859 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17861 if (fieldsize)
17863 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, fieldsize, 0);
17864 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17865 offset = pos + fieldsize;
17869 if (offset != size)
17871 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size - offset, 0);
17872 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17873 offset = size;
17876 have_address = !!want_address;
17878 else
17879 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17880 "constructor of non-record type");
17882 else
17883 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
17884 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17885 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
17886 break;
17888 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
17889 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
17890 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
17891 op = DW_OP_and;
17892 goto do_binop;
17894 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
17895 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
17896 op = DW_OP_xor;
17897 goto do_binop;
17899 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
17900 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
17901 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
17902 op = DW_OP_or;
17903 goto do_binop;
17905 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
17906 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
17907 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
17908 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
17909 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
17910 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17911 return 0;
17912 op = DW_OP_div;
17913 goto do_binop;
17915 case MINUS_EXPR:
17916 op = DW_OP_minus;
17917 goto do_binop;
17919 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
17920 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
17921 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
17922 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
17923 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17925 op = DW_OP_mod;
17926 goto do_binop;
17928 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17929 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17930 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
17931 return 0;
17933 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17934 if (list_ret == 0)
17935 return 0;
17936 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
17937 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
17938 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
17939 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
17940 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
17941 break;
17943 case MULT_EXPR:
17944 op = DW_OP_mul;
17945 goto do_binop;
17947 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
17948 op = DW_OP_shl;
17949 goto do_binop;
17951 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
17952 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
17953 goto do_binop;
17955 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
17956 case PLUS_EXPR:
17957 do_plus:
17958 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
17960 /* Big unsigned numbers can fit in HOST_WIDE_INT but it may be
17961 smarter to encode their opposite. The DW_OP_plus_uconst operation
17962 takes 1 + X bytes, X being the size of the ULEB128 addend. On the
17963 other hand, a "<push literal>; DW_OP_minus" pattern takes 1 + Y
17964 bytes, Y being the size of the operation that pushes the opposite
17965 of the addend. So let's choose the smallest representation. */
17966 const tree tree_addend = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1);
17967 offset_int wi_addend;
17968 HOST_WIDE_INT shwi_addend;
17969 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_naddend;
17971 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17972 if (list_ret == 0)
17973 return 0;
17975 /* Try to get the literal to push. It is the opposite of the addend,
17976 so as we rely on wrapping during DWARF evaluation, first decode
17977 the literal as a "DWARF-sized" signed number. */
17978 wi_addend = wi::to_offset (tree_addend);
17979 wi_addend = wi::sext (wi_addend, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8);
17980 shwi_addend = wi_addend.to_shwi ();
17981 loc_naddend = (shwi_addend != INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT))
17982 ? int_loc_descriptor (-shwi_addend)
17983 : NULL;
17985 if (loc_naddend != NULL
17986 && ((unsigned) size_of_uleb128 (shwi_addend)
17987 > size_of_loc_descr (loc_naddend)))
17989 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, loc_naddend);
17990 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17991 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
17993 else
17995 for (dw_loc_descr_ref loc_cur = loc_naddend; loc_cur != NULL; )
17997 loc_naddend = loc_cur;
17998 loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next;
17999 ggc_free (loc_naddend);
18001 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, wi_addend.to_shwi ());
18003 break;
18006 op = DW_OP_plus;
18007 goto do_binop;
18009 case LE_EXPR:
18010 op = DW_OP_le;
18011 goto do_comp_binop;
18013 case GE_EXPR:
18014 op = DW_OP_ge;
18015 goto do_comp_binop;
18017 case LT_EXPR:
18018 op = DW_OP_lt;
18019 goto do_comp_binop;
18021 case GT_EXPR:
18022 op = DW_OP_gt;
18023 goto do_comp_binop;
18025 do_comp_binop:
18026 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
18028 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18029 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18030 list_ret = loc_list_from_uint_comparison (list_ret, list_ret1,
18031 TREE_CODE (loc));
18032 break;
18034 else
18035 goto do_binop;
18037 case EQ_EXPR:
18038 op = DW_OP_eq;
18039 goto do_binop;
18041 case NE_EXPR:
18042 op = DW_OP_ne;
18043 goto do_binop;
18045 do_binop:
18046 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18047 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18048 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
18049 return 0;
18051 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
18052 if (list_ret == 0)
18053 return 0;
18054 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
18055 break;
18057 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
18058 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
18059 op = DW_OP_not;
18060 goto do_unop;
18062 case ABS_EXPR:
18063 op = DW_OP_abs;
18064 goto do_unop;
18066 case NEGATE_EXPR:
18067 op = DW_OP_neg;
18068 goto do_unop;
18070 do_unop:
18071 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18072 if (list_ret == 0)
18073 return 0;
18075 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
18076 break;
18078 case MIN_EXPR:
18079 case MAX_EXPR:
18081 const enum tree_code code =
18082 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
18084 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
18085 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
18086 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
18087 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
18090 /* fall through */
18092 case COND_EXPR:
18094 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
18095 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18096 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
18097 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0, context);
18098 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
18100 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18101 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
18102 return 0;
18104 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
18105 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
18107 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
18108 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
18109 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
18111 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
18112 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
18113 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
18115 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
18116 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
18117 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
18118 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
18119 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
18121 break;
18123 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
18124 return 0;
18126 default:
18127 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
18128 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
18129 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
18130 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
18132 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18133 "language specific tree node");
18134 return 0;
18137 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
18138 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
18139 if (flag_checking)
18140 gcc_unreachable ();
18142 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
18143 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
18144 return NULL;
18147 if (!ret && !list_ret)
18148 return 0;
18150 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
18151 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
18153 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18155 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18156 "DWARF address size mismatch");
18157 return 0;
18159 if (ret)
18160 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18161 else
18162 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
18163 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18164 have_address = 1;
18166 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
18167 if (want_address && !have_address)
18169 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18170 "Want address and only have value");
18171 return 0;
18174 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
18176 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
18177 if (!want_address && have_address)
18179 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
18181 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
18183 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18184 "DWARF address size mismatch");
18185 return 0;
18187 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18188 op = DW_OP_deref;
18189 else
18190 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
18192 if (ret)
18193 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18194 else
18195 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18197 if (ret)
18198 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
18200 return list_ret;
18203 /* Likewise, but strip useless DW_OP_nop operations in the resulting
18204 expressions. */
18206 static dw_loc_list_ref
18207 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18208 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18210 dw_loc_list_ref result = loc_list_from_tree_1 (loc, want_address, context);
18212 for (dw_loc_list_ref loc_cur = result;
18213 loc_cur != NULL; loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next)
18214 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_cur->expr);
18215 return result;
18218 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
18219 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18220 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18221 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18223 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address, context);
18224 if (!ret)
18225 return NULL;
18226 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
18228 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18229 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
18230 return NULL;
18232 return ret->expr;
18235 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
18236 which is not less than the value itself. */
18238 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
18239 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
18241 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
18244 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
18245 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
18246 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
18247 ERROR_MARK node. */
18249 static inline tree
18250 field_type (const_tree decl)
18252 tree type;
18254 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
18255 return integer_type_node;
18257 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
18258 if (type == NULL_TREE)
18259 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18261 return type;
18264 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
18265 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
18266 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
18268 static inline unsigned
18269 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
18271 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
18274 static inline unsigned
18275 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
18277 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
18280 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
18282 static inline offset_int
18283 round_up_to_align (const offset_int &t, unsigned int align)
18285 return wi::udiv_trunc (t + align - 1, align) * align;
18288 /* Compute the size of TYPE in bytes. If possible, return NULL and store the
18289 size as an integer constant in CST_SIZE. Otherwise, if possible, return a
18290 DWARF expression that computes the size. Return NULL and set CST_SIZE to -1
18291 if we fail to return the size in one of these two forms. */
18293 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18294 type_byte_size (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_size)
18296 tree tree_size;
18297 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
18299 /* Return a constant integer in priority, if possible. */
18300 *cst_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
18301 if (*cst_size != -1)
18302 return NULL;
18304 ctx.context_type = const_cast<tree> (type);
18305 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
18306 ctx.dpi = NULL;
18307 ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
18308 ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
18310 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
18311 tree_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type);
18312 return ((tree_size != NULL_TREE)
18313 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_size, 0, &ctx)
18314 : NULL);
18317 /* Helper structure for RECORD_TYPE processing. */
18318 struct vlr_context
18320 /* Root RECORD_TYPE. It is needed to generate data member location
18321 descriptions in variable-length records (VLR), but also to cope with
18322 variants, which are composed of nested structures multiplexed with
18323 QUAL_UNION_TYPE nodes. Each time such a structure is passed to a
18324 function processing a FIELD_DECL, it is required to be non null. */
18325 tree struct_type;
18326 /* When generating a variant part in a RECORD_TYPE (i.e. a nested
18327 QUAL_UNION_TYPE), this holds an expression that computes the offset for
18328 this variant part as part of the root record (in storage units). For
18329 regular records, it must be NULL_TREE. */
18330 tree variant_part_offset;
18333 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute the byte offset of the lowest
18334 addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL. If
18335 possible, return a native constant through CST_OFFSET (in which case NULL is
18336 returned); otherwise return a DWARF expression that computes the offset.
18338 Set *CST_OFFSET to 0 and return NULL if we are unable to determine what
18339 that offset is, either because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an
18340 ERROR_MARK node, or because the offset expression is too complex for us.
18342 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
18344 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18345 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx,
18346 HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_offset)
18348 tree tree_result;
18349 dw_loc_list_ref loc_result;
18351 *cst_offset = 0;
18353 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
18354 return NULL;
18355 else
18356 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
18358 /* We cannot handle variable bit offsets at the moment, so abort if it's the
18359 case. */
18360 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
18361 return NULL;
18363 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
18364 /* We used to handle only constant offsets in all cases. Now, we handle
18365 properly dynamic byte offsets only when PCC bitfield type doesn't
18366 matter. */
18367 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
18368 && TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (decl)) == INTEGER_CST)
18370 offset_int object_offset_in_bits;
18371 offset_int object_offset_in_bytes;
18372 offset_int bitpos_int;
18373 tree type;
18374 tree field_size_tree;
18375 offset_int deepest_bitpos;
18376 offset_int field_size_in_bits;
18377 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
18378 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
18379 offset_int type_size_in_bits;
18381 bitpos_int = wi::to_offset (bit_position (decl));
18382 type = field_type (decl);
18383 type_size_in_bits = offset_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
18384 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
18386 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
18388 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
18389 a flexible array member. */
18390 if (!field_size_tree)
18391 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
18393 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
18394 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
18395 field_size_in_bits = wi::to_offset (field_size_tree);
18396 else
18397 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
18399 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
18401 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
18402 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
18403 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
18404 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
18405 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
18406 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
18407 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
18408 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
18409 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
18411 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
18413 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
18414 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
18415 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
18416 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
18417 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
18418 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
18419 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
18420 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
18421 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
18422 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
18423 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
18425 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
18426 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
18427 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
18428 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
18429 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
18430 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
18431 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
18432 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
18433 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
18434 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
18435 structure type.)
18437 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
18438 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
18439 must have believed that the containing object started (within
18440 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
18441 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
18442 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
18443 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
18445 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
18446 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
18447 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
18449 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
18450 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
18451 be. */
18452 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
18454 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
18455 bitfields. */
18456 object_offset_in_bits
18457 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
18459 if (wi::gtu_p (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int))
18461 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
18463 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
18464 object_offset_in_bits
18465 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
18468 object_offset_in_bytes
18469 = wi::lrshift (object_offset_in_bits, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
18470 if (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE)
18472 *cst_offset = object_offset_in_bytes.to_shwi ();
18473 return NULL;
18475 tree_result = wide_int_to_tree (sizetype, object_offset_in_bytes);
18477 else
18478 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
18479 tree_result = byte_position (decl);
18481 if (ctx->variant_part_offset != NULL_TREE)
18482 tree_result = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tree_result),
18483 ctx->variant_part_offset, tree_result);
18485 /* If the byte offset is a constant, it's simplier to handle a native
18486 constant rather than a DWARF expression. */
18487 if (TREE_CODE (tree_result) == INTEGER_CST)
18489 *cst_offset = wi::to_offset (tree_result).to_shwi ();
18490 return NULL;
18492 struct loc_descr_context loc_ctx = {
18493 ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
18494 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
18495 NULL, /* dpi */
18496 false, /* placeholder_arg */
18497 false /* placeholder_seen */
18499 loc_result = loc_list_from_tree (tree_result, 0, &loc_ctx);
18501 /* We want a DWARF expression: abort if we only have a location list with
18502 multiple elements. */
18503 if (!loc_result || !single_element_loc_list_p (loc_result))
18504 return NULL;
18505 else
18506 return loc_result->expr;
18509 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
18510 associated with them. */
18512 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
18514 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
18515 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
18516 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
18518 static inline void
18519 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
18520 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
18522 if (descr == 0)
18523 return;
18524 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
18525 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
18526 else
18527 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
18530 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
18532 static void
18533 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18535 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
18536 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
18537 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
18538 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
18539 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18540 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
18542 if (dwarf_version == 2
18543 || die->die_parent == NULL
18544 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
18545 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
18547 else if (dwarf_version > 2
18548 && die->die_parent
18549 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
18550 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
18553 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
18554 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
18555 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
18556 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
18557 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
18558 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
18559 function above).
18561 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
18562 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
18563 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
18564 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
18565 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
18566 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
18567 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
18568 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
18569 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
18570 function below.)
18572 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
18574 static void
18575 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die,
18576 tree decl,
18577 struct vlr_context *ctx)
18579 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
18580 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
18582 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
18584 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
18585 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
18587 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
18588 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
18589 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
18590 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
18592 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
18594 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
18596 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
18598 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
18599 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
18600 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18602 /* Extract the vtable address. */
18603 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
18604 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18606 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
18607 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl));
18608 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
18610 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
18611 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18612 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
18613 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18615 /* Extract the offset. */
18616 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
18617 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18619 /* Add it to the object address. */
18620 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
18621 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18623 else
18624 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_OFFSET (decl));
18626 else
18628 loc_descr = field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &offset);
18630 /* If loc_descr is available then we know the field offset is dynamic.
18631 However, GDB does not handle dynamic field offsets very well at the
18632 moment. */
18633 if (loc_descr != NULL && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
18635 loc_descr = NULL;
18636 offset = 0;
18639 /* Data member location evalutation starts with the base address on the
18640 stack. Compute the field offset and add it to this base address. */
18641 else if (loc_descr != NULL)
18642 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
18645 if (! loc_descr)
18647 /* While DW_AT_data_bit_offset has been added already in DWARF4,
18648 e.g. GDB only added support to it in November 2016. For DWARF5
18649 we need newer debug info consumers anyway. We might change this
18650 to dwarf_version >= 4 once most consumers catched up. */
18651 if (dwarf_version >= 5
18652 && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
18653 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
18655 tree off = bit_position (decl);
18656 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (off) && get_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_size))
18658 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_byte_size);
18659 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_offset);
18660 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_bit_offset, tree_to_uhwi (off));
18661 return;
18664 if (dwarf_version > 2)
18666 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
18667 if (offset < 0)
18668 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
18669 else
18670 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
18671 return;
18673 else
18675 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
18677 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
18678 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
18679 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
18680 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
18681 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
18685 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
18688 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
18690 static void
18691 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
18693 while (size != 0)
18695 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
18696 val >>= 8;
18697 --size;
18701 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
18703 static HOST_WIDE_INT
18704 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
18706 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
18708 src += size;
18709 while (size != 0)
18711 val <<= 8;
18712 val |= *--src & 0xff;
18713 --size;
18715 return val;
18718 /* Writes wide_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
18720 static void
18721 insert_wide_int (const wide_int &val, unsigned char *dest, int elt_size)
18723 int i;
18725 if (elt_size <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT/BITS_PER_UNIT)
18727 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (0), elt_size, dest);
18728 return;
18731 /* We'd have to extend this code to support odd sizes. */
18732 gcc_assert (elt_size % (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
18734 int n = elt_size / (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
18736 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
18737 for (i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--)
18739 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
18740 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
18742 else
18743 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
18745 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
18746 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
18750 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
18752 static void
18753 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
18755 long val[4];
18756 int i;
18757 scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
18759 real_to_target (val, CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (rtl), mode);
18761 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
18762 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4; i++)
18764 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
18765 array += 4;
18769 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
18770 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
18771 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
18772 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
18773 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
18775 static bool
18776 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
18778 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
18780 case CONST_INT:
18782 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
18784 if (val < 0)
18785 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
18786 else
18787 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
18789 return true;
18791 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
18793 wide_int w1 = rtx_mode_t (rtl, MAX_MODE_INT);
18794 unsigned int prec = MIN (wi::min_precision (w1, UNSIGNED),
18795 (unsigned int)CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (rtl) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
18796 wide_int w = wi::zext (w1, prec);
18797 add_AT_wide (die, DW_AT_const_value, w);
18799 return true;
18801 case CONST_DOUBLE:
18802 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
18803 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
18804 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
18805 represented. */
18806 if (TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
18807 && !SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (rtl)))
18808 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
18809 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
18810 else
18812 scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
18813 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
18814 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
18816 insert_float (rtl, array);
18817 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
18819 return true;
18821 case CONST_VECTOR:
18823 unsigned int length;
18824 if (!CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl).is_constant (&length))
18825 return false;
18827 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
18828 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
18829 unsigned char *array
18830 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
18831 unsigned int i;
18832 unsigned char *p;
18833 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
18835 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
18837 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
18838 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
18840 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
18841 insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
18843 break;
18845 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
18846 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
18848 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
18849 insert_float (elt, p);
18851 break;
18853 default:
18854 gcc_unreachable ();
18857 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
18859 return true;
18861 case CONST_STRING:
18862 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18864 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
18865 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
18866 rtl_addr:
18867 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
18868 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18869 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
18870 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
18871 return true;
18873 return false;
18875 case CONST:
18876 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
18877 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
18878 /* FALLTHROUGH */
18879 case SYMBOL_REF:
18880 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
18881 return false;
18882 /* FALLTHROUGH */
18883 case LABEL_REF:
18884 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18885 goto rtl_addr;
18886 return false;
18888 case PLUS:
18889 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
18890 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
18891 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
18892 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
18893 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
18894 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
18895 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
18896 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
18897 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
18898 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
18899 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
18900 return false;
18902 case HIGH:
18903 case CONST_FIXED:
18904 return false;
18906 case MEM:
18907 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
18908 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
18909 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
18911 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
18912 return true;
18914 return false;
18916 default:
18917 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
18918 gcc_unreachable ();
18920 return false;
18923 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
18924 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
18925 output). */
18926 static tree
18927 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
18928 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18930 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
18931 *walk_subtrees = 0;
18933 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
18934 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
18935 return *tp;
18936 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
18937 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
18938 be conservative. */
18939 else if (!symtab->global_info_ready && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (*tp))
18940 return *tp;
18941 else if (VAR_P (*tp))
18943 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (*tp);
18944 if (!node || !node->definition)
18945 return *tp;
18947 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
18948 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
18950 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
18951 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
18952 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
18953 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
18954 if (!cgraph_node::get (*tp))
18955 return *tp;
18957 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
18958 return *tp;
18960 return NULL_TREE;
18963 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
18964 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
18966 static rtx
18967 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
18969 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
18971 STRIP_NOPS (init);
18973 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
18974 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
18975 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
18977 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
18978 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
18979 scalar_int_mode mode;
18981 if (is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
18982 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
18983 && domain
18984 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
18985 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
18986 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
18987 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
18988 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
18990 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
18991 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
18992 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
18993 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
18996 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
18997 CONCAT: FIXME! */
18998 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
18999 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
19000 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
19001 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
19003 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
19004 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
19005 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
19006 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
19008 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
19009 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
19010 reference variables which won't be output. */
19011 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
19012 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
19014 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
19015 possible. */
19016 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19017 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
19019 case VECTOR_CST:
19020 break;
19021 case CONSTRUCTOR:
19022 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
19024 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
19025 bool constant_p = true;
19026 tree value;
19027 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
19029 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
19030 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
19031 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
19032 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
19033 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
19035 constant_p = false;
19036 break;
19039 if (constant_p)
19041 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
19042 break;
19045 /* FALLTHRU */
19047 default:
19048 return NULL;
19051 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
19053 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
19054 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
19057 return rtl;
19060 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
19062 static rtx
19063 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
19065 rtx rtl;
19067 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
19068 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
19069 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
19071 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
19072 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
19073 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
19074 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
19075 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
19076 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
19077 referenced within the function.
19079 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
19080 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
19081 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
19082 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
19084 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
19085 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
19086 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
19087 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
19088 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
19089 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
19091 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
19092 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
19093 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
19094 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
19095 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
19096 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
19097 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
19098 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
19099 output at debug-time.
19101 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
19102 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
19103 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
19104 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
19105 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
19106 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
19107 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
19108 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
19109 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
19110 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
19111 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
19112 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
19113 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
19115 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
19116 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
19117 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
19118 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
19119 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
19120 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
19121 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
19122 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
19123 I'd like to fix it.
19125 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
19126 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
19127 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
19128 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
19129 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
19130 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
19131 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
19132 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
19133 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
19134 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
19135 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
19137 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
19138 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
19140 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
19141 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
19142 fixed registers. */
19143 if (! reload_completed)
19145 if (rtl
19146 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
19147 || (MEM_P (rtl)
19148 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
19149 || (REG_P (rtl)
19150 && VAR_P (decl)
19151 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
19153 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
19154 return rtl;
19156 rtl = NULL_RTX;
19158 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
19160 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19161 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
19162 || (MEM_P (rtl)
19163 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19164 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
19165 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19166 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
19168 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19169 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
19170 machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
19171 machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
19173 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
19174 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
19175 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
19176 if (dmode == pmode)
19177 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19178 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
19179 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
19180 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
19181 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19183 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19184 if (REG_P (inc))
19185 rtl = inc;
19186 else if (MEM_P (inc))
19188 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
19189 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
19190 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
19191 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
19192 else
19193 rtl = inc;
19198 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
19199 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
19200 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
19201 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
19202 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
19203 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
19204 thing to do. */
19205 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
19206 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
19207 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19208 /* Not passed in memory. */
19209 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19210 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
19211 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19212 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
19213 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
19214 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
19215 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
19216 #endif
19218 /* Big endian correction check. */
19219 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
19220 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
19221 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19222 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
19224 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19225 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
19226 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
19228 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19229 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
19232 else if (VAR_P (decl)
19233 && rtl
19234 && MEM_P (rtl)
19235 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19237 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19238 poly_int64 offset = byte_lowpart_offset (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19239 GET_MODE (rtl));
19241 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
19242 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
19243 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
19244 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
19245 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
19246 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
19247 if (maybe_ne (offset, 0))
19248 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19249 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
19252 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
19253 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
19254 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
19255 if (!rtl && VAR_P (decl) && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19256 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
19258 if (rtl)
19259 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
19261 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
19262 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
19263 code, and thus is not emitted. */
19264 if (rtl)
19265 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
19267 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
19268 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
19269 it. */
19270 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19271 && VAR_P (decl)
19272 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
19273 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
19274 && DECL_NAME (decl)
19275 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
19276 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
19278 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
19279 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
19280 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
19281 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
19282 rtl = NULL_RTX;
19285 return rtl;
19288 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
19289 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
19290 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
19292 static tree
19293 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
19295 tree val_expr, cvar;
19296 machine_mode mode;
19297 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos;
19298 tree offset;
19299 HOST_WIDE_INT cbitpos;
19300 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
19302 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
19303 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
19304 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
19305 be handled as such. */
19306 if (!VAR_P (decl)
19307 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
19308 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
19309 || !is_fortran ())
19310 return NULL_TREE;
19312 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
19313 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
19314 return NULL_TREE;
19316 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
19317 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
19319 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
19320 || !VAR_P (cvar)
19321 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
19322 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar)
19323 /* We don't expect to have to cope with variable offsets,
19324 since at present all static data must have a constant size. */
19325 || !bitpos.is_constant (&cbitpos))
19326 return NULL_TREE;
19328 *value = 0;
19329 if (offset != NULL)
19331 if (!tree_fits_shwi_p (offset))
19332 return NULL_TREE;
19333 *value = tree_to_shwi (offset);
19335 if (cbitpos != 0)
19336 *value += cbitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
19338 return cvar;
19341 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
19342 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
19343 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
19344 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
19345 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
19346 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
19347 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
19348 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
19349 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
19350 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
19352 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
19353 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
19354 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
19355 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
19357 static bool
19358 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p)
19360 rtx rtl;
19361 dw_loc_list_ref list;
19362 var_loc_list *loc_list;
19363 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
19365 if (early_dwarf)
19366 return false;
19368 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
19369 return false;
19371 if (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location)
19372 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
19373 return true;
19375 gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl) || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
19376 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
19378 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
19379 the location. */
19381 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
19382 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
19383 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
19384 return true;
19386 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
19387 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
19388 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
19389 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
19390 if (loc_list
19391 && loc_list->first
19392 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
19393 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
19394 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
19395 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
19397 struct var_loc_node *node;
19399 node = loc_list->first;
19400 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
19401 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
19402 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
19403 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
19404 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
19405 return true;
19407 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
19408 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
19409 list = NULL;
19410 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
19411 cache_p = false;
19412 if (cache_p)
19414 cache = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
19415 if (cache)
19416 list = cache->loc_list;
19418 if (list == NULL)
19420 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2,
19421 NULL);
19422 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
19423 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
19424 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
19426 cached_dw_loc_list **slot
19427 = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl,
19428 DECL_UID (decl),
19429 INSERT);
19430 cache = ggc_cleared_alloc<cached_dw_loc_list> ();
19431 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
19432 cache->loc_list = list;
19433 *slot = cache;
19436 if (list)
19438 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, list);
19439 return true;
19441 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
19442 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
19443 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
19446 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
19447 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
19449 static bool
19450 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
19452 tree type;
19454 if (init == NULL_TREE)
19455 return false;
19457 STRIP_NOPS (init);
19458 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
19460 case STRING_CST:
19461 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
19462 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19464 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
19465 scalar_int_mode mode;
19467 if (!is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
19468 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
19469 return false;
19470 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19471 return false;
19472 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
19474 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
19475 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
19476 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
19477 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
19479 else
19480 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
19481 return true;
19483 return false;
19484 case CONSTRUCTOR:
19485 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
19486 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19487 return false;
19488 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19490 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
19491 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
19492 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
19493 constructor_elt *ce;
19495 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
19496 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
19497 return false;
19499 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
19500 if (fieldsize <= 0)
19501 return false;
19503 min_index = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
19504 memset (array, '\0', size);
19505 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
19507 tree val = ce->value;
19508 tree index = ce->index;
19509 int pos = curpos;
19510 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
19511 pos = (tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0)) - min_index)
19512 * fieldsize;
19513 else if (index)
19514 pos = (tree_to_shwi (index) - min_index) * fieldsize;
19516 if (val)
19518 STRIP_NOPS (val);
19519 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
19520 return false;
19522 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
19523 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
19525 int count = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1))
19526 - tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0));
19527 while (count-- > 0)
19529 if (val)
19530 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
19531 curpos += fieldsize;
19534 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
19536 return true;
19538 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
19539 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
19541 tree field = NULL_TREE;
19542 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
19543 constructor_elt *ce;
19545 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19546 return false;
19548 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
19549 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
19551 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
19553 tree val = ce->value;
19554 int pos, fieldsize;
19556 if (ce->index != 0)
19557 field = ce->index;
19559 if (val)
19560 STRIP_NOPS (val);
19562 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
19563 return false;
19565 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
19566 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
19567 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
19568 return false;
19569 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
19570 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field)))
19571 return false;
19572 fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
19573 pos = int_byte_position (field);
19574 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
19575 if (val && fieldsize != 0
19576 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
19577 return false;
19579 return true;
19581 return false;
19582 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
19583 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
19584 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
19585 default:
19586 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
19590 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
19591 attribute is the const value T. */
19593 static bool
19594 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
19596 tree init;
19597 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
19598 rtx rtl;
19600 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
19601 return false;
19603 init = t;
19604 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
19606 if (TREE_CODE (init) == INTEGER_CST)
19608 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (init))
19610 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_uhwi (init));
19611 return true;
19613 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (init))
19615 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_shwi (init));
19616 return true;
19619 if (! early_dwarf)
19621 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
19622 if (rtl)
19623 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
19625 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
19626 if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
19627 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
19629 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
19630 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
19632 unsigned char *array = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (size);
19634 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
19636 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
19637 return true;
19639 ggc_free (array);
19642 return false;
19645 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
19646 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
19647 variable with static storage duration
19648 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
19650 static bool
19651 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
19654 if (!decl
19655 || (!VAR_P (decl) && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
19656 || (VAR_P (decl) && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
19657 return false;
19659 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
19660 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
19661 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19662 /* OK */;
19663 else
19664 return false;
19666 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
19667 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
19668 return false;
19670 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
19673 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
19674 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
19675 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
19676 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
19677 expressions. */
19679 static dw_loc_list_ref
19680 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
19682 int ix;
19683 dw_fde_ref fde;
19684 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
19685 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
19686 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
19687 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
19688 dw_cfa_location remember;
19690 fde = cfun->fde;
19691 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
19693 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
19694 list_tail = &list;
19695 list = NULL;
19697 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
19698 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
19699 remember = next_cfa;
19701 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
19703 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
19704 advance opcodes. */
19705 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
19706 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
19708 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19709 last_label = start_label;
19711 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
19713 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
19714 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
19715 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19716 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
19717 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19718 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
19721 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
19723 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
19725 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
19726 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
19727 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
19728 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
19729 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19731 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19732 start_label, last_label, section);
19734 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19735 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19736 start_label = last_label;
19738 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
19739 break;
19741 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
19742 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
19743 gcc_unreachable ();
19745 default:
19746 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
19747 break;
19749 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
19751 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19753 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19754 start_label, last_label, section);
19756 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19757 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19758 start_label = last_label;
19760 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19761 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
19762 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19763 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
19767 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19769 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19770 start_label, last_label, section);
19771 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19772 start_label = last_label;
19775 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
19776 start_label,
19777 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
19778 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end,
19779 section);
19781 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
19782 gen_llsym (list);
19784 return list;
19787 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
19788 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
19789 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
19790 before the latter is negated. */
19792 static void
19793 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (poly_int64 offset)
19795 rtx reg, elim;
19797 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
19798 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
19799 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
19800 #else
19801 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
19802 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
19803 #endif
19805 elim = (ira_use_lra_p
19806 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
19807 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
19808 elim = strip_offset_and_add (elim, &offset);
19810 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
19812 /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
19813 in which to eliminate. This is because it's stack pointer isn't
19814 directly accessible as a register within the ISA. To work around
19815 this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
19816 frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either. */
19817 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
19818 = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
19819 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
19820 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
19821 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
19822 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
19823 : stack_pointer_rtx));
19826 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
19827 the value of the attribute. */
19829 static void
19830 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
19832 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
19834 if (demangle_name_func)
19835 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
19837 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
19841 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
19842 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
19843 of TYPE accordingly.
19845 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
19846 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
19848 static void
19849 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
19850 dw_die_ref context_die)
19852 tree dtype;
19853 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
19855 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
19856 return;
19858 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
19859 if (!dtype)
19860 return;
19862 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
19863 if (!dtype_die)
19865 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
19866 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
19867 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
19870 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
19873 /* Retrieve the comp_dir string suitable for use with DW_AT_comp_dir. */
19875 static const char *
19876 comp_dir_string (void)
19878 const char *wd;
19879 char *wd1;
19880 static const char *cached_wd = NULL;
19882 if (cached_wd != NULL)
19883 return cached_wd;
19885 wd = get_src_pwd ();
19886 if (wd == NULL)
19887 return NULL;
19889 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
19891 int wdlen;
19893 wdlen = strlen (wd);
19894 wd1 = ggc_vec_alloc<char> (wdlen + 2);
19895 strcpy (wd1, wd);
19896 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
19897 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
19898 wd = wd1;
19901 cached_wd = remap_debug_filename (wd);
19902 return cached_wd;
19905 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
19907 static void
19908 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
19910 const char * wd = comp_dir_string ();
19911 if (wd != NULL)
19912 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
19915 /* Given a tree node VALUE describing a scalar attribute ATTR (i.e. a bound, a
19916 pointer computation, ...), output a representation for that bound according
19917 to the accepted FORMS (see enum dw_scalar_form) and add it to DIE. See
19918 loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
19920 static void
19921 add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr, tree value,
19922 int forms, struct loc_descr_context *context)
19924 dw_die_ref context_die, decl_die;
19925 dw_loc_list_ref list;
19926 bool strip_conversions = true;
19927 bool placeholder_seen = false;
19929 while (strip_conversions)
19930 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
19932 case ERROR_MARK:
19933 case SAVE_EXPR:
19934 return;
19936 CASE_CONVERT:
19937 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
19938 value = TREE_OPERAND (value, 0);
19939 break;
19941 default:
19942 strip_conversions = false;
19943 break;
19946 /* If possible and permitted, output the attribute as a constant. */
19947 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_constant) != 0
19948 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST)
19950 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value));
19952 /* If HOST_WIDE_INT is big enough then represent the bound as
19953 a constant value. We need to choose a form based on
19954 whether the type is signed or unsigned. We cannot just
19955 call add_AT_unsigned if the value itself is positive
19956 (add_AT_unsigned might add the unsigned value encoded as
19957 DW_FORM_data[1248]). Some DWARF consumers will lookup the
19958 bounds type and then sign extend any unsigned values found
19959 for signed types. This is needed only for
19960 DW_AT_{lower,upper}_bound, since for most other attributes,
19961 consumers will treat DW_FORM_data[1248] as unsigned values,
19962 regardless of the underlying type. */
19963 if (prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
19964 || tree_fits_uhwi_p (value))
19966 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)))
19967 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
19968 else
19969 add_AT_int (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
19971 else
19972 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with
19973 the precision of its type. The precision and signedness
19974 of the type will be necessary to re-interpret it
19975 unambiguously. */
19976 add_AT_wide (die, attr, wi::to_wide (value));
19977 return;
19980 /* Otherwise, if it's possible and permitted too, output a reference to
19981 another DIE. */
19982 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) != 0)
19984 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
19986 /* Some type attributes reference an outer type. For instance, the upper
19987 bound of an array may reference an embedding record (this happens in
19988 Ada). */
19989 if (TREE_CODE (value) == COMPONENT_REF
19990 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
19991 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
19992 decl = TREE_OPERAND (value, 1);
19994 else if (VAR_P (value)
19995 || TREE_CODE (value) == PARM_DECL
19996 || TREE_CODE (value) == RESULT_DECL)
19997 decl = value;
19999 if (decl != NULL_TREE)
20001 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20003 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
20004 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
20005 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
20006 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
20007 later parameter. */
20008 if (decl_die != NULL)
20010 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
20011 return;
20016 /* Last chance: try to create a stack operation procedure to evaluate the
20017 value. Do nothing if even that is not possible or permitted. */
20018 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_exprloc) == 0)
20019 return;
20021 list = loc_list_from_tree (value, 2, context);
20022 if (context && context->placeholder_arg)
20024 placeholder_seen = context->placeholder_seen;
20025 context->placeholder_seen = false;
20027 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
20029 /* If this attribute is not a reference nor constant, it is
20030 a DWARF expression rather than location description. For that
20031 loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, &context) is needed. */
20032 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, context);
20033 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
20035 if (placeholder_seen)
20037 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
20038 dpi.fndecl = NULL_TREE;
20039 dpi.args_count = 1;
20040 if (!resolve_args_picking (list2->expr, 1, &dpi))
20041 return;
20043 add_AT_loc (die, attr, list2->expr);
20044 return;
20048 /* If that failed to give a single element location list, fall back to
20049 outputting this as a reference... still if permitted. */
20050 if (list == NULL
20051 || (forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) == 0
20052 || placeholder_seen)
20053 return;
20055 if (current_function_decl == 0)
20056 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
20057 else
20058 context_die = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
20060 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, value);
20061 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20062 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (value), TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false,
20063 context_die);
20064 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
20065 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
20068 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
20069 default. */
20071 static int
20072 lower_bound_default (void)
20074 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
20076 case DW_LANG_C:
20077 case DW_LANG_C89:
20078 case DW_LANG_C99:
20079 case DW_LANG_C11:
20080 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
20081 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11:
20082 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14:
20083 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
20084 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
20085 return 0;
20086 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
20087 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
20088 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
20089 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
20090 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
20091 return 1;
20092 case DW_LANG_UPC:
20093 case DW_LANG_D:
20094 case DW_LANG_Python:
20095 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
20096 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
20097 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
20098 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
20099 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
20100 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
20101 case DW_LANG_PLI:
20102 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
20103 default:
20104 return -1;
20108 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
20109 a representation for that bound. */
20111 static void
20112 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,
20113 tree bound, struct loc_descr_context *context)
20115 int dflt;
20117 while (1)
20118 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
20120 /* Strip all conversions. */
20121 CASE_CONVERT:
20122 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
20123 bound = TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0);
20124 break;
20126 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. Lower bounds
20127 are even omitted when they are the default. */
20128 case INTEGER_CST:
20129 /* If the value for this bound is the default one, we can even omit the
20130 attribute. */
20131 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
20132 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bound)
20133 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
20134 && tree_to_shwi (bound) == dflt)
20135 return;
20137 /* FALLTHRU */
20139 default:
20140 /* Because of the complex interaction there can be with other GNAT
20141 encodings, GDB isn't ready yet to handle proper DWARF description
20142 for self-referencial subrange bounds: let GNAT encodings do the
20143 magic in such a case. */
20144 if (is_ada ()
20145 && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
20146 && contains_placeholder_p (bound))
20147 return;
20149 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound,
20150 dw_scalar_form_constant
20151 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
20152 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
20153 context);
20154 return;
20158 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
20159 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
20160 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
20161 includes information about the element type of the given array type.
20163 This function reuses previously set type and bound information if
20164 available. */
20166 static void
20167 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
20169 unsigned dimension_number;
20170 tree lower, upper;
20171 dw_die_ref child = type_die->die_child;
20173 for (dimension_number = 0;
20174 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
20175 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
20177 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
20179 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
20180 break;
20182 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
20183 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
20184 here. */
20186 /* Find and reuse a previously generated DW_TAG_subrange_type if
20187 available.
20189 For multi-dimensional arrays, as we iterate through the
20190 various dimensions in the enclosing for loop above, we also
20191 iterate through the DIE children and pick at each
20192 DW_TAG_subrange_type previously generated (if available).
20193 Each child DW_TAG_subrange_type DIE describes the range of
20194 the current dimension. At this point we should have as many
20195 DW_TAG_subrange_type's as we have dimensions in the
20196 array. */
20197 dw_die_ref subrange_die = NULL;
20198 if (child)
20199 while (1)
20201 child = child->die_sib;
20202 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20203 subrange_die = child;
20204 if (child == type_die->die_child)
20206 /* If we wrapped around, stop looking next time. */
20207 child = NULL;
20208 break;
20210 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20211 break;
20213 if (!subrange_die)
20214 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
20216 if (domain)
20218 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
20219 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
20220 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
20222 /* Define the index type. */
20223 if (TREE_TYPE (domain)
20224 && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_type))
20226 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
20227 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
20228 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
20229 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
20230 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
20231 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
20232 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
20234 else
20235 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain),
20236 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, type_die);
20239 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
20240 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
20241 dimension arr(N:*)
20242 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
20243 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
20244 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
20246 if (!get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound))
20247 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower, NULL);
20248 if (upper && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound))
20249 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper, NULL);
20252 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
20253 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
20254 bounds. */
20258 /* Add a DW_AT_byte_size attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's size. */
20260 static void
20261 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
20263 dw_die_ref decl_die;
20264 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
20265 dw_loc_descr_ref size_expr = NULL;
20267 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
20269 case ERROR_MARK:
20270 size = 0;
20271 break;
20272 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
20273 case RECORD_TYPE:
20274 case UNION_TYPE:
20275 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
20276 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
20277 && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
20279 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
20280 return;
20282 size_expr = type_byte_size (tree_node, &size);
20283 break;
20284 case FIELD_DECL:
20285 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
20286 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
20287 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
20288 even for bit-fields. */
20289 size = int_size_in_bytes (field_type (tree_node));
20290 break;
20291 default:
20292 gcc_unreachable ();
20295 /* Support for dynamically-sized objects was introduced by DWARFv3.
20296 At the moment, GDB does not handle variable byte sizes very well,
20297 though. */
20298 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20299 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
20300 && size_expr != NULL)
20301 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_expr);
20303 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
20304 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable and
20305 that we could not generate a DWARF expression that computes it. */
20306 if (size >= 0)
20307 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
20310 /* Add a DW_AT_alignment attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's non-default
20311 alignment. */
20313 static void
20314 add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
20316 if (dwarf_version < 5 && dwarf_strict)
20317 return;
20319 unsigned align;
20321 if (DECL_P (tree_node))
20323 if (!DECL_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
20324 return;
20326 align = DECL_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
20328 else if (TYPE_P (tree_node))
20330 if (!TYPE_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
20331 return;
20333 align = TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
20335 else
20336 gcc_unreachable ();
20338 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_alignment, align);
20341 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
20342 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
20343 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
20344 bit-field itself.
20346 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
20347 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
20348 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
20349 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
20350 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
20351 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
20353 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
20355 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
20356 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
20357 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
20359 static inline void
20360 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx)
20362 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes;
20363 tree original_type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
20364 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
20365 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
20366 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
20367 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
20369 field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &object_offset_in_bytes);
20371 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
20372 gcc_assert (original_type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
20374 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
20375 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
20376 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
20377 if (! tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (decl))
20378 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
20379 return;
20381 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
20383 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
20384 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
20385 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
20386 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
20387 below must take account of these differences. */
20388 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
20389 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
20391 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
20393 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
20394 highest_order_object_bit_offset +=
20395 simple_type_size_in_bits (original_type);
20398 bit_offset
20399 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
20400 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
20401 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
20403 if (bit_offset < 0)
20404 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
20405 else
20406 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
20409 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
20410 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
20412 static inline void
20413 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20415 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
20416 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
20417 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
20419 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
20420 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl)));
20423 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
20424 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
20426 static inline void
20427 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
20429 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
20431 case DW_LANG_C:
20432 case DW_LANG_C89:
20433 case DW_LANG_C99:
20434 case DW_LANG_C11:
20435 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
20436 if (prototype_p (func_type))
20437 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
20438 break;
20439 default:
20440 break;
20444 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
20445 by looking in the type declaration, the object declaration equate table or
20446 the block mapping. */
20448 static inline dw_die_ref
20449 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
20451 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
20453 if (DECL_P (origin))
20455 dw_die_ref c;
20456 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
20457 /* "Unwrap" the decls DIE which we put in the imported unit context.
20458 We are looking for the abstract copy here. */
20459 if (in_lto_p
20460 && origin_die
20461 && (c = get_AT_ref (origin_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
20462 /* ??? Identify this better. */
20463 && c->with_offset)
20464 origin_die = c;
20466 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
20467 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
20468 else if (TREE_CODE (origin) == BLOCK)
20469 origin_die = BLOCK_DIE (origin);
20471 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
20472 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
20473 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
20474 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
20475 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
20476 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
20477 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
20478 here. */
20480 if (origin_die)
20481 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
20482 return origin_die;
20485 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
20487 static inline void
20488 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
20490 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
20492 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
20494 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)))
20495 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
20496 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
20497 tree_to_shwi (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)),
20498 0));
20500 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
20501 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
20502 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
20503 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
20504 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
20508 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
20509 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
20510 standardized it. */
20512 static void
20513 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20515 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
20517 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
20518 if (name[0] == '*')
20519 name = &name[1];
20521 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
20522 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
20523 else
20524 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
20527 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
20529 static void
20530 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20532 expanded_location s;
20534 if (LOCATION_LOCUS (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl)) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
20535 return;
20536 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20537 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
20538 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
20539 if (debug_column_info && s.column)
20540 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
20543 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
20545 static void
20546 add_linkage_name_raw (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20548 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
20549 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
20551 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
20553 asm_name = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
20554 asm_name->die = die;
20555 asm_name->created_for = decl;
20556 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
20557 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
20559 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
20560 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
20563 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl if desired. */
20565 static void
20566 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20568 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE
20569 && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
20570 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
20571 && !(VAR_P (decl) && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
20572 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
20573 add_linkage_name_raw (die, decl);
20576 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
20577 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
20579 static void
20580 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
20581 bool no_linkage_name)
20583 tree decl_name;
20585 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
20586 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
20588 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
20589 if (name)
20590 add_name_attribute (die, name);
20591 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20592 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
20594 if (!no_linkage_name)
20595 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
20598 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20599 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
20600 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
20601 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
20603 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
20604 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), false);
20605 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
20607 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
20610 /* Add VALUE as a DW_AT_discr_value attribute to DIE. */
20612 static void
20613 add_discr_value (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_value *value)
20615 dw_attr_node attr;
20617 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_value;
20618 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_value;
20619 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
20620 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos = value->pos;
20621 if (value->pos)
20622 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.uval = value->v.uval;
20623 else
20624 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.sval = value->v.sval;
20625 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
20628 /* Add DISCR_LIST as a DW_AT_discr_list to DIE. */
20630 static void
20631 add_discr_list (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
20633 dw_attr_node attr;
20635 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_list;
20636 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_list;
20637 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
20638 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list = discr_list;
20639 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
20642 static inline dw_discr_list_ref
20643 AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *attr)
20645 return attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list;
20648 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20649 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
20651 void
20652 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
20654 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20655 dw_die_ref die;
20657 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
20658 die = new_die_raw (DW_TAG_subprogram);
20659 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
20660 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
20661 current_function_funcdef_no);
20662 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
20664 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
20665 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
20666 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
20668 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
20669 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
20671 else
20673 die->die_sib = die;
20674 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
20677 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
20679 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
20681 static void
20682 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
20684 vec_safe_push (decl_scope_table, scope);
20687 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
20689 static inline void
20690 pop_decl_scope (void)
20692 decl_scope_table->pop ();
20695 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below. */
20697 static tree
20698 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20700 if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
20701 *walk_subtrees = 0;
20702 else
20704 tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
20705 if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
20706 return *tp;
20708 return NULL_TREE;
20711 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
20712 non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE. */
20714 static tree
20715 uses_local_type (tree type)
20717 tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
20718 return used;
20721 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
20722 Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
20723 scope. Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
20724 containing scope. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
20725 the current active scope. */
20727 static dw_die_ref
20728 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
20730 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
20731 tree containing_scope;
20733 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
20734 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
20736 /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
20737 it refers to. */
20738 if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
20739 containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
20740 else
20741 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
20743 /* Use the containing namespace if there is one. */
20744 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20746 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
20747 /* OK */;
20748 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20749 context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
20750 else
20751 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
20754 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
20755 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
20756 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
20757 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
20758 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
20760 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
20762 /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
20763 to function-local DIEs from outside the function. */
20764 if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
20765 scope_die = context_die;
20766 else
20767 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
20769 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
20771 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. */
20772 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20773 scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
20774 else
20776 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
20777 if (scope_die == NULL)
20778 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
20781 else
20782 scope_die = context_die;
20784 return scope_die;
20787 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
20789 static inline int
20790 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20792 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
20793 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
20794 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
20795 return 1;
20797 return 0;
20800 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
20802 static inline int
20803 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20805 return (context_die
20806 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
20807 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
20808 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
20809 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
20812 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
20813 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
20815 static inline int
20816 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20818 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
20819 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
20822 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
20823 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
20824 by 'type' plus any additional qualifiers given by 'cv_quals', and
20825 adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
20827 static void
20828 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int cv_quals,
20829 bool reverse, dw_die_ref context_die)
20831 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
20832 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
20834 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
20835 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
20836 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
20837 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
20838 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
20839 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
20840 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
20842 if (code == ERROR_MARK
20843 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
20844 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
20845 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
20846 || code == VOID_TYPE)
20847 return;
20849 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
20850 cv_quals | TYPE_QUALS (type),
20851 reverse,
20852 context_die);
20854 if (type_die != NULL)
20855 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
20858 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
20859 function call type. */
20860 static void
20861 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
20863 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
20865 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
20866 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
20868 if (is_fortran ()
20869 && id_equal (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl), "MAIN__"))
20871 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
20872 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
20873 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
20874 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
20875 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
20876 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
20877 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
20878 value = DW_CC_program;
20880 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
20881 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
20884 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
20885 is not DW_CC_normal. */
20886 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
20887 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
20890 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
20891 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
20892 was declared without a tag. */
20894 static const char *
20895 type_tag (const_tree type)
20897 const char *name = 0;
20899 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
20901 tree t = 0;
20903 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
20904 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
20905 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
20906 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
20908 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
20909 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
20910 involved. */
20911 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
20912 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20914 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
20915 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
20916 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
20917 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
20918 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
20919 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20920 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
20923 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
20924 if (!name && t != 0)
20925 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
20928 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
20931 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
20932 for bit field types. */
20934 static inline tree
20935 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
20937 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
20938 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
20941 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
20942 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
20944 #if 0
20945 static const char *
20946 decl_start_label (tree decl)
20948 rtx x;
20949 const char *fnname;
20951 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
20952 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
20954 x = XEXP (x, 0);
20955 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
20957 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
20958 return fnname;
20960 #endif
20962 /* For variable-length arrays that have been previously generated, but
20963 may be incomplete due to missing subscript info, fill the subscript
20964 info. Return TRUE if this is one of those cases. */
20965 static bool
20966 fill_variable_array_bounds (tree type)
20968 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
20969 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20970 && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
20972 dw_die_ref array_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20973 if (!array_die)
20974 return false;
20975 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, !is_ada ());
20976 return true;
20978 return false;
20981 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
20982 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
20983 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
20985 static void
20986 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
20988 dw_die_ref array_die;
20990 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
20991 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
20992 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
20993 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
20994 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
20995 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
20996 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
20997 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
20998 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
21000 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
21002 if (fill_variable_array_bounds (type))
21003 return;
21005 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21006 tree element_type;
21008 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
21009 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
21010 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
21011 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21012 && is_fortran ()
21013 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
21015 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
21017 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
21018 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21019 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21020 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
21021 if (size >= 0)
21022 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
21023 /* ??? We can't annotate types late, but for LTO we may not
21024 generate a location early either (gfortran.dg/save_6.f90). */
21025 else if (! (early_dwarf && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
21026 && TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
21027 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE)
21029 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
21030 tree rszdecl = szdecl;
21032 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
21033 if (!DECL_P (szdecl))
21035 if (TREE_CODE (szdecl) == INDIRECT_REF
21036 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0)))
21038 rszdecl = TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0);
21039 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (rszdecl))
21040 != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
21041 size = 0;
21043 else
21044 size = 0;
21046 if (size > 0)
21048 dw_loc_list_ref loc
21049 = loc_list_from_tree (rszdecl, szdecl == rszdecl ? 2 : 0,
21050 NULL);
21051 if (loc)
21053 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length,
21054 loc);
21055 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
21056 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, dwarf_version >= 5
21057 ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
21058 : DW_AT_byte_size, size);
21062 return;
21065 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
21066 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21067 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21069 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
21070 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
21072 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
21073 if (is_fortran ()
21074 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21075 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
21076 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
21077 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
21079 #if 0
21080 /* We default the array ordering. Debuggers will probably do the right
21081 things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even an issue
21082 until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If a debugger
21083 is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
21084 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
21085 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
21086 for multidimensional arrays. */
21087 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
21088 #endif
21090 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
21092 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
21093 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
21094 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node, NULL);
21095 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
21096 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1), NULL);
21098 else
21099 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
21101 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
21102 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
21103 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
21104 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
21105 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
21107 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
21108 break;
21109 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
21112 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21113 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21114 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
21115 context_die);
21117 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
21118 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
21119 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21121 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
21122 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
21124 add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
21127 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
21128 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
21130 static void
21131 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
21132 dw_die_ref context_die)
21134 const dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21135 const dw_die_ref array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
21136 struct loc_descr_context context = { type, info->base_decl, NULL,
21137 false, false };
21138 enum dwarf_tag subrange_tag = DW_TAG_subrange_type;
21139 int dim;
21141 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21142 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21144 if (info->ndimensions > 1)
21145 switch (info->ordering)
21147 case array_descr_ordering_row_major:
21148 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
21149 break;
21150 case array_descr_ordering_column_major:
21151 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
21152 break;
21153 default:
21154 break;
21157 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21159 if (info->data_location)
21160 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
21161 dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21162 if (info->associated)
21163 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
21164 dw_scalar_form_constant
21165 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21166 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21167 if (info->allocated)
21168 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
21169 dw_scalar_form_constant
21170 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21171 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21172 if (info->stride)
21174 const enum dwarf_attribute attr
21175 = (info->stride_in_bits) ? DW_AT_bit_stride : DW_AT_byte_stride;
21176 const int forms
21177 = (info->stride_in_bits)
21178 ? dw_scalar_form_constant
21179 : (dw_scalar_form_constant
21180 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21181 | dw_scalar_form_reference);
21183 add_scalar_info (array_die, attr, info->stride, forms, &context);
21186 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
21188 if (info->rank)
21190 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_rank, info->rank,
21191 dw_scalar_form_constant
21192 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21193 subrange_tag = DW_TAG_generic_subrange;
21194 context.placeholder_arg = true;
21198 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
21200 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
21202 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (subrange_tag, array_die, NULL);
21204 if (info->dimen[dim].bounds_type)
21205 add_type_attribute (subrange_die,
21206 info->dimen[dim].bounds_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21207 false, context_die);
21208 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
21209 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
21210 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, &context);
21211 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
21212 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
21213 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound, &context);
21214 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict) && info->dimen[dim].stride)
21215 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
21216 info->dimen[dim].stride,
21217 dw_scalar_form_constant
21218 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21219 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
21220 &context);
21223 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
21224 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21225 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21226 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
21227 context_die);
21229 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
21230 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
21232 add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
21235 #if 0
21236 static void
21237 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21239 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21240 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
21242 if (origin != NULL)
21243 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
21244 else
21246 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
21247 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
21248 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
21251 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
21252 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
21253 else
21254 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
21256 #endif
21258 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
21259 emit full debugging info for them. */
21261 static void
21262 retry_incomplete_types (void)
21264 set_early_dwarf s;
21265 int i;
21267 for (i = vec_safe_length (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
21268 if (should_emit_struct_debug ((*incomplete_types)[i], DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
21269 gen_type_die ((*incomplete_types)[i], comp_unit_die ());
21270 vec_safe_truncate (incomplete_types, 0);
21273 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
21275 static enum dwarf_tag
21276 record_type_tag (tree type)
21278 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
21279 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21281 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
21283 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
21284 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21286 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
21287 return DW_TAG_class_type;
21289 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
21290 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21291 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
21292 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21294 default:
21295 gcc_unreachable ();
21299 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
21300 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
21301 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
21302 DIE. */
21304 static dw_die_ref
21305 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21307 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
21309 if (type_die == NULL)
21311 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
21312 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21313 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
21314 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
21315 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
21317 if (ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
21318 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
21319 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
21320 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21322 if (!dwarf_strict)
21323 add_AT_unsigned (type_die, DW_AT_encoding,
21324 TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
21325 ? DW_ATE_unsigned
21326 : DW_ATE_signed);
21328 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
21329 return type_die;
21330 else
21331 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
21333 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
21334 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
21335 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
21336 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
21338 tree link;
21340 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
21341 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
21342 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
21343 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21345 tree underlying = lang_hooks.types.enum_underlying_base_type (type);
21346 add_type_attribute (type_die, underlying, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21347 context_die);
21349 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
21351 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
21352 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
21355 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
21356 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
21357 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
21358 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
21360 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
21361 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
21363 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
21364 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
21366 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
21367 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
21369 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
21370 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
21372 if (simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value))
21373 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || tree_fits_shwi_p (value))
21375 /* For constant forms created by add_AT_unsigned DWARF
21376 consumers (GDB, elfutils, etc.) always zero extend
21377 the value. Only when the actual value is negative
21378 do we need to use add_AT_int to generate a constant
21379 form that can represent negative values. */
21380 HOST_WIDE_INT val = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value);
21381 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)) || val >= 0)
21382 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
21383 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
21384 else
21385 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
21387 else
21388 /* Enumeration constants may be wider than HOST_WIDE_INT. Handle
21389 that here. TODO: This should be re-worked to use correct
21390 signed/unsigned double tags for all cases. */
21391 add_AT_wide (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, wi::to_wide (value));
21394 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
21395 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
21396 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21398 else
21399 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21401 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
21403 return type_die;
21406 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
21407 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
21408 type.
21410 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
21411 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
21412 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
21413 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
21414 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
21415 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
21416 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
21417 argument type of some subprogram type.
21418 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
21419 are emitted. */
21421 static dw_die_ref
21422 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
21423 dw_die_ref context_die)
21425 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
21426 tree ultimate_origin;
21427 dw_die_ref parm_die = NULL;
21429 if (DECL_P (node_or_origin))
21431 parm_die = lookup_decl_die (node);
21433 /* If the contexts differ, we may not be talking about the same
21434 thing.
21435 ??? When in LTO the DIE parent is the "abstract" copy and the
21436 context_die is the specification "copy". But this whole block
21437 should eventually be no longer needed. */
21438 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent != context_die && !in_lto_p)
21440 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node))
21442 /* This can happen when creating an inlined instance, in
21443 which case we need to create a new DIE that will get
21444 annotated with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
21445 parm_die = NULL;
21447 else
21448 gcc_unreachable ();
21451 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent == NULL)
21453 /* Check that parm_die already has the right attributes that
21454 we would have added below. If any attributes are
21455 missing, fall through to add them. */
21456 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
21457 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_location)
21458 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_const_value))
21459 /* We are missing location info, and are about to add it. */
21461 else
21463 add_child_die (context_die, parm_die);
21464 return parm_die;
21469 /* If we have a previously generated DIE, use it, unless this is an
21470 concrete instance (origin != NULL), in which case we need a new
21471 DIE with a corresponding DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
21472 bool reusing_die;
21473 if (parm_die && origin == NULL)
21474 reusing_die = true;
21475 else
21477 parm_die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
21478 reusing_die = false;
21481 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
21483 case tcc_declaration:
21484 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
21485 if (node || ultimate_origin)
21486 origin = ultimate_origin;
21488 if (reusing_die)
21489 goto add_location;
21491 if (origin != NULL)
21492 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
21493 else if (emit_name_p)
21494 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
21495 if (origin == NULL
21496 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
21497 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
21498 decl_function_context
21499 (node_or_origin))))
21501 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
21502 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
21503 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
21504 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21505 false, context_die);
21506 else
21507 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
21508 decl_quals (node_or_origin),
21509 false, context_die);
21511 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
21512 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21513 add_location:
21514 if (node && node != origin)
21515 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
21516 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin))
21517 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
21518 node == NULL);
21520 break;
21522 case tcc_type:
21523 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
21524 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21525 context_die);
21526 break;
21528 default:
21529 gcc_unreachable ();
21532 return parm_die;
21535 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
21536 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
21537 parameter pack.
21539 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
21540 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
21541 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
21542 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
21543 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
21544 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
21546 static dw_die_ref
21547 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
21548 tree pack_arg,
21549 dw_die_ref subr_die,
21550 tree *next_arg)
21552 tree arg;
21553 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
21555 gcc_assert (parm_pack
21556 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
21557 && subr_die);
21559 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
21560 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
21562 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
21564 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
21565 parm_pack))
21566 break;
21567 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
21568 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
21569 parm_pack_die);
21571 if (next_arg)
21572 *next_arg = arg;
21573 return parm_pack_die;
21576 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
21577 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
21579 static void
21580 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21582 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
21585 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
21586 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
21587 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
21588 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
21590 static void
21591 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21593 tree link;
21594 tree formal_type = NULL;
21595 tree first_parm_type;
21596 tree arg;
21598 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21600 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
21601 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
21603 else
21604 arg = NULL_TREE;
21606 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
21608 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
21609 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
21610 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
21612 dw_die_ref parm_die;
21614 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
21615 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
21616 break;
21618 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
21619 if (!POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE_P (formal_type))
21621 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
21622 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
21623 context_die);
21624 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
21625 && link == first_parm_type)
21627 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21628 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21629 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
21631 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
21632 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21635 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
21636 if (arg)
21637 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
21640 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
21641 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
21642 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
21643 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
21645 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
21646 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
21647 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
21648 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
21649 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
21650 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
21653 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
21654 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
21655 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
21656 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
21657 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
21659 static void
21660 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
21662 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
21664 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
21665 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
21666 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
21667 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
21668 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
21670 dw_die_ref type_die;
21671 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
21673 push_decl_scope (type);
21674 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
21675 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21676 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
21677 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
21679 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
21680 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
21681 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
21682 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
21683 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
21685 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = {
21686 DECL_CONTEXT (member), /* struct_type */
21687 NULL_TREE /* variant_part_offset */
21689 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
21690 gen_field_die (member, &vlr_ctx, type_die);
21693 else
21694 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
21696 pop_decl_scope ();
21700 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
21701 with their set_block_* pairing functions. */
21702 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
21704 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
21705 given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
21706 that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
21707 own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
21708 the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
21709 it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
21710 therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
21711 still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
21712 values to point to themselves. */
21714 static void
21715 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
21717 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
21719 BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
21722 tree local_decl;
21724 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
21725 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
21726 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
21727 /* Do not recurse on nested functions since the inlining status
21728 of parent and child can be different as per the DWARF spec. */
21729 if (TREE_CODE (local_decl) != FUNCTION_DECL
21730 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
21731 set_decl_origin_self (local_decl);
21735 tree subblock;
21737 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
21738 subblock != NULL_TREE;
21739 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
21740 set_block_origin_self (subblock); /* Recurse. */
21745 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
21746 the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
21747 node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
21748 node represents its own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the
21749 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
21750 the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
21751 each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
21752 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
21753 set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
21754 point to themselves. */
21756 static void
21757 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
21759 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
21761 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
21762 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21764 tree arg;
21766 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
21767 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
21768 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
21769 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
21770 set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
21775 /* Mark the early DIE for DECL as the abstract instance. */
21777 static void
21778 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
21780 dw_die_ref old_die;
21782 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
21783 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
21785 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
21786 return;
21788 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21789 /* With early debug we always have an old DIE unless we are in LTO
21790 and the user did not compile but only link with debug. */
21791 if (in_lto_p && ! old_die)
21792 return;
21793 gcc_assert (old_die != NULL);
21794 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline)
21795 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
21796 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
21797 return;
21799 /* Go ahead and put DW_AT_inline on the DIE. */
21800 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
21802 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
21803 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
21804 else
21805 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
21807 else
21809 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
21810 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
21811 else
21812 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
21815 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
21816 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
21817 add_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21819 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
21822 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
21823 htab_traverse.
21825 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
21826 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
21828 bool
21829 premark_used_types_helper (tree const &type, void *)
21831 dw_die_ref die;
21833 die = lookup_type_die (type);
21834 if (die != NULL)
21835 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21836 return true;
21839 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
21840 through htab_traverse.
21842 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
21843 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
21844 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
21847 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (types_used_by_vars_entry **slot,
21848 void *)
21850 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
21851 dw_die_ref die;
21853 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
21854 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
21855 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
21856 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
21857 if (die)
21859 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
21860 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
21861 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (entry->var_decl);
21862 if (node && node->definition)
21864 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21865 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
21866 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
21867 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21870 return 1;
21873 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
21875 static void
21876 premark_used_types (struct function *fun)
21878 if (fun && fun->used_types_hash)
21879 fun->used_types_hash->traverse<void *, premark_used_types_helper> (NULL);
21882 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
21884 static void
21885 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
21887 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
21888 types_used_by_vars_hash
21889 ->traverse<void *, premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper> (NULL);
21892 /* Generate a DW_TAG_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
21893 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
21895 static dw_die_ref
21896 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
21897 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
21899 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
21900 tree block = ca_loc->block;
21902 while (block
21903 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
21904 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
21906 stmt_die = BLOCK_DIE (block);
21907 if (stmt_die)
21908 break;
21909 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
21911 if (stmt_die == NULL)
21912 stmt_die = subr_die;
21913 die = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site), stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
21914 add_AT_lbl_id (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_return_pc), ca_loc->label);
21915 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
21916 add_AT_flag (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_tail_call), 1);
21917 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
21919 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
21920 if (tdie)
21921 add_AT_die_ref (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), tdie);
21922 else
21923 add_AT_addr (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), ca_loc->symbol_ref,
21924 false);
21926 return die;
21929 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
21930 block-local). */
21932 static void
21933 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21935 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21936 dw_die_ref subr_die;
21937 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21939 /* This function gets called multiple times for different stages of
21940 the debug process. For example, for func() in this code:
21942 namespace S
21944 void func() { ... }
21947 ...we get called 4 times. Twice in early debug and twice in
21948 late debug:
21950 Early debug
21951 -----------
21953 1. Once while generating func() within the namespace. This is
21954 the declaration. The declaration bit below is set, as the
21955 context is the namespace.
21957 A new DIE will be generated with DW_AT_declaration set.
21959 2. Once for func() itself. This is the specification. The
21960 declaration bit below is clear as the context is the CU.
21962 We will use the cached DIE from (1) to create a new DIE with
21963 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration in (1).
21965 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final()
21966 -------------------------------------
21968 3. Once generating func() within the namespace. This is also the
21969 declaration, as in (1), but this time we will early exit below
21970 as we have a cached DIE and a declaration needs no additional
21971 annotations (no locations), as the source declaration line
21972 info is enough.
21974 4. Once for func() itself. As in (2), this is the specification,
21975 but this time we will re-use the cached DIE, and just annotate
21976 it with the location information that should now be available.
21978 For something without namespaces, but with abstract instances, we
21979 are also called a multiple times:
21981 class Base
21983 public:
21984 Base (); // constructor declaration (1)
21987 Base::Base () { } // constructor specification (2)
21989 Early debug
21990 -----------
21992 1. Once for the Base() constructor by virtue of it being a
21993 member of the Base class. This is done via
21994 rest_of_type_compilation.
21996 This is a declaration, so a new DIE will be created with
21997 DW_AT_declaration.
21999 2. Once for the Base() constructor definition, but this time
22000 while generating the abstract instance of the base
22001 constructor (__base_ctor) which is being generated via early
22002 debug of reachable functions.
22004 Even though we have a cached version of the declaration (1),
22005 we will create a DW_AT_specification of the declaration DIE
22006 in (1).
22008 3. Once for the __base_ctor itself, but this time, we generate
22009 an DW_AT_abstract_origin version of the DW_AT_specification in
22010 (2).
22012 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final
22013 -----------------------------------
22015 4. One final time for the __base_ctor (which will have a cached
22016 DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin created in (3). This time,
22017 we will just annotate the location information now
22018 available.
22020 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
22021 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
22023 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
22024 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
22025 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
22026 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
22027 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
22028 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22029 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
22031 /* A concrete instance, tag a new DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
22032 if (origin != NULL)
22034 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
22036 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
22037 inline function. */
22038 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
22039 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
22041 if (old_die && get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
22043 /* If we have a DW_AT_abstract_origin we have a working
22044 cached version. */
22045 subr_die = old_die;
22047 else
22049 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22050 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
22051 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
22052 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
22053 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
22054 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
22055 K::K". */
22056 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
22059 /* A cached copy, possibly from early dwarf generation. Reuse as
22060 much as possible. */
22061 else if (old_die)
22063 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped needs no
22064 additional information. */
22065 if (declaration)
22066 return;
22068 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
22069 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
22070 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
22071 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
22072 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
22074 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
22075 something we have already output. */
22076 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_low_pc)
22077 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_ranges))
22078 return;
22080 /* If we have no location information, this must be a
22081 partially generated DIE from early dwarf generation.
22082 Fall through and generate it. */
22085 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
22086 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
22087 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
22088 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
22089 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
22090 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
22091 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
22092 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
22093 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
22094 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent)
22095 /* This condition fixes the inconsistency/ICE with the
22096 following Fortran test (or some derivative thereof) while
22097 building libgfortran:
22099 module some_m
22100 contains
22101 logical function funky (FLAG)
22102 funky = .true.
22103 end function
22104 end module
22106 || (old_die->die_parent
22107 && old_die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_module)
22108 || context_die == NULL)
22109 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
22110 /* The location attributes may be in the abstract origin
22111 which in the case of LTO might be not available to
22112 look at. */
22113 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
22114 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
22115 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
22116 == (unsigned) s.line)
22117 && (!debug_column_info
22118 || s.column == 0
22119 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22120 == (unsigned) s.column)))))
22122 subr_die = old_die;
22124 /* Clear out the declaration attribute, but leave the
22125 parameters so they can be augmented with location
22126 information later. Unless this was a declaration, in
22127 which case, wipe out the nameless parameters and recreate
22128 them further down. */
22129 if (remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration))
22132 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
22133 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
22136 /* Make a specification pointing to the previously built
22137 declaration. */
22138 else
22140 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22141 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
22142 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22143 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
22144 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
22145 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
22146 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
22147 if (debug_column_info
22148 && s.column
22149 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22150 != (unsigned) s.column))
22151 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
22153 /* If the prototype had an 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' return type,
22154 emit the real type on the definition die. */
22155 if (is_cxx () && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22157 dw_die_ref die = get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_type);
22158 if (die == auto_die || die == decltype_auto_die)
22159 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22160 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22163 /* When we process the method declaration, we haven't seen
22164 the out-of-class defaulted definition yet, so we have to
22165 recheck now. */
22166 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || ! dwarf_strict)
22167 && !get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted))
22169 int defaulted
22170 = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22171 DW_AT_defaulted);
22172 if (defaulted != -1)
22174 /* Other values must have been handled before. */
22175 gcc_assert (defaulted == DW_DEFAULTED_out_of_class);
22176 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22181 /* Create a fresh DIE for anything else. */
22182 else
22184 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22186 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22187 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22189 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
22190 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22191 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22193 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
22194 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22195 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22198 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22199 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22200 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22202 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
22203 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_noreturn, 1);
22205 add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22207 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22210 /* Unless we have an existing non-declaration DIE, equate the new
22211 DIE. */
22212 if (!old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die))
22213 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
22215 if (declaration)
22217 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
22219 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22221 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
22222 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
22223 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22224 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22225 DW_AT_explicit) == 1)
22226 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
22228 /* If this is a C++11 deleted special function member then generate
22229 a DW_AT_deleted attribute. */
22230 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22231 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22232 DW_AT_deleted) == 1)
22233 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_deleted, 1);
22235 /* If this is a C++11 defaulted special function member then
22236 generate a DW_AT_defaulted attribute. */
22237 if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22239 int defaulted
22240 = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22241 DW_AT_defaulted);
22242 if (defaulted != -1)
22243 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22246 /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with & ref-qualifier
22247 then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute. */
22248 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22249 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22250 DW_AT_reference) == 1)
22251 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
22253 /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with &&
22254 ref-qualifier then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute. */
22255 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22256 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22257 DW_AT_rvalue_reference)
22258 == 1)
22259 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
22262 /* For non DECL_EXTERNALs, if range information is available, fill
22263 the DIE with it. */
22264 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !early_dwarf)
22266 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
22268 struct function *fun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
22270 if (!crtl->has_bb_partition)
22272 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
22273 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
22275 /* We have already generated the labels. */
22276 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22277 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
22279 else
22281 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
22282 char label_id_low[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22283 char label_id_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22284 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_low, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
22285 current_function_funcdef_no);
22286 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_high, FUNC_END_LABEL,
22287 current_function_funcdef_no);
22288 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, label_id_low, label_id_high,
22289 false);
22292 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
22293 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
22294 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
22295 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
22296 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
22297 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
22298 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
22299 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
22300 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
22301 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
22302 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
22303 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
22306 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
22307 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
22308 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
22310 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
22311 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
22312 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
22314 #endif
22317 else
22319 /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges. */
22320 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
22322 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
22324 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22326 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
22327 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
22328 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
22329 alignment offset. */
22330 bool range_list_added = false;
22331 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22332 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
22333 false);
22334 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
22335 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
22336 &range_list_added, false);
22337 if (range_list_added)
22338 add_ranges (NULL);
22340 else
22342 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
22343 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
22344 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
22345 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
22346 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
22347 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
22348 sections when given "b foo". */
22349 const char *name = NULL;
22350 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
22351 dw_die_ref seg_die;
22353 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
22354 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22355 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
22357 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
22358 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
22359 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
22361 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22362 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22364 if (decl_name != NULL
22365 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
22367 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
22368 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22369 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
22371 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
22373 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
22374 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
22375 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22376 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22378 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
22379 add_AT_low_high_pc (seg_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
22380 fde->dw_fde_second_end, false);
22381 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
22382 if (want_pubnames ())
22383 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
22386 else
22387 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end,
22388 false);
22391 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
22393 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
22394 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
22395 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
22396 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
22397 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
22398 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
22399 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
22400 function. */
22401 if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
22403 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
22404 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
22406 else
22408 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
22409 if (list->dw_loc_next)
22410 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
22411 else
22412 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
22415 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
22416 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
22417 will reference in the rtl; the latter is what we've told the
22418 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
22419 by this displacement. */
22420 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
22422 if (fun->static_chain_decl)
22424 /* DWARF requires here a location expression that computes the
22425 address of the enclosing subprogram's frame base. The machinery
22426 in tree-nested.c is supposed to store this specific address in the
22427 last field of the FRAME record. */
22428 const tree frame_type
22429 = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fun->static_chain_decl));
22430 const tree fb_decl = tree_last (TYPE_FIELDS (frame_type));
22432 tree fb_expr
22433 = build1 (INDIRECT_REF, frame_type, fun->static_chain_decl);
22434 fb_expr = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (fb_decl),
22435 fb_expr, fb_decl, NULL_TREE);
22437 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
22438 loc_list_from_tree (fb_expr, 0, NULL));
22441 resolve_variable_values ();
22444 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
22445 if (early_dwarf && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22446 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
22448 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
22449 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
22450 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
22451 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
22452 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
22453 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
22454 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
22455 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
22456 an ellipsis at the end. */
22458 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
22459 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
22460 its formal parameters. */
22461 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22463 else if (declaration)
22464 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
22465 else
22467 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
22468 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
22469 tree generic_decl = early_dwarf
22470 ? lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl) : NULL;
22471 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
22472 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
22473 : NULL;
22475 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
22476 emit their relevant DIEs.
22478 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
22479 as well as it being a normal function.
22481 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
22482 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
22483 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
22484 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
22485 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
22486 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
22487 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
22488 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
22489 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
22490 children DIE.
22492 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
22493 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
22495 if (generic_decl_parm
22496 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
22497 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
22498 parm, subr_die,
22499 &parm);
22500 else if (parm && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (parm))
22502 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, NULL, subr_die);
22504 if (early_dwarf
22505 && parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
22506 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
22507 && parm_die
22508 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
22509 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
22511 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
22513 else if (parm)
22514 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
22516 if (generic_decl_parm)
22517 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
22520 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
22521 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
22522 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
22523 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
22524 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
22525 parameters at all. */
22526 if (early_dwarf)
22528 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
22530 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
22531 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
22532 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
22534 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
22535 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
22539 if (subr_die != old_die)
22540 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
22541 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22543 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
22544 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).
22546 OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
22547 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
22548 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
22549 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
22550 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
22551 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
22552 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
22554 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
22555 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
22556 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
22557 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
22558 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
22559 constructor function. */
22560 tree outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
22561 if (! declaration && outer_scope && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
22563 int call_site_note_count = 0;
22564 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
22566 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
22567 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
22568 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, NULL, subr_die);
22570 /* The first time through decls_for_scope we will generate the
22571 DIEs for the locals. The second time, we fill in the
22572 location info. */
22573 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die);
22575 if (call_arg_locations && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
22577 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
22578 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
22580 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
22581 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
22582 rtx arg, next_arg;
22584 for (arg = (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note != NULL_RTX
22585 ? NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note)
22586 : NULL_RTX);
22587 arg; arg = next_arg)
22589 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
22590 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
22591 dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
22593 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
22594 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22595 && next_arg
22596 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
22597 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
22598 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22599 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
22600 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
22601 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22603 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
22604 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22605 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
22607 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
22608 continue;
22609 /* Get dynamic information about call target only if we
22610 have no static information: we cannot generate both
22611 DW_AT_call_origin and DW_AT_call_target
22612 attributes. */
22613 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX)
22615 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
22617 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
22618 continue;
22620 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
22621 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
22623 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
22624 continue;
22627 reg = NULL;
22628 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
22629 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
22630 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22631 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
22633 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
22634 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
22635 get_address_mode (mem),
22636 GET_MODE (mem),
22637 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22639 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22640 == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
22642 tree tdecl
22643 = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
22644 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
22645 if (tdie == NULL)
22646 continue;
22648 else
22649 continue;
22650 if (reg == NULL
22651 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22652 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
22653 continue;
22654 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
22655 VOIDmode,
22656 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22657 if (val == NULL)
22658 continue;
22659 if (die == NULL)
22660 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
22661 cdie = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site_parameter), die,
22662 NULL_TREE);
22663 if (reg != NULL)
22664 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
22665 else if (tdie != NULL)
22666 add_AT_die_ref (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_parameter),
22667 tdie);
22668 add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_value), val);
22669 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
22671 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
22672 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22673 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
22674 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
22675 0), 1),
22676 mode, VOIDmode,
22677 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22678 if (val != NULL)
22679 add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_data_value),
22680 val);
22683 if (die == NULL
22684 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
22685 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
22686 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
22688 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
22690 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
22691 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
22692 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
22693 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
22694 VOIDmode,
22695 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22696 if (tval)
22697 add_AT_loc (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target), tval);
22698 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
22700 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
22701 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
22702 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
22703 VOIDmode,
22704 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22705 if (tval)
22706 add_AT_loc (die,
22707 dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target_clobbered),
22708 tval);
22711 if (die != NULL)
22713 call_site_note_count++;
22714 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
22715 tail_call_site_note_count++;
22719 call_arg_locations = NULL;
22720 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
22721 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
22722 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
22723 && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
22725 if (call_site_count >= 0
22726 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
22727 add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_calls), 1);
22728 else
22729 add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls), 1);
22731 call_site_count = -1;
22732 tail_call_site_count = -1;
22735 /* Mark used types after we have created DIEs for the functions scopes. */
22736 premark_used_types (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
22739 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
22741 hashval_t
22742 block_die_hasher::hash (die_struct *d)
22744 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
22747 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
22748 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
22750 bool
22751 block_die_hasher::equal (die_struct *x, die_struct *y)
22753 return x->decl_id == y->decl_id && x->die_parent == y->die_parent;
22756 /* Return TRUE if DECL, which may have been previously generated as
22757 OLD_DIE, is a candidate for a DW_AT_specification. DECLARATION is
22758 true if decl (or its origin) is either an extern declaration or a
22759 class/namespace scoped declaration.
22761 The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
22762 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid
22763 considering one to be a specification, so we must test for
22764 DECLARATION and DW_AT_declaration. */
22765 static inline bool
22766 decl_will_get_specification_p (dw_die_ref old_die, tree decl, bool declaration)
22768 return (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && !declaration
22769 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1);
22772 /* Return true if DECL is a local static. */
22774 static inline bool
22775 local_function_static (tree decl)
22777 gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl));
22778 return TREE_STATIC (decl)
22779 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
22780 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL;
22783 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
22784 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
22786 static void
22787 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
22789 HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
22790 tree com_decl;
22791 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
22792 tree ultimate_origin;
22793 dw_die_ref var_die;
22794 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
22795 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
22796 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
22797 bool specialization_p = false;
22798 bool no_linkage_name = false;
22800 /* While C++ inline static data members have definitions inside of the
22801 class, force the first DIE to be a declaration, then let gen_member_die
22802 reparent it to the class context and call gen_variable_die again
22803 to create the outside of the class DIE for the definition. */
22804 if (!declaration
22805 && old_die == NULL
22806 && decl
22807 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
22808 && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
22809 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl, DW_AT_inline) != -1)
22811 declaration = true;
22812 if (dwarf_version < 5)
22813 no_linkage_name = true;
22816 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
22817 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
22818 origin = ultimate_origin;
22819 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
22821 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
22822 of a data member. */
22823 if (com_decl)
22825 dw_die_ref com_die;
22826 dw_loc_list_ref loc = NULL;
22827 die_node com_die_arg;
22829 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
22830 if (var_die)
22832 if (! early_dwarf && get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
22834 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2, NULL);
22835 if (loc)
22837 if (off)
22839 /* Optimize the common case. */
22840 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
22841 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
22842 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
22843 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
22844 == SYMBOL_REF)
22846 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
22847 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
22848 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
22850 else
22851 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
22853 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22854 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22857 return;
22860 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
22861 common_block_die_table = hash_table<block_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
22863 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
22864 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
22865 com_die = common_block_die_table->find (&com_die_arg);
22866 if (! early_dwarf)
22867 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22868 if (com_die == NULL)
22870 const char *cnam
22871 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
22872 die_node **slot;
22874 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
22875 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
22876 if (loc)
22878 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22879 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
22880 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
22881 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22883 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
22884 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22885 if (want_pubnames ())
22886 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
22887 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
22888 slot = common_block_die_table->find_slot (com_die, INSERT);
22889 *slot = com_die;
22891 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
22893 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22894 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22895 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22897 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
22898 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl_or_origin);
22899 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
22900 decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
22901 context_die);
22902 add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
22903 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22904 if (loc)
22906 if (off)
22908 /* Optimize the common case. */
22909 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
22910 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
22911 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
22912 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
22914 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
22915 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
22916 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
22918 else
22919 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
22921 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22923 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
22924 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22925 if (decl)
22926 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
22927 return;
22930 if (old_die)
22932 if (declaration)
22934 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped, needs no
22935 further annotations, since it doesn't need location on
22936 the second pass. */
22937 return;
22939 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration)
22940 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_specification))
22942 /* Fall-thru so we can make a new variable die along with a
22943 DW_AT_specification. */
22945 else if (origin && old_die->die_parent != context_die)
22947 /* If we will be creating an inlined instance, we need a
22948 new DIE that will get annotated with
22949 DW_AT_abstract_origin. Clear things so we can get a
22950 new DIE. */
22951 gcc_assert (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl));
22952 old_die = NULL;
22954 else
22956 /* If a DIE was dumped early, it still needs location info.
22957 Skip to where we fill the location bits. */
22958 var_die = old_die;
22960 /* ??? In LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
22961 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
22962 references to them. Thus we dumped them again, also add a
22963 reference to them. */
22964 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
22965 if (in_lto_p
22966 && variably_modified_type_p
22967 (type, decl_function_context (decl_or_origin)))
22969 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
22970 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
22971 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22972 else
22973 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin),
22974 false, context_die);
22977 goto gen_variable_die_location;
22981 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
22982 to have DW_TAG_member tag in DWARF{3,4} and we emit it for compatibility
22983 also in DWARF2; the specification should still be DW_TAG_variable
22984 referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
22985 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die) && dwarf_version < 5)
22986 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
22987 else
22988 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
22990 if (origin != NULL)
22991 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
22993 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
22994 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
22996 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
22997 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on them instead of
22998 sharing them.
23000 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
23001 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration))
23003 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
23004 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
23005 specialization_p = true;
23006 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
23008 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
23009 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
23011 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
23012 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
23014 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
23015 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
23017 if (debug_column_info
23018 && s.column
23019 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
23020 != (unsigned) s.column))
23021 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
23023 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
23024 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
23027 else
23028 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl, no_linkage_name);
23030 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
23031 || (origin != NULL
23032 && !DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
23033 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
23034 decl_function_context
23035 (decl_or_origin))))
23037 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
23039 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
23040 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23041 context_die);
23042 else
23043 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
23044 context_die);
23047 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
23049 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
23050 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23052 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23053 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23055 add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
23057 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
23060 if (declaration)
23061 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23063 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
23064 || !old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die)))
23065 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
23067 gen_variable_die_location:
23068 if (! declaration
23069 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
23070 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
23071 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
23072 already set. */
23073 || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin)
23074 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
23075 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin))))
23077 if (early_dwarf)
23078 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
23079 else
23080 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
23081 decl == NULL);
23083 else
23084 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
23086 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
23087 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
23088 DW_AT_const_expr) == 1
23089 && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr)
23090 && !specialization_p)
23091 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr, 1);
23093 if (!dwarf_strict)
23095 int inl = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
23096 DW_AT_inline);
23097 if (inl != -1
23098 && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_inline)
23099 && !specialization_p)
23100 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_inline, inl);
23104 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
23106 static void
23107 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
23109 dw_die_ref const_die;
23110 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
23112 const_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23113 if (const_die)
23114 return;
23116 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
23117 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, const_die);
23118 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
23119 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false, context_die);
23120 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
23121 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23122 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23123 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23124 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
23127 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
23129 static void
23130 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
23132 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
23133 dw_die_ref lbl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23134 rtx insn;
23135 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23137 if (!lbl_die)
23139 lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
23140 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
23142 if (origin != NULL)
23143 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
23144 else
23145 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
23148 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
23149 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
23150 else if (! early_dwarf)
23152 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
23154 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
23155 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
23156 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
23157 if (insn
23158 && (LABEL_P (insn)
23159 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
23160 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
23162 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
23163 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
23164 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
23165 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
23166 it if it ever does happen. */
23167 gcc_assert (!as_a<rtx_insn *> (insn)->deleted ());
23169 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23170 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23172 else if (insn
23173 && NOTE_P (insn)
23174 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
23175 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
23177 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23178 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23183 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
23184 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
23185 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
23187 static inline void
23188 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
23190 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
23192 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23194 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
23195 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
23196 if (debug_column_info && s.column)
23197 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_column, s.column);
23202 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
23203 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
23205 static inline void
23206 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
23208 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23210 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
23211 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23213 tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
23214 dw_die_ref pdie;
23215 dw_attr_node *attr = NULL;
23217 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
23219 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
23220 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23221 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
23224 /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
23225 lists. If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
23226 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
23227 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
23228 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range. */
23229 for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
23230 BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
23231 chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
23233 dw_attr_node *new_attr;
23235 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
23236 if (pdie == NULL)
23237 break;
23238 if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
23239 break;
23240 new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
23241 if (new_attr == NULL
23242 || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
23243 break;
23244 attr = new_attr;
23245 superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
23247 if (attr != NULL
23248 && ((*ranges_table)[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset].num
23249 == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
23250 && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
23252 unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset;
23253 unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
23254 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
23255 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
23257 ++supercnt;
23258 gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt].num
23259 == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
23261 gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
23262 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
23263 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
23264 ++thiscnt;
23265 gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
23266 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, off + supercnt - thiscnt,
23267 false);
23268 note_rnglist_head (off + supercnt - thiscnt);
23269 return;
23272 unsigned int offset = add_ranges (stmt, true);
23273 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, false);
23274 note_rnglist_head (offset);
23276 bool prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (stmt);
23277 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
23280 add_ranges (chain, prev_in_cold != BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain));
23281 prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain);
23282 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
23284 while (chain);
23285 add_ranges (NULL);
23287 else
23289 char label_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23290 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
23291 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23292 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_high, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
23293 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23294 add_AT_low_high_pc (die, label, label_high, false);
23298 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
23300 static void
23301 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
23303 dw_die_ref old_die = BLOCK_DIE (stmt);
23304 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL;
23305 if (!old_die)
23307 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
23308 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
23311 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
23313 if (old_die)
23315 /* This must have been generated early and it won't even
23316 need location information since it's a DW_AT_inline
23317 function. */
23318 if (flag_checking)
23319 for (dw_die_ref c = context_die; c; c = c->die_parent)
23320 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
23321 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
23323 gcc_assert (get_AT (c, DW_AT_inline));
23324 break;
23326 return;
23329 else if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt))
23331 /* If this is an inlined instance, create a new lexical die for
23332 anything below to attach DW_AT_abstract_origin to. */
23333 if (old_die)
23335 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
23336 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
23337 old_die = NULL;
23340 tree origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
23341 if (origin != NULL_TREE && origin != stmt)
23342 add_abstract_origin_attribute (stmt_die, origin);
23345 if (old_die)
23346 stmt_die = old_die;
23348 /* A non abstract block whose blocks have already been reordered
23349 should have the instruction range for this block. If so, set the
23350 high/low attributes. */
23351 if (!early_dwarf && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
23353 gcc_assert (stmt_die);
23354 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
23357 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die);
23360 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
23362 static void
23363 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
23365 tree decl;
23367 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
23368 be abstract. */
23369 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
23371 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
23373 /* Make sure any inlined functions are known to be inlineable. */
23374 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
23375 || cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl));
23377 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
23379 dw_die_ref subr_die
23380 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
23382 if (call_arg_locations)
23383 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = subr_die;
23384 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
23385 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
23386 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
23387 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
23389 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die);
23393 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. CTX is required: see
23394 the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
23396 static void
23397 gen_field_die (tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx, dw_die_ref context_die)
23399 dw_die_ref decl_die;
23401 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
23402 return;
23404 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
23405 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
23406 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl), decl_quals (decl),
23407 TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)),
23408 context_die);
23410 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
23412 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23413 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23414 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
23417 add_alignment_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23419 /* If we have a variant part offset, then we are supposed to process a member
23420 of a QUAL_UNION_TYPE, which is how we represent variant parts in
23421 trees. */
23422 gcc_assert (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE
23423 || TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
23424 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
23425 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
23427 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23428 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23430 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23432 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
23433 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
23436 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. TYPE can be an
23437 OFFSET_TYPE, for a pointer to data member, or a RECORD_TYPE, for a
23438 pointer to member function. */
23440 static void
23441 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
23443 if (lookup_type_die (type))
23444 return;
23446 dw_die_ref ptr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
23447 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
23449 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
23450 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
23451 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
23452 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23453 context_die);
23454 add_alignment_attribute (ptr_die, type);
23456 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
23457 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != METHOD_TYPE)
23459 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
23460 add_AT_loc (ptr_die, DW_AT_use_location, op);
23464 static char *producer_string;
23466 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
23467 if -grecord-gcc-switches. */
23469 static char *
23470 gen_producer_string (void)
23472 size_t j;
23473 auto_vec<const char *> switches;
23474 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
23475 char *producer, *tail;
23476 const char *p;
23477 size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
23478 size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
23480 for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
23481 switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
23483 case OPT_o:
23484 case OPT_d:
23485 case OPT_dumpbase:
23486 case OPT_dumpdir:
23487 case OPT_auxbase:
23488 case OPT_auxbase_strip:
23489 case OPT_quiet:
23490 case OPT_version:
23491 case OPT_v:
23492 case OPT_w:
23493 case OPT_L:
23494 case OPT_D:
23495 case OPT_I:
23496 case OPT_U:
23497 case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
23498 case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
23499 case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
23500 case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
23501 case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
23502 case OPT__output_pch_:
23503 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
23504 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
23505 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
23506 case OPT_fdiagnostics_color_:
23507 case OPT_fverbose_asm:
23508 case OPT____:
23509 case OPT__sysroot_:
23510 case OPT_nostdinc:
23511 case OPT_nostdinc__:
23512 case OPT_fpreprocessed:
23513 case OPT_fltrans_output_list_:
23514 case OPT_fresolution_:
23515 case OPT_fdebug_prefix_map_:
23516 case OPT_fcompare_debug:
23517 /* Ignore these. */
23518 continue;
23519 default:
23520 if (cl_options[save_decoded_options[j].opt_index].flags
23521 & CL_NO_DWARF_RECORD)
23522 continue;
23523 gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
23524 == '-');
23525 switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
23527 case 'M':
23528 case 'i':
23529 case 'W':
23530 continue;
23531 case 'f':
23532 if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
23533 "dump", 4) == 0)
23534 continue;
23535 break;
23536 default:
23537 break;
23539 switches.safe_push (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
23540 len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
23541 break;
23544 producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
23545 tail = producer;
23546 sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
23547 tail += plen;
23549 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (switches, j, p)
23551 len = strlen (p);
23552 *tail = ' ';
23553 memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
23554 tail += len + 1;
23557 *tail = '\0';
23558 return producer;
23561 /* Given a C and/or C++ language/version string return the "highest".
23562 C++ is assumed to be "higher" than C in this case. Used for merging
23563 LTO translation unit languages. */
23564 static const char *
23565 highest_c_language (const char *lang1, const char *lang2)
23567 if (strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang2) == 0)
23568 return "GNU C++17";
23569 if (strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang2) == 0)
23570 return "GNU C++14";
23571 if (strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang2) == 0)
23572 return "GNU C++11";
23573 if (strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang2) == 0)
23574 return "GNU C++98";
23576 if (strcmp ("GNU C17", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C17", lang2) == 0)
23577 return "GNU C17";
23578 if (strcmp ("GNU C11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C11", lang2) == 0)
23579 return "GNU C11";
23580 if (strcmp ("GNU C99", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C99", lang2) == 0)
23581 return "GNU C99";
23582 if (strcmp ("GNU C89", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C89", lang2) == 0)
23583 return "GNU C89";
23585 gcc_unreachable ();
23589 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
23591 static dw_die_ref
23592 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
23594 dw_die_ref die;
23595 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
23596 int language;
23598 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
23600 if (filename)
23602 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
23603 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
23604 if (filename[0] != '<')
23605 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
23608 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string ? producer_string : "");
23610 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
23611 from the global list of translation units. */
23612 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
23614 unsigned i;
23615 tree t;
23616 const char *common_lang = NULL;
23618 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (all_translation_units, i, t)
23620 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
23621 continue;
23622 if (!common_lang)
23623 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
23624 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
23626 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
23627 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
23628 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
23629 common_lang = highest_c_language (common_lang,
23630 TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t));
23631 else
23633 /* Fall back to C. */
23634 common_lang = NULL;
23635 break;
23639 if (common_lang)
23640 language_string = common_lang;
23643 language = DW_LANG_C;
23644 if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C", 5) == 0
23645 && ISDIGIT (language_string[5]))
23647 language = DW_LANG_C89;
23648 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23650 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C89") != 0)
23651 language = DW_LANG_C99;
23653 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23654 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C11") == 0
23655 || strcmp (language_string, "GNU C17") == 0)
23656 language = DW_LANG_C11;
23659 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C++", 7) == 0)
23661 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
23662 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23664 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++11") == 0)
23665 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11;
23666 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++14") == 0)
23667 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
23668 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++17") == 0)
23669 /* For now. */
23670 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
23673 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
23674 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
23675 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23677 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
23678 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
23679 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
23681 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
23682 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23684 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2003") == 0)
23685 language = DW_LANG_Fortran03;
23686 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2008") == 0)
23687 language = DW_LANG_Fortran08;
23690 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
23691 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
23692 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
23693 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
23694 else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
23696 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
23697 language = DW_LANG_Go;
23700 /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works. */
23701 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
23702 language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
23704 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
23706 switch (language)
23708 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
23709 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
23710 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
23711 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
23712 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
23713 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
23714 lowercases everything. */
23715 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
23716 break;
23717 default:
23718 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
23719 break;
23721 return die;
23724 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
23726 static void
23727 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, tree type,
23728 dw_die_ref context_die)
23730 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
23731 struct vlr_context ctx = { type, NULL };
23733 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23734 context_die);
23735 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo, &ctx);
23737 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
23738 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
23740 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
23741 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
23742 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
23743 if (access == access_public_node)
23745 if (dwarf_version == 2
23746 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
23747 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
23749 else if (access == access_protected_node)
23750 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
23751 else if (dwarf_version > 2
23752 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
23753 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
23756 /* Return whether DECL is a FIELD_DECL that represents the variant part of a
23757 structure. */
23758 static bool
23759 is_variant_part (tree decl)
23761 return (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
23762 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
23765 /* Check that OPERAND is a reference to a field in STRUCT_TYPE. If it is,
23766 return the FIELD_DECL. Return NULL_TREE otherwise. */
23768 static tree
23769 analyze_discr_in_predicate (tree operand, tree struct_type)
23771 bool continue_stripping = true;
23772 while (continue_stripping)
23773 switch (TREE_CODE (operand))
23775 CASE_CONVERT:
23776 operand = TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0);
23777 break;
23778 default:
23779 continue_stripping = false;
23780 break;
23783 /* Match field access to members of struct_type only. */
23784 if (TREE_CODE (operand) == COMPONENT_REF
23785 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
23786 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == struct_type
23787 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
23788 return TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1);
23789 else
23790 return NULL_TREE;
23793 /* Check that SRC is a constant integer that can be represented as a native
23794 integer constant (either signed or unsigned). If so, store it into DEST and
23795 return true. Return false otherwise. */
23797 static bool
23798 get_discr_value (tree src, dw_discr_value *dest)
23800 tree discr_type = TREE_TYPE (src);
23802 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
23804 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (discr_type);
23805 if (debug_type != NULL)
23806 discr_type = debug_type;
23809 if (TREE_CODE (src) != INTEGER_CST || !INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (discr_type))
23810 return false;
23812 /* Signedness can vary between the original type and the debug type. This
23813 can happen for character types in Ada for instance: the character type
23814 used for code generation can be signed, to be compatible with the C one,
23815 but from a debugger point of view, it must be unsigned. */
23816 bool is_orig_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (src));
23817 bool is_debug_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (discr_type);
23819 if (is_orig_unsigned != is_debug_unsigned)
23820 src = fold_convert (discr_type, src);
23822 if (!(is_debug_unsigned ? tree_fits_uhwi_p (src) : tree_fits_shwi_p (src)))
23823 return false;
23825 dest->pos = is_debug_unsigned;
23826 if (is_debug_unsigned)
23827 dest->v.uval = tree_to_uhwi (src);
23828 else
23829 dest->v.sval = tree_to_shwi (src);
23831 return true;
23834 /* Try to extract synthetic properties out of VARIANT_PART_DECL, which is a
23835 FIELD_DECL in STRUCT_TYPE that represents a variant part. If unsuccessful,
23836 store NULL_TREE in DISCR_DECL. Otherwise:
23838 - store the discriminant field in STRUCT_TYPE that controls the variant
23839 part to *DISCR_DECL
23841 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_P an array where for each variant, the item
23842 represents the corresponding matching list of discriminant values.
23844 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_LENGTH the number of variants, which is the size of
23845 the above array.
23847 Note that when the array is allocated (i.e. when the analysis is
23848 successful), it is up to the caller to free the array. */
23850 static void
23851 analyze_variants_discr (tree variant_part_decl,
23852 tree struct_type,
23853 tree *discr_decl,
23854 dw_discr_list_ref **discr_lists_p,
23855 unsigned *discr_lists_length)
23857 tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
23858 tree variant;
23859 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
23860 unsigned i;
23862 /* Compute how many variants there are in this variant part. */
23863 *discr_lists_length = 0;
23864 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
23865 variant != NULL_TREE;
23866 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant))
23867 ++*discr_lists_length;
23869 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23870 *discr_lists_p
23871 = (dw_discr_list_ref *) xcalloc (*discr_lists_length,
23872 sizeof (**discr_lists_p));
23873 discr_lists = *discr_lists_p;
23875 /* And then analyze all variants to extract discriminant information for all
23876 of them. This analysis is conservative: as soon as we detect something we
23877 do not support, abort everything and pretend we found nothing. */
23878 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type), i = 0;
23879 variant != NULL_TREE;
23880 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
23882 tree match_expr = DECL_QUALIFIER (variant);
23884 /* Now, try to analyze the predicate and deduce a discriminant for
23885 it. */
23886 if (match_expr == boolean_true_node)
23887 /* Typically happens for the default variant: it matches all cases that
23888 previous variants rejected. Don't output any matching value for
23889 this one. */
23890 continue;
23892 /* The following loop tries to iterate over each discriminant
23893 possibility: single values or ranges. */
23894 while (match_expr != NULL_TREE)
23896 tree next_round_match_expr;
23897 tree candidate_discr = NULL_TREE;
23898 dw_discr_list_ref new_node = NULL;
23900 /* Possibilities are matched one after the other by nested
23901 TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR expressions. Process the current possibility and
23902 continue with the rest at next iteration. */
23903 if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
23905 next_round_match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
23906 match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23908 else
23909 next_round_match_expr = NULL_TREE;
23911 if (match_expr == boolean_false_node)
23912 /* This sub-expression matches nothing: just wait for the next
23913 one. */
23916 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == EQ_EXPR)
23918 /* We are matching: <discr_field> == <integer_cst>
23919 This sub-expression matches a single value. */
23920 tree integer_cst = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23922 candidate_discr
23923 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0),
23924 struct_type);
23926 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
23927 if (!get_discr_value (integer_cst,
23928 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound))
23929 goto abort;
23930 new_node->dw_discr_range = false;
23933 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR)
23935 /* We are matching:
23936 <discr_field> > <integer_cst>
23937 && <discr_field> < <integer_cst>.
23938 This sub-expression matches the range of values between the
23939 two matched integer constants. Note that comparisons can be
23940 inclusive or exclusive. */
23941 tree candidate_discr_1, candidate_discr_2;
23942 tree lower_cst, upper_cst;
23943 bool lower_cst_included, upper_cst_included;
23944 tree lower_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
23945 tree upper_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23947 /* When the comparison is exclusive, the integer constant is not
23948 the discriminant range bound we are looking for: we will have
23949 to increment or decrement it. */
23950 if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GE_EXPR)
23951 lower_cst_included = true;
23952 else if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GT_EXPR)
23953 lower_cst_included = false;
23954 else
23955 goto abort;
23957 if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LE_EXPR)
23958 upper_cst_included = true;
23959 else if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LT_EXPR)
23960 upper_cst_included = false;
23961 else
23962 goto abort;
23964 /* Extract the discriminant from the first operand and check it
23965 is consistant with the same analysis in the second
23966 operand. */
23967 candidate_discr_1
23968 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 0),
23969 struct_type);
23970 candidate_discr_2
23971 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 0),
23972 struct_type);
23973 if (candidate_discr_1 == candidate_discr_2)
23974 candidate_discr = candidate_discr_1;
23975 else
23976 goto abort;
23978 /* Extract bounds from both. */
23979 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
23980 lower_cst = TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 1);
23981 upper_cst = TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 1);
23983 if (!lower_cst_included)
23984 lower_cst
23985 = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), lower_cst,
23986 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), 1));
23987 if (!upper_cst_included)
23988 upper_cst
23989 = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), upper_cst,
23990 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), 1));
23992 if (!get_discr_value (lower_cst,
23993 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound)
23994 || !get_discr_value (upper_cst,
23995 &new_node->dw_discr_upper_bound))
23996 goto abort;
23998 new_node->dw_discr_range = true;
24001 else
24002 /* Unsupported sub-expression: we cannot determine the set of
24003 matching discriminant values. Abort everything. */
24004 goto abort;
24006 /* If the discriminant info is not consistant with what we saw so
24007 far, consider the analysis failed and abort everything. */
24008 if (candidate_discr == NULL_TREE
24009 || (*discr_decl != NULL_TREE && candidate_discr != *discr_decl))
24010 goto abort;
24011 else
24012 *discr_decl = candidate_discr;
24014 if (new_node != NULL)
24016 new_node->dw_discr_next = discr_lists[i];
24017 discr_lists[i] = new_node;
24019 match_expr = next_round_match_expr;
24023 /* If we reach this point, we could match everything we were interested
24024 in. */
24025 return;
24027 abort:
24028 /* Clean all data structure and return no result. */
24029 free (*discr_lists_p);
24030 *discr_lists_p = NULL;
24031 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24034 /* Generate a DIE to represent VARIANT_PART_DECL, a variant part that is part
24035 of STRUCT_TYPE, a record type. This new DIE is emitted as the next child
24036 under CONTEXT_DIE.
24038 Variant parts are supposed to be implemented as a FIELD_DECL whose type is a
24039 QUAL_UNION_TYPE: this is the VARIANT_PART_DECL parameter. The members for
24040 this type, which are record types, represent the available variants and each
24041 has a DECL_QUALIFIER attribute. The discriminant and the discriminant
24042 values are inferred from these attributes.
24044 In trees, the offsets for the fields inside these sub-records are relative
24045 to the variant part itself, whereas the corresponding DIEs should have
24046 offset attributes that are relative to the embedding record base address.
24047 This is why the caller must provide a VARIANT_PART_OFFSET expression: it
24048 must be an expression that computes the offset of the variant part to
24049 describe in DWARF. */
24051 static void
24052 gen_variant_part (tree variant_part_decl, struct vlr_context *vlr_ctx,
24053 dw_die_ref context_die)
24055 const tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
24056 tree variant_part_offset = vlr_ctx->variant_part_offset;
24057 struct loc_descr_context ctx = {
24058 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
24059 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
24060 NULL, /* dpi */
24061 false, /* placeholder_arg */
24062 false /* placeholder_seen */
24065 /* The FIELD_DECL node in STRUCT_TYPE that acts as the discriminant, or
24066 NULL_TREE if there is no such field. */
24067 tree discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24068 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
24069 unsigned discr_lists_length = 0;
24070 unsigned i;
24072 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die = NULL;
24073 dw_die_ref variant_part_die
24074 = new_die (DW_TAG_variant_part, context_die, variant_part_type);
24076 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant_part_decl, variant_part_die);
24078 analyze_variants_discr (variant_part_decl, vlr_ctx->struct_type,
24079 &discr_decl, &discr_lists, &discr_lists_length);
24081 if (discr_decl != NULL_TREE)
24083 dw_die_ref discr_die = lookup_decl_die (discr_decl);
24085 if (discr_die)
24086 add_AT_die_ref (variant_part_die, DW_AT_discr, discr_die);
24087 else
24088 /* We have no DIE for the discriminant, so just discard all
24089 discrimimant information in the output. */
24090 discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24093 /* If the offset for this variant part is more complex than a constant,
24094 create a DWARF procedure for it so that we will not have to generate DWARF
24095 expressions for it for each member. */
24096 if (TREE_CODE (variant_part_offset) != INTEGER_CST
24097 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
24099 const tree dwarf_proc_fndecl
24100 = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, NULL_TREE,
24101 build_function_type (TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
24102 NULL_TREE));
24103 const tree dwarf_proc_call = build_call_expr (dwarf_proc_fndecl, 0);
24104 const dw_loc_descr_ref dwarf_proc_body
24105 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (variant_part_offset, 0, &ctx);
24107 dwarf_proc_die = new_dwarf_proc_die (dwarf_proc_body,
24108 dwarf_proc_fndecl, context_die);
24109 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
24110 variant_part_offset = dwarf_proc_call;
24113 /* Output DIEs for all variants. */
24114 i = 0;
24115 for (tree variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
24116 variant != NULL_TREE;
24117 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
24119 tree variant_type = TREE_TYPE (variant);
24120 dw_die_ref variant_die;
24122 /* All variants (i.e. members of a variant part) are supposed to be
24123 encoded as structures. Sub-variant parts are QUAL_UNION_TYPE fields
24124 under these records. */
24125 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (variant_type) == RECORD_TYPE);
24127 variant_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variant, variant_part_die, variant_type);
24128 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant, variant_die);
24130 /* Output discriminant values this variant matches, if any. */
24131 if (discr_decl == NULL || discr_lists[i] == NULL)
24132 /* In the case we have discriminant information at all, this is
24133 probably the default variant: as the standard says, don't
24134 output any discriminant value/list attribute. */
24136 else if (discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_next == NULL
24137 && !discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_range)
24138 /* If there is only one accepted value, don't bother outputting a
24139 list. */
24140 add_discr_value (variant_die, &discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_lower_bound);
24141 else
24142 add_discr_list (variant_die, discr_lists[i]);
24144 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_type);
24145 member != NULL_TREE;
24146 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24148 struct vlr_context vlr_sub_ctx = {
24149 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* struct_type */
24150 NULL /* variant_part_offset */
24152 if (is_variant_part (member))
24154 /* All offsets for fields inside variant parts are relative to
24155 the top-level embedding RECORD_TYPE's base address. On the
24156 other hand, offsets in GCC's types are relative to the
24157 nested-most variant part. So we have to sum offsets each time
24158 we recurse. */
24160 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset
24161 = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
24162 variant_part_offset, byte_position (member));
24163 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
24165 else
24167 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset = variant_part_offset;
24168 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
24173 free (discr_lists);
24176 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
24178 static void
24179 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24181 tree member;
24182 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
24184 gcc_assert (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type) == type);
24186 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
24187 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
24188 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
24189 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
24190 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
24191 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
24192 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
24193 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
24194 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
24195 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
24196 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
24198 /* First output info about the base classes. */
24199 if (binfo)
24201 vec<tree, va_gc> *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
24202 int i;
24203 tree base;
24205 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
24206 gen_inheritance_die (base,
24207 (accesses ? (*accesses)[i] : access_public_node),
24208 type,
24209 context_die);
24212 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
24213 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24215 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = { type, NULL_TREE };
24216 bool static_inline_p
24217 = (TREE_STATIC (member)
24218 && (lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (member, DW_AT_inline)
24219 != -1));
24221 /* Ignore clones. */
24222 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
24223 continue;
24225 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
24226 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
24227 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
24228 do put them in the right order. */
24230 if (dw_die_ref child = lookup_decl_die (member))
24232 /* Handle inline static data members, which only have in-class
24233 declarations. */
24234 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
24235 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24236 && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ())
24238 ref = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
24239 /* For C++17 inline static data members followed by redundant
24240 out of class redeclaration, we might get here with
24241 child being the DIE created for the out of class
24242 redeclaration and with its DW_AT_specification being
24243 the DIE created for in-class definition. We want to
24244 reparent the latter, and don't want to create another
24245 DIE with DW_AT_specification in that case, because
24246 we already have one. */
24247 if (ref
24248 && static_inline_p
24249 && ref->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24250 && ref->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
24251 && get_AT (ref, DW_AT_specification) == NULL)
24253 child = ref;
24254 ref = NULL;
24255 static_inline_p = false;
24259 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24260 && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
24261 && ref == NULL)
24263 reparent_child (child, context_die);
24264 if (dwarf_version < 5)
24265 child->die_tag = DW_TAG_member;
24267 else
24268 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
24271 /* Do not generate standard DWARF for variant parts if we are generating
24272 the corresponding GNAT encodings: DIEs generated for both would
24273 conflict in our mappings. */
24274 else if (is_variant_part (member)
24275 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
24277 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = byte_position (member);
24278 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
24280 else
24282 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = NULL_TREE;
24283 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
24286 /* For C++ inline static data members emit immediately a DW_TAG_variable
24287 DIE that will refer to that DW_TAG_member/DW_TAG_variable through
24288 DW_AT_specification. */
24289 if (static_inline_p)
24291 int old_extern = DECL_EXTERNAL (member);
24292 DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = 0;
24293 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, NULL, comp_unit_die ());
24294 DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = old_extern;
24299 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
24300 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
24301 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
24303 static void
24304 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
24305 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24307 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24309 /* Fill in the bound of variable-length fields in late dwarf if
24310 still incomplete. */
24311 if (!early_dwarf && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
24312 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
24313 member;
24314 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24315 fill_variable_array_bounds (TREE_TYPE (member));
24316 return;
24319 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
24320 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
24321 int nested = 0;
24322 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
24323 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
24324 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
24325 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
24326 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
24328 if (type_die && ! complete)
24329 return;
24331 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
24332 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
24333 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
24334 nested = 1;
24336 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
24338 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
24339 if (!type_die && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24340 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
24342 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
24343 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
24345 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
24347 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
24348 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
24349 scope_die, type);
24350 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24351 if (old_die)
24352 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
24353 else
24354 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
24356 else
24357 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
24359 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
24360 then give a list of members. */
24361 if (complete && !ns_decl)
24363 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
24364 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
24365 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24366 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
24367 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
24368 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
24370 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
24371 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
24374 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
24375 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
24376 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
24377 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
24379 push_decl_scope (type);
24380 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
24381 pop_decl_scope ();
24383 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
24384 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
24385 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
24387 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
24388 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
24390 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
24392 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
24393 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
24394 lookup_type_die (vtype));
24397 else
24399 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
24401 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
24402 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
24403 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
24404 vec_safe_push (incomplete_types, type);
24407 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
24408 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
24411 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
24413 static void
24414 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24416 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
24417 dw_die_ref subr_die
24418 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
24419 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
24421 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
24422 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
24423 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
24424 context_die);
24425 add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, type);
24426 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
24428 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
24429 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
24430 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
24431 && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type, DW_AT_reference) != -1)
24432 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
24433 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
24434 && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type,
24435 DW_AT_rvalue_reference) != -1)
24436 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
24439 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
24441 static void
24442 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
24444 dw_die_ref type_die;
24445 tree type;
24447 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
24449 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
24450 fill_variable_array_bounds (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl));
24451 return;
24454 /* As we avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs (see decl_ultimate_origin
24455 checks in process_scope_var and modified_type_die), this should be called
24456 only for original types. */
24457 gcc_assert (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == NULL
24458 || decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == decl);
24460 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
24461 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
24463 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
24464 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
24466 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
24467 if (type == error_mark_node)
24468 return;
24470 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
24471 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
24473 else
24475 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
24476 if (type == error_mark_node)
24477 return;
24479 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24481 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
24482 an anonymous type, e.g:
24483 typedef struct {...} foo;
24484 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
24485 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
24486 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
24487 the C++ FE.
24489 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
24490 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
24491 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
24492 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
24493 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
24494 anonymous struct DIE. */
24495 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24496 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24498 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
24499 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
24500 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
24501 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
24502 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
24503 this debug info. */
24504 add_linkage_name_raw (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
24508 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, decl_quals (decl), false,
24509 context_die);
24511 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
24512 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
24513 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
24514 created. */
24515 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24517 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
24519 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
24521 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
24522 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
24524 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
24525 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
24528 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
24530 static void
24531 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
24532 dw_die_ref context_die,
24533 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24535 int need_pop;
24537 if (type == NULL_TREE
24538 || !is_tagged_type (type))
24539 return;
24541 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24542 need_pop = 0;
24543 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
24544 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
24545 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
24546 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
24547 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
24548 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
24549 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
24550 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
24551 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
24553 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
24555 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24556 return;
24558 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
24559 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24560 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24561 need_pop = 1;
24563 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
24564 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
24566 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
24567 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
24568 decls_for_scope. */
24569 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24570 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
24571 specification. */
24572 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
24573 context_die = NULL;
24574 need_pop = 0;
24576 else
24578 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
24579 need_pop = 0;
24582 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
24584 /* This might have been written out by the call to
24585 declare_in_namespace. */
24586 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24587 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
24589 else
24590 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
24592 if (need_pop)
24593 pop_decl_scope ();
24595 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
24596 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
24597 when appropriate. */
24600 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
24602 static void
24603 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
24604 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24606 struct array_descr_info info;
24608 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
24609 return;
24611 if (flag_checking && type)
24612 verify_type (type);
24614 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
24615 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
24616 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
24617 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24618 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
24619 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
24620 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
24621 type. */
24622 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
24624 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
24625 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
24626 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
24628 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24629 return;
24631 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
24632 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
24633 if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
24635 gen_decl_die (origin, NULL, NULL, context_die);
24636 return;
24639 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
24640 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type);
24642 /* Give typedefs the right scope. */
24643 context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
24645 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24647 gen_decl_die (name, NULL, NULL, context_die);
24648 return;
24651 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
24652 generate debug info for the typedef. */
24653 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24655 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
24656 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
24657 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
24658 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
24659 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
24661 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
24662 return;
24665 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
24667 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
24669 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
24671 gen_type_die_with_usage (debug_type, context_die, usage);
24672 return;
24676 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
24677 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
24678 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
24679 now. (Vectors and arrays are special because the debugging info is in the
24680 cloned type itself. Similarly function/method types can contain extra
24681 ref-qualification). */
24682 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
24683 || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
24685 /* For function/method types, can't use type_main_variant here,
24686 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
24687 but try to canonicalize. */
24688 tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
24689 for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
24690 if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
24691 && check_base_type (t, main)
24692 && check_lang_type (t, type))
24694 type = t;
24695 break;
24698 else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
24699 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
24700 type = type_main_variant (type);
24702 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
24703 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
24704 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info)
24706 memset (&info, 0, sizeof (info));
24707 if (lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
24709 /* Fortran sometimes emits array types with no dimension. */
24710 gcc_assert (info.ndimensions >= 0
24711 && (info.ndimensions
24712 <= DWARF2OUT_ARRAY_DESCR_INFO_MAX_DIMEN));
24713 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
24714 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24715 return;
24719 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24721 /* Variable-length types may be incomplete even if
24722 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN. For such types, fall through to
24723 gen_array_type_die() and possibly fill in
24724 DW_AT_{upper,lower}_bound attributes. */
24725 if ((TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE
24726 && TREE_CODE (type) != RECORD_TYPE
24727 && TREE_CODE (type) != UNION_TYPE
24728 && TREE_CODE (type) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
24729 || !variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
24730 return;
24733 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
24735 case ERROR_MARK:
24736 break;
24738 case POINTER_TYPE:
24739 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
24740 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
24741 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
24742 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
24743 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
24744 statement. */
24745 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24747 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
24748 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
24749 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24750 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24751 break;
24753 case OFFSET_TYPE:
24754 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
24755 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
24756 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
24757 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24759 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
24760 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24761 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24763 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
24764 itself. */
24765 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
24766 break;
24768 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
24769 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
24770 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24771 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24772 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
24773 break;
24775 case METHOD_TYPE:
24776 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
24777 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24778 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24779 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
24780 break;
24782 case ARRAY_TYPE:
24783 case VECTOR_TYPE:
24784 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
24785 break;
24787 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
24788 case RECORD_TYPE:
24789 case UNION_TYPE:
24790 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
24791 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
24792 return;
24794 case VOID_TYPE:
24795 case INTEGER_TYPE:
24796 case REAL_TYPE:
24797 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
24798 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
24799 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
24800 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
24801 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
24802 break;
24804 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
24805 case LANG_TYPE:
24806 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
24808 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
24809 if (type_die == NULL)
24811 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
24812 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (),
24813 type);
24814 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
24815 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24818 break;
24820 default:
24821 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
24823 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
24824 dw_die_ref *die = (name == get_identifier ("auto")
24825 ? &auto_die : &decltype_auto_die);
24826 if (!*die)
24828 *die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type,
24829 comp_unit_die (), NULL_TREE);
24830 add_name_attribute (*die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
24832 equate_type_number_to_die (type, *die);
24833 break;
24835 gcc_unreachable ();
24838 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24841 static void
24842 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24844 if (type != error_mark_node)
24846 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24847 if (flag_checking)
24849 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
24850 if (die)
24851 check_die (die);
24856 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
24857 things which are local to the given block. */
24859 static void
24860 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24862 int must_output_die = 0;
24863 bool inlined_func;
24865 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
24866 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
24867 return;
24869 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
24871 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
24872 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
24873 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
24874 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
24876 tree sub;
24878 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
24879 gen_block_die (sub, context_die);
24881 return;
24884 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
24885 block. */
24886 if (inlined_func)
24887 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
24888 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
24889 must_output_die = 1;
24890 else
24892 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
24893 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
24894 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24895 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
24896 as being a "significant" one. */
24897 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
24898 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
24899 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
24900 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
24901 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
24902 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
24903 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
24904 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24905 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
24906 must_output_die = 1;
24909 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
24910 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
24911 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
24912 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
24913 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
24914 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
24915 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
24916 if (must_output_die)
24918 if (inlined_func)
24920 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
24921 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
24922 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
24923 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
24924 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
24925 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
24926 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
24927 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
24929 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
24930 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
24931 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
24932 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
24933 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24934 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die);
24936 else
24937 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die);
24939 else
24940 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die);
24943 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
24944 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
24945 static void
24946 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
24948 dw_die_ref die;
24949 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
24951 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24952 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
24953 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL)
24955 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
24956 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
24957 else
24958 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
24959 /* Avoid re-creating the DIE late if it was optimized as unused early. */
24960 if (! die && ! early_dwarf)
24961 return;
24963 else
24964 die = NULL;
24966 /* Avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs and concrete static variables that
24967 will only be pruned later. */
24968 if ((origin || decl_ultimate_origin (decl))
24969 && (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
24970 || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin) && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin))))
24972 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
24973 if (decl && VAR_P (decl) && die != NULL)
24975 die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
24976 if (die != NULL)
24977 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
24979 return;
24982 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
24983 add_child_die (context_die, die);
24984 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
24986 if (early_dwarf)
24987 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
24988 stmt, context_die);
24990 else
24992 if (decl && DECL_P (decl))
24994 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
24996 /* Early created DIEs do not have a parent as the decls refer
24997 to the function as DECL_CONTEXT rather than the BLOCK. */
24998 if (die && die->die_parent == NULL)
25000 gcc_assert (in_lto_p);
25001 add_child_die (context_die, die);
25005 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, NULL, context_die);
25009 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
25010 all of its sub-blocks. */
25012 static void
25013 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
25015 tree decl;
25016 unsigned int i;
25017 tree subblocks;
25019 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
25020 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
25021 return;
25023 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
25024 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
25025 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
25026 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. We don't
25027 have to do this if we're at -g1. */
25028 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25030 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
25031 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
25032 /* BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARs simply generate DIE stubs with abstract
25033 origin - avoid doing this twice as we have no good way to see
25034 if we've done it once already. */
25035 if (! early_dwarf)
25036 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
25038 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
25039 if (decl == current_function_decl)
25040 /* Ignore declarations of the current function, while they
25041 are declarations, gen_subprogram_die would treat them
25042 as definitions again, because they are equal to
25043 current_function_decl and endlessly recurse. */;
25044 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
25045 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
25046 else
25047 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL_TREE, decl, context_die);
25051 /* Even if we're at -g1, we need to process the subblocks in order to get
25052 inlined call information. */
25054 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
25055 therein) of this block. */
25056 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
25057 subblocks != NULL;
25058 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
25059 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die);
25062 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
25064 bool
25065 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
25067 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
25068 return true;
25070 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
25071 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
25072 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
25073 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
25074 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
25075 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
25076 return true;
25078 return false;
25081 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
25082 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
25083 constructs like:
25085 typedef struct {...} foo;
25087 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
25088 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
25089 struct type. */
25091 static bool
25092 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
25094 if (decl == NULL_TREE
25095 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
25096 || DECL_NAMELESS (decl)
25097 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
25098 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
25099 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
25100 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
25101 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
25102 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
25103 || !is_cxx (decl))
25104 return FALSE;
25106 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
25107 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
25108 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
25109 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
25112 /* Looks up the DIE for a context. */
25114 static inline dw_die_ref
25115 lookup_context_die (tree context)
25117 if (context)
25119 /* Find die that represents this context. */
25120 if (TYPE_P (context))
25122 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
25123 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_type_die (context);
25124 if (!ctx)
25125 return NULL;
25126 return strip_naming_typedef (context, ctx);
25128 else
25129 return lookup_decl_die (context);
25131 return comp_unit_die ();
25134 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
25136 static inline dw_die_ref
25137 get_context_die (tree context)
25139 if (context)
25141 /* Find die that represents this context. */
25142 if (TYPE_P (context))
25144 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
25145 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
25147 else
25148 return force_decl_die (context);
25150 return comp_unit_die ();
25153 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
25155 static dw_die_ref
25156 force_decl_die (tree decl)
25158 dw_die_ref decl_die;
25159 unsigned saved_external_flag;
25160 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
25161 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25162 if (!decl_die)
25164 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25166 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25167 if (decl_die)
25168 return decl_die;
25170 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
25172 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25173 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
25174 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
25175 declaration die. */
25176 save_fn = current_function_decl;
25177 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
25178 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
25179 current_function_decl = save_fn;
25180 break;
25182 case VAR_DECL:
25183 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
25184 gen_decl_die() call. */
25185 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
25186 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
25187 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25188 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
25189 break;
25191 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25192 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25193 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25194 else
25195 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
25196 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
25197 break;
25199 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
25200 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
25201 break;
25203 default:
25204 gcc_unreachable ();
25207 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
25208 if (!decl_die)
25209 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25210 gcc_assert (decl_die);
25213 return decl_die;
25216 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
25217 always returned. */
25219 static dw_die_ref
25220 force_type_die (tree type)
25222 dw_die_ref type_die;
25224 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
25225 if (!type_die)
25227 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25229 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
25230 false, context_die);
25231 gcc_assert (type_die);
25233 return type_die;
25236 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
25237 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
25239 static dw_die_ref
25240 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
25242 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
25243 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
25244 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25245 /* Force out the namespace. */
25246 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
25248 return context_die;
25251 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
25252 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
25254 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
25255 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope, with
25256 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration (like with class
25257 members). */
25259 static dw_die_ref
25260 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
25262 dw_die_ref ns_context;
25264 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25265 return context_die;
25267 /* External declarations in the local scope only need to be emitted
25268 once, not once in the namespace and once in the scope.
25270 This avoids declaring the `extern' below in the
25271 namespace DIE as well as in the innermost scope:
25273 namespace S
25275 int i=5;
25276 int foo()
25278 int i=8;
25279 extern int i;
25280 return i;
25284 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_EXTERNAL (thing) && local_scope_p (context_die))
25285 return context_die;
25287 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
25288 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
25289 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
25290 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
25291 return context_die;
25293 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
25295 if (ns_context != context_die)
25297 if (is_fortran ())
25298 return ns_context;
25299 if (DECL_P (thing))
25300 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, NULL, ns_context);
25301 else
25302 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
25304 return context_die;
25307 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
25309 static void
25310 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
25312 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
25314 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
25315 they are an alias of. */
25316 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
25318 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
25319 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
25320 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
25321 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
25322 context_die, decl);
25323 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
25324 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
25326 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
25327 if (name)
25328 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
25330 else
25331 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
25332 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
25333 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
25334 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
25336 else
25338 /* Output a namespace alias. */
25340 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
25341 dw_die_ref origin_die
25342 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
25344 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
25345 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25346 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
25347 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
25348 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
25349 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
25350 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
25351 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
25353 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
25354 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
25355 DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
25356 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_export_symbols, 1);
25358 /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS. */
25359 if (want_pubnames ())
25360 add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
25363 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
25364 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
25365 for all other decls it returns NULL.
25367 If DECL is a FIELD_DECL, CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
25368 It can be NULL otherwise. */
25370 static dw_die_ref
25371 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, struct vlr_context *ctx,
25372 dw_die_ref context_die)
25374 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
25375 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
25377 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
25378 return NULL;
25380 /* Ignore pointer bounds decls. */
25381 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin)
25382 && TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)
25383 && POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl_or_origin))
25384 return NULL;
25386 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
25388 case ERROR_MARK:
25389 break;
25391 case CONST_DECL:
25392 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
25394 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
25395 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
25396 break;
25399 /* Emit its type. */
25400 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
25402 /* And its containing namespace. */
25403 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
25405 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
25406 break;
25408 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25409 #if 0
25410 /* FIXME */
25411 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
25412 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
25413 if (current_function_decl != decl)
25414 /* This is only a declaration. */;
25415 #endif
25417 /* We should have abstract copies already and should not generate
25418 stray type DIEs in late LTO dumping. */
25419 if (! early_dwarf)
25422 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
25423 else if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
25424 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
25425 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
25426 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
25428 /* If we're emitting a possibly inlined function emit it as
25429 abstract instance. */
25430 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
25431 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
25432 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
25433 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
25434 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
25435 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
25436 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25437 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
25439 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
25440 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25442 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
25443 have its containing type. */
25444 if (!origin)
25445 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
25446 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
25447 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
25449 /* And its return type. */
25450 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
25452 /* And its virtual context. */
25453 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25454 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
25456 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
25457 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
25458 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
25460 /* And its containing namespace. */
25461 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
25464 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
25465 if (decl)
25466 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
25467 break;
25469 case TYPE_DECL:
25470 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25471 actual typedefs. */
25472 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25473 break;
25475 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
25476 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
25477 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
25478 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
25479 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
25480 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
25481 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
25482 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
25483 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
25484 case. */
25485 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25486 break;
25488 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
25489 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
25490 else
25491 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
25492 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
25493 break;
25495 case LABEL_DECL:
25496 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
25497 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
25498 break;
25500 case VAR_DECL:
25501 case RESULT_DECL:
25502 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25503 variable declarations or definitions. */
25504 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25505 break;
25507 /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
25508 All types have been dumped early. */
25509 if (early_dwarf
25510 /* ??? But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
25511 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
25512 references to them. Dump them again as happens for inlining
25513 which copies both the decl and the types. */
25514 /* ??? And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
25515 in VLA bound information for example. */
25516 || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
25517 current_function_decl)))
25519 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
25520 object. */
25521 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
25522 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
25523 else
25524 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
25527 if (early_dwarf)
25529 /* And its containing type. */
25530 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
25531 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
25532 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
25534 /* And its containing namespace. */
25535 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
25538 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
25539 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
25540 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
25541 function. */
25542 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
25543 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
25544 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
25545 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
25546 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
25547 context_die);
25548 else
25549 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
25550 break;
25552 case FIELD_DECL:
25553 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL && ctx->struct_type != NULL);
25554 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
25555 anonymous unions and structs. */
25556 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
25557 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
25558 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
25560 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
25561 gen_field_die (decl, ctx, context_die);
25563 break;
25565 case PARM_DECL:
25566 /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
25567 All types have been dumped early. */
25568 if (early_dwarf
25569 /* ??? But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
25570 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
25571 references to them. Dump them again as happens for inlining
25572 which copies both the decl and the types. */
25573 /* ??? And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
25574 in VLA bound information for example. */
25575 || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
25576 current_function_decl)))
25578 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
25579 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
25580 else
25581 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
25583 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
25584 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
25585 context_die);
25587 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25588 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25589 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
25590 break;
25592 case IMPORTED_DECL:
25593 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, DECL_NAME (decl),
25594 DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
25595 break;
25597 case NAMELIST_DECL:
25598 gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl), context_die,
25599 NAMELIST_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl));
25600 break;
25602 default:
25603 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
25604 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
25605 break;
25608 return NULL;
25611 /* Output initial debug information for global DECL. Called at the
25612 end of the parsing process.
25614 This is the initial debug generation process. As such, the DIEs
25615 generated may be incomplete. A later debug generation pass
25616 (dwarf2out_late_global_decl) will augment the information generated
25617 in this pass (e.g., with complete location info). */
25619 static void
25620 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree decl)
25622 set_early_dwarf s;
25624 /* gen_decl_die() will set DECL_ABSTRACT because
25625 cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p() returns true. This is in
25626 turn will cause DW_AT_inline attributes to be set.
25628 This happens because at early dwarf generation, there is no
25629 cgraph information, causing cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
25630 to return true. Trick cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
25631 while we generate dwarf early. */
25632 bool save = symtab->global_info_ready;
25633 symtab->global_info_ready = true;
25635 /* We don't handle TYPE_DECLs. If required, they'll be reached via
25636 other DECLs and they can point to template types or other things
25637 that dwarf2out can't handle when done via dwarf2out_decl. */
25638 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
25639 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
25641 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
25643 tree save_fndecl = current_function_decl;
25645 /* For nested functions, make sure we have DIEs for the parents first
25646 so that all nested DIEs are generated at the proper scope in the
25647 first shot. */
25648 tree context = decl_function_context (decl);
25649 if (context != NULL)
25651 dw_die_ref context_die = lookup_decl_die (context);
25652 current_function_decl = context;
25654 /* Avoid emitting DIEs multiple times, but still process CONTEXT
25655 enough so that it lands in its own context. This avoids type
25656 pruning issues later on. */
25657 if (context_die == NULL || is_declaration_die (context_die))
25658 dwarf2out_decl (context);
25661 /* Emit an abstract origin of a function first. This happens
25662 with C++ constructor clones for example and makes
25663 dwarf2out_abstract_function happy which requires the early
25664 DIE of the abstract instance to be present. */
25665 tree origin = DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
25666 dw_die_ref origin_die;
25667 if (origin != NULL
25668 /* Do not emit the DIE multiple times but make sure to
25669 process it fully here in case we just saw a declaration. */
25670 && ((origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin)) == NULL
25671 || is_declaration_die (origin_die)))
25673 current_function_decl = origin;
25674 dwarf2out_decl (origin);
25677 /* Emit the DIE for decl but avoid doing that multiple times. */
25678 dw_die_ref old_die;
25679 if ((old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl)) == NULL
25680 || is_declaration_die (old_die))
25682 current_function_decl = decl;
25683 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25686 current_function_decl = save_fndecl;
25688 else
25689 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25691 symtab->global_info_ready = save;
25694 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from
25695 toplev.c after compilation proper has finished. */
25697 static void
25698 dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree decl)
25700 /* Fill-in any location information we were unable to determine
25701 on the first pass. */
25702 if (VAR_P (decl) && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl))
25704 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25706 /* We may have to generate early debug late for LTO in case debug
25707 was not enabled at compile-time or the target doesn't support
25708 the LTO early debug scheme. */
25709 if (! die && in_lto_p)
25711 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25712 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25715 if (die)
25717 /* We get called via the symtab code invoking late_global_decl
25718 for symbols that are optimized out. Do not add locations
25719 for those, except if they have a DECL_VALUE_EXPR, in which case
25720 they are relevant for debuggers. */
25721 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (decl);
25722 if ((! node || ! node->definition) && ! DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl))
25723 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
25724 else
25725 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl, false);
25730 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
25731 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
25732 static void
25733 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
25735 if (!local)
25737 set_early_dwarf s;
25738 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25742 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
25743 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
25744 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
25745 that DECL belongs to.
25746 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
25747 static void
25748 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
25749 tree name,
25750 tree lexical_block,
25751 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
25753 expanded_location xloc;
25754 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
25755 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
25757 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
25759 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
25760 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
25761 gcc_assert (decl);
25763 else
25764 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
25766 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
25768 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
25769 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
25770 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
25771 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
25772 if (!at_import_die)
25774 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
25775 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
25776 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
25777 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
25780 else
25782 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25783 if (!at_import_die)
25785 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
25786 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
25787 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
25789 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
25791 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
25792 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
25793 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
25794 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
25795 return;
25796 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
25797 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
25799 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMELIST_DECL)
25800 at_import_die = gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl),
25801 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)),
25802 NULL_TREE);
25803 else
25804 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
25808 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25810 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25811 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
25812 lexical_block_die,
25813 lexical_block);
25814 else
25815 return;
25817 else
25818 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
25819 lexical_block_die,
25820 lexical_block);
25822 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
25823 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
25824 if (debug_column_info && xloc.column)
25825 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_column, xloc.column);
25826 if (name)
25827 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
25828 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25829 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
25832 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
25833 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
25834 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
25835 importing whole module.
25836 IMPLICIT is set if this hook is called for an implicit import
25837 such as inline namespace. */
25839 static void
25840 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
25841 bool child, bool implicit)
25843 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
25844 dw_die_ref scope_die;
25846 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25847 return;
25849 gcc_assert (decl);
25851 /* For DWARF5, just DW_AT_export_symbols on the DW_TAG_namespace
25852 should be enough, for DWARF4 and older even if we emit as extension
25853 DW_AT_export_symbols add the implicit DW_TAG_imported_module anyway
25854 for the benefit of consumers unaware of DW_AT_export_symbols. */
25855 if (implicit
25856 && dwarf_version >= 5
25857 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
25858 DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
25859 return;
25861 set_early_dwarf s;
25863 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
25864 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
25865 itself. */
25867 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
25868 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
25869 if (context
25870 && TYPE_P (context)
25871 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
25872 return;
25874 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
25876 if (child)
25878 /* DW_TAG_imported_module was introduced in the DWARFv3 specification, so
25879 there is nothing we can do, here. */
25880 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
25881 return;
25883 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
25884 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
25885 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
25886 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
25889 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
25890 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
25893 /* Output debug information for namelists. */
25895 static dw_die_ref
25896 gen_namelist_decl (tree name, dw_die_ref scope_die, tree item_decls)
25898 dw_die_ref nml_die, nml_item_die, nml_item_ref_die;
25899 tree value;
25900 unsigned i;
25902 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25903 return NULL;
25905 gcc_assert (scope_die != NULL);
25906 nml_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist, scope_die, NULL);
25907 add_AT_string (nml_die, DW_AT_name, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25909 /* If there are no item_decls, we have a nondefining namelist, e.g.
25910 with USE association; hence, set DW_AT_declaration. */
25911 if (item_decls == NULL_TREE)
25913 add_AT_flag (nml_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
25914 return nml_die;
25917 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (item_decls), i, value)
25919 nml_item_ref_die = lookup_decl_die (value);
25920 if (!nml_item_ref_die)
25921 nml_item_ref_die = force_decl_die (value);
25923 nml_item_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist_item, nml_die, NULL);
25924 add_AT_die_ref (nml_item_die, DW_AT_namelist_items, nml_item_ref_die);
25926 return nml_die;
25930 /* Write the debugging output for DECL and return the DIE. */
25932 static void
25933 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
25935 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
25937 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
25939 case ERROR_MARK:
25940 return;
25942 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25943 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
25944 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
25945 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
25946 if (decl_function_context (decl)
25947 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
25948 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25949 context_die = NULL;
25950 break;
25952 case VAR_DECL:
25953 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
25954 if (local_function_static (decl))
25955 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25957 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25958 variable declarations or definitions. */
25959 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25960 return;
25961 break;
25963 case CONST_DECL:
25964 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25965 return;
25966 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
25967 return;
25968 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
25969 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25970 break;
25972 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25973 case IMPORTED_DECL:
25974 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25975 return;
25976 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
25977 return;
25978 break;
25980 case TYPE_DECL:
25981 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
25982 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
25983 return;
25985 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
25986 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
25987 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
25988 return;
25990 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
25991 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25992 return;
25994 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
25995 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
25996 if (decl_function_context (decl))
25997 context_die = NULL;
25999 break;
26001 case NAMELIST_DECL:
26002 break;
26004 default:
26005 return;
26008 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
26010 if (flag_checking)
26012 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26013 if (die)
26014 check_die (die);
26018 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
26020 static void
26021 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
26023 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26024 call_arg_locations = NULL;
26025 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
26026 call_site_count = -1;
26027 tail_call_site_count = -1;
26028 decl_loc_table->empty ();
26029 cached_dw_loc_list_table->empty ();
26032 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
26033 a lexical block. */
26035 static void
26036 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26037 unsigned int blocknum)
26039 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26040 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
26043 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
26044 lexical block. */
26046 static void
26047 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
26049 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26050 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
26053 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
26054 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
26056 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
26057 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
26058 we may end up calling them anyway. */
26060 static bool
26061 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
26063 tree decl;
26064 unsigned int i;
26066 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
26067 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
26068 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
26069 return 0;
26070 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
26072 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
26073 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
26074 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
26075 return 0;
26078 return 1;
26081 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
26083 bool
26084 dwarf_file_hasher::equal (dwarf_file_data *p1, const char *p2)
26086 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
26089 hashval_t
26090 dwarf_file_hasher::hash (dwarf_file_data *p)
26092 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
26095 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
26096 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
26097 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
26098 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
26099 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
26100 and .debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
26101 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
26102 available unique index number. */
26104 static struct dwarf_file_data *
26105 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
26107 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
26109 if (!file_name)
26110 return NULL;
26112 dwarf_file_data **slot
26113 = file_table->find_slot_with_hash (file_name, htab_hash_string (file_name),
26114 INSERT);
26115 if (*slot)
26116 return *slot;
26118 created = ggc_alloc<dwarf_file_data> ();
26119 created->filename = file_name;
26120 created->emitted_number = 0;
26121 *slot = created;
26122 return created;
26125 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
26126 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
26127 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
26128 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
26129 types, which may include filenames. */
26131 static int
26132 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
26134 if (! fd->emitted_number)
26136 if (last_emitted_file)
26137 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
26138 else
26139 fd->emitted_number = 1;
26140 last_emitted_file = fd;
26142 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
26144 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
26145 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
26146 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
26147 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
26151 return fd->emitted_number;
26154 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
26155 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
26156 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
26158 static void
26159 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
26161 die_arg_entry entry;
26163 if (!die || !arg)
26164 return;
26166 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
26168 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
26169 vec_alloc (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, 32);
26171 entry.die = die;
26172 entry.arg = arg;
26173 vec_safe_push (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, entry);
26176 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
26177 otherwise. */
26179 static bool
26180 generic_type_p (tree t)
26182 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
26183 return false;
26184 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
26187 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
26188 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
26189 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
26191 static void
26192 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
26194 if (!generic_type_p (t))
26195 return;
26197 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
26199 if (!generic_type_instances)
26200 vec_alloc (generic_type_instances, 256);
26202 vec_safe_push (generic_type_instances, t);
26205 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
26206 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
26207 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
26209 static void
26210 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
26212 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
26214 unsigned i, j;
26215 die_arg_entry *e;
26217 /* We do this in two phases - first get the cases we can
26218 handle during early-finish, preserving those we cannot
26219 (containing symbolic constants where we don't yet know
26220 whether we are going to output the referenced symbols).
26221 For those we try again at late-finish. */
26222 j = 0;
26223 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
26225 if (!e->die->removed
26226 && !tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg))
26228 dw_loc_descr_ref loc = NULL;
26229 if (! early_dwarf
26230 && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
26231 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (e->arg, 2, NULL);
26232 if (loc)
26233 add_AT_loc (e->die, DW_AT_location, loc);
26234 else
26235 (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table)[j++] = *e;
26238 tmpl_value_parm_die_table->truncate (j);
26242 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
26243 that have been previously scheduled by
26244 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
26245 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
26247 static void
26248 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
26250 unsigned i;
26251 tree t;
26253 if (!generic_type_instances)
26254 return;
26256 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*generic_type_instances, i, t)
26257 if (COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t))
26258 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
26260 generic_type_instances = NULL;
26264 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
26266 static void
26267 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
26269 dw_die_ref die;
26270 dw_attr_node *attr;
26271 const char *dname;
26273 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
26274 if (!die)
26275 return;
26277 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
26278 if (!dname)
26279 return;
26281 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
26282 if (attr)
26284 struct indirect_string_node *node;
26286 node = find_AT_string (dname);
26287 /* replace the string. */
26288 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
26291 else
26292 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
26295 /* True if before or during processing of the first function being emitted. */
26296 static bool in_first_function_p = true;
26297 /* True if loc_note during dwarf2out_var_location call might still be
26298 before first real instruction at address equal to .Ltext0. */
26299 static bool maybe_at_text_label_p = true;
26300 /* One above highest N where .LVLN label might be equal to .Ltext0 label. */
26301 static unsigned int first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label;
26303 /* Look ahead for a real insn, or for a begin stmt marker. */
26305 static rtx_insn *
26306 dwarf2out_next_real_insn (rtx_insn *loc_note)
26308 rtx_insn *next_real = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
26310 while (next_real)
26311 if (INSN_P (next_real))
26312 break;
26313 else
26314 next_real = NEXT_INSN (next_real);
26316 return next_real;
26319 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
26320 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
26321 our lookup table. */
26323 static void
26324 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *loc_note)
26326 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
26327 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
26328 rtx_insn *next_real, *next_note;
26329 rtx_insn *call_insn = NULL;
26330 static const char *last_label;
26331 static const char *last_postcall_label;
26332 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
26333 static rtx_insn *expected_next_loc_note;
26334 tree decl;
26335 bool var_loc_p;
26337 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
26339 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
26341 call_site_count++;
26342 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26343 tail_call_site_count++;
26344 if (optimize == 0 && !flag_var_tracking)
26346 /* When the var-tracking pass is not running, there is no note
26347 for indirect calls whose target is compile-time known. In this
26348 case, process such calls specifically so that we generate call
26349 sites for them anyway. */
26350 rtx x = PATTERN (loc_note);
26351 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
26352 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
26353 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
26354 x = SET_SRC (x);
26355 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL)
26356 x = XEXP (x, 0);
26357 if (!MEM_P (x)
26358 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
26359 || !SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
26360 || (TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0)))
26361 != FUNCTION_DECL))
26363 call_insn = loc_note;
26364 loc_note = NULL;
26365 var_loc_p = false;
26367 next_real = dwarf2out_next_real_insn (call_insn);
26368 next_note = NULL;
26369 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
26370 goto create_label;
26374 return;
26377 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
26378 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
26379 return;
26381 /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
26382 notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn. If the
26383 next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
26384 calculation for next time. */
26385 next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
26386 if (next_real)
26388 if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
26389 next_real = NULL;
26392 next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
26393 if (! next_note
26394 || next_note->deleted ()
26395 || ! NOTE_P (next_note)
26396 || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
26397 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_BEGIN_STMT
26398 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION))
26399 next_note = NULL;
26401 if (! next_real)
26402 next_real = dwarf2out_next_real_insn (loc_note);
26404 if (next_note)
26406 expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
26407 cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
26409 else
26410 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
26412 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
26413 don't do anything. */
26414 if (var_loc_p
26415 && next_real == NULL_RTX
26416 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26417 return;
26419 create_label:
26421 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
26422 next_real = get_last_insn ();
26424 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
26425 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
26426 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
26427 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
26428 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
26429 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
26431 last_label = NULL;
26432 last_postcall_label = NULL;
26435 if (var_loc_p)
26437 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
26438 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
26439 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
26440 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
26441 if (newloc == NULL)
26442 return;
26444 else
26446 decl = NULL_TREE;
26447 newloc = NULL;
26450 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
26451 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
26452 create a new label and emit it. */
26453 if (last_label == NULL)
26455 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
26456 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
26457 loclabel_num++;
26458 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
26459 /* See if loclabel might be equal to .Ltext0. If yes,
26460 bump first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label. */
26461 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
26462 && in_first_function_p
26463 && maybe_at_text_label_p)
26465 static rtx_insn *last_start;
26466 rtx_insn *insn;
26467 for (insn = loc_note; insn; insn = previous_insn (insn))
26468 if (insn == last_start)
26469 break;
26470 else if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
26471 continue;
26472 else
26474 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
26475 if (GET_CODE (body) == USE || GET_CODE (body) == CLOBBER)
26476 continue;
26477 /* Inline asm could occupy zero bytes. */
26478 else if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT
26479 || asm_noperands (body) >= 0)
26480 continue;
26481 #ifdef HAVE_attr_length
26482 else if (get_attr_min_length (insn) == 0)
26483 continue;
26484 #endif
26485 else
26487 /* Assume insn has non-zero length. */
26488 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
26489 break;
26492 if (maybe_at_text_label_p)
26494 last_start = loc_note;
26495 first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label = loclabel_num;
26500 gcc_assert ((loc_note == NULL_RTX && call_insn != NULL_RTX)
26501 || (loc_note != NULL_RTX && call_insn == NULL_RTX));
26503 if (!var_loc_p)
26505 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
26506 = ggc_cleared_alloc<call_arg_loc_node> ();
26507 rtx_insn *prev
26508 = loc_note != NULL_RTX ? prev_real_insn (loc_note) : call_insn;
26510 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note = loc_note;
26511 ca_loc->next = NULL;
26512 ca_loc->label = last_label;
26513 gcc_assert (prev
26514 && (CALL_P (prev)
26515 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
26516 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
26517 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
26518 if (!CALL_P (prev))
26519 prev = as_a <rtx_sequence *> (PATTERN (prev))->insn (0);
26520 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
26522 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF in the "prev" instruction. */
26523 rtx x = get_call_rtx_from (PATTERN (prev));
26524 if (x)
26526 /* Try to get the call symbol, if any. */
26527 if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
26528 x = XEXP (x, 0);
26529 /* First, look for a memory access to a symbol_ref. */
26530 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
26531 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
26532 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))) == FUNCTION_DECL)
26533 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (x, 0);
26534 /* Otherwise, look at a compile-time known user-level function
26535 declaration. */
26536 else if (MEM_P (x)
26537 && MEM_EXPR (x)
26538 && TREE_CODE (MEM_EXPR (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
26539 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (DECL_RTL (MEM_EXPR (x)), 0);
26542 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
26543 if (call_arg_locations)
26544 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
26545 else
26546 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
26547 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
26549 else if (loc_note != NULL_RTX && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26550 newloc->label = last_label;
26551 else
26553 if (!last_postcall_label)
26555 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
26556 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
26558 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
26561 if (var_loc_p && flag_debug_asm)
26563 const char *name = NULL, *sep = " => ", *patstr = NULL;
26564 if (decl && DECL_NAME (decl))
26565 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl));
26566 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
26567 patstr = str_pattern_slim (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note));
26568 else
26570 sep = " ";
26571 patstr = "RESET";
26573 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s DEBUG %s%s%s\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
26574 name, sep, patstr);
26577 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
26578 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
26581 /* Called from finalize_size_functions for size functions so that their body
26582 can be encoded in the debug info to describe the layout of variable-length
26583 structures. */
26585 static void
26586 dwarf2out_size_function (tree decl)
26588 function_to_dwarf_procedure (decl);
26591 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
26594 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (var_loc_list **slot, void *)
26596 var_loc_list *list = *slot;
26597 if (list->first)
26598 list->last_before_switch
26599 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
26600 return 1;
26603 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
26605 static void
26606 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
26608 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
26609 return;
26611 decl_loc_table->traverse<void *, var_location_switch_text_section_1> (NULL);
26614 /* Create a new line number table. */
26616 static dw_line_info_table *
26617 new_line_info_table (void)
26619 dw_line_info_table *table;
26621 table = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_line_info_table> ();
26622 table->file_num = 1;
26623 table->line_num = 1;
26624 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
26626 return table;
26629 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
26630 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
26632 static void
26633 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
26635 dw_line_info_table *table;
26637 if (sec == text_section)
26638 table = text_section_line_info;
26639 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
26641 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
26642 if (!table)
26644 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
26645 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
26648 else
26650 const char *end_label;
26652 if (crtl->has_bb_partition)
26654 if (in_cold_section_p)
26655 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
26656 else
26657 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
26659 else
26661 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
26662 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
26663 current_function_funcdef_no);
26664 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
26667 table = new_line_info_table ();
26668 table->end_label = end_label;
26670 vec_safe_push (separate_line_info, table);
26673 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
26674 table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
26675 ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
26676 : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
26677 cur_line_info_table = table;
26681 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
26682 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
26683 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
26684 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
26686 static void
26687 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
26689 section *sec = function_section (fun);
26691 if (sec != text_section)
26692 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
26694 if (crtl->has_bb_partition && !cold_text_section)
26696 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
26697 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
26698 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
26699 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
26700 switch_to_section (sec);
26703 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
26704 call_site_count = 0;
26705 tail_call_site_count = 0;
26707 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
26710 /* Helper function of dwarf2out_end_function, called only after emitting
26711 the very first function into assembly. Check if some .debug_loc range
26712 might end with a .LVL* label that could be equal to .Ltext0.
26713 In that case we must force using absolute addresses in .debug_loc ranges,
26714 because this range could be .LVLN-.Ltext0 .. .LVLM-.Ltext0 for
26715 .LVLN == .LVLM == .Ltext0, thus 0 .. 0, which is a .debug_loc
26716 list terminator.
26717 Set have_multiple_function_sections to true in that case and
26718 terminate htab traversal. */
26721 find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label (var_loc_list **slot, int)
26723 var_loc_list *entry = *slot;
26724 struct var_loc_node *node;
26726 node = entry->first;
26727 if (node && node->next && node->next->label)
26729 unsigned int i;
26730 const char *label = node->next->label;
26731 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
26733 for (i = 0; i < first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label; i++)
26735 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", i);
26736 if (strcmp (label, loclabel) == 0)
26738 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
26739 return 0;
26743 return 1;
26746 /* Hook called after emitting a function into assembly.
26747 This does something only for the very first function emitted. */
26749 static void
26750 dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int)
26752 if (in_first_function_p
26753 && !have_multiple_function_sections
26754 && first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label
26755 && decl_loc_table)
26756 decl_loc_table->traverse<int, find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label> (0);
26757 in_first_function_p = false;
26758 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
26761 /* Temporary holder for dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit. Used to let
26762 front-ends register a translation unit even before dwarf2out_init is
26763 called. */
26764 static tree main_translation_unit = NULL_TREE;
26766 /* Hook called by front-ends after they built their main translation unit.
26767 Associate comp_unit_die to UNIT. */
26769 static void
26770 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit)
26772 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (unit) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
26773 && main_translation_unit == NULL_TREE);
26774 main_translation_unit = unit;
26775 /* If dwarf2out_init has not been called yet, it will perform the association
26776 itself looking at main_translation_unit. */
26777 if (decl_die_table != NULL)
26778 equate_decl_number_to_die (unit, comp_unit_die ());
26781 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
26783 static void
26784 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
26785 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
26787 dw_line_info_entry e;
26788 e.opcode = opcode;
26789 e.val = val;
26790 vec_safe_push (table->entries, e);
26793 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
26794 and record information relating to this source line, in
26795 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
26796 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
26798 static void
26799 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, unsigned int column,
26800 const char *filename,
26801 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
26803 unsigned int file_num;
26804 dw_line_info_table *table;
26806 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE || line == 0)
26807 return;
26809 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
26810 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
26811 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
26812 discriminator = 0;
26814 if (!debug_column_info)
26815 column = 0;
26817 table = cur_line_info_table;
26818 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
26820 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
26821 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
26822 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
26823 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
26824 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
26825 that second line number entry. */
26826 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
26827 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
26828 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
26829 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to precede the first insn
26830 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
26831 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
26832 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
26834 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
26835 && line == table->line_num
26836 && column == table->column_num
26837 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
26838 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
26839 return;
26841 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26843 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
26844 if (flag_debug_asm)
26846 if (debug_column_info)
26847 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
26848 filename, line, column);
26849 else
26850 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
26851 filename, line);
26854 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
26856 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
26857 /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
26858 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
26859 fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
26860 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
26861 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
26862 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
26863 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
26864 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, column);
26866 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
26868 fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
26869 putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
26871 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
26873 gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
26874 fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
26875 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
26877 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
26879 else
26881 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
26883 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
26885 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
26886 if (file_num != table->file_num)
26887 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
26888 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
26889 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
26890 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
26891 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
26892 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
26893 if (debug_column_info)
26894 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_column, column);
26897 table->file_num = file_num;
26898 table->line_num = line;
26899 table->column_num = column;
26900 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
26901 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
26902 table->in_use = true;
26905 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
26907 static void
26908 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
26910 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26912 macinfo_entry e;
26913 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
26914 e.lineno = lineno;
26915 e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
26916 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26920 /* Record the end of a source file. */
26922 static void
26923 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26925 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26927 macinfo_entry e;
26928 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
26929 e.lineno = lineno;
26930 e.info = NULL;
26931 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26935 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
26936 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
26937 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
26939 static void
26940 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26941 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26943 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26945 macinfo_entry e;
26946 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
26947 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import. */
26948 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
26950 e.code = 0;
26951 e.lineno = 0;
26952 e.info = NULL;
26953 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26955 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
26956 e.lineno = lineno;
26957 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
26958 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26962 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
26963 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
26964 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
26966 static void
26967 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26968 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26970 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26972 macinfo_entry e;
26973 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
26974 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import. */
26975 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
26977 e.code = 0;
26978 e.lineno = 0;
26979 e.info = NULL;
26980 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26982 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
26983 e.lineno = lineno;
26984 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
26985 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26989 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
26991 struct macinfo_entry_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <macinfo_entry>
26993 static inline hashval_t hash (const macinfo_entry *);
26994 static inline bool equal (const macinfo_entry *, const macinfo_entry *);
26997 inline hashval_t
26998 macinfo_entry_hasher::hash (const macinfo_entry *entry)
27000 return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
27003 inline bool
27004 macinfo_entry_hasher::equal (const macinfo_entry *entry1,
27005 const macinfo_entry *entry2)
27007 return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
27010 typedef hash_table<macinfo_entry_hasher> macinfo_hash_type;
27012 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry. */
27014 static void
27015 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
27017 int file_num;
27018 size_t len;
27019 struct indirect_string_node *node;
27020 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27021 struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
27023 switch (ref->code)
27025 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
27026 fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
27027 file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
27028 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
27029 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
27030 "Included from line number %lu",
27031 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
27032 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
27033 break;
27034 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
27035 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
27036 break;
27037 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27038 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27039 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
27040 if (!dwarf_strict
27041 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
27042 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
27043 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
27045 ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
27046 ? DW_MACRO_define_strp : DW_MACRO_undef_strp;
27047 output_macinfo_op (ref);
27048 return;
27050 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
27051 ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
27052 ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
27053 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
27054 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
27055 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
27056 break;
27057 case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
27058 case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
27059 node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
27060 gcc_assert (node
27061 && (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
27062 || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index));
27063 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
27064 ref->code == DW_MACRO_define_strp
27065 ? "Define macro strp"
27066 : "Undefine macro strp");
27067 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
27068 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
27069 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
27070 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
27071 debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
27072 ref->info);
27073 else
27074 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (node->index, "The macro: \"%s\"",
27075 ref->info);
27076 break;
27077 case DW_MACRO_import:
27078 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Import");
27079 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
27080 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
27081 ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
27082 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
27083 break;
27084 default:
27085 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
27086 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
27087 break;
27091 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
27092 other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections. IDX is the first
27093 index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
27094 emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
27095 a DW_MACRO_import entry referencing it.
27096 If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0. */
27098 static unsigned
27099 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files,
27100 macinfo_hash_type **macinfo_htab)
27102 macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
27103 char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
27104 unsigned char checksum[16];
27105 struct md5_ctx ctx;
27106 char *grp_name, *tail;
27107 const char *base;
27108 unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
27109 macinfo_entry **slot;
27111 first = &(*macinfo_table)[idx];
27112 second = &(*macinfo_table)[idx + 1];
27114 /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
27115 and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
27116 with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
27117 in some included header file. */
27118 if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
27119 return 0;
27120 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
27122 if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
27123 return 0;
27125 else if (first->lineno == 0)
27126 return 0;
27128 /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
27129 with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
27130 codes, linenumbers and strings. */
27131 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
27132 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur); i++)
27133 if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
27134 break;
27135 else if (vec_safe_is_empty (files) && cur->lineno > 1)
27136 break;
27137 else
27139 unsigned char code = cur->code;
27140 md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
27141 checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
27142 md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
27144 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
27145 count = i - idx;
27147 /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
27148 usable characters from its basename. */
27149 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
27150 base = "";
27151 else
27152 base = lbasename (files->last ().info);
27153 for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
27154 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
27155 encoded_filename_len++;
27156 /* Count . at the end. */
27157 if (encoded_filename_len)
27158 encoded_filename_len++;
27160 sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
27161 linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
27163 /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum> */
27164 grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
27165 + 16 * 2 + 1);
27166 memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
27167 tail = grp_name + 4;
27168 if (encoded_filename_len)
27170 for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
27171 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
27172 *tail++ = base[i];
27173 *tail++ = '.';
27175 memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
27176 tail += linebuf_len;
27177 *tail++ = '.';
27178 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
27179 sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
27181 /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_import
27182 in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef. */
27183 inc = &(*macinfo_table)[idx - 1];
27184 inc->code = DW_MACRO_import;
27185 inc->lineno = 0;
27186 inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
27187 if (!*macinfo_htab)
27188 *macinfo_htab = new macinfo_hash_type (10);
27189 /* Avoid emitting duplicates. */
27190 slot = (*macinfo_htab)->find_slot (inc, INSERT);
27191 if (*slot != NULL)
27193 inc->code = 0;
27194 inc->info = NULL;
27195 /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
27196 a DW_MACRO_import op. */
27197 inc = *slot;
27198 output_macinfo_op (inc);
27199 /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
27200 in the second pass. */
27201 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur) && i < idx + count; i++)
27203 cur->code = 0;
27204 cur->info = NULL;
27207 else
27209 *slot = inc;
27210 inc->lineno = (*macinfo_htab)->elements ();
27211 output_macinfo_op (inc);
27213 return count;
27216 /* Save any strings needed by the macinfo table in the debug str
27217 table. All strings must be collected into the table by the time
27218 index_string is called. */
27220 static void
27221 save_macinfo_strings (void)
27223 unsigned len;
27224 unsigned i;
27225 macinfo_entry *ref;
27227 for (i = 0; macinfo_table && macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27229 switch (ref->code)
27231 /* Match the logic in output_macinfo_op to decide on
27232 indirect strings. */
27233 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27234 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27235 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
27236 if (!dwarf_strict
27237 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
27238 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
27239 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
27240 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
27241 break;
27242 case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
27243 case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
27244 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
27245 break;
27246 default:
27247 break;
27252 /* Output macinfo section(s). */
27254 static void
27255 output_macinfo (const char *debug_line_label, bool early_lto_debug)
27257 unsigned i;
27258 unsigned long length = vec_safe_length (macinfo_table);
27259 macinfo_entry *ref;
27260 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files = NULL;
27261 macinfo_hash_type *macinfo_htab = NULL;
27262 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27264 if (! length)
27265 return;
27267 /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably. */
27268 gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_define
27269 && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_undef
27270 && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_start_file
27271 && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_end_file);
27273 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
27274 offset expected by debuggers. */
27275 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_label);
27276 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
27277 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
27279 /* For .debug_macro emit the section header. */
27280 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
27282 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
27283 "DWARF macro version number");
27284 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
27285 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
27286 else
27287 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
27288 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_line_label,
27289 debug_line_section, NULL);
27292 /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
27293 and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
27294 If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
27295 DW_MACRO_import, the DW_MACRO_import op is emitted and kept in
27296 the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
27297 whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept. */
27298 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27300 switch (ref->code)
27302 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
27303 vec_safe_push (files, *ref);
27304 break;
27305 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
27306 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (files))
27307 files->pop ();
27308 break;
27309 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27310 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27311 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
27312 && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
27313 && vec_safe_length (files) != 1
27314 && i > 0
27315 && i + 1 < length
27316 && (*macinfo_table)[i - 1].code == 0)
27318 unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
27319 if (count)
27321 i += count - 1;
27322 continue;
27325 break;
27326 case 0:
27327 /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
27328 to optimize the whole block of predefined macros. */
27329 if (i == 0)
27330 continue;
27331 default:
27332 break;
27334 output_macinfo_op (ref);
27335 ref->info = NULL;
27336 ref->code = 0;
27339 if (!macinfo_htab)
27340 return;
27342 /* Save the number of transparent includes so we can adjust the
27343 label number for the fat LTO object DWARF. */
27344 unsigned macinfo_label_base_adj = macinfo_htab->elements ();
27346 delete macinfo_htab;
27347 macinfo_htab = NULL;
27349 /* If any DW_MACRO_import were used, on those DW_MACRO_import entries
27350 terminate the current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
27351 section and emit the define/undef entries within it. */
27352 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27353 switch (ref->code)
27355 case 0:
27356 continue;
27357 case DW_MACRO_import:
27359 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27360 tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
27361 /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section. */
27362 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
27363 targetm.asm_out.named_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27364 SECTION_DEBUG
27365 | SECTION_LINKONCE
27366 | (early_lto_debug
27367 ? SECTION_EXCLUDE : 0),
27368 comdat_key);
27369 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
27370 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
27371 ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
27372 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
27373 ref->code = 0;
27374 ref->info = NULL;
27375 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
27376 "DWARF macro version number");
27377 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
27378 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
27379 else
27380 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
27382 break;
27383 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27384 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27385 output_macinfo_op (ref);
27386 ref->code = 0;
27387 ref->info = NULL;
27388 break;
27389 default:
27390 gcc_unreachable ();
27393 macinfo_label_base += macinfo_label_base_adj;
27396 /* Initialize the various sections and labels for dwarf output and prefix
27397 them with PREFIX if non-NULL. Returns the generation (zero based
27398 number of times function was called). */
27400 static unsigned
27401 init_sections_and_labels (bool early_lto_debug)
27403 /* As we may get called multiple times have a generation count for
27404 labels. */
27405 static unsigned generation = 0;
27407 if (early_lto_debug)
27409 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27411 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
27412 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27413 NULL);
27414 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27415 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27416 NULL);
27417 debug_macinfo_section_name
27418 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27419 ? DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION);
27420 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27421 SECTION_DEBUG
27422 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27423 /* For macro info we have to refer to a debug_line section, so
27424 similar to split-dwarf emit a skeleton one for early debug. */
27425 debug_skeleton_line_section
27426 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
27427 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27428 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27429 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27430 generation);
27432 else
27434 /* ??? Which of the following do we need early? */
27435 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
27436 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27437 NULL);
27438 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27439 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27440 NULL);
27441 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
27442 SECTION_DEBUG
27443 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27444 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section
27445 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27446 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27447 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
27448 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
27449 generation);
27451 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
27452 stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the split
27453 off dwo. */
27454 debug_skeleton_line_section
27455 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
27456 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27457 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27458 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27459 generation);
27460 debug_str_offsets_section
27461 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
27462 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27463 NULL);
27464 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
27465 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
27466 generation);
27467 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION,
27468 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
27469 NULL);
27470 debug_macinfo_section_name
27471 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27472 ? DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
27473 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27474 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27475 NULL);
27477 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION,
27478 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS
27479 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27480 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
27481 debug_line_str_section
27482 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION,
27483 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27485 else
27487 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27489 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
27490 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27491 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
27492 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27493 debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27494 ? DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
27495 : DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
27496 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27497 debug_macinfo_section_name
27498 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27499 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION);
27500 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27501 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27503 else
27505 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
27506 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27507 NULL);
27508 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27509 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27510 NULL);
27511 debug_addr_section = get_section (DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION,
27512 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27513 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
27514 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27515 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
27516 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27517 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
27518 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
27519 generation);
27521 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
27522 stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the
27523 split off dwo. */
27524 debug_skeleton_line_section
27525 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION,
27526 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27527 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27528 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27529 generation);
27530 debug_str_offsets_section
27531 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
27532 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27533 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
27534 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
27535 generation);
27536 debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27537 ? DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
27538 : DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION,
27539 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27540 NULL);
27541 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION,
27542 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
27543 NULL);
27544 debug_macinfo_section_name
27545 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27546 ? DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
27547 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27548 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27549 NULL);
27551 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
27552 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27553 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
27554 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27555 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
27556 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27557 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
27558 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27559 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
27560 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
27561 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
27562 debug_line_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION,
27563 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
27564 debug_ranges_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27565 ? DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
27566 : DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
27567 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27568 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
27569 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27572 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
27573 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27574 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
27575 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27576 info_section_emitted = false;
27577 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
27578 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27579 /* There are up to 4 unique ranges labels per generation.
27580 See also output_rnglists. */
27581 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
27582 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, generation * 4);
27583 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
27584 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_base_label,
27585 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
27586 1 + generation * 4);
27587 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_addr_section_label,
27588 DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27589 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
27590 (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27591 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
27592 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27593 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL,
27594 generation);
27596 ++generation;
27597 return generation - 1;
27600 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
27602 static void
27603 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
27605 /* Allocate the file_table. */
27606 file_table = hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher>::create_ggc (50);
27608 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27609 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
27610 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27612 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
27613 decl_loc_table = hash_table<decl_loc_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27615 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
27616 cached_dw_loc_list_table = hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27618 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
27619 vec_alloc (decl_scope_table, 256);
27621 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
27622 vec_alloc (abbrev_die_table, 256);
27623 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
27624 abbrev_die_table->quick_push (NULL);
27626 /* Allocate the dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map. */
27627 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = new hash_map<dw_die_ref, int>;
27629 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
27630 vec_alloc (pubname_table, 32);
27631 vec_alloc (pubtype_table, 32);
27633 vec_alloc (incomplete_types, 64);
27635 vec_alloc (used_rtx_array, 32);
27637 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
27638 vec_alloc (macinfo_table, 64);
27639 #endif
27641 /* If front-ends already registered a main translation unit but we were not
27642 ready to perform the association, do this now. */
27643 if (main_translation_unit != NULL_TREE)
27644 equate_decl_number_to_die (main_translation_unit, comp_unit_die ());
27647 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
27648 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
27650 static void
27651 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
27653 if (text_section_line_info)
27654 return;
27656 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27657 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
27658 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
27659 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
27660 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
27661 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
27663 switch_to_section (text_section);
27664 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
27665 #endif
27667 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
27668 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
27669 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
27671 #ifdef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27672 cur_line_info_table = text_section_line_info;
27673 #endif
27675 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
27676 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
27677 && !dwarf2out_do_eh_frame ())
27678 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
27681 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27682 htab_traverse. Assign a string its index. All strings must be
27683 collected into the table by the time index_string is called,
27684 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
27685 in the same order for each run. */
27688 index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *index)
27690 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27692 find_string_form (node);
27693 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27695 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
27696 node->index = *index;
27697 *index += 1;
27699 return 1;
27702 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings called through
27703 htab_traverse. Output the offset to a string and update the
27704 current offset. */
27707 output_index_string_offset (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *offset)
27709 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27711 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27713 /* Assert that this node has been assigned an index. */
27714 gcc_assert (node->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
27715 && node->index != NOT_INDEXED);
27716 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, *offset,
27717 "indexed string 0x%x: %s", node->index, node->str);
27718 *offset += strlen (node->str) + 1;
27720 return 1;
27723 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27724 htab_traverse. Output the indexed string. */
27727 output_index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *cur_idx)
27729 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27731 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27733 /* Assert that the strings are output in the same order as their
27734 indexes were assigned. */
27735 gcc_assert (*cur_idx == node->index);
27736 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
27737 *cur_idx += 1;
27739 return 1;
27742 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27743 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
27746 output_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, enum dwarf_form form)
27748 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27750 node->form = find_string_form (node);
27751 if (node->form == form && node->refcount > 0)
27753 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
27754 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
27757 return 1;
27760 /* Output the indexed string table. */
27762 static void
27763 output_indirect_strings (void)
27765 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
27766 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27767 debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
27768 output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
27769 else
27771 unsigned int offset = 0;
27772 unsigned int cur_idx = 0;
27774 skeleton_debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
27775 output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
27777 switch_to_section (debug_str_offsets_section);
27778 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
27779 <unsigned int *, output_index_string_offset> (&offset);
27780 switch_to_section (debug_str_dwo_section);
27781 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_index_string>
27782 (&cur_idx);
27786 /* Callback for htab_traverse to assign an index to an entry in the
27787 table, and to write that entry to the .debug_addr section. */
27790 output_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *cur_index)
27792 addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
27794 if (entry->refcount == 0)
27796 gcc_assert (entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
27797 || entry->index == NOT_INDEXED);
27798 return 1;
27801 gcc_assert (entry->index == *cur_index);
27802 (*cur_index)++;
27804 switch (entry->kind)
27806 case ate_kind_rtx:
27807 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.rtl,
27808 "0x%x", entry->index);
27809 break;
27810 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
27811 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
27812 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
27813 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
27814 entry->addr.rtl);
27815 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
27816 break;
27817 case ate_kind_label:
27818 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.label,
27819 "0x%x", entry->index);
27820 break;
27821 default:
27822 gcc_unreachable ();
27824 return 1;
27827 /* Produce the .debug_addr section. */
27829 static void
27830 output_addr_table (void)
27832 unsigned int index = 0;
27833 if (addr_index_table == NULL || addr_index_table->size () == 0)
27834 return;
27836 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
27837 addr_index_table
27838 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_addr_table_entry> (&index);
27841 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
27842 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
27844 static void
27845 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
27847 dw_die_ref c;
27849 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
27850 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
27852 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
27854 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
27855 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
27857 static void
27858 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
27860 dw_die_ref c;
27862 if (die->die_mark)
27863 die->die_mark = 0;
27864 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
27867 /* Given LOC that is referenced by a DIE we're marking as used, find all
27868 referenced DWARF procedures it references and mark them as used. */
27870 static void
27871 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
27873 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
27874 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
27876 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
27877 case DW_OP_convert:
27878 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
27879 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
27880 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
27881 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
27882 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
27883 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27884 break;
27885 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
27886 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
27888 dw_die_ref ref
27889 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
27890 if (ref == NULL)
27891 break;
27892 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
27893 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
27894 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
27896 /* FALLTHRU */
27897 case DW_OP_call2:
27898 case DW_OP_call4:
27899 case DW_OP_call_ref:
27900 case DW_OP_const_type:
27901 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
27902 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
27903 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
27904 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27905 break;
27906 case DW_OP_regval_type:
27907 case DW_OP_deref_type:
27908 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
27909 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
27910 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
27911 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27912 break;
27913 case DW_OP_entry_value:
27914 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
27915 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
27916 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
27917 break;
27918 default:
27919 break;
27923 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
27924 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
27926 static void
27927 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
27929 dw_attr_node *a;
27930 unsigned ix;
27932 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27934 switch (AT_class (a))
27936 /* Make sure DWARF procedures referenced by location descriptions will
27937 get emitted. */
27938 case dw_val_class_loc:
27939 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (AT_loc (a));
27940 break;
27941 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
27942 for (dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
27943 list != NULL;
27944 list = list->dw_loc_next)
27945 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (list->expr);
27946 break;
27948 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
27949 /* A reference to another DIE.
27950 Make sure that it will get emitted.
27951 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
27952 if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
27953 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
27954 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27955 break;
27957 case dw_val_class_str:
27958 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
27959 accounts properly for it. */
27960 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
27961 break;
27963 default:
27964 break;
27969 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
27971 static void
27972 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
27974 dw_die_ref c;
27976 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
27977 return;
27978 c = die->die_child;
27981 if (is_template_parameter (c))
27982 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
27983 c = c->die_sib;
27984 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
27987 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
27988 to DIE's children. */
27990 static void
27991 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
27993 dw_die_ref c;
27995 if (die->die_mark == 0)
27997 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
27998 die->die_mark = 1;
27999 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
28000 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
28001 args. */
28002 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
28004 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
28005 (But we don't want to mark our parent's kids due to this,
28006 unless it is a class.) */
28007 if (die->die_parent)
28008 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent,
28009 class_scope_p (die->die_parent));
28011 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
28012 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
28014 /* If this node is a specification,
28015 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
28016 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
28017 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
28020 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
28022 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
28023 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
28024 die->die_mark = 2;
28026 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
28027 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
28028 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
28029 for all type definitions. */
28030 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
28031 || (use_debug_types
28032 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
28033 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
28034 else
28035 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
28039 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
28040 and if so, mark them. */
28042 static void
28043 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
28045 dw_die_ref c;
28047 if (die->die_mark == 2)
28048 return;
28050 switch (die->die_tag)
28052 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
28053 case DW_TAG_union_type:
28054 case DW_TAG_class_type:
28055 break;
28057 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
28058 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
28059 || die->die_definition != NULL)
28060 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
28061 return;
28063 default:
28064 return;
28067 /* Mark children. */
28068 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
28071 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
28073 static void
28074 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
28076 dw_die_ref c;
28078 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
28079 children have been marked as well. */
28080 if (die->die_mark == 2)
28081 return;
28083 switch (die->die_tag)
28085 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
28086 case DW_TAG_union_type:
28087 case DW_TAG_class_type:
28088 if (die->die_perennial_p)
28089 break;
28091 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
28092 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
28093 break;
28095 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
28096 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
28097 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
28098 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
28099 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
28100 if (c)
28101 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
28103 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
28104 return;
28106 case DW_TAG_const_type:
28107 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
28108 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
28109 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
28110 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
28111 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
28112 case DW_TAG_typedef:
28113 case DW_TAG_array_type:
28114 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
28115 case DW_TAG_friend:
28116 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
28117 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
28118 case DW_TAG_string_type:
28119 case DW_TAG_set_type:
28120 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
28121 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
28122 case DW_TAG_file_type:
28123 /* Type nodes are useful only when other DIEs reference them --- don't
28124 mark them. */
28125 /* FALLTHROUGH */
28127 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
28128 /* Likewise for DWARF procedures. */
28130 if (die->die_perennial_p)
28131 break;
28133 return;
28135 default:
28136 /* Mark everything else. */
28137 break;
28140 if (die->die_mark == 0)
28142 die->die_mark = 1;
28144 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
28145 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
28148 die->die_mark = 2;
28150 /* Mark children. */
28151 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
28154 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
28155 attributes. */
28157 static void
28158 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
28160 dw_attr_node *a;
28161 unsigned ix;
28163 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
28164 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
28166 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
28167 s->refcount++;
28168 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
28169 twice in the hash table. */
28170 if (s->refcount
28171 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
28173 indirect_string_node **slot
28174 = debug_str_hash->find_slot_with_hash (s->str,
28175 htab_hash_string (s->str),
28176 INSERT);
28177 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
28178 *slot = s;
28183 /* Mark DIE and its children as removed. */
28185 static void
28186 mark_removed (dw_die_ref die)
28188 dw_die_ref c;
28189 die->removed = true;
28190 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_removed (c));
28193 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
28195 static void
28196 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
28198 dw_die_ref c;
28200 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
28201 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
28203 if (! die->die_child)
28204 return;
28206 c = die->die_child;
28207 do {
28208 dw_die_ref prev = c, next;
28209 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = next)
28210 if (c == die->die_child)
28212 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
28213 if (prev == c)
28214 /* No marked children at all. */
28215 die->die_child = NULL;
28216 else
28218 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
28219 die->die_child = prev;
28221 c->die_sib = NULL;
28222 mark_removed (c);
28223 return;
28225 else
28227 next = c->die_sib;
28228 c->die_sib = NULL;
28229 mark_removed (c);
28232 if (c != prev->die_sib)
28233 prev->die_sib = c;
28234 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
28235 } while (c != die->die_child);
28238 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
28240 static void
28241 prune_unused_types (void)
28243 unsigned int i;
28244 limbo_die_node *node;
28245 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
28246 pubname_entry *pub;
28247 dw_die_ref base_type;
28249 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
28250 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
28251 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
28252 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28253 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
28254 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28255 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
28256 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
28258 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
28259 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
28261 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
28262 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
28263 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28264 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
28265 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28267 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
28268 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
28271 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table. Enumerators
28272 are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
28273 They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
28274 not as roots in themselves. */
28275 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*pubname_table, i, pub)
28276 if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
28277 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
28278 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
28279 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
28281 /* For -fvar-tracking-assignments, also set the mark on nodes that could be
28282 referenced by DW_TAG_call_site DW_AT_call_origin (i.e. direct call
28283 callees). */
28284 cgraph_node *cnode;
28285 FOR_EACH_FUNCTION (cnode)
28286 if (cnode->referred_to_p (false))
28288 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (cnode->decl);
28289 if (die == NULL || die->die_mark)
28290 continue;
28291 for (cgraph_edge *e = cnode->callers; e; e = e->next_caller)
28292 if (e->caller != cnode
28293 && opt_for_fn (e->caller->decl, flag_var_tracking_assignments))
28295 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
28296 break;
28300 if (debug_str_hash)
28301 debug_str_hash->empty ();
28302 if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
28303 skeleton_debug_str_hash->empty ();
28304 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
28305 for (limbo_die_node **pnode = &limbo_die_list; *pnode; )
28307 node = *pnode;
28308 if (!node->die->die_mark)
28309 *pnode = node->next;
28310 else
28312 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
28313 pnode = &node->next;
28316 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28317 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
28319 /* Leave the marks clear. */
28320 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
28321 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28322 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
28323 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28324 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
28327 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
28329 struct comdat_type_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <comdat_type_node>
28331 static inline hashval_t hash (const comdat_type_node *);
28332 static inline bool equal (const comdat_type_node *, const comdat_type_node *);
28335 inline hashval_t
28336 comdat_type_hasher::hash (const comdat_type_node *type_node)
28338 hashval_t h;
28339 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
28340 return h;
28343 inline bool
28344 comdat_type_hasher::equal (const comdat_type_node *type_node_1,
28345 const comdat_type_node *type_node_2)
28347 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
28348 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
28351 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
28352 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
28353 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
28354 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
28355 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
28356 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
28358 static inline void
28359 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
28361 unsigned ix = vec_safe_length (die->die_attr);
28362 dw_attr_node linkage = (*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
28364 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
28365 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
28367 while (--ix > 0)
28369 dw_attr_node *prev = &(*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
28371 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line
28372 || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_column
28373 || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
28374 break;
28377 if (ix != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) - 1)
28379 die->die_attr->pop ();
28380 die->die_attr->quick_insert (ix, linkage);
28384 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
28385 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
28387 static void
28388 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28390 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
28392 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
28394 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
28396 case DW_OP_regval_type:
28397 case DW_OP_deref_type:
28398 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
28399 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
28400 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
28401 break;
28402 case DW_OP_convert:
28403 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
28404 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
28405 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
28406 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28407 continue;
28408 /* FALLTHRU */
28409 case DW_OP_const_type:
28410 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
28411 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28412 break;
28413 case DW_OP_entry_value:
28414 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
28415 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
28416 continue;
28417 default:
28418 continue;
28420 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
28421 if (base_type->die_mark)
28422 base_type->die_mark++;
28423 else
28425 base_types.safe_push (base_type);
28426 base_type->die_mark = 1;
28431 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
28433 static int
28434 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
28436 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
28437 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
28438 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
28439 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
28440 unsigned int align1, align2;
28441 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
28442 return -1;
28443 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
28444 return 1;
28445 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
28446 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
28447 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
28448 return 1;
28449 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
28450 return -1;
28451 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
28452 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
28453 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
28454 return 1;
28455 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
28456 return -1;
28457 align1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_alignment);
28458 align2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_alignment);
28459 if (align1 < align2)
28460 return 1;
28461 if (align1 > align2)
28462 return -1;
28463 return 0;
28466 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
28467 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
28468 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
28469 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
28470 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
28472 static void
28473 move_marked_base_types (void)
28475 unsigned int i;
28476 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
28478 if (base_types.is_empty ())
28479 return;
28481 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
28482 order later on. */
28483 base_types.qsort (base_type_cmp);
28484 die = comp_unit_die ();
28485 c = die->die_child;
28488 dw_die_ref prev = c;
28489 c = c->die_sib;
28490 while (c->die_mark)
28492 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
28493 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
28494 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
28495 gcc_assert (die->die_child != NULL);
28496 c = prev->die_sib;
28499 while (c != die->die_child);
28500 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
28501 c = die->die_child;
28502 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
28504 base_type->die_mark = 0;
28505 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
28506 c->die_sib = base_type;
28507 c = base_type;
28511 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
28512 one CONST_STRING, return true if successful. Similarly verify that
28513 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
28515 static bool
28516 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr)
28518 rtx rtl = *addr;
28520 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
28522 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
28523 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
28524 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
28525 TREE_TYPE (t)
28526 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
28527 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
28528 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
28529 return false;
28530 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
28531 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
28532 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
28533 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
28534 return false;
28535 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
28536 *addr = rtl;
28537 return true;
28540 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
28541 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
28543 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
28545 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
28546 return false;
28548 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
28549 return false;
28552 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
28554 subrtx_ptr_iterator::array_type array;
28555 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_PTR (iter, array, &XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
28556 if (!resolve_one_addr (*iter))
28557 return false;
28560 return true;
28563 /* For STRING_CST, return SYMBOL_REF of its constant pool entry,
28564 if possible, and create DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure that can be referenced
28565 from DW_OP_implicit_pointer if the string hasn't been seen yet. */
28567 static rtx
28568 string_cst_pool_decl (tree t)
28570 rtx rtl = output_constant_def (t, 1);
28571 unsigned char *array;
28572 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
28573 tree decl;
28574 size_t len;
28575 dw_die_ref ref;
28577 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
28578 return NULL_RTX;
28579 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
28580 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF
28581 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl) == NULL_TREE)
28582 return NULL_RTX;
28584 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28585 if (!lookup_decl_die (decl))
28587 len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (t);
28588 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
28589 ref = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, comp_unit_die (), decl);
28590 array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (len);
28591 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (t), len);
28592 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value, len, 0);
28593 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
28594 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = len;
28595 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 1;
28596 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
28597 add_AT_loc (ref, DW_AT_location, l);
28598 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, ref);
28600 return rtl;
28603 /* Helper function of resolve_addr_in_expr. LOC is
28604 a DW_OP_addr followed by DW_OP_stack_value, either at the start
28605 of exprloc or after DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, and val_addr can't be
28606 resolved. Replace it (both DW_OP_addr and DW_OP_stack_value)
28607 with DW_OP_implicit_pointer if possible
28608 and return true, if unsuccessful, return false. */
28610 static bool
28611 optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28613 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
28614 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
28615 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
28616 tree decl;
28618 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
28619 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == PLUS
28620 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1)))
28622 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1));
28623 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
28625 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
28627 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
28628 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
28629 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
28631 TREE_TYPE (t)
28632 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
28633 rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (t);
28634 if (!rtl)
28635 return false;
28637 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
28639 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28640 if (VAR_P (decl) && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
28642 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
28643 if (ref && (get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
28644 || get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
28646 loc->dw_loc_opc = dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer);
28647 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28648 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
28649 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28650 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28651 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
28652 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = offset;
28653 return true;
28657 return false;
28660 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
28661 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
28662 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
28664 static bool
28665 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28667 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
28668 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
28669 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
28671 case DW_OP_addr:
28672 if (!resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
28674 if ((prev == NULL
28675 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece
28676 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
28677 && loc->dw_loc_next
28678 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value
28679 && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
28680 && optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (loc))
28681 break;
28682 return false;
28684 break;
28685 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
28686 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
28687 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
28688 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_const_index && loc->dtprel))
28690 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->addr.rtl;
28691 if (!resolve_one_addr (&rtl))
28692 return false;
28693 remove_addr_table_entry (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
28694 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
28695 = add_addr_table_entry (rtl, ate_kind_rtx);
28697 break;
28698 case DW_OP_const4u:
28699 case DW_OP_const8u:
28700 if (loc->dtprel
28701 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
28702 return false;
28703 break;
28704 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
28705 if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
28706 > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
28708 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
28710 dw_loc_descr_ref repl
28711 = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
28712 add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
28713 add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
28714 *loc = *repl;
28716 break;
28717 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
28718 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
28719 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr))
28720 return false;
28721 break;
28722 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
28723 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
28724 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
28725 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
28726 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
28728 dw_die_ref ref
28729 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
28730 if (ref == NULL)
28731 return false;
28732 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28733 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28734 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28736 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value)
28738 if (prev == NULL
28739 && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL
28740 && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
28741 switch (a->dw_attr)
28743 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
28744 so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
28745 alone we could transform it into reference. */
28746 case DW_AT_byte_size:
28747 case DW_AT_bit_size:
28748 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
28749 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
28750 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
28751 case DW_AT_count:
28752 case DW_AT_allocated:
28753 case DW_AT_associated:
28754 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
28755 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28756 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
28757 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die
28758 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28759 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28760 return true;
28761 default:
28762 break;
28764 if (dwarf_strict)
28765 return false;
28767 break;
28768 case DW_OP_const_type:
28769 case DW_OP_regval_type:
28770 case DW_OP_deref_type:
28771 case DW_OP_convert:
28772 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
28773 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
28774 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
28775 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
28776 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
28777 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
28778 while (loc->dw_loc_next
28779 && (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_convert
28780 || loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert))
28782 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
28783 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
28784 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
28785 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
28786 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
28787 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
28788 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
28789 else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
28790 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28791 break;
28792 else
28793 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28794 if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
28795 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28796 break;
28797 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28798 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
28799 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
28800 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
28801 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
28802 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
28803 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
28804 if (size1 == size2
28805 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
28806 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
28807 && loc != keep)
28808 || enc1 == enc2))
28810 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_convert after
28811 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
28812 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
28813 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
28814 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
28815 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
28816 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
28817 else
28818 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
28819 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
28820 continue;
28822 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_convert after e.g. floating
28823 point typed stack entry. */
28824 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
28825 keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
28826 break;
28828 break;
28829 default:
28830 break;
28832 return true;
28835 /* Helper function of resolve_addr. DIE had DW_AT_location of
28836 DW_OP_addr alone, which referred to DECL in DW_OP_addr's operand
28837 and DW_OP_addr couldn't be resolved. resolve_addr has already
28838 removed the DW_AT_location attribute. This function attempts to
28839 add a new DW_AT_location attribute with DW_OP_implicit_pointer
28840 to it or DW_AT_const_value attribute, if possible. */
28842 static void
28843 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
28845 if (!VAR_P (decl)
28846 || lookup_decl_die (decl) != die
28847 || DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
28848 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
28849 || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
28850 || DECL_P (DECL_INITIAL (decl))
28851 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
28852 return;
28854 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
28855 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
28856 /* For variables that have been optimized away and thus
28857 don't have a memory location, see if we can emit
28858 DW_AT_const_value instead. */
28859 if (tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, init))
28860 return;
28861 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28862 return;
28863 /* If init is ADDR_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR of ADDR_EXPR,
28864 and ADDR_EXPR refers to a decl that has DW_AT_location or
28865 DW_AT_const_value (but isn't addressable, otherwise
28866 resolving the original DW_OP_addr wouldn't fail), see if
28867 we can add DW_OP_implicit_pointer. */
28868 STRIP_NOPS (init);
28869 if (TREE_CODE (init) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
28870 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1)))
28872 offset = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1));
28873 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
28874 STRIP_NOPS (init);
28876 if (TREE_CODE (init) != ADDR_EXPR)
28877 return;
28878 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST
28879 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)))
28880 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == VAR_DECL
28881 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))
28882 && TREE_OPERAND (init, 0) != decl))
28884 dw_die_ref ref;
28885 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
28887 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST)
28889 rtx rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0));
28890 if (!rtl)
28891 return;
28892 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28894 else
28895 decl = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
28896 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
28897 if (ref == NULL
28898 || (!get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
28899 && !get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
28900 return;
28901 l = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
28902 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28903 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28904 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28905 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, l);
28909 /* Return NULL if l is a DWARF expression, or first op that is not
28910 valid DWARF expression. */
28912 static dw_loc_descr_ref
28913 non_dwarf_expression (dw_loc_descr_ref l)
28915 while (l)
28917 if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
28918 return l;
28919 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
28921 case DW_OP_regx:
28922 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
28923 case DW_OP_stack_value:
28924 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
28925 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
28926 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
28927 case DW_OP_piece:
28928 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
28929 return l;
28930 default:
28931 break;
28933 l = l->dw_loc_next;
28935 return NULL;
28938 /* Return adjusted copy of EXPR:
28939 If it is empty DWARF expression, return it.
28940 If it is valid non-empty DWARF expression,
28941 return copy of EXPR with DW_OP_deref appended to it.
28942 If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_reg{N,x}, return
28943 copy of the DWARF expression with DW_OP_breg{N,x} <0> appended.
28944 If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_stack_value, return
28945 copy of the DWARF expression without anything appended.
28946 Otherwise, return NULL. */
28948 static dw_loc_descr_ref
28949 copy_deref_exprloc (dw_loc_descr_ref expr)
28951 dw_loc_descr_ref tail = NULL;
28953 if (expr == NULL)
28954 return NULL;
28956 dw_loc_descr_ref l = non_dwarf_expression (expr);
28957 if (l && l->dw_loc_next)
28958 return NULL;
28960 if (l)
28962 if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
28963 tail = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom)
28964 (DW_OP_breg0 + (l->dw_loc_opc - DW_OP_reg0)),
28965 0, 0);
28966 else
28967 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
28969 case DW_OP_regx:
28970 tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx,
28971 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned, 0);
28972 break;
28973 case DW_OP_stack_value:
28974 break;
28975 default:
28976 return NULL;
28979 else
28980 tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
28982 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, *p = &ret;
28983 while (expr != l)
28985 *p = new_loc_descr (expr->dw_loc_opc, 0, 0);
28986 (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd1 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd1;
28987 (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd2 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd2;
28988 p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
28989 expr = expr->dw_loc_next;
28991 *p = tail;
28992 return ret;
28995 /* For DW_AT_string_length attribute with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
28996 reference to a variable or argument, adjust it if needed and return:
28997 -1 if the DW_AT_string_length attribute and DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size
28998 attribute if present should be removed
28999 0 keep the attribute perhaps with minor modifications, no need to rescan
29000 1 if the attribute has been successfully adjusted. */
29002 static int
29003 optimize_string_length (dw_attr_node *a)
29005 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a), lv;
29006 dw_die_ref die;
29007 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
29009 tree decl = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
29010 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
29011 if (die)
29013 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29014 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
29015 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29017 else
29018 return -1;
29020 else
29021 die = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29023 /* DWARF5 allows reference class, so we can then reference the DIE.
29024 Only do this for DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value. */
29025 if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL && dwarf_version >= 5)
29027 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29028 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
29029 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
29030 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29031 return 0;
29034 dw_attr_node *av = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
29035 dw_loc_list_ref d;
29036 bool non_dwarf_expr = false;
29038 if (av == NULL)
29039 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
29040 switch (AT_class (av))
29042 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
29043 for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
29044 if (d->expr && non_dwarf_expression (d->expr))
29045 non_dwarf_expr = true;
29046 break;
29047 case dw_val_class_loc:
29048 lv = AT_loc (av);
29049 if (lv == NULL)
29050 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
29051 if (non_dwarf_expression (lv))
29052 non_dwarf_expr = true;
29053 break;
29054 default:
29055 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
29058 /* If it is safe to transform DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value
29059 into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_GNU_variable_value into
29060 DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, do so. */
29061 if (!non_dwarf_expr
29062 && (l->dw_loc_next != NULL || AT_class (av) == dw_val_class_loc))
29064 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_call4;
29065 if (l->dw_loc_next)
29066 l->dw_loc_next = NULL;
29067 else
29068 l->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
29069 return 0;
29072 /* For DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value, we can just
29073 copy over the DW_AT_location attribute from die to a. */
29074 if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
29076 a->dw_attr_val = av->dw_attr_val;
29077 return 1;
29080 dw_loc_list_ref list, *p;
29081 switch (AT_class (av))
29083 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
29084 p = &list;
29085 list = NULL;
29086 for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
29088 lv = copy_deref_exprloc (d->expr);
29089 if (lv)
29091 *p = new_loc_list (lv, d->begin, d->end, d->section);
29092 p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
29094 else if (!dwarf_strict && d->expr)
29095 return 0;
29097 if (list == NULL)
29098 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
29099 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
29100 gen_llsym (list);
29101 *AT_loc_list_ptr (a) = list;
29102 return 1;
29103 case dw_val_class_loc:
29104 lv = copy_deref_exprloc (AT_loc (av));
29105 if (lv == NULL)
29106 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
29107 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = lv;
29108 return 1;
29109 default:
29110 gcc_unreachable ();
29114 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
29115 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
29116 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
29117 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
29118 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
29119 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
29121 static void
29122 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
29124 dw_die_ref c;
29125 dw_attr_node *a;
29126 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
29127 unsigned ix;
29128 bool remove_AT_byte_size = false;
29130 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29131 switch (AT_class (a))
29133 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
29134 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
29135 loc = *curr;
29136 gcc_assert (loc);
29137 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
29138 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
29139 if (loc->replaced)
29140 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
29141 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
29143 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
29144 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
29145 References must be identical or completely separate.
29146 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
29147 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
29148 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
29149 while (*curr)
29151 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
29152 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (a, (*curr)->expr))
29154 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
29155 dw_loc_descr_ref l = (*curr)->expr;
29157 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
29159 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
29160 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
29162 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29163 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
29164 *curr = next;
29166 else
29168 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
29169 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
29172 if (loc == *start)
29173 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
29174 else
29176 loc->replaced = 1;
29177 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
29180 if (!*start)
29182 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29183 ix--;
29185 break;
29186 case dw_val_class_loc:
29188 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
29189 /* DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value or
29190 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in DW_AT_string_length can be converted
29191 into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, which is standard
29192 DWARF4 unlike DW_OP_GNU_variable_value. Or for DWARF5
29193 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value can be replaced
29194 with DW_FORM_ref referencing the same DIE as
29195 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value used to reference. */
29196 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length
29197 && l
29198 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
29199 && (l->dw_loc_next == NULL
29200 || (l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next == NULL
29201 && l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value)))
29203 switch (optimize_string_length (a))
29205 case -1:
29206 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29207 ix--;
29208 /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
29209 DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size. */
29210 remove_AT_byte_size = true;
29211 continue;
29212 default:
29213 break;
29214 case 1:
29215 /* Even if we keep the optimized DW_AT_string_length,
29216 it might have changed AT_class, so process it again. */
29217 ix--;
29218 continue;
29221 /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
29222 DW_AT_data_member_location containing
29223 DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
29224 rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
29225 but shorter, location description. */
29226 if ((dwarf_version > 2
29227 || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
29228 || l == NULL
29229 || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
29230 || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
29231 && !resolve_addr_in_expr (a, l))
29233 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29234 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
29235 if (l != NULL
29236 && l->dw_loc_next == NULL
29237 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
29238 && GET_CODE (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF
29239 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
29240 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_location)
29242 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr);
29243 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29244 ix--;
29245 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (die, decl);
29246 break;
29248 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length)
29249 /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
29250 DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size. */
29251 remove_AT_byte_size = true;
29252 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29253 ix--;
29255 else
29256 mark_base_types (l);
29258 break;
29259 case dw_val_class_addr:
29260 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
29261 && !resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr))
29263 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
29264 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
29265 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29266 ix--;
29268 if ((die->die_tag == DW_TAG_call_site
29269 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_call_origin)
29270 || (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
29271 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin))
29273 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
29274 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
29275 dw_die_ref cdie;
29276 if (tdie == NULL
29277 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
29278 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE
29279 && (cdie = lookup_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (tdecl))))
29281 dw_die_ref pdie = cdie;
29282 /* Make sure we don't add these DIEs into type units.
29283 We could emit skeleton DIEs for context (namespaces,
29284 outer structs/classes) and a skeleton DIE for the
29285 innermost context with DW_AT_signature pointing to the
29286 type unit. See PR78835. */
29287 while (pdie && pdie->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
29288 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
29289 if (pdie == NULL)
29291 /* Creating a full DIE for tdecl is overly expensive and
29292 at this point even wrong when in the LTO phase
29293 as it can end up generating new type DIEs we didn't
29294 output and thus optimize_external_refs will crash. */
29295 tdie = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, cdie, NULL_TREE);
29296 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_external, 1);
29297 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
29298 add_linkage_attr (tdie, tdecl);
29299 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (tdie, tdecl, true);
29300 equate_decl_number_to_die (tdecl, tdie);
29303 if (tdie)
29305 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29306 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
29307 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29309 else
29311 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
29312 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
29313 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29314 ix--;
29317 break;
29318 default:
29319 break;
29322 if (remove_AT_byte_size)
29323 remove_AT (die, dwarf_version >= 5
29324 ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
29325 : DW_AT_byte_size);
29327 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
29330 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
29331 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
29332 section. */
29334 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode into HSTATE. */
29336 static void
29337 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
29339 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29340 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29342 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
29344 case DW_OP_const4u:
29345 case DW_OP_const8u:
29346 if (loc->dtprel)
29347 goto hash_addr;
29348 /* FALLTHRU */
29349 case DW_OP_const1u:
29350 case DW_OP_const1s:
29351 case DW_OP_const2u:
29352 case DW_OP_const2s:
29353 case DW_OP_const4s:
29354 case DW_OP_const8s:
29355 case DW_OP_constu:
29356 case DW_OP_consts:
29357 case DW_OP_pick:
29358 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
29359 case DW_OP_breg0:
29360 case DW_OP_breg1:
29361 case DW_OP_breg2:
29362 case DW_OP_breg3:
29363 case DW_OP_breg4:
29364 case DW_OP_breg5:
29365 case DW_OP_breg6:
29366 case DW_OP_breg7:
29367 case DW_OP_breg8:
29368 case DW_OP_breg9:
29369 case DW_OP_breg10:
29370 case DW_OP_breg11:
29371 case DW_OP_breg12:
29372 case DW_OP_breg13:
29373 case DW_OP_breg14:
29374 case DW_OP_breg15:
29375 case DW_OP_breg16:
29376 case DW_OP_breg17:
29377 case DW_OP_breg18:
29378 case DW_OP_breg19:
29379 case DW_OP_breg20:
29380 case DW_OP_breg21:
29381 case DW_OP_breg22:
29382 case DW_OP_breg23:
29383 case DW_OP_breg24:
29384 case DW_OP_breg25:
29385 case DW_OP_breg26:
29386 case DW_OP_breg27:
29387 case DW_OP_breg28:
29388 case DW_OP_breg29:
29389 case DW_OP_breg30:
29390 case DW_OP_breg31:
29391 case DW_OP_regx:
29392 case DW_OP_fbreg:
29393 case DW_OP_piece:
29394 case DW_OP_deref_size:
29395 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
29396 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29397 break;
29398 case DW_OP_skip:
29399 case DW_OP_bra:
29401 int offset;
29403 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
29404 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
29405 hstate.add_object (offset);
29407 break;
29408 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
29409 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
29410 switch (val2->val_class)
29412 case dw_val_class_const:
29413 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29414 break;
29415 case dw_val_class_vec:
29417 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
29418 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
29420 hstate.add_int (elt_size);
29421 hstate.add_int (len);
29422 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
29424 break;
29425 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29426 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
29427 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
29428 break;
29429 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29430 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
29431 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
29432 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
29433 break;
29434 case dw_val_class_addr:
29435 inchash::add_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hstate);
29436 break;
29437 default:
29438 gcc_unreachable ();
29440 break;
29441 case DW_OP_bregx:
29442 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
29443 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29444 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29445 break;
29446 case DW_OP_addr:
29447 hash_addr:
29448 if (loc->dtprel)
29450 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
29451 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
29453 inchash::add_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hstate);
29454 break;
29455 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
29456 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
29458 if (loc->dtprel)
29460 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
29461 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
29463 inchash::add_rtx (val1->val_entry->addr.rtl, hstate);
29465 break;
29466 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29467 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29468 hstate.add_int (val2->v.val_int);
29469 break;
29470 case DW_OP_entry_value:
29471 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29472 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_loc);
29473 break;
29474 case DW_OP_regval_type:
29475 case DW_OP_deref_type:
29476 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29477 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29479 unsigned int byte_size
29480 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
29481 unsigned int encoding
29482 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
29483 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29484 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
29485 hstate.add_object (encoding);
29487 break;
29488 case DW_OP_convert:
29489 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29490 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29491 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29492 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29494 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
29495 break;
29497 /* FALLTHRU */
29498 case DW_OP_const_type:
29499 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29501 unsigned int byte_size
29502 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
29503 unsigned int encoding
29504 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
29505 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
29506 hstate.add_object (encoding);
29507 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_const_type
29508 && loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
29509 break;
29510 hstate.add_object (val2->val_class);
29511 switch (val2->val_class)
29513 case dw_val_class_const:
29514 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29515 break;
29516 case dw_val_class_vec:
29518 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
29519 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
29521 hstate.add_object (elt_size);
29522 hstate.add_object (len);
29523 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
29525 break;
29526 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29527 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
29528 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
29529 break;
29530 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29531 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
29532 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
29533 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
29534 break;
29535 default:
29536 gcc_unreachable ();
29539 break;
29541 default:
29542 /* Other codes have no operands. */
29543 break;
29547 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC into HSTATE. */
29549 static inline void
29550 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
29552 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
29553 bool sizes_computed = false;
29554 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
29555 size_of_locs (loc);
29557 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
29559 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
29560 hstate.add_object (opc);
29561 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
29563 size_of_locs (loc);
29564 sizes_computed = true;
29566 hash_loc_operands (l, hstate);
29570 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
29572 static inline void
29573 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
29575 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
29576 inchash::hash hstate;
29578 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
29580 hstate.add (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1);
29581 hstate.add (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1);
29582 if (curr->section)
29583 hstate.add (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1);
29584 hash_locs (curr->expr, hstate);
29586 list_head->hash = hstate.end ();
29589 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
29591 static inline bool
29592 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
29594 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29595 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29596 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29597 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29599 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
29601 case DW_OP_const4u:
29602 case DW_OP_const8u:
29603 if (x->dtprel)
29604 goto hash_addr;
29605 /* FALLTHRU */
29606 case DW_OP_const1u:
29607 case DW_OP_const1s:
29608 case DW_OP_const2u:
29609 case DW_OP_const2s:
29610 case DW_OP_const4s:
29611 case DW_OP_const8s:
29612 case DW_OP_constu:
29613 case DW_OP_consts:
29614 case DW_OP_pick:
29615 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
29616 case DW_OP_breg0:
29617 case DW_OP_breg1:
29618 case DW_OP_breg2:
29619 case DW_OP_breg3:
29620 case DW_OP_breg4:
29621 case DW_OP_breg5:
29622 case DW_OP_breg6:
29623 case DW_OP_breg7:
29624 case DW_OP_breg8:
29625 case DW_OP_breg9:
29626 case DW_OP_breg10:
29627 case DW_OP_breg11:
29628 case DW_OP_breg12:
29629 case DW_OP_breg13:
29630 case DW_OP_breg14:
29631 case DW_OP_breg15:
29632 case DW_OP_breg16:
29633 case DW_OP_breg17:
29634 case DW_OP_breg18:
29635 case DW_OP_breg19:
29636 case DW_OP_breg20:
29637 case DW_OP_breg21:
29638 case DW_OP_breg22:
29639 case DW_OP_breg23:
29640 case DW_OP_breg24:
29641 case DW_OP_breg25:
29642 case DW_OP_breg26:
29643 case DW_OP_breg27:
29644 case DW_OP_breg28:
29645 case DW_OP_breg29:
29646 case DW_OP_breg30:
29647 case DW_OP_breg31:
29648 case DW_OP_regx:
29649 case DW_OP_fbreg:
29650 case DW_OP_piece:
29651 case DW_OP_deref_size:
29652 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
29653 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
29654 case DW_OP_skip:
29655 case DW_OP_bra:
29656 /* If splitting debug info, the use of DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
29657 can cause irrelevant differences in dw_loc_addr. */
29658 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
29659 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
29660 && (dwarf_split_debug_info
29661 || x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr));
29662 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
29663 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
29664 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
29665 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
29666 return false;
29667 switch (valx2->val_class)
29669 case dw_val_class_const:
29670 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29671 case dw_val_class_vec:
29672 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29673 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
29674 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
29675 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29676 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
29677 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29678 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
29679 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
29680 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29681 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
29682 case dw_val_class_addr:
29683 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
29684 default:
29685 gcc_unreachable ();
29687 case DW_OP_bregx:
29688 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
29689 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
29690 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29691 case DW_OP_addr:
29692 hash_addr:
29693 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
29694 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
29695 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
29697 rtx ax1 = valx1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
29698 rtx ay1 = valy1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
29699 return rtx_equal_p (ax1, ay1);
29701 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29702 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29703 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
29704 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
29705 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
29706 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29707 case DW_OP_entry_value:
29708 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29709 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
29710 case DW_OP_const_type:
29711 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29712 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
29713 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
29714 return false;
29715 switch (valx2->val_class)
29717 case dw_val_class_const:
29718 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29719 case dw_val_class_vec:
29720 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29721 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
29722 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
29723 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29724 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
29725 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29726 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
29727 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
29728 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29729 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
29730 default:
29731 gcc_unreachable ();
29733 case DW_OP_regval_type:
29734 case DW_OP_deref_type:
29735 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29736 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29737 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
29738 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
29739 case DW_OP_convert:
29740 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29741 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29742 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29743 if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
29744 return false;
29745 if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29746 return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
29747 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
29748 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
29749 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
29750 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
29751 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
29752 default:
29753 /* Other codes have no operands. */
29754 return true;
29758 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
29760 static inline bool
29761 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
29763 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
29764 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
29765 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
29766 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
29767 break;
29768 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
29771 /* Hashtable helpers. */
29773 struct loc_list_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <dw_loc_list_struct>
29775 static inline hashval_t hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *);
29776 static inline bool equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *,
29777 const dw_loc_list_struct *);
29780 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
29782 inline hashval_t
29783 loc_list_hasher::hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *x)
29785 return x->hash;
29788 /* Return true if location lists A and B are the same. */
29790 inline bool
29791 loc_list_hasher::equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *a,
29792 const dw_loc_list_struct *b)
29794 if (a == b)
29795 return 1;
29796 if (a->hash != b->hash)
29797 return 0;
29798 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
29799 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
29800 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
29801 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
29802 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
29803 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
29804 break;
29805 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
29808 typedef hash_table<loc_list_hasher> loc_list_hash_type;
29811 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
29812 children and share them whenever possible. */
29814 static void
29815 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, loc_list_hash_type *htab)
29817 dw_die_ref c;
29818 dw_attr_node *a;
29819 unsigned ix;
29820 dw_loc_list_struct **slot;
29822 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29823 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
29825 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
29826 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
29827 it and storing into the hash table. */
29828 hash_loc_list (list);
29829 slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (list, list->hash, INSERT);
29830 if (*slot == NULL)
29831 *slot = list;
29832 else
29833 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = *slot;
29836 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
29840 /* Recursively assign each location list a unique index into the debug_addr
29841 section. */
29843 static void
29844 index_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
29846 dw_die_ref c;
29847 dw_attr_node *a;
29848 unsigned ix;
29850 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29851 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
29853 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
29854 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
29855 for (curr = list; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
29857 /* Don't index an entry that has already been indexed
29858 or won't be output. */
29859 if (curr->begin_entry != NULL
29860 || (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force))
29861 continue;
29863 curr->begin_entry
29864 = add_addr_table_entry (xstrdup (curr->begin), ate_kind_label);
29868 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, index_location_lists (c));
29871 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
29872 children and share them whenever possible. */
29874 static void
29875 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
29877 loc_list_hash_type htab (500);
29878 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, &htab);
29881 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
29882 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
29883 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
29884 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
29885 instance. */
29887 static void
29888 flush_limbo_die_list (void)
29890 limbo_die_node *node;
29892 /* get_context_die calls force_decl_die, which can put new DIEs on the
29893 limbo list in LTO mode when nested functions are put in a different
29894 partition than that of their parent function. */
29895 while ((node = limbo_die_list))
29897 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
29898 limbo_die_list = node->next;
29900 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
29902 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
29904 if (origin && origin->die_parent)
29905 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
29906 else if (is_cu_die (die))
29908 else if (seen_error ())
29909 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
29910 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
29911 else
29913 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
29914 nested function can be optimized away, which results
29915 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
29916 with the return type of that nested function. Force
29917 this to be a child of the containing function.
29919 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
29920 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
29921 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
29922 the function is likely unreachable too. */
29923 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
29925 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
29926 origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
29927 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
29928 origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
29929 else
29930 origin = comp_unit_die ();
29932 add_child_die (origin, die);
29938 /* Reset DIEs so we can output them again. */
29940 static void
29941 reset_dies (dw_die_ref die)
29943 dw_die_ref c;
29945 /* Remove stuff we re-generate. */
29946 die->die_mark = 0;
29947 die->die_offset = 0;
29948 die->die_abbrev = 0;
29949 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_sibling);
29951 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, reset_dies (c));
29954 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
29955 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
29957 static void
29958 dwarf2out_finish (const char *)
29960 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
29961 dw_die_ref main_comp_unit_die;
29962 unsigned char checksum[16];
29963 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
29965 /* Flush out any latecomers to the limbo party. */
29966 flush_limbo_die_list ();
29968 if (flag_checking)
29970 verify_die (comp_unit_die ());
29971 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29972 verify_die (node->die);
29975 /* We shouldn't have any symbols with delayed asm names for
29976 DIEs generated after early finish. */
29977 gcc_assert (deferred_asm_name == NULL);
29979 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
29981 if (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload)
29983 gcc_assert (flag_fat_lto_objects || flag_generate_offload);
29985 /* Prune stuff so that dwarf2out_finish runs successfully
29986 for the fat part of the object. */
29987 reset_dies (comp_unit_die ());
29988 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29989 reset_dies (node->die);
29991 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
29992 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29994 comdat_type_node **slot
29995 = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
29997 /* Don't reset types twice. */
29998 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
29999 continue;
30001 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
30002 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
30003 attributes. */
30004 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
30005 reset_dies (ctnode->root_die);
30007 *slot = ctnode;
30010 /* Reset die CU symbol so we don't output it twice. */
30011 comp_unit_die ()->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
30013 /* Remove DW_AT_macro from the early output. */
30014 if (have_macinfo)
30015 remove_AT (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE);
30017 /* Remove indirect string decisions. */
30018 debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, reset_indirect_string> (NULL);
30021 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
30023 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
30024 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
30026 #endif
30027 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
30028 move_marked_base_types ();
30030 /* Initialize sections and labels used for actual assembler output. */
30031 unsigned generation = init_sections_and_labels (false);
30033 /* Traverse the DIE's and add sibling attributes to those DIE's that
30034 have children. */
30035 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
30036 limbo_die_node *node;
30037 for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30038 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
30039 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30040 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
30042 /* When splitting DWARF info, we put some attributes in the
30043 skeleton compile_unit DIE that remains in the .o, while
30044 most attributes go in the DWO compile_unit_die. */
30045 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30047 limbo_die_node *cu;
30048 main_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
30049 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30050 main_comp_unit_die->die_tag = DW_TAG_skeleton_unit;
30051 cu = limbo_die_list;
30052 gcc_assert (cu->die == main_comp_unit_die);
30053 limbo_die_list = limbo_die_list->next;
30054 cu->next = cu_die_list;
30055 cu_die_list = cu;
30057 else
30058 main_comp_unit_die = comp_unit_die ();
30060 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
30061 switch_to_section (text_section);
30062 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
30063 if (cold_text_section)
30065 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
30066 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
30069 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
30070 in .text. */
30071 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
30072 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
30074 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
30075 if (text_section_used)
30076 add_AT_low_high_pc (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
30077 text_end_label, true);
30079 else
30081 unsigned fde_idx;
30082 dw_fde_ref fde;
30083 bool range_list_added = false;
30085 if (text_section_used)
30086 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
30087 text_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
30088 if (cold_text_section_used)
30089 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
30090 cold_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
30092 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
30094 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
30095 continue;
30096 if (!fde->in_std_section)
30097 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
30098 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
30099 true);
30100 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
30101 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
30102 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added,
30103 true);
30106 if (range_list_added)
30108 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
30109 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
30110 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
30111 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
30112 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
30113 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx, true);
30114 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
30115 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx, true);
30117 add_ranges (NULL);
30121 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
30122 offset expected by debuggers. */
30123 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_section_label);
30124 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
30125 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
30127 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
30128 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
30129 dl_section_ref);
30131 if (have_macinfo)
30132 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
30133 macinfo_section_label);
30135 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30137 if (have_location_lists)
30139 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30140 add_AT_loclistsptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_loclists_base,
30141 loc_section_label);
30142 /* optimize_location_lists calculates the size of the lists,
30143 so index them first, and assign indices to the entries.
30144 Although optimize_location_lists will remove entries from
30145 the table, it only does so for duplicates, and therefore
30146 only reduces ref_counts to 1. */
30147 index_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
30150 if (addr_index_table != NULL)
30152 unsigned int index = 0;
30153 addr_index_table
30154 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_addr_table_entry>
30155 (&index);
30159 loc_list_idx = 0;
30160 if (have_location_lists)
30162 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
30163 /* And finally assign indexes to the entries for -gsplit-dwarf. */
30164 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
30165 assign_location_list_indexes (comp_unit_die ());
30168 save_macinfo_strings ();
30170 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30172 unsigned int index = 0;
30174 /* Add attributes common to skeleton compile_units and
30175 type_units. Because these attributes include strings, it
30176 must be done before freezing the string table. Top-level
30177 skeleton die attrs are added when the skeleton type unit is
30178 created, so ensure it is created by this point. */
30179 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (main_comp_unit_die);
30180 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
30183 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
30184 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
30185 for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30186 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
30188 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
30189 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30191 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
30193 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
30194 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
30195 continue;
30197 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
30198 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
30199 attributes. */
30200 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
30201 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
30202 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
30203 ? dl_section_ref
30204 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
30206 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
30207 *slot = ctnode;
30210 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30212 int mark;
30213 struct md5_ctx ctx;
30215 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && !vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30216 index_rnglists ();
30218 /* Compute a checksum of the comp_unit to use as the dwo_id. */
30219 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
30220 mark = 0;
30221 die_checksum (comp_unit_die (), &ctx, &mark);
30222 unmark_all_dies (comp_unit_die ());
30223 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
30225 if (dwarf_version < 5)
30227 /* Use the first 8 bytes of the checksum as the dwo_id,
30228 and add it to both comp-unit DIEs. */
30229 add_AT_data8 (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
30230 add_AT_data8 (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
30233 /* Add the base offset of the ranges table to the skeleton
30234 comp-unit DIE. */
30235 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30237 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30238 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_rnglists_base,
30239 ranges_base_label);
30240 else
30241 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_ranges_base,
30242 ranges_section_label);
30245 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
30246 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_addr_section_label);
30247 output_addr_table ();
30250 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
30251 or .debug_macro will be emitted. */
30252 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo,
30253 dwarf_split_debug_info ? checksum : NULL);
30255 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
30256 output_skeleton_debug_sections (main_comp_unit_die, checksum);
30258 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
30259 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
30261 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
30262 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
30263 output_abbrev_section ();
30266 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
30267 if (have_location_lists)
30269 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
30270 char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
30271 /* Output the location lists info. */
30272 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
30273 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30275 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 1);
30276 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 2);
30277 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
30278 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
30279 "Initial length escape value indicating "
30280 "64-bit DWARF extension");
30281 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
30282 "Length of Location Lists");
30283 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
30284 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
30285 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
30286 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
30287 dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? loc_list_idx : 0,
30288 "Offset Entry Count");
30290 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
30291 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
30293 unsigned int save_loc_list_idx = loc_list_idx;
30294 loc_list_idx = 0;
30295 output_loclists_offsets (comp_unit_die ());
30296 gcc_assert (save_loc_list_idx == loc_list_idx);
30298 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
30299 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30300 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
30303 output_pubtables ();
30305 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
30306 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
30307 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
30308 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
30309 generate a table that would have contained data. */
30310 if (info_section_emitted)
30312 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
30313 output_aranges ();
30316 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
30317 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30319 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30320 output_rnglists (generation);
30321 else
30322 output_ranges ();
30325 /* Have to end the macro section. */
30326 if (have_macinfo)
30328 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
30329 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
30330 output_macinfo (!dwarf_split_debug_info ? debug_line_section_label
30331 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label, false);
30332 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
30335 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
30336 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
30337 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
30338 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
30339 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
30340 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
30341 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
30342 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
30343 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
30344 output_line_info (false);
30346 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
30348 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
30349 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
30350 output_line_info (true);
30353 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
30354 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
30355 output_indirect_strings ();
30356 if (debug_line_str_hash)
30358 switch_to_section (debug_line_str_section);
30359 const enum dwarf_form form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
30360 debug_line_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
30361 output_indirect_string> (form);
30365 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a variable_value_struct). */
30367 inline hashval_t
30368 variable_value_hasher::hash (variable_value_struct *x)
30370 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
30373 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of variable_value_struct X is the same as
30374 UID of decl Y. */
30376 inline bool
30377 variable_value_hasher::equal (variable_value_struct *x, tree y)
30379 return x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y);
30382 /* Helper function for resolve_variable_value, handle
30383 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in one location expression.
30384 Return true if exprloc has been changed into loclist. */
30386 static bool
30387 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
30389 dw_loc_descr_ref next;
30390 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = next)
30392 next = loc->dw_loc_next;
30393 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30394 || loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_decl_ref)
30395 continue;
30397 tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
30398 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) != current_function_decl)
30399 continue;
30401 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30402 if (ref)
30404 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30405 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30406 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30407 continue;
30409 dw_loc_list_ref l = loc_list_from_tree (decl, 0, NULL);
30410 if (l == NULL)
30411 continue;
30412 if (l->dw_loc_next)
30414 if (AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
30415 continue;
30416 switch (a->dw_attr)
30418 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and loclist
30419 classes, so we can change them into a loclist. */
30420 case DW_AT_location:
30421 case DW_AT_string_length:
30422 case DW_AT_return_addr:
30423 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
30424 case DW_AT_frame_base:
30425 case DW_AT_segment:
30426 case DW_AT_static_link:
30427 case DW_AT_use_location:
30428 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
30429 if (prev)
30431 prev->dw_loc_next = NULL;
30432 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (l, AT_loc (a));
30434 if (next)
30435 add_loc_descr_to_each (l, next);
30436 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
30437 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
30438 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = l;
30439 have_location_lists = true;
30440 return true;
30441 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
30442 so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value alone
30443 we could transform it into reference. */
30444 case DW_AT_byte_size:
30445 case DW_AT_bit_size:
30446 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
30447 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
30448 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
30449 case DW_AT_count:
30450 case DW_AT_allocated:
30451 case DW_AT_associated:
30452 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
30453 if (prev == NULL && next == NULL)
30454 break;
30455 /* FALLTHRU */
30456 default:
30457 if (dwarf_strict)
30458 continue;
30459 break;
30461 /* Create DW_TAG_variable that we can refer to. */
30462 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL,
30463 lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl));
30464 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30465 if (ref)
30467 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30468 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30469 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30471 continue;
30473 if (prev)
30475 prev->dw_loc_next = l->expr;
30476 add_loc_descr (&prev->dw_loc_next, next);
30477 free_loc_descr (loc, NULL);
30478 next = prev->dw_loc_next;
30480 else
30482 memcpy (loc, l->expr, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
30483 add_loc_descr (&loc, next);
30484 next = loc;
30486 loc = prev;
30488 return false;
30491 /* Attempt to resolve DW_OP_GNU_variable_value using loc_list_from_tree. */
30493 static void
30494 resolve_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
30496 dw_attr_node *a;
30497 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
30498 unsigned ix;
30500 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30501 switch (AT_class (a))
30503 case dw_val_class_loc:
30504 if (!resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, AT_loc (a)))
30505 break;
30506 /* FALLTHRU */
30507 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30508 loc = AT_loc_list (a);
30509 gcc_assert (loc);
30510 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30511 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, loc->expr);
30512 break;
30513 default:
30514 break;
30518 /* Attempt to optimize DW_OP_GNU_variable_value refering to
30519 temporaries in the current function. */
30521 static void
30522 resolve_variable_values (void)
30524 if (!variable_value_hash || !current_function_decl)
30525 return;
30527 struct variable_value_struct *node
30528 = variable_value_hash->find_with_hash (current_function_decl,
30529 DECL_UID (current_function_decl));
30531 if (node == NULL)
30532 return;
30534 unsigned int i;
30535 dw_die_ref die;
30536 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (node->dies, i, die)
30537 resolve_variable_value (die);
30540 /* Helper function for note_variable_value, handle one location
30541 expression. */
30543 static void
30544 note_variable_value_in_expr (dw_die_ref die, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
30546 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30547 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30548 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
30550 tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
30551 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30552 if (! ref && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
30554 /* ??? This is somewhat a hack because we do not create DIEs
30555 for variables not in BLOCK trees early but when generating
30556 early LTO output we need the dw_val_class_decl_ref to be
30557 fully resolved. For fat LTO objects we'd also like to
30558 undo this after LTO dwarf output. */
30559 gcc_assert (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
30560 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
30561 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL);
30562 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL, ctx);
30563 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30564 gcc_assert (ref != NULL);
30566 if (ref)
30568 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30569 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30570 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30571 continue;
30573 if (VAR_P (decl)
30574 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
30575 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL
30576 && lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)))
30578 if (!variable_value_hash)
30579 variable_value_hash
30580 = hash_table<variable_value_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
30582 tree fndecl = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
30583 struct variable_value_struct *node;
30584 struct variable_value_struct **slot
30585 = variable_value_hash->find_slot_with_hash (fndecl,
30586 DECL_UID (fndecl),
30587 INSERT);
30588 if (*slot == NULL)
30590 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<variable_value_struct> ();
30591 node->decl_id = DECL_UID (fndecl);
30592 *slot = node;
30594 else
30595 node = *slot;
30597 vec_safe_push (node->dies, die);
30602 /* Walk the tree DIE and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
30603 with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand. */
30605 static void
30606 note_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
30608 dw_die_ref c;
30609 dw_attr_node *a;
30610 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
30611 unsigned ix;
30613 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30614 switch (AT_class (a))
30616 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30617 loc = AT_loc_list (a);
30618 gcc_assert (loc);
30619 if (!loc->noted_variable_value)
30621 loc->noted_variable_value = 1;
30622 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30623 note_variable_value_in_expr (die, loc->expr);
30625 break;
30626 case dw_val_class_loc:
30627 note_variable_value_in_expr (die, AT_loc (a));
30628 break;
30629 default:
30630 break;
30633 /* Mark children. */
30634 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, note_variable_value (c));
30637 /* Perform any cleanups needed after the early debug generation pass
30638 has run. */
30640 static void
30641 dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *filename)
30643 set_early_dwarf s;
30645 /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
30646 header compilation, so always fill it with empty string initially
30647 and overwrite only here. */
30648 dw_attr_node *producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
30649 producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
30650 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
30651 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = find_AT_string (producer_string);
30653 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
30654 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
30655 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
30656 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
30658 /* When emitting DWARF5 .debug_line_str, move DW_AT_name and
30659 DW_AT_comp_dir into .debug_line_str section. */
30660 if (!DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
30661 && dwarf_version >= 5
30662 && DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
30664 for (int i = 0; i < 2; i++)
30666 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (comp_unit_die (),
30667 i ? DW_AT_comp_dir : DW_AT_name);
30668 if (a == NULL
30669 || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_str
30670 || strlen (AT_string (a)) + 1 <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
30671 continue;
30673 if (! debug_line_str_hash)
30674 debug_line_str_hash
30675 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
30677 struct indirect_string_node *node
30678 = find_AT_string_in_table (AT_string (a), debug_line_str_hash);
30679 set_indirect_string (node);
30680 node->form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
30681 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
30682 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
30686 /* With LTO early dwarf was really finished at compile-time, so make
30687 sure to adjust the phase after annotating the LTRANS CU DIE. */
30688 if (in_lto_p)
30690 early_dwarf_finished = true;
30691 return;
30694 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
30695 emit full debugging info for them. */
30696 retry_incomplete_types ();
30698 /* The point here is to flush out the limbo list so that it is empty
30699 and we don't need to stream it for LTO. */
30700 flush_limbo_die_list ();
30702 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
30703 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
30705 /* Add DW_AT_linkage_name for all deferred DIEs. */
30706 for (limbo_die_node *node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
30708 tree decl = node->created_for;
30709 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
30710 /* A missing DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME can be a constant DIE that
30711 ended up in deferred_asm_name before we knew it was
30712 constant and never written to disk. */
30713 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl))
30715 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
30716 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
30719 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
30721 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
30722 prune_unused_types ();
30724 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
30725 if (use_debug_types)
30727 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
30729 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
30730 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
30731 limbo die list. */
30732 limbo_die_list = NULL;
30734 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
30735 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
30736 references to the main compile unit). */
30737 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30738 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30739 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
30740 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
30742 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
30743 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
30744 referenced. Prune them. */
30745 prune_unused_types ();
30748 /* Traverse the DIE's and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
30749 with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand. */
30750 note_variable_value (comp_unit_die ());
30751 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30752 note_variable_value (node->die);
30753 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL;
30754 ctnode = ctnode->next)
30755 note_variable_value (ctnode->root_die);
30756 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30757 note_variable_value (node->die);
30759 /* The AT_pubnames attribute needs to go in all skeleton dies, including
30760 both the main_cu and all skeleton TUs. Making this call unconditional
30761 would end up either adding a second copy of the AT_pubnames attribute, or
30762 requiring a special case in add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs. */
30763 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
30764 add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
30766 /* The early debug phase is now finished. */
30767 early_dwarf_finished = true;
30769 /* Do not generate DWARF assembler now when not producing LTO bytecode. */
30770 if (!flag_generate_lto && !flag_generate_offload)
30771 return;
30773 /* Now as we are going to output for LTO initialize sections and labels
30774 to the LTO variants. We don't need a random-seed postfix as other
30775 LTO sections as linking the LTO debug sections into one in a partial
30776 link is fine. */
30777 init_sections_and_labels (true);
30779 /* The output below is modeled after dwarf2out_finish with all
30780 location related output removed and some LTO specific changes.
30781 Some refactoring might make both smaller and easier to match up. */
30783 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
30784 that have children. */
30785 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
30786 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30787 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
30788 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30789 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30790 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
30792 if (have_macinfo)
30793 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
30794 macinfo_section_label);
30796 save_macinfo_strings ();
30798 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
30799 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
30800 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30801 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
30803 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
30804 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30805 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30807 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
30809 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
30810 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
30811 continue;
30813 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
30814 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
30815 attributes. */
30816 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
30817 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
30818 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
30819 ? debug_line_section_label
30820 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
30822 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
30823 *slot = ctnode;
30826 /* Stick a unique symbol to the main debuginfo section. */
30827 compute_comp_unit_symbol (comp_unit_die ());
30829 /* Output the main compilation unit. We always need it if only for
30830 the CU symbol. */
30831 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), true, NULL);
30833 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
30834 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
30836 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
30837 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
30838 output_abbrev_section ();
30841 /* Have to end the macro section. */
30842 if (have_macinfo)
30844 /* We have to save macinfo state if we need to output it again
30845 for the FAT part of the object. */
30846 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *saved_macinfo_table = macinfo_table;
30847 if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
30848 macinfo_table = macinfo_table->copy ();
30850 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
30851 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
30852 output_macinfo (debug_skeleton_line_section_label, true);
30853 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
30855 /* Emit a skeleton debug_line section. */
30856 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
30857 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
30858 output_line_info (true);
30860 if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
30862 vec_free (macinfo_table);
30863 macinfo_table = saved_macinfo_table;
30868 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
30869 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
30870 output_indirect_strings ();
30872 /* Switch back to the text section. */
30873 switch_to_section (text_section);
30876 /* Reset all state within dwarf2out.c so that we can rerun the compiler
30877 within the same process. For use by toplev::finalize. */
30879 void
30880 dwarf2out_c_finalize (void)
30882 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
30883 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
30884 used_rtx_array = NULL;
30885 incomplete_types = NULL;
30886 decl_scope_table = NULL;
30887 debug_info_section = NULL;
30888 debug_skeleton_info_section = NULL;
30889 debug_abbrev_section = NULL;
30890 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = NULL;
30891 debug_aranges_section = NULL;
30892 debug_addr_section = NULL;
30893 debug_macinfo_section = NULL;
30894 debug_line_section = NULL;
30895 debug_skeleton_line_section = NULL;
30896 debug_loc_section = NULL;
30897 debug_pubnames_section = NULL;
30898 debug_pubtypes_section = NULL;
30899 debug_str_section = NULL;
30900 debug_line_str_section = NULL;
30901 debug_str_dwo_section = NULL;
30902 debug_str_offsets_section = NULL;
30903 debug_ranges_section = NULL;
30904 debug_frame_section = NULL;
30905 fde_vec = NULL;
30906 debug_str_hash = NULL;
30907 debug_line_str_hash = NULL;
30908 skeleton_debug_str_hash = NULL;
30909 dw2_string_counter = 0;
30910 have_multiple_function_sections = false;
30911 text_section_used = false;
30912 cold_text_section_used = false;
30913 cold_text_section = NULL;
30914 current_unit_personality = NULL;
30916 early_dwarf = false;
30917 early_dwarf_finished = false;
30919 next_die_offset = 0;
30920 single_comp_unit_die = NULL;
30921 comdat_type_list = NULL;
30922 limbo_die_list = NULL;
30923 file_table = NULL;
30924 decl_die_table = NULL;
30925 common_block_die_table = NULL;
30926 decl_loc_table = NULL;
30927 call_arg_locations = NULL;
30928 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
30929 call_site_count = -1;
30930 tail_call_site_count = -1;
30931 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
30932 abbrev_die_table = NULL;
30933 delete dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
30934 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = NULL;
30935 line_info_label_num = 0;
30936 cur_line_info_table = NULL;
30937 text_section_line_info = NULL;
30938 cold_text_section_line_info = NULL;
30939 separate_line_info = NULL;
30940 info_section_emitted = false;
30941 pubname_table = NULL;
30942 pubtype_table = NULL;
30943 macinfo_table = NULL;
30944 ranges_table = NULL;
30945 ranges_by_label = NULL;
30946 rnglist_idx = 0;
30947 have_location_lists = false;
30948 loclabel_num = 0;
30949 poc_label_num = 0;
30950 last_emitted_file = NULL;
30951 label_num = 0;
30952 tmpl_value_parm_die_table = NULL;
30953 generic_type_instances = NULL;
30954 frame_pointer_fb_offset = 0;
30955 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid = false;
30956 base_types.release ();
30957 XDELETEVEC (producer_string);
30958 producer_string = NULL;
30961 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"